WEBB DEL CORP
10-K405, 1996-09-10
OPERATIVE BUILDERS
Previous: WATSCO INC, SC 13G/A, 1996-09-10
Next: WESTVACO CORP, 10-Q, 1996-09-10



                                  UNITED STATES
                       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                             Washington, D.C. 20549

                                    FORM 10-K

[X] Annual Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act
    of 1934. For the fiscal year July 1, 1995 to June 30, 1996.

[ ] Transition Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange
    Act of 1934. For the transition period from N/A to N/A .
                                               -----  -----
Commission File Number:  1-4785

                              DEL WEBB CORPORATION
             (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)


                Delaware                                  86-0077724
        (State of Incorporation)            (IRS Employer Identification Number)

6001 North 24th Street, Phoenix, Arizona                    85016
(Address of principal executive offices)                  (Zip Code)

                                 (602) 808-8000
                (Registrant's phone number, including area code)

           Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

            Title of each class        Name of each exchange on which registered
            -------------------        -----------------------------------------
                                                   New York Stock Exchange
  Common Stock (par value $.001 per share)         Pacific Stock Exchange

       10 7/8% Senior Notes due 2000               New York Stock Exchange
9 3/4% Senior Subordinated Debentures due 2003     New York Stock Exchange
 9% Senior Subordinated Debentures due 2006        New York Stock Exchange

           Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:
                                      NONE

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required
to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during
the  preceding 12 months (or for such  shorter  period that the  registrant  was
required  to file  such  reports),  and  (2) has  been  subject  to such  filing
requirements for the past 90 days. Yes  X   No     .
                                      -----   -----

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent  filers  pursuant to Item 405
of Regulation  S-K is not contained  herein,  and will not be contained,  to the
best of Registrant's  knowledge,  in definitive proxy or information  statements
incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this
Form 10-K. [X]

Registrant's Common Stock outstanding at July 31, 1996 was 17,537,903 shares. At
that date,  the  aggregate  market value of  Registrant's  Common shares held by
non-affiliates, based upon the closing price of the Common Stock on the New York
Stock Exchange on that date, was approximately $306,900,000.

                       Documents Incorporated by Reference

Portions of  Registrant's  definitive  Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of
Shareholders  to be held on  November  14, 1996 are  incorporated  herein as set
forth in Part III of this Annual Report.
<PAGE>
                              DEL WEBB CORPORATION
                             FORM 10-K ANNUAL REPORT
                            For the Fiscal Year Ended
                                  June 30, 1996

                                TABLE OF CONTENTS

                                     PART I

Item 1.                                                                     PAGE
  and                                                                    
Item 2.       Business and Properties

              The Company..................................................... 1
              Master-Planned Communities...................................... 1
              Potential Future Communities.................................... 3
              Conventional Homebuilding....................................... 4
              Product Design.................................................. 4
              Construction.................................................... 4
              Sales Activities................................................ 4
              Other Real Estate Activity.......................................5
              Competition..................................................... 5
              Certain Factors Affecting the Company's Operations.............. 6
              Executive Officers of the Company............................... 8
              Employees.......................................................10

Item 3.       Legal Proceedings...............................................10

Item 4.       Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders.............10





                                     PART II

Item 5.       Market for the Registrant's Common Equity and
                Related Stockholder Matters...................................11

Item 6.       Selected Consolidated Financial Data............................12

Item 7.       Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition
                and Results of Operations
                  Certain Consolidated Financial and Operating Data...........14
                  Results of Operations.......................................16
                  Liquidity and Financial Condition of the Company............19
                  Impact of Inflation.........................................20
<PAGE>
                          TABLE OF CONTENTS (continued)

                               PART II (Continued)

                                                                            PAGE
                                                                            

Item  8.      Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.....................20

Item  9.      Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants
                on Accounting and Financial Disclosure........................20


                                    PART III

Item 10.      Directors and Executive Officers of the Registrant..............21

Item 11.      Executive Compensation..........................................21

Item 12.      Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners
                and Management................................................21

Item 13.      Certain Relationships and Related Transactions..................21


                                     PART IV

Item 14.      Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules and
                Reports on Form 8-K...........................................22
<PAGE>
                                     PART I

Items 1. and 2.            Business and Properties

THE COMPANY

Del  Webb   Corporation   develops   large-scale,   master-planned   residential
communities,  primarily for active adults age 55 and over,  and has  significant
conventional subdivision homebuilding operations.

The Company is one of the nation's leading  developers of age-restricted  active
adult  communities.  It has extensive  experience in the active adult  community
business,  having  built and sold more  than  52,000  homes at its nine Sun City
communities  over the past 36 years.  The  Company is also  delivering  homes at
Terravita, a gate-guarded, amenity-rich, master-planned residential community in
north  Scottsdale,  Arizona,  that is not  age-restricted.  The Company designs,
develops and markets  these  communities,  controlling  all phases of the master
plan development  process from land selection  through the construction and sale
of homes.  Within its  communities,  the Company is the  exclusive  developer of
homes.

The Company conducts its conventional  subdivision homebuilding operations under
the name "Coventry Homes" in the Phoenix,  Tucson and Las Vegas areas,  southern
California and north-central Arizona.

The Company was  incorporated in 1946 under the laws of the State of Arizona and
reincorporated  in 1994 under the laws of the State of Delaware.  The  Company's
principal  executive  offices  are located at 6001 North 24th  Street,  Phoenix,
Arizona 85016 and its telephone  number is (602) 808-8000.  The Company conducts
substantially  all of its activities  through  subsidiaries and, as used in this
Annual  Report,  the  term  "Company"  includes  Del  Webb  Corporation  and its
subsidiaries unless the context indicates otherwise.

Statements in this Annual Report as to acreage, mileage, number of future homes,
square  feet  and  number  of   residents,   employees  and   shareholders   are
approximations.

MASTER-PLANNED COMMUNITIES

At June 30, 1996 the Company had nine  master-planned  communities at which home
closings were taking place. The Company also had one master-planned community in
an earlier stage of development.

              Communities Delivering Homes

The following table shows certain information concerning the nine communities at
which  the  Company  was  delivering  homes  at  June  30,  1996.  Two of  these
communities,  Sun City Summerlin  (formerly known as Sun City Las Vegas) and Sun
City  MacDonald  Ranch,  are  reported  on a combined  basis since they are both
located in the Las Vegas metropolitan area. The table includes  information with
respect  to land  owned by the  Company  and which it has  options  to  acquire.
Information  for Sun City Palm Desert  (formerly known as Sun City Palm Springs)
is presented for phase one of that community. The Company also owns 700 acres of
land for a second phase of  development  at Sun City Palm Desert.  If developed,
this second phase is currently  planned for 2,300 homes.  Development  of future
phases  at any of the  Company's  communities  will  depend  on the state of the
economy and prospects for the  communities  at the time the current  phases near
completion.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                Sun City  Sun City Sun Cities  Sun City    Sun City  Sun City    Sun City
                                  West     Tucson   Las Vegas Palm Desert Roseville Hilton Head Georgetown  Terravita
                                  ----     ------   --------- ----------- --------- ----------- ----------  ---------
<S>                              <C>       <C>       <C>         <C>        <C>        <C>         <C>        <C>  
First home closing...........     1978      1987      1989       1992        1995      1995        1996       1994
Total acres..................     7,000    1,000      3,064       906       1,200      5,600       5,300       823
Homes at completion..........    16,328    2,460     10,140      2,435      3,072      8,000       9,650      1,380
Home closings through
  June 30, 1996..............    15,159    2,356      5,995      1,136      1,024       305         235        850
Future homes to be closed....     1,169     104       4,145      1,299      2,048      7,695       9,415       530
Future homes to be sold......      616       59       3,503      1,187      1,671      7,502       9,037       226
Base price range of homes at
  June 30, 1996 (in thousands)  $90-240  $110-230    $90-280   $100-300   $120-280    $90-260    $100-240   $170-390
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>
                                        1
<PAGE>
              Sun City West
              -------------

Sun City  West is a  self-contained  active  adult  community  located  25 miles
northwest of downtown Phoenix,  Arizona. The focal point of Sun City West is its
central  activities  area,  including a very large  recreation  center,  a large
indoor theater, a library, a bowling alley,  tennis courts,  lawn bowling greens
and a Company-owned 18- hole  championship  golf course.  Sun City West also has
eight other  18-hole  golf courses  (seven of which are owned by the  residents'
community  association  and one of which is owned  by a  private  club  owned by
residents) and three smaller recreation centers. In addition,  Sun City West has
over  200  civic  and  social  organizations  and  clubs.  Sun  City  West had a
population of 29,000 at June 30, 1996.  The build-out of this community is being
coordinated  with the  development of Sun City Grand, a nearby  community  being
developed by the Company.

              Sun City Tucson
              ---------------

Sun City  Tucson is located 20 miles north of downtown  Tucson,  Arizona.  It is
developed  around  an  18-hole  championship  golf  course.  This  active  adult
community's  primary  recreation  center includes a social hall, arts and crafts
rooms,  a  large  kitchen  and a  sports  and  exercise  facility.  Its  outdoor
recreational  facilities  include tennis courts,  a swimming pool,  shuffleboard
courts,  bocci ball courts and a miniature golf course. Sun City Tucson also has
two smaller recreation  facilities  (including swimming pools, tennis courts and
activity rooms). Sun City Tucson has numerous civic and social organizations and
clubs  and had a  population  of 4,500  at June  30,  1996.  This  community  is
anticipated to be built out in the 1997 fiscal year.

              Sun Cities Las Vegas
              --------------------

The Sun Cities  Las Vegas  include  Sun City  Summerlin  and Sun City  MacDonald
Ranch.

Sun City  Summerlin  is located  eight miles  northwest  of downtown  Las Vegas,
Nevada.  It has two 18-hole  championship  golf  courses and a third,  executive
course.  Other  amenities  in this  active  adult  community  include  extensive
recreational  facilities  at two  large  and  two  smaller  recreation  centers.
Together,  these  facilities  include  meeting halls,  arts and crafts rooms and
tennis,  shuffleboard,  bocci ball and horseshoe  courts,  as well as sports and
exercise  complexes  that include  indoor and outdoor  swimming  pools,  saunas,
weight training and exercise rooms and a racquetball  court.  Sun City Summerlin
has  approximately  65  civic  and  social  organizations  and  clubs  and had a
population of 11,000 at June 30, 1996.

Sun City MacDonald Ranch is located in Henderson,  Nevada, near Las Vegas. It is
an active adult  community with fewer  amenities (an executive golf course and a
smaller recreational facility with an outdoor pool, tennis courts, a fitness and
exercise  center,  arts and crafts studios and a social hall) and higher density
than the  Company's  other active adult  communities.  Home closings at Sun City
MacDonald Ranch began in January 1996. Sun City MacDonald Ranch had a population
of 500 at June 30, 1996.

              Sun City Palm Desert
              --------------------

Sun City Palm  Desert is located in the  Coachella  Valley 20 miles east of Palm
Springs and 130 miles east of downtown Los Angeles.  It is a gate-guarded active
adult  community  that  has an  18-hole  championship  golf  course  and a large
recreation  center  with  indoor and outdoor  swimming  pools and therapy  spas,
tennis courts, bocci ball courts, a fitness and exercise center, arts and crafts
studios,  a ballroom and a full  service  restaurant  and lounge.  Sun City Palm
Desert had a population of 2,000 at June 30, 1996.

              Sun City Roseville
              ------------------

Sun City  Roseville  is  located  20 miles  northeast  of  downtown  Sacramento,
California.  This  active  adult  community  is  planned  to include 27 holes of
championship  golf and has extensive  parks and a large  recreation  center with
indoor and outdoor  swimming pools and therapy spas,  tennis courts,  bocci ball
courts, a fitness and exercise center, arts and crafts studios, a ballroom and a
full-service restaurant and lounge. Sun City Roseville had a population of 2,000
at June 30, 1996.
                                        2
<PAGE>
              Sun City Hilton Head
              --------------------

Sun City Hilton Head is located  inland 13 miles from Hilton Head Island,  South
Carolina.  This community  encompasses  5,600 acres,  2,300 of which are already
owned by the  Company  and the  balance  of which the  Company  has  options  to
purchase. Sun City Hilton Head is a gate-guarded active adult community that has
an 18-hole  championship  golf course,  a clubhouse and  restaurant  and a large
recreation  center with indoor and outdoor  swimming  pools,  tennis  courts,  a
croquet  course,  a putting  course,  bocci ball courts,  a fitness and exercise
center,  arts  and  crafts  studios  and a social  hall.  Future  amenities  are
currently planned to include  additional golf courses, a nature trail system and
a river club . Home  closings at Sun City Hilton Head began in August 1995.  Sun
City Hilton Head had a population of 500 at June 30, 1996.

              Sun City Georgetown
              -------------------

Sun City  Georgetown  is an active  adult  community  located 30 miles  north of
downtown Austin,  Texas. This community  encompasses 5,300 acres, 3,500 of which
are  already  owned by the  Company  and the  balance of which the  Company  has
options to  purchase.  Sun City  Georgetown's  amenities  are planned to include
several  golf  courses,  a clubhouse  and  restaurant,  a trail system and large
recreation center with indoor and outdoor swimming pools, a fitness and exercise
center,  arts and crafts  studios and a social hall. Sun City  Georgetown  began
home closings in February 1996 and had a population of 400 at June 30, 1996.

              Terravita
              ---------

Terravita is a gate-guarded, amenity-rich,  master-planned residential community
located in north  Scottsdale,  Arizona,  that is not  age-restricted.  It has an
18-hole  championship  golf course,  a large  clubhouse,  restaurant and fitness
center,  a  swimming  pool,  tennis  courts  and other  recreational  amenities.
Terravita had a population of 1,500 at June 30, 1996.

              Community in an Earlier Stage of Development

The  Company  had  one  community,  Sun  City  Grand,  in an  earlier  stage  of
development  at June 30, 1996. Sun City Grand is located on 3,775 acres near Sun
City West. It is currently planned as a gate-guarded  community to include 9,550
homes and four  championship  golf  courses,  each with a spacious golf club and
restaurant facility.  The major amenities will be centralized and are planned to
include a large  recreation  center with indoor and outdoor  swimming  pools,  a
fitness and  exercise  center,  a large social  hall,  numerous  arts and crafts
studios,  lighted tennis courts,  bocci ball courts and  entertainment  cabanas.
Future  phases  are also  planned  to  include  a  theater  and  bowling  alley.
Development  of Sun  City  Grand  began  in the  Spring  of  1995  and is  being
coordinated  with  the  build-out  of  Sun  City  West.  The  Company  currently
anticipates  that home sales and closings will begin at Sun City Grand in fiscal
1997.

POTENTIAL FUTURE COMMUNITIES

The Company believes that the demographic  attributes of its active adult target
market segment of people age 55 and over present  significant  opportunities for
carefully  selected  future active adult  communities.  The Company's plan is to
capitalize on those  opportunities and its experience,  expertise and reputation
by developing active adult communities in strategically selected locations.  The
current business  strategy of the Company includes  conducting  extensive market
research on prospective areas,  including consumer surveys and supply and demand
analyses,  in  connection  with its  evaluation of sites for future active adult
communities.  To the extent the Company  has had a  successful  community  in an
area, the Company  generally  strives to maintain a market presence in that area
through  development  of a  successor  community  as  build-out  of  the  former
community approaches.

At any  given  time,  the  Company  may have a number of land  acquisitions  for
potential  communities  under study and in various  stages of  investigation  or
negotiation.  The Company is currently investigating the acquisition of land for
communities  to be located  both in areas of the  country  where the Company has
active adult  communities and in other areas,  including full four-season  areas
(i.e.,  areas which experience cold winters),  where it does not have experience
in developing communities. In making significant land acquisitions,  the Company
generally  endeavors  to  acquire  options on the land to  mitigate  the risk of
holding  the land  during the  detailed  feasibility  and  entitlement  process.
However, under certain  circumstances,  the Company may acquire such property at
an earlier stage in the development process.
                                        3
<PAGE>
In 1992 the Company  purchased  5,600 acres of land north of Phoenix  (currently
known as the Villages at Desert Hills) as the site for a possible master-planned
community.  In fiscal 1995 the Company  received a general  plan  amendment  and
development  master plan approval (the initial  governmental  planning approvals
required) for 16,500 homes on this  property.  In fiscal 1996 the primary zoning
approvals were received;  however,  development of this property remains subject
to  uncertainties  and the planning and permitting  process is still in an early
stage. At June 30, 1996 the Company's investment in the Villages at Desert Hills
was $17.9 million.

CONVENTIONAL HOMEBUILDING

The Company began its conventional  subdivision  homebuilding  operations in the
Phoenix area in 1991 and expanded these operations to Tucson in fiscal 1994, Las
Vegas and southern California in fiscal 1995 and north-central Arizona in fiscal
1996.  At June 30,  1996 the  Company  had a backlog of home sales  orders at 28
subdivisions -- 15 in the Phoenix area, 4 in the Tucson area, 4 in the Las Vegas
area, 4 in southern California and 1 in north-central  Arizona.  The Company has
no  current  plans  to  continue  its  conventional   subdivision   homebuilding
operations in southern California after completion of its existing subdivisions.

In order to capitalize on its market knowledge and organizational structure, the
Company's conventional  homebuilding activities are primarily conducted in those
metropolitan  or market areas in which the Company is developing an active adult
community.  Through  June  30,  1996  the  Company's  conventional  homebuilding
operations have generally targeted first-time and move-up buyers,  although some
luxury  homes are also being sold.  The base price of homes  offered for sale at
June 30, 1996 ranged from $70,000 to  $420,000.  The Company  currently  expects
that community  development will continue to be its primary  business  activity.
For the year ended June 30, 1996, conventional homebuilding operations generated
21.5 percent of the Company's homebuilding revenues.

PRODUCT DESIGN

The Company  designs  homes to suit its market and  endeavors  to conform to the
popular  home  design   characteristics  in  the  particular  geographic  market
involved.  Home  designs  are  periodically  reviewed  and refined or changed to
reflect  changing  home  buyer  tastes in each  market.  Homes at the  Company's
communities generally range in size from 1,000 square feet to 3,700 square feet.
The  Company  offers a program of  interior  and  exterior  upgrades,  including
different  styles of cabinetry and floor  coverings and, at its  communities,  a
program for  architectural  changes to allow home buyers to further modify their
homes.

CONSTRUCTION

The Company generally functions as its own general contractor.  At all stages of
production,  the  Company's  management  personnel  and on-site  superintendents
coordinate the activities of contractors,  consultants and suppliers and subject
their work to quality  and cost  controls.  Consulting  firms  assist in project
planning and  independent  contractors are employed to perform almost all of the
site development and construction work. Within its active adult communities and,
generally, its conventional subdivisions, the Company is the exclusive developer
of homes and does not sell  vacant lots to others for  residential  construction
purposes.  The time required for  construction of the Company's homes depends on
the weather, time of year, local labor situations, availability of materials and
supplies and other factors.  The Company strives to coordinate the  construction
of homes with home sales orders to control the costs and risks  associated  with
completed but unsold inventory.  An inventory of unsold homes under construction
is maintained for immediate sale to customers.

SALES ACTIVITIES

At each of its  communities the Company  establishes a large and  well-appointed
sales pavilion and an extensive  complex of furnished model homes.  These models
include  a wide  variety  of single  family  homes,  each of which is  generally
available in several exterior styles.

The  Company's  homes  are sold by its  commissioned  sales  personnel,  who are
available  to  provide   prospective   home  buyers  with  floor  plans,   price
information,  option  selections and tours of models and lots.  All  communities
have co-brokerage programs with independent real estate brokers.  Homes are sold
through sales  contracts,  some of which allow  customers to purchase  homes for
delivery up to one year or more in the  future.  The sales  contracts  generally
require an initial  deposit and an additional  deposit prior to  commencement of
construction.  The Company provides to all home buyers  standardized  warranties
subject to specified limitations.
                                        4
<PAGE>
While more than one factor may  contribute  to a given home sale,  the Company's
experience  indicates  that a  substantial  portion  of the  home  sales  at its
communities  are  attributable  to follow-ups on referrals from residents of its
communities and, at certain active adult communities, to the Company's "Vacation
Getaway" program. This program enables prospective purchasers to visit an active
adult  community and stay (for a modest  charge) in vacation homes for up to one
week to experience the Sun City lifestyle prior to deciding  whether to purchase
a home.

The  Company's  information  is  that  most  home  buyers  at its  active  adult
communities  generally  visit the  community in which they purchase on more than
one occasion  before buying.  This may affect the success or initial  success of
the  sales  effort  at those  communities  at which a higher  proportion  of the
potential customers do not live within a several-hour  driving distance from the
community.

The Company also markets its  communities  through  billboards,  television  and
radio  commercials,  local and national print  advertising,  direct mailings and
telemarketing.

The  Company  offers  mortgage  financing  for the  purchasers  of  homes at its
communities and  conventional  subdivisions.  The Company sells the mortgages it
generates to third parties.

OTHER REAL ESTATE ACTIVITY

The  Company is  completing  the  development  of The  Foothills,  a  4,140-acre
master-planned  residential land development project located in Phoenix in which
individual land parcels and lots are being sold to other  builder/developers for
conventional housing and related commercial  development.  At June 30, 1996, 294
acres of residential  and commercial  land remained to be sold at The Foothills.
At June 30, 1996 the Company's investment in The Foothills was $17.7 million.

COMPETITION

All  of  the  Company's  real  estate  operations  are  subject  to  substantial
competition.  The Company  competes with numerous  national,  regional and local
homebuilders  and developers,  a few of which have greater  financial  resources
than the Company.

The Company  believes  that it  maintains a leading  position  within the active
adult  community  market  in each of the  metropolitan  areas  in which it has a
community that is currently generating revenues.  The Company believes the major
competitive  factors in active adult community home purchases  include location,
lifestyle,  price,  value,  recreational  facilities  and  other  amenities  and
builder/developer  reputation. The Company believes its reputation,  established
by building and selling  more than 52,000  homes over 36 years and  providing an
attractive  lifestyle for adults age 55 and over,  enhances the Company's active
adult community marketing position.

For the Company's active adult communities,  there are varying degrees of direct
and increasing  competition from businesses engaged  exclusively or primarily in
the  sale of homes  to  buyers  age 55 and  older  and from  non-age-restricted,
master-planned  communities in these areas.  The Company  competes with new home
sales and resales at these other  communities,  as well as with resales of homes
in its own communities. The Company believes there may be significant additional
future competition in active adult community development,  including competition
from  national  homebuilders  and  conventional  community  developers.  Also, a
national   homebuilder  is  developing  an  active  adult  community  in  Indio,
California,  near Sun City Palm Desert, which will cause additional  competitive
pressures at that community.

In  each  of the  areas  in  which  the  Company  has  conventional  subdivision
homebuilding operations,  the Company is subject to a high degree of competition
from  new  home  developers,   home  resales,  rental  housing  and  condominium
development.  The Company  believes that the major  competitive  factors in this
part of its business include location,  home quality, price, design and mortgage
financing terms.
                                        5
<PAGE>
CERTAIN FACTORS AFFECTING THE COMPANY'S OPERATIONS

Set forth below is a brief  description  of certain  matters that may affect the
Company.

FUTURE AND NEWER COMMUNITIES.  The Company's  communities will be built out over
time.  Therefore,  the  medium-  and  long-term  future of the  Company  will be
dependent  on the  Company's  ability to develop and market  future  communities
successfully.  Acquiring  land  and  committing  the  financial  and  managerial
resources to develop a community on that land involve  significant risks. Before
these communities generate any revenues, they require material expenditures for,
among  other  things,   acquiring  land,  obtaining  development  approvals  and
constructing project  infrastructure  (such as roads and utilities),  recreation
centers, model homes and sales facilities.  It generally takes several years for
communities to achieve cumulative positive cash flow.

The Company will incur additional risks to the extent it develops communities in
climates  or other  geographic  areas in  which it does not have  experience  or
develops  a  different  size or  style of  community,  including  acquiring  the
necessary  construction  materials  and  labor  in  sufficient  amounts  and  on
acceptable  terms and adapting the Company's  construction  methods to different
geographies  and  climates.  Among other  things,  the Company  believes  that a
significant  portion  of the  home  sales at its  active  adult  communities  is
attributable to referrals from, or sales to, residents of those communities. The
extent of such  referrals  or sales at new  communities,  including  communities
developed  in other  areas of the  country,  may be less  than the  Company  has
enjoyed at the active  adult  communities  where it currently  sells homes,  and
there may be  challenges  attracting  potential  customers  from  areas and to a
market in which the Company has not had significant experience.

COMPETITION; REAL ESTATE, ECONOMIC AND OTHER CONDITIONS GENERALLY. The Company's
communities  and its other real estate  operations  are  subject to  substantial
existing and  potential  competition  (including  increased  competition  from a
number of national homebuilders that are entering or expanding their presence in
active adult community  development),  real estate market conditions (both where
its  communities  and  conventional  homebuilding  operations are located and in
areas where its potential  customers  reside),  the cyclical  nature of the real
estate business,  general national economic conditions and changing  demographic
conditions.

A significant  number of purchasers at the Company's active adult communities in
Arizona,  Nevada and southern  California  are from southern  California.  Those
communities may be affected by the continuing adverse conditions in the southern
California real estate market and the southern California economy generally.

FINANCING AND LEVERAGE. Real estate development is dependent on the availability
and cost of  financing.  In periods of  significant  growth,  the  Company  will
require  significant  additional  capital  resources,  whether from issuances of
equity or by incurring additional indebtedness.  No assurance can be given as to
the availability or cost of any future financing. The Company's principal credit
facility and the indentures for its publicly-held debt restrict the indebtedness
the Company may incur.  The  availability of debt financing is also dependent on
governmental  policies and other factors outside the control of the Company.  If
the  Company  cannot  obtain  sufficient  capital  to fund its  development  and
expansion expenditures,  its projects may be significantly delayed, resulting in
cost increases and adverse effects on the Company's results of operations.

The  Company's  degree of leverage  from time to time will  affect its  interest
incurred and may limit funds  available  for  operations,  which could limit its
ability to withstand adverse changes or capitalize on business opportunities. If
the Company is at any time unable to service its debt,  refinancing or obtaining
additional financing may be required and may not be available.

INTEREST  RATES.   The  Company's  real  estate   operations   depend  upon  the
availability  and cost of mortgage  financing.  An  increase in interest  rates,
which may result  from  governmental  policies  and other  factors  outside  the
control of the Company,  may adversely  affect the buying decisions of potential
home buyers and their ability to sell their existing homes.
                                        6
<PAGE>
CONSTRUCTION  LABOR  AND  MATERIALS  COSTS.  The  Company  has from time to time
experienced  shortages  of  materials  or  qualified  tradespeople  or  volatile
increases in the cost of certain materials  (particularly increases in the price
of lumber and framing,  which are  significant  components of home  construction
costs), resulting in longer than normal construction periods and increased costs
not  reflected  in the  prices of homes for which home sale  contracts  had been
entered  into up to one year in advance of  scheduled  closing.  Generally,  the
Company's home sale contracts do not contain, or contain limited, provisions for
price  increases if the Company's costs of  construction  increase.  The Company
relies  heavily on local  contractors,  who may be  inadequately  capitalized or
understaffed.  The  inability  or failure of one or more  local  contractors  to
perform may result in construction delays, increased costs and loss of some home
sale contracts.

GOVERNMENTAL REGULATION AND ENVIRONMENTAL CONSIDERATIONS. The Company's business
is subject to extensive federal,  state and local regulatory  requirements,  the
broad  discretion  that  governmental   agencies  have  in  administering  those
requirements and "no growth" or "slow growth" political  policies,  all of which
can prevent,  delay,  make uneconomic or significantly  increase the cost of its
developments.  In  addition,  environmental  concerns  and related  governmental
requirements  have  affected  and will  continue to affect all of the  Company's
community development operations.

In connection with the  development of the Company's  communities and other real
estate projects, particularly those located in California, numerous governmental
approvals and permits are required  throughout the development  process,  and no
assurance  can be  given as to the  receipt  (or  timing  of  receipt)  of these
approvals or permits. In addition,  third parties can file lawsuits  challenging
approvals or permits received,  which could cause substantial  uncertainties and
material delays for the project and, if successful, could result in approvals or
permits being voided.

PERIOD-TO-PERIOD FLUCTUATIONS. The Company's communities are long-term projects.
Sales activity at the Company's  communities  varies from period to period,  and
the ultimate success of any community cannot necessarily be judged by results in
any particular period or periods. A community may generate  significantly higher
sales levels at inception  (whether  because of local pent-up demand in the area
or  other  reasons)  than it does  during  later  periods  over  the life of the
community.  Revenues  and  earnings  of the  Company  will also be  affected  by
period-to-period  fluctuations  in the mix of  product,  subdivisions  and  home
closings  among  the  Company's   communities  and   conventional   homebuilding
operations and by sales of commercial land at the Company's communities.

GEOGRAPHIC   CONCENTRATION.   The  Company's  primary  business  operations  are
concentrated  in a limited number of  communities in five states.  The Company's
geographic  concentration  and limited  number of projects may create  increased
vulnerability to regional economic  downturns or other adverse  project-specific
matters.

NATURAL  RISKS.  Sun City  Roseville  and Sun City  Hilton  Head are  subject to
significant  seasonal  rainfall  that  can  cause  delays  in  construction  and
development or that can increase  costs.  Earthquake  faults,  including the San
Andreas fault,  run through the Coachella  Valley,  which includes Sun City Palm
Desert and the  communities  of Palm  Springs,  Indio,  Palm Desert,  La Quinta,
Rancho  Mirage  and  Indian  Wells.  A portion  of Sun City Palm  Desert is also
located in a flood plain.  The Coachella  Valley Water District has approved the
Company's  conceptual  flood  control  plan for Sun  City  Palm  Desert  and has
approved the Company's  specific  flood control plan for the first phase of this
project.  Sun City  Hilton  Head is  located  in an area which may be subject to
hurricanes. A major earthquake, flood or hurricane could have a material adverse
impact  on the  development  of and  results  of  operations  for the  community
affected.

FORWARD LOOKING INFORMATION;  CERTAIN CAUTIONARY STATEMENTS.  Certain statements
contained in this Annual Report are forward  looking  statements.  These forward
looking statements involve risks and uncertainties  including but not limited to
those  referred  to above.  Actual  results  may  differ  materially  from those
projected or implied in the forward looking statements. Further, certain forward
looking  statements are based upon  assumptions of future events,  which may not
prove to be accurate.  Additional  information on factors which could affect the
Company's  financial results may be included in subsequent  reports filed by the
Company with the Securities and Exchange Commission.
                                        7
<PAGE>
EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE COMPANY

Set forth below are the names and ages of all executive  officers of the Company
and the offices held with the Company at July 31, 1996.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                              Years
                                                                                          Years as an       Employed
                                                                                           Executive         by the
           Name               Age                         Position                          Officer          Company
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                           <C>                                                          <C>              <C>
P. J. Dion                    51      Chairman of the Board and                               14               14
                                         Chief Executive Officer
J. F. Contadino               54      Executive Vice President                                 4                5
L. C. Hanneman, Jr.           49      Executive Vice President                                 7               24
J. H. Gleason                 54      Senior Vice President, Project Planning                  6                8
                                         and Development
A. L. Mariucci                39      Senior Vice President and General                       10               12
                                         Manager - Terravita
F. D. Pankratz                46      Senior Vice President and                                8                9
                                         General  Manager - Sun City
                                         Summerlin and Sun City
                                         MacDonald Ranch
C. T. Roach                   49      Senior Vice President and                                7               17
                                         General Manager - Sun City West
                                         and Sun City Grand
J. A. Spencer                 47      Senior Vice President and Chief                         11               17
                                         Financial Officer
J. D. Wilkins                 51      Senior Vice President and                                7                7
                                         General Manager - Sun City Hilton Head
L. W. Beckner                 49      Vice President, Information Services                 Less than        Less than
                                                                                           one year         one year
R. C. Jones                   51      Vice President and General Counsel                       4                4
D. V. Mickus                  50      Vice President, Treasurer and Secretary                 10               13
J. M. Murray                  42      Vice President and General Manager,                  Less than            7
                                         Sun City Roseville                                one year
D. E. Rau                     39      Vice President and Controller                           10               11
D. G. Schreiner               43      Vice President, Marketing                                3                5
M. L. Schuttenberg            53      Vice President, Human Resources                          3               10
R. R. Wagoner                 55      Vice President, Land Development                         2                4

- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

Mr. Dion  has served  as Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer since
November 1987.

Mr.  Contadino has served as Executive Vice President,  overseeing  conventional
homebuilding and community development operations, since May 1996. Prior to that
time he served as Senior Vice  President  from  January  1994 to May 1996 and as
Vice  President  from  November  1991 to January  1994.  He became  President of
Coventry Homes in January 1991.
                                        8
<PAGE>
EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE COMPANY (Continued)

Mr.  Hanneman has served as Executive Vice  President,  overseeing  active adult
community  operations,  since May  1996.  Prior to that time he served as Senior
Vice  President from January 1994 to May 1996 and as Vice President from January
1989 to January 1994.  From August 1987 to May 1996 he served as General Manager
of Sun City Summerlin and, subsequently, Sun City MacDonald Ranch.

Mr.  Gleason  has  served  as  Senior  Vice  President,   Project  Planning  and
Development, since January 1994. Prior to that time he served as Vice President,
Project  Planning and  Development,  from June 1993 to January 1994. He became a
Vice President in January 1990.

Ms. Mariucci has served as Senior Vice President  since May 1996.  Prior to that
time she served as a Vice  President  from June 1986 (when she began  serving as
Vice President,  Corporate Planning and Development) to May 1996. She has served
as General Manager of Terravita since December 1992.

Mr.  Pankratz has served as General  Manager of Sun City  Summerlin and Sun City
MacDonald Ranch since May 1996.  Prior to that time he served as General Manager
of Sun City Palm Desert from February 1990 to May 1996.  Since September 1988 he
has served as Senior Vice President.

Mr. Roach has served as Senior Vice President since January 1994.  Prior to that
time he served as Vice President from January 1989 to January 1994. Since August
1987 he has served as General  Manager of Sun City West and,  subsequently,  Sun
City Grand.

Mr.  Spencer has served as Chief  Financial  Officer  since  April  1993.  Since
February 1991 he has served as Senior Vice President.

Mr. Wilkins has served as Senior Vice President and General  Manager of Sun City
Hilton Head since January 1994.  Prior to that time he served as Vice  President
and General Manager of Sun City Tucson from July 1989 to January 1994.

Mr. Beckner has served as Vice President,  Information Services,  since November
1995.  Prior to that time he was employed by AlliedSignal  Corporation in Tempe,
Arizona, where he held the position of Director, Strategic Alliances.

Mr. Jones has served as Vice  President and General  Counsel since January 1992.
From March 1990 to November  1991 he was a partner with the law firm of Gaston &
Snow.

Mr. Mickus has served as Vice President and Treasurer since November 1985 and as
Secretary commencing in June 1991.

Mr. Murray has served as Vice President  since  September  1995.  Since December
1992 he has served as General Manager of Sun City Roseville.  Prior to that time
he served in a financial  management  capacity for a  subsidiary  of the Company
from July 1989 to December 1992.

Mr. Rau has served as Vice President and Controller since February 1991.

Mr.  Schreiner has served as Vice  President,  Marketing,  since  December 1992.
Prior to that time he served as Senior Vice President, Marketing and Operations,
of  Coventry  Homes  from  October  1992 to  December  1992 and Vice  President,
Marketing and Operations, of Coventry Homes from January 1991 to October 1992.

Ms.  Schuttenberg  has served as Vice President,  Human  Resources,  since April
1993.  Prior to that time she served as Director of Human  Resources  from March
1992 to April 1993 and as Director of Taxes from April 1989 to March 1992.

Mr. Wagoner has served as Vice President, Land Development,  since January 1994.
Prior to that time he served as Director of Land  Development  from January 1992
to January 1994.  Prior to 1992 Mr. Wagoner was a principal and  stockholder for
32 years at Collar,  Williams and White  Engineering  in Phoenix,  where he held
various positions including President.
                                        9
<PAGE>
EMPLOYEES

At June 30, 1996 the Company had 2,300 employees.  The Company  currently has no
unionized  employees.  The Company  believes  that its  employee  relations  are
generally satisfactory.

Item 3.       Legal Proceedings

The  Company is a party to various  legal  proceedings  arising in the  ordinary
course of business. While it is not feasible to predict the ultimate disposition
of these  matters,  it is the opinion of management  that their outcome will not
have a material adverse effect on the financial condition of the Company.

Item 4.       Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders

None.
                                       10
<PAGE>
                                     PART II

Item 5.       Market for the Registrant's Common Equity and Related Stockholder
              Matters

The Company's  common stock is listed on the New York Stock Exchange and Pacific
Stock Exchange under the trading  symbol (WBB).  The following  table sets forth
the high and low sales  prices  of the  Company's  common  stock on the New York
Stock Exchange for the two fiscal years ended June 30, 1996.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                        Sales Price
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                       Fiscal Year 1996              Fiscal Year 1995
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Quarter Ended                                          High        Low               High           Low
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

<S>                                                    <C>        <C>                <C>           <C>      
September 30                                           25         17 3/4             17 3/8        13 5/8
December 31                                            21 1/2     17 3/8             17 5/8        14 1/4
March 31                                               20 3/4     16 1/4             20            17
June 30                                                20         16 3/8             23 5/8        16 5/8
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

As of July 31, 1996 the number of  shareholders of record of common stock of the
Company was 3,200.

The  Company has paid  regular  quarterly  dividends  of $.05 per share for each
quarter  in the last five  fiscal  years.  The  amount  and timing of any future
dividends  is subject to the  discretion  of the Board of  Directors.  Among the
factors which the Board of Directors may consider in determining  the amount and
timing of dividends  are the earnings,  cash needs and capital  resources of the
Company.  In  addition,  the  Company is party to a loan  agreement  and various
indentures  that contain  covenants  restricting  the  Company's  ability to pay
dividends  and acquire its common  stock.  Under the most  restrictive  of these
covenants, at June 30, 1996 $9.0 million of the Company's retained earnings were
available for payment of cash  dividends and for the  acquisition by the Company
of its common stock.

In August 1995 the Company publicly sold 2,474,900 shares of its common stock at
a price to the public of $19.50 per share.
                                       11
<PAGE>
Item 6.       Selected Consolidated Financial Data
              (Not covered by report of independent auditors)

The  following  tables set forth  selected  consolidated  financial  data of the
Company as of and for each of the five fiscal  years ended June 30,  1996.  They
should be read in conjunction  with the  Consolidated  Financial  Statements and
Notes thereto and "Management's  Discussion and Analysis of Financial  Condition
and Results of Operations."
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                            Dollars In Thousands Except Per Share Data
                                                                        Year Ended June 30,
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                      1996         1995         1994         1993        1992
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                               <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>        
Statement of operations information:
Revenues:
  Home sales - communities                        $   794,671  $   620,012  $   405,462  $   324,817  $   226,014
  Home sales - conventional homebuilding              217,158      144,469       79,992       44,456       27,097
  Land sales and other                                 38,904       38,638       24,607       21,313        7,761
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
  Total revenues                                  $ 1,050,733  $   803,119  $   510,061  $   390,586  $   260,872
=================================================================================================================
Earnings (loss):
  Continuing operations (1), (2)                  $    (7,751) $    28,491  $    17,021  $    16,863  $    14,068
  Total (3)                                       $    (7,751) $    28,491  $    17,021  $    24,511  $    17,107
=================================================================================================================
Net earnings (loss) per share:
  Continuing operations (1)                       $      (.44) $      1.87  $      1.13  $      1.05  $      1.09
  Total                                                  (.44)        1.87         1.13         1.53         1.33
=================================================================================================================
Cash dividends per share                          $       .20  $       .20  $       .20  $       .20  $       .20
=================================================================================================================
</TABLE>
(1)   In fiscal 1996, in connection  with the adoption of Statement of Financial
      Accounting  Standards  ("SFAS") No. 121,  the Company  incurred a non-cash
      loss from impairment of southern California real estate inventories in the
      amount of $65.0 million  pre-tax  ($42.3 million after tax) related to the
      valuation of its Sun City Palm Desert active adult community. Exclusive of
      the non-cash  loss,  the Company's net earnings for fiscal 1996 were $34.5
      million, or $1.96 per share.

(2)   Earnings (loss) from continuing operations for fiscal 1996, 1995, 1994 and
      1993 reflect a higher  income tax rate (a rate more closely  approximating
      the  statutory  rate)  than for fiscal  1992 as a result of the  Company's
      adoption of SFAS No. 109 effective July 1, 1992.

(3)   Total  earnings  for  fiscal  1993  include  a  $12.8  million  loss  from
      discontinued  operations  (primarily additional loss provisions related to
      the Company's  discontinued  land  development  projects),  a $0.5 million
      extraordinary  gain from the  extinguishment of debt on a discounted basis
      and a $20.0  million  increase in net earnings as a result of a cumulative
      effect of an  accounting  change from the adoption of SFAS No. 109.  Total
      earnings for fiscal 1992 include a $3.0  million  extraordinary  gain from
      the extinguishment of debt on a discounted basis.
                                       12
<PAGE>
Item 6.       Selected Consolidated Financial Data (Continued)
              (Not covered by report of independent auditors)
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                       Dollars In Thousands
                                                                       Year Ended June 30,
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                      1996         1995        1994         1993         1992
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                               <C>          <C>          <C>         <C>          <C>        
Balance sheet information at year-end:
  Total assets                                    $ 1,024,795  $   925,050  $  758,424  $   555,586  $   442,051

  Notes payable and senior debt                       320,063      284,585     189,657      133,175      159,637
  Subordinated debt                                   194,614      206,673     206,019      108,688       12,622
                                                  -----------  -----------  ----------  -----------  -----------
  Total notes payable, senior and
    subordinated debt                                 514,677      491,258     395,676      241,863      172,259

  Shareholders' equity                            $   264,776  $   229,342  $  201,324  $   199,446  $   178,615

  Total notes payable, senior and
    subordinated debt divided by total
    notes payable, senior and subordinated
    debt and shareholders' equity                        66.0%        68.2%       66.3%        54.8%        49.1%
=================================================================================================================
</TABLE>
                                       13
<PAGE>
Item 7.       Management's Discussion and  Analysis of  Financial  Condition and
              Results of Operations

The following discussion of results of operations and financial condition should
be read in  conjunction  with the Selected  Consolidated  Financial Data and the
Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes thereto.

CERTAIN  CONSOLIDATED  FINANCIAL  AND  OPERATING  DATA
- ------------------------------------------------------

Set forth below is certain  consolidated  financial  and  operating  data of the
Company as of and for each of the three fiscal years ended June 30, 1996.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                               Year Ended                    Change                  Change
                                                June 30,                  1996 vs 1995            1995 vs 1994
- -------------------------------------------------------------------   --------------------    --------------------
                                          1996       1995      1994    Amount      Percent     Amount      Percent
- -------------------------------------------------------------------   --------------------    --------------------
<S>                                      <C>        <C>       <C>     <C>           <C>       <C>           <C> 
OPERATING DATA:
 Number of net new orders(1):
   Sun City West                           963        946     1,156            17     1.8%           (210)  (18.2%)
   Sun City Tucson                         160        310       357          (150)  (48.4%)           (47)  (13.2%)
   Sun Cities Las Vegas(2)               1,241        770       863           471    61.2%            (93)  (10.8%)
   Sun City Palm Desert                    216        267       315           (51)  (19.1%)           (48)  (15.2%)
   Sun City Roseville(3)                   537        515       349            22     4.3%            166    47.6%
   Sun City Hilton Head(3)                 349        149       N/A           200   134.2%            149      N/A
   Sun City Georgetown(3)                  491        122       N/A           369   302.5%            122      N/A
   Terravita(3)                            431        392       331            39     9.9%             61    18.4%
   Coventry Homes                        1,462      1,063       774           399    37.5%            289    37.3%
- -------------------------------------------------------------------   --------------------    --------------------
     Total                               5,850      4,534     4,145         1,316    29.0%            389     9.4%
===================================================================   ====================    ====================
 Number of home closings:
   Sun City West                           912      1,104     1,161          (192)  (17.4%)           (57)   (4.9%)
   Sun City Tucson                         264        444       342          (180)  (40.5%)           102    29.8%
   Sun Cities Las Vegas(2)               1,001        847       815           154    18.2%             32     3.9%
   Sun City Palm Desert                    251        282       278           (31)  (11.0%)             4     1.4%
   Sun City Roseville(3)                   731        293       N/A           438   149.5%            293      N/A
   Sun City Hilton Head(3)                 305        N/A       N/A           305      N/A            N/A      N/A
   Sun City Georgetown(3)                  235        N/A       N/A           235      N/A            N/A      N/A
   Terravita(3)                            425        425       N/A             -        -            425      N/A
   Coventry Homes                        1,407        921       587           486    52.8%            334    56.9%
- -------------------------------------------------------------------   --------------------    --------------------
      Total                              5,531      4,316     3,183         1,215    28.2%          1,133    35.6%
===================================================================   ====================    ====================
BACKLOG DATA:
 Homes under contract at June 30:
   Sun City West                           553        502       660            51    10.2%           (158)  (23.9%)
   Sun City Tucson                          45        149       283          (104)  (69.8%)          (134)  (47.3%)
   Sun Cities Las Vegas(2)                 642        402       479           240    59.7%            (77)  (16.1%)
   Sun City Palm Desert                    112        147       162           (35)  (23.8%)           (15)   (9.3%)
   Sun City Roseville(3)                   377        571       349          (194)  (34.0%)           222    63.6%
   Sun City Hilton Head(3)                 193        149       N/A            44    29.5%            149      N/A
   Sun City Georgetown(3)                  378        122       N/A           256   209.8%            122      N/A
   Terravita(3)                            304        298       331             6     2.0%            (33)  (10.0%)
   Coventry Homes                          595        540       398            55    10.2%            142    35.7%
- -------------------------------------------------------------------   --------------------    --------------------
      Total(4)                           3,199      2,880     2,662           319    11.1%            218     8.2%
===================================================================   ====================    ====================
Aggregate contract sales amount
  (dollars in millions)                   $617       $565      $471           $52     9.2%            $94    20.0%
Average contract sales amount
  per home (dollars in thousands)         $193       $196      $177           $(3)   (1.5%)           $19    10.7%
===================================================================   ====================    ====================
</TABLE>
                                       14
<PAGE>
Item 7.       Management's  Discussion and Analysis of  Financial  Condition and
              Results of Operations (Continued)

CERTAIN  CONSOLIDATED  FINANCIAL  AND  OPERATING  DATA  (Continued)
- -------------------------------------------------------------------
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                              Year Ended                       Change                Change
                                               June 30,                     1996 vs 1995          1995 vs 1994
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------  --------------------  --------------------
                                    1996         1995         1994       Amount    Percent      Amount   Percent
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------  --------------------  --------------------
<S>                             <C>          <C>          <C>           <C>            <C>    <C>           <C> 
AVERAGE REVENUE PER
  HOME CLOSING:
  Sun City West                 $    160,300 $    151,100 $    143,500  $   9,200       6.1%  $    7,600      5.3%
  Sun City Tucson                    170,600      164,400      159,700      6,200       3.8%       4,700      2.9%
  Sun Cities Las Vegas(2)            171,000      180,700      160,800     (9,700)     (5.4%)     19,900     12.4%
  Sun City Palm Desert               224,100      214,400      191,400      9,700       4.5%      23,000     12.0%
  Sun City Roseville(3)              217,800      201,100          N/A     16,700       8.3%         N/A       N/A
  Sun City Hilton Head(3)            159,200          N/A          N/A        N/A        N/A         N/A       N/A
  Sun City Georgetown(3)             181,500          N/A          N/A        N/A        N/A         N/A       N/A
  Terravita(3)                       295,600      253,700          N/A     41,900      16.5%         N/A       N/A
  Coventry Homes                     154,300      156,900      136,300     (2,600)     (1.7%)     20,600     15.1%
    Weighted average            $    182,900 $    177,100 $    152,500  $   5,800       3.3%  $   24,600     16.1%
======================================================================  ====================  ====================

OPERATING STATISTICS:
  Costs and expenses as a
     percentage of  revenues:
        Home construction, land and
           other                       76.9%        76.6%        75.7%       0.3%       0.4%        0.9%      1.2%
        Interest                        4.0%         3.9%         3.5%       0.1%       2.6%        0.4%     11.4%
        Selling, general and
           administrative              14.0%        14.1%        15.6%      (0.1%)     (0.7%)      (1.5%)    (9.6%)
  Ratio of home closings to homes
    under contract in backlog at
    beginning of year                 192.0%       162.1%       187.2%      29.9%      18.4%      (25.1%)   (13.4%)
======================================================================  ====================  ====================
</TABLE>

(1)Net of cancellations.  The Company recognizes revenue at close of escrow.

(2)Includes Sun City Summerlin and Sun City MacDonald  Ranch.  The Company began
   taking new home sales orders at Sun City MacDonald  Ranch in September  1995.
   Home closings began at Sun City MacDonald Ranch in January 1996.

(3)The Company  began taking new home sales orders at Sun City  Roseville in May
   1994,  at Sun City Hilton Head in November  1994,  at Sun City  Georgetown in
   June 1995 and at Terravita in November 1993.  Home closings began at Sun City
   Roseville in February  1995,  at Sun City Hilton Head in August 1995,  at Sun
   City Georgetown in February 1996 and at Terravita in July 1994.

(4)A majority of the backlog at June 30, 1996 is currently anticipated to result
   in  revenues  in the next 12 months.  However,  a majority  of the backlog is
   contingent upon the  availability of financing for the customer,  sale of the
   customer's existing residence or other factors.  Also, as a practical matter,
   the Company's ability to obtain damages for breach of contract by a potential
   home buyer is limited to retaining all or a portion of the deposit  received.
   In the years ended June 30, 1996, 1995 and 1994,  cancellations of home sales
   orders as a percentage of new home sales orders  written during the year were
   17.2 percent, 18.3 percent and 15.6 percent, respectively.
                                       15
<PAGE>
Item 7.           Management's  Discussion  and Analysis  of Financial Condition
                  and Results of Operations (Continued)

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
- ---------------------

REVENUES.  Home  closings  at Sun  City  Hilton  Head  and Sun  City  Georgetown
accounted for $48.6 million and $42.7 million,  respectively, of the increase in
revenues  to $1.05  billion  for the fiscal year ended June 30, 1996 from $803.1
million for the fiscal year ended June 30,  1995.  The Company had not yet begun
delivering homes at these communities in fiscal 1995. Increased home closings at
the Sun Cities Las Vegas (where home closings began at Sun City MacDonald  Ranch
in January 1996) and Sun City Roseville (where the Company had home closings for
only a part of fiscal  1995)  accounted  for $27.8  million  and $88.1  million,
respectively, of the increase in revenues.

Decreased  home  closings  at Sun  City  West  (due  to a lower  backlog  at the
beginning of the year), Sun City Tucson (reflecting the approaching build-out of
that  community) and Sun City Palm Desert (see "Loss from Impairment of Southern
California Real Estate  Inventories")  collectively  resulted in a $65.2 million
decrease  in  revenues.   Increased  home  closings  at  Coventry  Homes  (which
benefitted from increases in Phoenix,  Tucson, Las Vegas and southern California
operations) resulted in increased revenues of $76.3 million.

An  increase  in the  average  revenue  per  home  closing  (excluding  the  new
communities of Sun City Hilton Head and Sun City Georgetown) resulted in a $29.1
million  increase in revenues.  This  increase was  primarily due to sales price
increases  previously  implemented by the Company,  increases in lot premiums at
certain communities and changes in product mix.

Home closings at Terravita and Sun City  Roseville  accounted for $107.8 million
and $58.9 million,  respectively,  of the increase in revenues to $803.1 million
for fiscal 1995  compared  to $510.1  million for the fiscal year ended June 30,
1994.  The Company had not yet begun  delivering  homes at these  communities in
fiscal 1994.  Increased home closings (due to a higher beginning backlog) at Sun
City  West,  Sun City  Tucson,  Sun City  Summerlin  and Sun  City  Palm  Desert
collectively accounted for $14.0 million of the increase in revenues.  Increased
home closings at Coventry  Homes  accounted for $45.5 million of the increase in
revenues.  Coventry Homes'  increased home closings were due both to an increase
in Phoenix-area  operations and to the expansion of operations in the Tucson and
Las Vegas areas and southern California.

Increases  in the average  revenue per home  closing at Sun City West,  Sun City
Tucson, Sun City Summerlin, Sun City Palm Desert and Coventry Homes collectively
accounted  for $52.8  million of the  increase in  revenues  from fiscal 1994 to
fiscal 1995. These increases in average revenues per home closing were partially
due to sales price  increases  implemented  by the Company and  partially due to
changes in product mix.

Land sales and other  revenues were $14.0 million  higher in fiscal 1995 than in
fiscal  1994.  Land  sales  are a normal  part of the  Company's  master-planned
community  developments  but occur  irregularly,  complicating  period-to-period
comparisons.

HOME CONSTRUCTION, LAND AND OTHER COSTS. The increase in home construction, land
and other costs to $808.0 million for fiscal 1996 compared to $614.8 million for
fiscal 1995 was primarily due to the increase in home closings.  As a percentage
of  revenues,  these costs were 76.9  percent  for fiscal 1996  compared to 76.6
percent for fiscal 1995, with the increase primarily  attributable to changes in
mix of product,  subdivisions and home closings among the Company's  communities
and conventional homebuilding operations.

The  increase in home  construction,  land and other costs to $614.8  million in
fiscal 1995  compared to $386.2  million in fiscal 1994 was primarily due to the
increase in home closings. As a percentage of revenues, home construction,  land
and other costs  increased  to 76.6  percent  for fiscal  1995  compared to 75.7
percent for fiscal 1994.  This  increase was the result of a variety of factors,
including  changes  in the  mix of  contributions  by  various  communities  and
Coventry  Homes and decreased base housing  margins at Sun City Tucson.  Pricing
strategies  employed by the Company to  facilitate  the  completion  of Sun City
Tucson resulted in the decrease in base housing margins at that community.

On a  period-to-period  basis,  home  construction,  land and  other  costs as a
percentage of revenues will vary due to, among other things,  changes in product
mix,  differences  between individual  communities,  lot premiums,  upgrades and
extras, price increases and changes in construction costs.
                                       16
<PAGE>
Item 7.           Management's  Discussion  and Analysis  of Financial Condition
                  and Results of Operations (Continued)

INTEREST. As a percentage of revenues,  amortization of capitalized interest was
4.0  percent for fiscal 1996  compared  to 3.9  percent  for fiscal  1995.  This
increase was  primarily due to higher  levels of  indebtedness  and increases in
land held for  longer-term  development,  with respect to which land the Company
does not allocate  capitalized  interest.  As a result of the non-cash loss from
impairment  of southern  California  real estate  inventories  recognized by the
Company in fiscal 1996 (see "Loss from  Impairment of Southern  California  Real
Estate  Inventories"),  management  currently  anticipates  that  in the  future
greater capitalized interest will be allocated to communities with more expected
home  closings than Sun City Palm Desert.  If all other  factors were  constant,
this would result in an increase in  amortization  of capitalized  interest as a
percentage of revenues in future periods.

Increased  borrowings  and higher  interest rates resulted in an increase in the
amortization of capitalized  interest to 3.9 percent of revenues for fiscal 1995
compared to 3.5 percent of revenues for fiscal 1994.

Because the Company capitalizes  interest and amortizes  capitalized interest as
home  closings  occur over the lives of its projects and the Company has several
communities at which  closings just began in fiscal 1996, a significant  portion
of the  reduction in interest  costs  resulting  from the use of proceeds of the
August  1995  public  offering  of  2,474,900  shares of  common  stock to repay
indebtedness  was not reflected in reported  earnings for the  Company's  fiscal
year ended June 30,  1996 and some  portion  will not be  reflected  in the 1997
fiscal year. See "Liquidity and Financial Condition of the Company."

SELLING,  GENERAL AND ADMINISTRATIVE EXPENSES. Of the increase in total selling,
general  and  administrative  expenses  to $147.3  million  for fiscal 1996 from
$113.2 million for fiscal 1995,  $12.7 million was  attributable to higher sales
and marketing  expenses,  $6.5 million was due to increased  commissions  on the
increased revenues and $7.7 million resulted from the recognition of expenses at
Sun City Roseville,  Sun City Hilton Head, Sun City MacDonald Ranch and Sun City
Georgetown in fiscal 1996 (which were  capitalized  prior to the commencement of
home  closings,  which  for each of these  communities  included  part or all of
fiscal  1995).  The balance of the  increase was due to a variety of general and
administrative expenses.

Of the  increase  in  selling,  general  and  administrative  expenses to $113.2
million in fiscal 1995 as compared to $79.7 million in fiscal 1994, $9.2 million
was  attributable  to higher sales and  marketing  expenses and $7.9 million was
attributable to increased commissions on the higher revenues. The balance of the
increase was attributable to a variety of general and  administrative  expenses.
Since a significant portion of selling,  general and administrative  expenses is
fixed,  the increase in revenues for fiscal 1995 resulted in a decrease in these
expenses as a percentage of revenues as compared to fiscal 1994.

LOSS FROM IMPAIRMENT OF SOUTHERN CALIFORNIA REAL ESTATE  INVENTORIES.  In fiscal
1996 the Company adopted Statement of Financial  Accounting  Standards  ("SFAS")
No. 121,  Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived  Assets and for Long-Lived
Assets to Be Disposed Of. (For a brief  description  of SFAS No. 121, see Note 1
to the  Consolidated  Financial  Statements.) In connection with its adoption of
SFAS No. 121, the Company  incurred a non-cash loss from  impairment of southern
California real estate inventories in the amount of $65.0 million pre-tax ($42.3
million  after tax) related to the  valuation of its Sun City Palm Desert active
adult community.  Exclusive of the non-cash loss, the Company's net earnings for
fiscal 1996 were $34.5 million, or $1.96 per share.
                                       17
<PAGE>
Item 7.           Management's  Discussion  and Analysis of Financial  Condition
                  and Results of Operations (Continued)

In the first six months of fiscal  1996,  net new orders at Sun City Palm Desert
were substantially below both the comparable period of the prior fiscal year and
the  Company's  expectations.  Although  the Company was  encouraged  by net new
orders significantly greater in the first 45 days of the third quarter of fiscal
1996 than in the  comparable  period  in the prior  fiscal  year,  a lower  than
anticipated level of net new orders was expected in the remainder of fiscal 1996
and net new orders for all of fiscal 1996 were  anticipated  to be lower than in
prior fiscal  years.  Additionally,  a national  home builder is  developing  an
active adult  community  near Sun City Palm Desert  which will cause  additional
competitive  pressures at that community.  Based on these and other factors, the
Company  reduced its estimate with respect to net new orders and closings in the
fiscal years ending June 30,1997 and beyond to below the levels  achieved in the
three  fiscal years ended June 30, 1995.  This  resulted in expected  future net
cash flows  (undiscounted  and without interest charges) at Sun City Palm Desert
being less than the book value of the asset.  As required  by SFAS No. 121,  the
Company  therefore  recorded in fiscal 1996 a non-cash  loss from  impairment of
southern  California real estate  inventories to reflect Sun City Palm Desert at
its estimated fair value.  Fair value was estimated  based upon an evaluation of
comparable market prices and discounted expected future cash flows.

The Company owns  additional  land for a second phase of development at Sun City
Palm  Desert.  Development  of  subsequent  phases of  large-scale  real  estate
projects is always assessed in light of conditions existing when construction of
the phase is to begin,  and any decision on the  development of the second phase
at this  community will depend on the state of the economy and prospects for the
community at the time the current phase is nearing completion.

INCOME  TAXES.  The change in income tax expense to a $4.2  million  benefit for
fiscal 1996 as compared  to a $15.3  million  expense for fiscal 1995 was due to
the change in earnings  (loss) before  income taxes.  The increase in income tax
expense to $15.3  million in fiscal 1995 as  compared to $9.2  million in fiscal
1994 was due to the increase in earnings before income taxes.  The effective tax
rate in all three years was 35 percent.

NET NEW ORDER  ACTIVITY AND BACKLOG.  Net new orders  increased  29.0 percent in
fiscal 1996 as compared to fiscal 1995.  This increase was largely  attributable
to new sales orders at Sun City  Georgetown  (at which the Company  began taking
new sales orders in June 1995) and substantial increases for Coventry Homes (due
to increases in Phoenix,  Tucson, Las Vegas and southern California  operations)
and Sun City Hilton Head (at which new orders were negatively impacted in fiscal
1995 by adverse weather conditions).

Net new orders at Sun City Tucson decreased 48.4 percent in fiscal 1996 compared
to fiscal 1995, reflecting the approaching build-out of that community.  Net new
orders at the Sun Cities Las Vegas increased 61.2 percent, primarily as a result
of the  commencement  of new  order  activity  at Sun  City  MacDonald  Ranch in
September 1995.

At Sun City Palm Desert,  net new orders  decreased  19.1 percent in fiscal 1996
compared  to fiscal  1995.  Management  continues  to be  concerned  by  adverse
conditions in the southern California economy and real estate market. Future net
new order activity at Sun City Palm Desert will be affected by various  factors,
including  the  condition  of the  southern  California  economy and real estate
market and  competition.  See "Loss from Impairment of Southern  California Real
Estate Inventories."

The number of homes under contract at June 30, 1996 was 11.1 percent higher than
at June 30, 1995.  This increase was primarily  attributable to new sales orders
at Sun City  Georgetown and Sun City MacDonald  Ranch,  partially  offset by the
decreased  net new order  activity  at Sun City  Tucson and a  reduction  in the
number  of homes  under  contract  at Sun  City  Roseville  as a result  of home
closings at that community.
                                       18
<PAGE>
Item 7.           Management's  Discussion  and Analysis of Financial  Condition
                  and Results of Operations (Continued)

Net new orders  increased  9.4 percent in fiscal 1995  compared to fiscal  1994.
This increase was  attributable to new sales orders at Sun City  Roseville,  Sun
City Hilton Head,  Sun City  Georgetown  and the  expansion  of Coventry  Homes'
conventional  subdivision  homebuilding  operations.  The Company did not have a
full year of sales  activity at Sun City Roseville in fiscal 1994 and began home
sales  activity at Sun City Hilton Head and Sun City  Georgetown in fiscal 1995.
At the more mature  communities of Sun City West, Sun City  Summerlin,  Sun City
Tucson and Sun City Palm Desert,  net new orders decreased by 14.8 percent,  due
primarily to exceptionally high new order activity at Sun City West and Sun City
Summerlin in the prior year,  the winding down of new order activity at Sun City
Tucson as build-out of that community approaches and the effect on Sun City Palm
Desert of continued adverse conditions in the southern California economy.

The number of homes in backlog at June 30, 1995 was 8.2  percent  higher than at
June 30, 1994.  This  increase was  primarily  attributable  to the inclusion of
homes  under  contract  at Sun City  Hilton  Head and Sun  City  Georgetown  and
increases in backlog at Sun City Roseville and Coventry Homes,  partially offset
by declines in homes under contract at the Company's more mature communities.

LIQUIDITY AND FINANCIAL CONDITION OF THE COMPANY
- ------------------------------------------------

At  June  30,  1996  the  Company  had  $18.3  million  of cash  and  short-term
investments,  $190.0 million outstanding under its $300 million senior unsecured
revolving credit facility and $3.0 million  outstanding under its $15 million of
short-term lines of credit.

In August 1995 the Company  publicly sold 2,474,900  shares of its common stock.
The net  proceeds  of  $45.3  million  were  used  to  repay  a  portion  of the
indebtedness  then  outstanding  under the  Company's  then $300 million  senior
unsecured  revolving  credit  facility.  The  Company  has  reborrowed  and will
continue to reborrow under the senior unsecured  revolving credit agreement from
time to time as necessary to fund  development  of existing and new projects and
for other general corporate purposes.

Management believes that the Company's current borrowing capacity, when combined
with existing cash and short-term  investments  and currently  anticipated  cash
flows from the  Company's  operations  will  provide the Company  with  adequate
capital  resources  to  fund  the  Company's  currently   anticipated  operating
requirements  for the  next 12  months.  Given  the  Company's  current  capital
resources,  operating  requirements  reflect limitations on some of the projects
and activities  that the Company might  otherwise  desire to undertake.  In July
1996 the senior unsecured  revolving credit facility was amended to increase the
amount of the facility to $350  million.  This  amendment  will provide  greater
flexibility in the nature and timing of future development expenditures.

The Company's senior unsecured  revolving credit facility and the indentures for
the Company's  publicly-held debt contain restrictions which could, depending on
the circumstances,  affect the Company's ability to borrow in the future. If the
Company at any time is not  successful in obtaining  sufficient  capital to fund
its then planned  development  and  expansion  expenditures,  some or all of its
projects  may be  significantly  delayed.  Any such delay  could  result in cost
increases and may adversely affect the Company's results of operations.

The cash flow for each of the  Company's  communities  can differ  substantially
from reported  earnings,  depending on the status of the development  cycle. The
initial years of development or expansion require  significant cash outlays for,
among other things, land acquisition, obtaining master plan and other approvals,
construction of amenities (including golf courses and recreation centers), model
homes,  sales and administration  facilities,  major roads,  utilities,  general
landscaping and interest.  Since these initial costs are generally  capitalized,
this can result in income reported for financial  statement  purposes during the
initial years  significantly  exceeding  cash flow.  However,  after the initial
years of development or expansion,  when these  expenditures are made, cash flow
can significantly exceed earnings reported for financial statement purposes,  as
costs and  expenses  include  amortization  charges for  substantial  amounts of
previously expended costs.
                                       19
<PAGE>
Item 7.           Management's  Discussion  and Analysis of Financial  Condition
                  and Results of Operations (Continued)

During  fiscal  1996 the  Company  generated  $291.4  million  of net cash  from
community  sales  activities,  used $169.1  million of cash for land and lot and
amenity  development  at  operating  communities,  paid $92.7  million for costs
related to communities in the pre-operating stage, generated $8.6 million of net
cash from  conventional  homebuilding  operations and used $83.4 million of cash
for other operating activities. The resulting $45.2 million of net cash used for
operating  activities  (which was primarily  attributable  to  expenditures  for
communities  not yet generating  home sales  revenues) was funded mainly through
borrowings under the Company's  senior  unsecured  revolving credit facility and
proceeds from the sale of common stock.

At June 30, 1996,  under the most  restrictive of the covenants in the Company's
debt agreements,  $9.0 million of the Company's  retained earnings was available
for  payment of cash  dividends  and for the  acquisition  by the Company of its
common stock.

IMPACT OF INFLATION
- -------------------

Operations  of the Company can be  impacted  by  inflation.  Home and land sales
prices can increase,  but inflation can also cause  increases in interest  costs
and the costs of land, raw materials and contract  labor.  Unless such increased
costs  are  recovered  through  higher  sales  prices,  operating  margins  will
decrease.  High mortgage  interest rates may also make it more difficult for the
Company's  potential  customers to sell their existing homes in order to move to
one of the Company's communities or to finance the purchases of their new homes.

Item 8.           Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

The  response  to this item is  submitted  as a separate  section of this report
below.


Item 9.           Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting 
                  and Financial Disclosure

None.
                                       20
<PAGE>
                                    PART III

Item 10.          Directors and Executive Officers of the Registrant

For information  with respect to the Executive  Officers of the Registrant,  see
"Item  1 --  Executive  Officers  of the  Company"  at the end of Part I of this
report.  Information  with  respect  to  the  Directors  of  the  Registrant  is
incorporated herein by reference to the Registrant's  definitive proxy statement
to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A within 120 days after the end of the most
recent fiscal year covered by this Form 10-K.


Item 11.          Executive Compensation

Information in response to this Item is incorporated  herein by reference to the
Registrant's  definitive  proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A
within 120 days after the end of the most  recent  fiscal  year  covered by this
Form 10-K.


Item 12.          Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners
                  and Management

Information in response to this Item is incorporated  herein by reference to the
Registrant's  definitive  proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A
within 120 days after the end of the most  recent  fiscal  year  covered by this
Form 10-K.


Item 13.          Certain Relationships and Related Transactions

Information in response to this Item is incorporated  herein by reference to the
Registrant's  definitive  proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A
within 120 days after the end of the most  recent  fiscal  year  covered by this
Form 10-K.
                                       21
<PAGE>
                                     PART IV

Item 14.          Exhibits,  Financial  Statement  Schedules and Reports on Form
                  8-K

(a)      1. and 2.         The response to this  portion of Item 14 is submitted
                           as a separate  section of this  report  beginning  on
                           page 24.

         3.                Exhibits

                           The Exhibit  Index  attached to this Report is hereby
                           incorporated by reference.

(b)      In the quarter  ended June 30, 1996 the Company  filed a report on Form
         8-K dated April 24, 1996 stating that, in connection  with its adoption
         of SFAS No. 121, the Company  incurred a non-cash loss from  impairment
         of southern  California real estate  inventories in the amount of $65.0
         million  pre-tax  ($42.3 million after tax) related to the valuation of
         its Sun City Palm Desert active adult community.

                                       22
<PAGE>
                                   SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the  requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities  Exchange
Act of 1934,  the  registrant  has duly  caused  this report to be signed on its
behalf by the undersigned,  who is duly authorized to do so, in Phoenix, Arizona
on the 22nd day of August, 1996.

                                   DEL WEBB CORPORATION
                                   (Registrant)

                                   By:      /s/ Philip J. Dion
                                            ------------------------------------
                                            Philip J. Dion
                                            Chairman and Chief Executive Officer

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report
has been signed below by the  following  persons on behalf of the  registrant in
the capacities and on the dates indicated.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
   Signature                                Title                                            Date
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

<S>                                     <C>                                                  <C>
/s/ Philip J. Dion                      Chairman and Chief Executive Officer                 August 22, 1996
- ------------------------------------    (Principal Executive Officer)
   (Philip J. Dion)                     

/s/ John A. Spencer                     Senior Vice President and Chief                      August 22, 1996
- ------------------------------------    Financial Officer            
   (John A. Spencer)                    (Principal Financial Officer)
                                        

/s/ David E. Rau                        Vice President and Controller                        August 22, 1996
- ------------------------------------    (Principal Accounting Officer)
   (David E. Rau)                       

/s/ D. Kent Anderson                    Director                                             August 22, 1996
- ------------------------------------
   (D. Kent Anderson)

/s/ Robert Bennett                      Director                                             August 22, 1996
- ------------------------------------
   (Robert Bennett)

/s/ Hugh F. Culverhouse, Jr.            Director                                             August 29, 1996
- ------------------------------------
   (Hugh F. Culverhouse, Jr.)

/s/ Kenny C. Guinn                      Director                                             August 22, 1996
- ------------------------------------
   (Kenny C. Guinn)

/s/ J. Russell Nelson                   Director                                             August 22, 1996
- ------------------------------------
   (J. Russell Nelson)

/s/ Peter A. Nelson                     Director                                             August 22, 1996
- ------------------------------------
   (Peter A. Nelson)

/s/ Michael E. Rossi                    Director                                             August 22, 1996
- ------------------------------------
   (Michael E. Rossi)

/s/ C. Anthony Wainwright               Director                                             August 30, 1996
- ------------------------------------
   (C. Anthony Wainwright)

/s/ Sam Yellen                          Director                                             August 22, 1996
- ------------------------------------
   (Sam Yellen)
</TABLE>
                                       23
<PAGE>
                              DEL WEBB CORPORATION
                                    FORM 10-K
                         Item 8, Item 14(a) (1) and (2)
             Index of Consolidated Financial Statements and Schedule


The following  financial  statements required to be included in Item 8 and other
disclosures by the Registrant are listed below:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                              PAGE
<S>                                                                                                            <C>
Management's Report........................................................................................... 25

Independent Auditors' Report.................................................................................. 26

Consolidated Financial Statements:

            Balance Sheets as of June 30, 1996 and 1995....................................................... 27

            Statements of Operations for each of the years in the three-year
              period ended June 30, 1996...................................................................... 28

            Statements of Shareholders' Equity for each of the years in the
              three-year period ended June 30, 1996........................................................... 29

            Statements of Cash Flows for each of the years in the three-year
              period ended June 30, 1996...................................................................... 30

            Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements........................................................ 32
</TABLE>

Separate financial statements of the Company's  subsidiaries that are guarantors
of the  Company's 10 7/8%  Senior Notes due 2000 are not included  because those
subsidiaries are jointly and severally liable as guarantors of the Notes and the
aggregate  assets,  liabilities,  earnings and equity of those  subsidiaries are
substantially equivalent to the assets, liabilities,  earnings and equity of the
Company and its subsidiaries on a consolidated basis.


The  following   financial   statement   schedule  of  the  Registrant  and  its
subsidiaries is included in Item 14(a) (2):
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                              PAGE
Consolidated Financial Statement Schedule:

        <S>                                                                                                    <C>
        II  Valuation and Qualifying Accounts for each of the years in the
            three-year period ended June 30, 1996............................................................. 45
</TABLE>

Schedules  other than the one listed  above are omitted  because the  conditions
requiring their filing do not exist or because the required information is given
in the financial statements, including the notes thereto.
                                       24
<PAGE>
MANAGEMENT'S REPORT

Financial Statements

Del Webb  Corporation is  responsible  for the  preparation,  integrity and fair
presentation of its published  financial  statements.  The financial  statements
that follow have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted  accounting
principles and, as such,  include amounts based on judgements and estimates made
by management.  The Company also prepared the other information  included in the
annual  report and is  responsible  for its  accuracy and  consistency  with the
financial statements.

The financial  statements have been audited by the independent  accounting firm,
KPMG Peat  Marwick  LLP,  which was given  access to all  financial  records and
related data,  including  minutes of all meetings of shareholders,  the board of
directors  and  committees  of  the  board.   The  Company   believes  that  all
representations  made to the independent  auditors during their audit were valid
and  appropriate.  KPMG Peat  Marwick  LLP's audit  report is  presented  on the
following page.

Internal Control System

The Company maintains a system of internal control over financial  reporting and
over safeguarding of assets against unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition
which is designed to provide  reasonable  assurance to the Company's  management
and board of directors regarding the preparation of reliable published financial
statements  and such  asset  safeguarding.  The  system  includes  a  documented
organizational  structure and division of responsibility,  established  policies
and procedures  (including a code of conduct) which are communicated  throughout
the Company, and the selection,  training and development of employees. Internal
auditors  monitor  the  operation  of the  internal  control  system  and report
findings and  recommendations  to  management  and the board of  directors,  and
corrective  actions  are  taken  to  correct  deficiencies  if and as  they  are
identified.  The board,  operating through its audit committee which is composed
of  directors  who  are not  officers  or  employees  of the  Company,  provides
oversight to the financial reporting and asset safeguarding process.

Even an effective  internal  control  system,  no matter how well designed,  has
inherent  limitations  -- including  the  possibility  of the  circumvention  or
overriding of controls -- and therefore  can provide only  reasonable  assurance
with respect to financial statement preparation and asset safeguarding. Further,
because of changes in conditions, internal control system effectiveness may vary
over time.

The Company assessed its internal control system as of June 30, 1996 in relation
to criteria for effective internal control over financial reporting described in
"Internal Control -- Integrated Framework" issued by the Committee of Sponsoring
Organizations of the Treadway Commission.  Based on its assessment,  the Company
believes  that,  as of June 30,  1996,  its  system  of  internal  control  over
financial  reporting  and  over  safeguarding  of  assets  against  unauthorized
acquisition, use or disposition met those criteria.


/s/ Philip J. Dion
- ------------------------------------
Philip J. Dion
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer


/s/ John A. Spencer
- ------------------------------------
John A. Spencer
Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

June 30, 1996
                                       25
<PAGE>
                          Independent Auditors' Report
                          ----------------------------




The Board of Directors and Shareholders
Del Webb Corporation:

We have audited the  consolidated  financial  statements of Del Webb Corporation
and  subsidiaries  as listed in the  accompanying  index. In connection with our
audits  of the  consolidated  financial  statements,  we also have  audited  the
financial   statement   schedule  listed  in  the  accompanying   index.   These
consolidated  financial  statements  and  financial  statement  schedule are the
responsibility of the Company's management.  Our responsibility is to express an
opinion on these  consolidated  financial  statements  and  financial  statement
schedule based on our audits.

We  conducted  our  audits  in  accordance  with  generally   accepted  auditing
standards.  Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement.  An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements.  An audit also includes
assessing the  accounting  principles  used and  significant  estimates  made by
management,  as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.
We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated  financial statements referred to above present
fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Del Webb Corporation
and  subsidiaries  as of June  30,  1996  and  1995,  and the  results  of their
operations and their cash flows for each of the years in the  three-year  period
ended June 30, 1996 in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles.
Also in our opinion,  the related financial statement schedule,  when considered
in relation to the basic  consolidated  financial  statements  taken as a whole,
presents fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein.

As  discussed in Notes 1 and 12 to the  consolidated  financial  statements,  in
fiscal  1996 the Company  changed its method of  accounting  for  impairment  of
long-lived  assets in  accordance  with the  adoption of  Statement of Financial
Accounting Standards No. 121.


                                                KPMG Peat Marwick LLP
Phoenix, Arizona
August 16, 1996
                                       26
<PAGE>
                      DEL WEBB CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
                           CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
                             June 30, 1996 and 1995
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                         In Thousands
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                      1996           1995
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                                              <C>             <C>         
                                     Assets
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Real estate inventories (Notes 2, 5 and 11)                                      $      899,815  $    828,752
Cash and short-term investments                                                          18,340        18,900
Receivables (Note 3)                                                                     25,162        21,995
Property and equipment, net (Note 4)                                                     27,599        29,326
Deferred income taxes (Note 6)                                                           12,612             -
Other assets                                                                             41,267        26,077
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                 $    1,024,795  $    925,050
=============================================================================================================

                      Liabilities and Shareholders' Equity
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Notes payable, senior and subordinated debt (Note 5)                             $      514,677  $    491,258
Contractor and trade accounts payable                                                    82,918        76,421
Accrued liabilities and other payables                                                   68,920        52,046
Home sale deposits                                                                       88,304        66,887
Income taxes payable (Note 6)                                                             5,200         3,899
Deferred income taxes (Note 6)                                                                -         5,197
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
      Total liabilities                                                                 760,019       695,708
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Shareholders' equity:
  Common stock, $.001 par value.  Authorized 30,000,000
    shares; issued 17,541,772 shares and 15,798,649 shares
    at June 30, 1996 and 1995, respectively (Notes 7 and 8)                                  18            16
  Additional paid-in capital (Note 7)                                                   158,262       121,059
  Retained earnings (Note 5)                                                            111,033       122,153
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                        269,313       243,228

  Less cost of common stock in treasury, 3,751 shares and
    877,728 shares at June 30, 1996 and 1995, respectively (Note 7)                         (70)      (11,058)
  Less deferred compensation (Note 8)                                                    (4,467)       (2,828)
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
      Total shareholders' equity                                                        264,776       229,342
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                 $    1,024,795  $    925,050
=============================================================================================================
</TABLE>
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
                                       27
<PAGE>
                      DEL WEBB CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
                      CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
                    Years ended June 30, 1996, 1995 and 1994
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                        In Thousands
                                                                                    Except Per Share Data
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                             1996           1995           1994
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                                     <C>            <C>             <C>          
Revenues (Note 10)                                                      $   1,050,733  $      803,119  $     510,061
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Costs and expenses (Note 10):
    Home construction, land and other                                         807,988         614,847        386,199
    Interest (Note 11)                                                         42,354          31,205         18,003
    Selling, general and administrative                                       147,315         113,235         79,673
    Loss from impairment of southern California real estate
      inventories (Notes 11 and 12)                                            65,000               -              -
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                            1,062,657         759,287        483,875
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

           Earnings (loss) before income taxes                                (11,924)         43,832         26,186
Income taxes (Note 6)                                                           4,173         (15,341)        (9,165)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
           Net earnings (loss)                                          $      (7,751) $       28,491  $      17,021
====================================================================================================================

Weighted average shares outstanding                                            17,425          15,209         15,036
====================================================================================================================

Net earnings (loss) per share                                           $       (0.44)  $        1.87  $        1.13
====================================================================================================================
</TABLE>
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
                                       28
<PAGE>
                      DEL WEBB CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
                 CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY
                    Years ended June 30, 1996, 1995 and 1994
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                In Thousands                                    
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                                                Additional                                           Total        
                                                    Common       Paid-In      Retained    Treasury    Deferred    Shareholders'    
                                                     Stock       Capital      Earnings     Stock    Compensation     Equity       
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
<S>                                               <C>         <C>           <C>         <C>        <C>          <C>             
Balances at July 1, 1993                          $  113,289  $      8,019  $    82,591 $  (2,596) $    (1,857) $     199,446   

Shares issued and retired for stock option and                                                                         
restricted stock plans (123,167 shares of                                                                                       
treasury stock issued and 23,453 shares of                                                                             
common stock retired), net of amortization              (345)          314            -     1,322         (126)         1,165   

Treasury stock acquired, 1,046,751 shares                  -             -            -   (13,326)           -        (13,326)   

Cash dividends ($ .20 per share)                           -             -       (2,982)        -            -         (2,982)   

Net earnings                                               -             -       17,021         -            -         17,021   
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------  
                                                                                                                                
Balances at June 30, 1994                            112,944         8,333       96,630   (14,600)      (1,983)       201,324   

Shares issued and retired for stock option,                                                                            
restricted stock and retirement savings plans                                                                          
(254,781 shares of treasury stock issued and                                                                           
30,291 shares of common stock retired), net                                                                            
of amortization                                         (202)            -            -     3,550         (845)         2,503   

Treasury stock acquired, 444 shares                        -             -            -        (8)           -             (8)   

Change from common stock without par value                                                                             
to $.001 par value common stock (Note 7)            (112,726)      112,726            -         -            -              -   

Cash dividends ($ .20 per share)                           -             -       (2,968)        -            -         (2,968)   

Net earnings                                               -             -       28,491         -            -         28,491   
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------  
                                                                                                                                
Balances at June 30, 1995                                 16       121,059      122,153   (11,058)      (2,828)       229,342   

Shares issued and retired for stock option and                                                                         
restricted stock plans (178,463 shares of                                                                              
common stock issued, 2,200 shares net                                                                                  
increase in treasury stock and 32,512 shares                                                                           
of common stock retired), net of amortization                        2,992            -       (39)      (1,639)         1,314   

Proceeds from sale of 1,597,172 shares of                                                                              
common stock and 877,728 shares of                                                                                     
treasury stock, less offering costs of $3.0                                                                            
million (Note 7)                                           2        34,211            -    11,058            -         45,271   

Treasury stock acquired, 1,551 shares                      -             -            -       (31)           -            (31)   

Cash dividends ($ .20 per share)                           -             -       (3,369)        -            -         (3,369)   

Net loss                                                   -             -       (7,751)        -            -         (7,751)   
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
Balances at June 30, 1996                         $       18  $    158,262  $   111,033 $     (70) $    (4,467) $     264,776   
=============================================================================================================================== 
</TABLE>
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
                                       29
<PAGE>
                      DEL WEBB CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
                      CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                    Years ended June 30, 1996, 1995 and 1994
                                 (In Thousands)
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                1996          1995         1994
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                                         <C>          <C>           <C>         
Cash flows from operating activities:
  Cash received from customers related to community home sales              $   792,835  $    588,526  $   415,090
  Cash received from commercial land sales                                        7,880         1,599        3,730
  Cash paid for costs related to community home construction                   (509,315)     (377,735)    (275,079)
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
    Net cash provided by community sales activities                             291,400       212,390      143,741
  Cash paid for land acquisitions at operating communities                       (8,351)       (8,046)      (5,212)
  Cash paid for lot development at operating communities                        (96,863)      (62,612)     (46,921)
  Cash paid for amenity development at operating communities                    (63,853)      (29,683)     (34,292)
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
    Net cash provided by operating communities                                  122,333       112,049       57,316

  Cash paid for costs related to communities in the pre-operating
      stage                                                                     (92,668)      (98,183)    (101,469)
  Cash received from customers related to conventional
      homebuilding                                                              222,513       146,210       79,282
  Cash paid for land, development, construction and other costs
      related to conventional homebuilding                                     (213,959)     (152,696)    (102,726)
  Cash received from residential land development project                         8,834        10,309        3,143
  Cash paid for corporate activities                                            (34,280)      (29,402)     (24,432)
  Interest paid                                                                 (47,444)      (44,104)     (27,258)
  Cash received (paid) for income taxes                                         (10,501)       (1,796)         759
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
    Net cash used for operating activities                                      (45,172)      (57,613)    (115,385)
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Cash flows from investing activities:
  Purchases of property and equipment                                            (6,715)      (13,256)     (13,380)
  Investments in life insurance policies                                         (3,554)       (1,594)      (2,511)
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
    Net cash used for investing activities                                      (10,269)      (14,850)     (15,891)
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Cash flows from financing activities:
  Borrowings                                                                    305,122       766,968      315,922
  Repayments of debt                                                           (292,260)     (679,985)    (195,706)
  Proceeds from sale of common stock                                             45,271             -            -
  Purchases of treasury stock                                                       (31)           (8)     (13,326)
  Proceeds from exercise of common stock options                                    148           882          164
  Dividends paid                                                                 (3,369)       (2,968)      (2,982)
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
    Net cash provided by financing activities                                    54,881        84,889      104,072
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Net increase (decrease) in cash and short-term investments                         (560)       12,426      (27,204)
Cash and short-term investments at beginning of year                             18,900         6,474       33,678
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Cash and short-term investments at end of year                              $    18,340  $     18,900  $     6,474
==================================================================================================================
</TABLE>
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
                                       30
<PAGE>
                      DEL WEBB CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
                CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS (Continued)
                    Years ended June 30, 1996, 1995 and 1994
                                 (In Thousands)
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                               1996           1995         1994
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                                        <C>            <C>          <C>        
Reconciliation of net earnings (loss) to net cash used for operating 
activities:
   Net earnings (loss)                                                     $     (7,751)  $    28,491  $    17,021
   Allocation of non-cash common costs to costs and expenses,
         excluding interest                                                     247,734       188,081      110,478
   Amortization of capitalized interest in costs and expenses                    42,354        31,205       18,003
   Deferred compensation amortization                                             1,804         1,598        1,330
   Depreciation and other amortization                                            8,740         5,243        3,698
   Deferred income taxes                                                        (17,810)       16,801        9,061
   Non-cash loss from impairment of southern California real estate
          inventories                                                            65,000             -            -
   Net increase in home construction costs                                      (35,445)      (42,566)     (34,192)
   Land acquisitions                                                            (37,176)      (39,332)     (81,788)
   Lot development                                                             (190,959)     (154,864)     (89,983)
   Amenity development                                                         (103,086)      (78,785)     (62,621)
   Pre-acquisition costs                                                         (8,732)       (2,770)      (5,228)
   Net change in other assets and liabilities                                    (9,845)      (10,715)      (1,164)
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
      Net cash used for operating activities                               $    (45,172)  $   (57,613)  $ (115,385)
==================================================================================================================
</TABLE>
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
                                       31
<PAGE>
                      DEL WEBB CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
                   NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                          June 30, 1996, 1995 and 1994


(1)      SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

         Principles of Consolidation
         ---------------------------

         The consolidated  financial statements include the accounts of Del Webb
         Corporation   and  its   Subsidiaries   ("Company").   All  significant
         intercompany   transactions   and  accounts  have  been  eliminated  in
         consolidation.  Certain financial statement items from prior years have
         been  reclassified  to be  consistent  with the current year  financial
         statement presentation.

         Operations
         ----------

         The  Company's   operations   include  its  communities,   conventional
         homebuilding  operations and residential land development  project. The
         Company's  communities  are  large-scale,   master-planned  residential
         communities at which the Company controls all phases of the master plan
         development  process from land selection  through the  construction and
         sale of homes.  Within its  communities,  the Company is the  exclusive
         builder of homes. The Company's  conventional  homebuilding  operations
         encompass  the  construction  and sale of homes  in  subdivisions.  The
         Company's  residential land development  project is being completed and
         includes the sale of individual land parcels and lots to other builders
         and  developers  for  conventional   housing  and  related   commercial
         development.

         The  Company's  operations  are  subject  to  a  number  of  risks  and
         uncertainties, including, but not limited to, risks associated with the
         development of future and newer communities  (including  development in
         new geographic areas), competition, the real estate markets and general
         economic  conditions  of the areas in which the Company  competes,  the
         availability  and cost of financing,  fluctuations  in interest  rates,
         fluctuations in labor and raw material costs,  governmental regulation,
         environmental considerations,  period-to-period fluctuations during the
         long-term  operations  of the  Company's  communities,  the  geographic
         concentration  of the Company's  operations  and certain  natural risks
         that exist in some of the Company's market areas.

         Real Estate Inventories
         -----------------------

         Real estate inventories  include  undeveloped land,  partially improved
         land,  amenities  and homes on  finished  lots,  in  various  stages of
         completion.  These assets include direct  construction  costs for homes
         and common costs.  Common costs include land,  general and  subdivision
         land  development  costs,  model and  vacation  home costs in excess of
         normal direct  construction  costs,  costs of community  sales centers,
         costs  of  assets  (such  as  golf  courses  and  recreation   centers)
         contributed  to  certain  of  the  community  associations,   costs  of
         subsidizing the community  associations,  other costs (such as property
         taxes and pre-operating costs) and development period interest,  all of
         which are  capitalized.  The  capitalized  costs and  estimated  future
         common  costs are  allocated,  on a community by  community  basis,  to
         residential and commercial lots based upon the estimated relative sales
         value that each lot has to the estimated  aggregate  sales value of all
         lots in the  community.  Home  construction,  land and other  costs and
         expenses  includes  the  direct  construction  costs of the home and an
         allocation of common costs.  Sales  commissions,  advertising and other
         marketing expenses are included in selling,  general and administrative
         expenses. The Company recognizes revenue at close of escrow.

         The  Company  values its real estate  inventories  in  accordance  with
         Statement  of  Financial   Accounting   Standards   ("SFAS")  No.  121,
         Accounting for the  Impairment of Long-Lived  Assets and for Long-Lived
         Assets to Be Disposed Of, which was issued by the Financial  Accounting
         Standards  Board in March 1995 and which the Company  adopted in fiscal
         1996.  In  accordance  with  SFAS  No.  121,  prior  period   financial
         statements  have not been  restated to reflect the change in accounting
         principle.
                                       32
<PAGE>
(1)      SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Continued)

         SFAS No. 121  requires  that  long-lived  assets,  such as real  estate
         inventories,  be reviewed for impairment  whenever events or changes in
         circumstances  indicate  that the book  value of the  asset  may not be
         recoverable.  If  the  sum  of  the  expected  future  net  cash  flows
         (undiscounted  and without  interest  charges) from an asset to be held
         and used is less than the book value of the asset,  an impairment  loss
         must be  recognized  in the amount of the  difference  between the book
         value and fair value,  as opposed to the difference  between book value
         and net realizable value under the previous  accounting  standard.  For
         long-term assets like active adult  communities,  the  determination of
         whether  there is an  impairment  loss is  dependent  primarily  on the
         Company's  estimate  of  annual  home  closings  over  the  life of the
         community,  which involves  numerous  assumptions  and judgements as to
         future  events  over a period of many  years.  In  connection  with its
         adoption of SFAS No. 121,  the  Company  incurred a non-cash  loss from
         impairment of southern California real estate inventories in the amount
         of $65.0  million  pre-tax  ($42.3  million  after tax)  related to the
         valuation of its Sun City Palm Desert active adult  community (see Note
         12).

         Cash and Short-Term Investments
         -------------------------------

         The   Company's   policy   is  to  invest   its  cash  in   high-grade,
         income-producing short-term investments.  Accordingly,  uninvested cash
         balances are generally kept at minimum levels.  Short-term  investments
         are  valued  at the  lower of cost or market  and  principally  include
         overnight repurchase agreements, certificates of deposit and commercial
         paper with an original maturity of less than 90 days.

         Depreciation
         ------------

         Depreciation is computed using principally the straight-line method for
         financial  statement purposes and accelerated methods for tax purposes,
         over the estimated useful lives of the assets.

         Income Taxes
         ------------

         The Company  accounts for income taxes in accordance with SFAS No. 109,
         Accounting  for Income Taxes.  Under the asset and liability  method of
         SFAS No. 109,  deferred tax assets and  liabilities  are recognized for
         the future tax  consequences  attributable  to differences  between the
         financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities
         and their respective tax bases. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are
         measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in
         future years in which those  temporary  differences  are expected to be
         recovered  or settled.  Under SFAS No. 109,  the effect on deferred tax
         assets and  liabilities  of a change in tax rates is  recognized in the
         consolidated  statement of operations as an adjustment to the effective
         income tax rate in the period that includes the enactment date.

         Earnings (Loss) Per Share
         -------------------------

         Earnings (loss) per share is determined by dividing net earnings (loss)
         by the weighted average number of common and common  equivalent  shares
         outstanding  during the year.  Common  equivalent shares of 382,000 and
         219,000  included in the  computation  of earnings per share for fiscal
         1995 and 1994, respectively, represent the effect of stock options.

         Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows
         -------------------------------------

         In the  Consolidated  Statements  of Cash Flows,  the  Company  defines
         operating  communities  as  communities  generating  revenues from home
         closings.  Communities  in the  pre-operating  stage  are those not yet
         generating revenues from home closings.

         Warranty Costs
         --------------

         Estimated future warranty costs are charged to home construction,  land
         and other costs and expenses  when the revenues  from home closings are
         recognized.
                                       33
<PAGE>
(1)      SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Continued)

         Financial Instruments
         ---------------------

         In the normal  course of  business,  the  Company may invest in various
         financial assets and incurs various financial liabilities.  The Company
         does  not  trade  in  derivative  financial  instruments,  although  it
         occasionally  enters into  agreements  involving  derivative  financial
         instruments  for  purposes  other than  trading.  At June 30,  1996 the
         Company had no derivative financial instruments.

         The fair value estimates of financial  instruments  presented in Note 5
         have been determined by the Company using available market  information
         and  valuation   methodologies   deemed  appropriate  by  the  Company.
         Considerable  judgement  is  required  in  interpreting  market data to
         develop  the  estimates  of fair value.  Accordingly,  these fair value
         estimates  are not  necessarily  indicative  of the amounts the Company
         might pay or receive in actual market transactions. Potential taxes and
         other  transaction  costs have not been  considered in estimating  fair
         value. As  substantially  all of the Company's  assets  (including real
         estate  inventories,  property and equipment and deferred income taxes)
         are not financial instruments, the disclosures in Note 5 do not reflect
         the value of the Company as a whole.

         The fair values of the Company's publicly held debt are estimated based
         on the quoted bid prices for these debt  instruments  on June 30, 1996.
         The carrying  amounts of the Company's  remaining debt  approximate the
         estimated fair values because they are at interest rates  comparable to
         rates  currently  available to the Company for debt with similar  terms
         and remaining  maturities.  For all other  financial  instruments,  the
         carrying  amounts  approximate  the fair  values  because  of the short
         maturity  of these  instruments  and in some  cases  because  they bear
         interest at market rates.

         Use of Estimates
         ----------------

         The preparation of the Company's  consolidated  financial statements in
         conformity  with  generally  accepted  accounting  principles  requires
         management  to  make  estimates  and  assumptions,  particularly  those
         previously  discussed  for real  estate  inventories,  that  affect the
         amounts   reported  in  the  consolidated   financial   statements  and
         accompanying  notes.  Actual results could differ materially from those
         estimates.

(2)      REAL ESTATE INVENTORIES

         The components of real estate inventories are as follows:
         <TABLE>
         <CAPTION>
                                                                                             In Thousands          
                                                                                              at June 30,          
         --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                                                                         1996            1995      
         --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
         <S>                                                                        <C>             <C>             
         Home construction costs                                                    $      177,800  $      142,355 
         Unamortized improvement and amenity costs                                         439,679         356,457 
         Unamortized capitalized interest                                                   43,661          55,793 
         Land held for housing                                                             168,530         220,297 
         Land held for future development or sale                                           70,145          53,850 
         --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                                                                    $      899,815  $      828,752 
         ========================================================================================================= 
         </TABLE>
                                       34
<PAGE>
(2)      REAL ESTATE INVENTORIES (Continued)

         At June 30,  1996,  the Company had 252  completed  homes and 480 homes
         under  construction  that were not subject to a sales  contract.  These
         homes  represented  $20.1 million and $15.0 million,  respectively,  of
         home construction  costs at June 30, 1996. At June 30, 1995 the Company
         had 366 completed homes and 388 homes under construction  (representing
         $26.3 million and $10.3  million,  respectively,  of home  construction
         costs) that were not subject to a sales contract.

         Included in land held for future  development  or sale at June 30, 1996
         were 385 acres of residential  land,  commercial land and worship sites
         that are currently being marketed for sale at the Company's communities
         and conventional  homebuilding  operations.  Also included in land held
         for  future  development  or sale at June 30,  1996  were 294  acres of
         residential land and commercial land at the Company's  residential land
         development project.

(3)      RECEIVABLES

         Receivables are summarized as follows:
         <TABLE>
         <CAPTION>
                                                                                            In Thousands         
                                                                                             at June 30,         
         ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                       1996              1995      
         ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         <S>                                                                     <C>               <C>             
         Escrow funds from home sales                                            $          7,479  $          7,089
         Note from sale of commercial building                                              2,603             2,665
         Mortgages held for sale                                                            9,073             3,617
         Notes from sales of land                                                           1,944             1,708
         Other                                                                              4,063             6,916
         ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                 $         25,162  $         21,995
         ==========================================================================================================
         </TABLE>
         
(4)      PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT, NET


         Property  and  equipment,  stated  at  cost,  and  related  accumulated
         depreciation are summarized as follows:
         <TABLE>
         <CAPTION>
                                                                                            In Thousands
                                                                                             at June 30, 
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                                                                       1996              1995       
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
         <S>                                                                     <C>               <C>              
         Buildings and improvements                                              $          9,120  $          9,422 
         Equipment                                                                         39,133            35,267 
         Land and improvements                                                              2,839             2,839 
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                                                                           51,092            47,528 
         Less accumulated depreciation                                                     23,493            18,202 
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                                                                 $         27,599  $         29,326 
         ========================================================================================================== 
         </TABLE>
                                       35
<PAGE>
(5)      NOTES PAYABLE, SENIOR AND SUBORDINATED DEBT

         Notes payable, senior and subordinated debt consists of the following:
         <TABLE>
         <CAPTION>

                                                                                             In Thousands 
                                                                                              at June 30, 
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                                                                       1996             1995        
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
         <S>                                                                     <C>               <C>              
         10 7/8% Senior Notes, net                                               $         97,475  $         96,787 
         9 3/4% Senior Subordinated Debentures, net                                        97,259            96,847 
         9% Senior Subordinated Debentures, net                                            97,355            97,081 
         Subordinated Swiss Franc Bonds, net                                                    -            12,745 
                                                                                                                    
         Notes payable to banks under a revolving credit facility and short-                                        
             term lines of credit                                                         193,000           160,200 
                                                                                                                    
         Real estate and other notes, variable interest rates from prime to                                         
             prime plus 1% and fixed rates from 9.0% to 10.2%, interest                                             
             payable quarterly, maturities to 2004                                         29,588            27,598 
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                                                                 $        514,677  $        491,258 
         ========================================================================================================== 
         </TABLE>
         
         In April 1992 the Company  completed a public  offering of $100 million
         of Senior Notes, which are shown net of unamortized  deferred financing
         costs and  discount.  The  Notes  are due on March 31,  2000 and have a
         stated  interest  rate of 10 7/8 percent per year.  Interest is payable
         semi-annually  on March  31 and  September  30.  The  annual  effective
         interest rate of the Notes,  after giving effect to the amortization of
         deferred financing costs and discount,  is 11.6 percent.  The Notes may
         be redeemed  by the Company  after March 31, 1997 at 100 percent of the
         principal  amount  of the  Notes  redeemed,  plus  accrued  and  unpaid
         interest to the redemption date.

         In March 1993 the Company  completed a public  offering of $100 million
         of Senior Subordinated  Debentures,  which are shown net of unamortized
         deferred  financing  costs and discount.  These  Debentures  are due on
         March 1,  2003 and have a stated  interest  rate of 9 3/4  percent  per
         year. Interest is payable semi-annually on March 1 and September 1. The
         annual effective  interest rate of the Debentures,  after giving effect
         to the amortization of deferred  financing costs and discount,  is 10.2
         percent.  The  Debentures  may be  redeemed  by the Company on or after
         March 1, 1998, 1999 and 2000 at 104.875  percent,  102.4375 percent and
         100 percent,  respectively,  of the principal  amount of the Debentures
         redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest to the redemption date.

         In  February  1994 the  Company  completed  a public  offering  of $100
         million  of  Senior  Subordinated  Debentures,  which  are shown net of
         unamortized  deferred  financing  costs.  These  Debentures  are due on
         February  15,  2006 and have a stated  interest  rate of 9 percent  per
         year.  Interest is payable  semi-annually on February 15 and August 15.
         The annual  effective  interest  rate of the  Debentures,  after giving
         effect to the amortization of deferred financing costs, is 9.3 percent.
         The  Debentures may be redeemed by the Company on or after February 15,
         1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 and 2003 at 104.500,  103.375,  102.250, 101.125
         and  100  percent,   respectively,  of  the  principal  amount  of  the
         Debentures redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest to the redemption
         date.

         In February 1986 the Company issued 50 million Subordinated Swiss Franc
         Bonds ($24  million)  outside of the United  States and  simultaneously
         entered into a currency exchange  agreement.  In February 1996 the then
         remaining  Bonds matured and were paid. The related  currency  exchange
         agreement was fully performed and expired in February 1996.

         The Company also had an interest rate swap  agreement  which called for
         an interest rate  conversion  from a variable rate to a fixed rate on a
         notional  amount of $20  million.  This  agreement  expired in February
         1996. As a result of this agreement,  the Company incurred net interest
         of $0.6  million,  $1.0  million and $1.4  million for the fiscal years
         ended June 30, 1996, 1995, and 1994, respectively.
                                       36
<PAGE>
(5)      NOTES PAYABLE, SENIOR AND SUBORDINATED DEBT (Continued)

         In March 1994 the Company  established a $125 million senior  unsecured
         revolving  credit  facility.  The  facility was amended to increase the
         amount of the facility to $175 million in November  1994,  $300 million
         in June 1995 and $350  million in July 1996.  If the  revolving  credit
         facility is not subsequently amended, its capacity will begin declining
         in June 1998 through its maturity in December  2000.  Borrowings  under
         this  facility  bear  interest  at the prime  rate or,  if the  Company
         selects,  at the  Eurodollar  rate plus  1.95  percent.  The  effective
         interest  rate on  borrowings  outstanding  under the senior  unsecured
         revolving credit facility at June 30, 1996 is 7.5 percent.

         The senior  unsecured  revolving credit facility and the indentures for
         the  Company's   publicly-held  debt  contain  covenants  which,  taken
         together and among other things,  limit  investments in unentitled land
         and unsold homes under construction,  conventional homebuilding assets,
         dividends,  stock  repurchases,  incurrence of indebtedness and certain
         acquisitions and which could,  depending on the  circumstances,  affect
         the Company's ability to borrow in the future.

         At June 30, 1996 the Company had $190.0 million  outstanding  under its
         $300  million  senior  unsecured  revolving  credit  facility  and $3.0
         million  outstanding  under  its $15  million  of  short-term  lines of
         credit.

         At June 30, 1996,  under the most  restrictive  of the covenants in the
         Company's  debt  agreements,  $9.0  million of the  Company's  retained
         earnings  was  available  for  payment  of cash  dividends  and for the
         acquisition by the Company of its common stock.

         The  estimated  fair  values at June 30, 1996 of the  Company's  Senior
         Notes, 9 3/4% Senior Subordinated Debentures and 9% Senior Subordinated
         Debentures  were $101.5  million,  $100.0  million  and $92.5  million,
         respectively.

         The principal payment  requirements (in thousands) on debt for the next
         five years ended June 30 are as follows:


                                 1997      $      23,219  
                                 1998      $       2,870  
                                 1999      $      76,825  
                                 2000      $     174,351  
                                 2001      $      38,962  
                                 

(6)      INCOME TAXES

         Components of Income Taxes         
         --------------------------         
                                            
         The components of income taxes are:
         <TABLE>
         <CAPTION>
                                                                                      In Thousands                  
                                                                                   Year Ended June 30,              
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                                                          1996            1995            1994      
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
         <S>                                                         <C>             <C>              <C>           
         Current:                                                                                                   
           Federal                                                   $       11,333  $       (3,336)  $          49 
           State                                                              2,304           1,876              55 
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                                                             13,637          (1,460)            104 
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
         Deferred:                                                                                                  
           Federal                                                          (15,084)         15,953           7,364 
           State                                                             (2,726)            848           1,697 
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                                                            (17,810)         16,801           9,061 
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                   Income tax expense (benefit)                      $       (4,173)  $      15,341  $        9,165 
         ========================================================================================================== 
         </TABLE>
                                       37
<PAGE>
(6)      INCOME TAXES (Continued)

         Components of Deferred Income Taxes
         -----------------------------------

         The components of deferred income taxes are as follows:
         <TABLE>
         <CAPTION>
                                                                                               In Thousands                  
                                                                                   Year Ended June 30,              
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                                                          1996            1995            1994      
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
         <S>                                                         <C>              <C>            <C>             
         Change in net operating loss carryforwards                  $         (201)  $      15,164  $       (2,197) 
         Change in loss provisions for discontinued                                                                 
           operations                                                         1,854           3,556          (2,260) 
         Change in basis differences of real estate                         (18,214)          9,721          18,076 
         Deferred compensation                                               (1,087)           (237)         (1,356) 
         Amortization of short period loss                                      486              76             262 
         Accelerated depreciation                                             4,245          (6,037)         (2,973) 
         Change in deferred tax asset valuation allowance                         -          (2,744)         (1,115) 
         Other                                                               (4,893)         (2,698)            624 
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                  Deferred income tax expense (benefit)              $      (17,810)  $      16,801  $        9,061 
         ========================================================================================================== 
         </TABLE>
         
         The  deferred  income tax  benefit  for fiscal  1996,  and the  related
         deferred tax asset at June 30, 1996,  resulted  from the non-cash  loss
         from  impairment  of  southern   California  real  estate   inventories
         recognized by the Company in fiscal 1996 (see Note 12).

         Included  in  deferred  income  taxes  for  fiscal  1995  and  1994 are
         reductions  in the  deferred  tax  asset  valuation  allowance  of $2.7
         million and $1.1 million, respectively.  These reductions resulted from
         additional years of operating earnings generated by the Company,  which
         increased the portion of the gross  deferred tax asset that the Company
         believed would more likely than not be realized.
                                       38
<PAGE>

(6)      INCOME TAXES (Continued)

         Deferred Tax Assets and Liabilities
         -----------------------------------

         Deferred  tax  assets  and  liabilities  have  been  recognized  in the
         consolidated   balance   sheets  due  to   temporary   difference   and
         carryforwards as follows:
         <TABLE>
         <CAPTION>
                                                                                           In Thousands             
                                                                                            at June 30,           
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                      1996               1995     
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         <S>                                                                  <C>                 <C>             
         Deferred tax assets:                                                                                     
            Net operating loss carryforwards                                  $              201  $              -
            Tax credit carryforwards                                                       3,051             4,649
            Liabilities of discontinued operations,                                                               
              principally due to loss provisions                                           7,579             9,433
            Property and equipment, principally due                                                               
              to differences in depreciation                                               7,224            11,469
            State income taxes                                                             2,886             2,948
            Amortization of short period loss                                                  -               486
            Deferred compensation                                                          5,374             4,287
            Other loss provisions                                                          8,903             4,519
            Other                                                                            766               966
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                          35,984            38,757
            Valuation allowance                                                            3,862             3,862
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                          32,122            34,895
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         Deferred tax liabilities:                                                                                
            Real estate, principally due to basis differences                             18,285            36,499
            Other                                                                          1,225             3,593
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                          19,510            40,092
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  Net deferred income taxes                                   $           12,612  $         (5,197)
         =========================================================================================================
         </TABLE>
                                               
         Reconciliation of Effective Income Tax Expense (Benefit)
         --------------------------------------------------------

         Income tax expense  (benefit)  differs from the amounts  computed using
         the federal statutory income tax rate as a result of the following:
         <TABLE>
         <CAPTION>
         
                                                                                      In Thousands                  
                                                                                   Year Ended June 30,              
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                                                          1996            1995            1994      
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
         <S>                                                         <C>              <C>            <C>            
         Expected tax at current federal statutory                                                                  
             income tax rate                                         $       (4,173)  $      15,341  $        9,165 
         State income taxes, net of federal benefit                            (274)          1,771           1,139 
         Tax credits                                                         (2,580)              -               - 
         Adjustments due to the settlement of audits and                                                            
         resolution of issues                                                 2,407             718               - 
         Change in deferred tax asset valuation allowance                         -          (2,744)         (1,115) 
         Other                                                                  447             255             (24) 
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                  Total income tax expense (benefit)                 $       (4,173)  $      15,341  $        9,165 
         ========================================================================================================== 
         </TABLE>
                                       39
<PAGE>
(6)      INCOME TAXES (Continued)

         Carryforwards
         -------------

         For federal  income tax purposes,  at June 30, 1996 the Company had tax
         credit  carryforwards  and a state net operating loss  carryforward  of
         $3.1 million and $4.0 million,  respectively,  that expire beginning in
         fiscal 2000 and fiscal 2010, respectively.

(7)      EQUITY TRANSACTIONS

         In August 1995 the Company publicly sold 2,474,900 shares of its common
         stock.  The net proceeds of $45.3  million were used to repay a portion
         of the indebtedness  then outstanding  under the Company's $300 million
         senior unsecured revolving credit facility.

         In November 1994 the Company  changed its state of  incorporation  from
         Arizona to  Delaware.  In  connection  with this  reincorporation,  the
         common  stock  changed  from common  stock  without par value to common
         stock  with a par  value  of  $.001  per  share,  which  resulted  in a
         consolidated balance sheet reclassification within shareholders' equity
         from common stock to additional paid-in capital. There was no impact on
         total shareholders' equity as a result of the reincorporation.

(8)      COMMON STOCK RESERVED

         The Company has five stock  option  plans:  the 1981 Stock  Option Plan
         (under which no grants can be made  subsequent  to December 31,  1991),
         the 1986 Stock Option and Stock  Appreciation  Rights (SAR) Plan (under
         which no grants can be made  subsequent  to December  31, 1995) and the
         1991,  1993 and 1995 Executive  Long-Term  Incentive Plans (1991 ELTIP,
         1993 ELTIP and 1995  ELTIP,  which cover both  options  and  restricted
         stock  grants).  Options  under each of these  plans are granted to key
         employees to purchase  shares of the Company's  common stock at a price
         not less than the current  market  price at the date of the grant.  The
         options  are  exercisable  over a ten-year  period from the date of the
         grant.  Shares authorized for grant under the 1991 ELTIP total 750,000.
         Shares  authorized for grant under the 1993 ELTIP total  1,200,000,  of
         which no more than  450,000 may be used for  restricted  stock  grants.
         Shares  authorized for grant under the 1995 ELTIP total  1,200,000,  of
         which no more than 100,000 may be used for restricted stock grants.

         The Company has the 1991  Directors'  Stock Plan and the 1995  Director
         Stock Plan,  under which options may be granted to the Directors of the
         Company to purchase shares of the Company's common stock at a price not
         less than the current  market  price at the date of grant.  Under these
         plans  the  Directors  may elect to defer  some or all of their  annual
         retainers and receive restricted stock or stock options at prices that,
         when combined with the amounts of deferred retainers, equal the current
         market price at the date of the grant.  Shares  authorized  under these
         plans total 75,000 per plan. 
                                       40
<PAGE>
(8)      COMMON STOCK RESERVED (Continued)

         Activity in the stock  option  plans for the years ended June 30, 1996,
         1995 and 1994 is summarized as follows:
         <TABLE>
         <CAPTION>
         
                                                                                    Year Ended June 30,             
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                                            1996                                                    
                                                         Price Range         1996           1995          1994      
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
         <S>                                             <C>                  <C>            <C>          <C>       
         Options outstanding, beginning of year           $5.63 - $17.69      1,438,470      1,248,019    1,002,218 
           Granted                                       $14.53 - $20.88        388,201        325,720      276,548 
           Exercised                                      $8.00 - $16.88        (12,883)       (72,785)     (14,933) 
           Canceled                                      $16.06 - $20.88        (12,500)       (62,484)     (15,814) 
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
         Options outstanding, end of year                 $5.63 - $20.88      1,801,288      1,438,470    1,248,019 
         ========================================================================================================== 
                                                                                                                    
         Number of options exercisable at                                                                           
           end of year                                                        1,145,236        924,828      800,129 
         Number of options at end of year available                                                                 
           for future option or restricted stock grants                       1,491,646        755,727    1,175,364 
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
         </TABLE>
         
         Shares granted,  net of cancellations,  under the Company's  restricted
         stock  plans  during  the  years  ended  June 30,  1996,  1995 and 1994
         aggregated   163,380   shares,   148,901  shares  and  108,234  shares,
         respectively.  The  Company  recognized  compensation  expense  of $1.8
         million,  $1.6 million and $1.3 million related to shares granted under
         the restricted  stock plans for the years ended June 30, 1996, 1995 and
         1994, respectively.

(9)      DEFINED CONTRIBUTION PLAN

         The Company  sponsors a defined  contribution  retirement  savings plan
         that covers substantially all employees of the Company after completion
         of six months of service.  Company  contributions  to this plan,  which
         include amounts based on a percentage of employee contributions as well
         as  discretionary  contributions,  were $2.0 million,  $1.5 million and
         $1.2  million  for the  years  ended  June 30,  1996,  1995  and  1994,
         respectively.
                                       41
<PAGE>
(10)     REVENUES AND COSTS AND EXPENSES

         The components of revenues and costs and expenses:
         <TABLE>
         <CAPTION>


                                                                                    In Thousands                   
                                                                                 Year Ended June 30,               
         --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                                                         1996            1995            1994      
         --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
         <S>                                                        <C>             <C>             <C>            
         Revenues:                                                                                                 
            Homebuilding:                                                                                          
                 Communities                                        $      794,671  $      620,012  $      405,462 
                 Conventional                                              217,158         144,469          79,992 
         --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                     Total  homebuilding                                 1,011,829         764,481         485,454 
            Land sales                                                      29,525          31,892          17,951 
            Other                                                            9,379           6,746           6,656 
         --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                                                    $    1,050,733  $      803,119  $      510,061 
         ========================================================================================================= 
                                                                                                                   
         Costs and expenses:                                                                                       
            Home construction and land:                                                                            
                 Communities                                        $      597,014  $      459,258  $      301,570 
                 Conventional                                              184,532         121,915          67,292 
         --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                      Total homebuilding                                   781,546         581,173         368,862 

            Interest                                                        42,354          31,205          18,003 
            Cost of land sales                                              23,227          28,847          14,197 
            Other cost of sales                                              3,215           4,827           3,140 
            Selling, general and administrative                            147,315         113,235          79,673 
            Loss from impairment of southern California real                                                       
               estate inventories                                           65,000               -               - 
         --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                                                    $    1,062,657  $      759,287  $      483,875 
         ========================================================================================================= 
         </TABLE>

(11)     INTEREST

         The following table shows the components of interest: 
         <TABLE>
         <CAPTION>
         
                                                                                     In Thousands                   
                                                                                  Year Ended June 30,               
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------  
                                                                         1996            1995            1994       
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------  
         <S>                                                        <C>             <C>             <C>             
         Interest incurred                                          $       52,022  $       46,641  $       33,677  
         Less capitalized interest                                          52,022          46,641          33,677  
         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------  
           Interest expense                                         $            -  $            -  $            -  
         =========================================================================================================  
         Amortization of capitalized interest in costs and                                                          
            expenses                                                $       42,354  $       31,205  $       18,003  
         =========================================================================================================  
         Unamortized capitalized interest included in real                                                          
            estate inventories at year end                          $       43,661  $       55,793  $       40,357  
         =========================================================================================================  
                                                                                                                    
         Interest income                                            $        1,017  $          581  $        1,056  
         =========================================================================================================  
         </TABLE>
         
         Unamortized capitalized interest included in real estate inventories at
         June 30,  1996 has been  reduced by $21.8  million,  the portion of the
         non-cash  loss from  impairment  of  southern  California  real  estate
         inventories  allocated to  unamortized  capitalized  interest (see Note
         12).
                                       42
<PAGE>
(12)     IMPAIRMENT OF SOUTHERN CALIFORNIA REAL ESTATE INVENTORIES

         In March 1995 the Financial  Accounting Standards Board issued SFAS No.
         121,  Accounting  for  the  Impairment  of  Long-Lived  Assets  and for
         Long-Lived  Assets to Be  Disposed  Of. The  Company  adopted  this new
         standard in fiscal 1996.  In  connection  with its adoption of SFAS No.
         121, the Company  incurred a non-cash loss from  impairment of southern
         California  real  estate  inventories  in the  amount of $65.0  million
         ($42.3 million after tax) related to the valuation of its Sun City Palm
         Desert active adult community (see Note 1).

         In the first six months of fiscal 1996, net new orders at Sun City Palm
         Desert were substantially below both the comparable period of the prior
         fiscal year and the  Company's  expectations.  Although the Company was
         encouraged by net new orders significantly greater in the first 45 days
         of the third  quarter of fiscal 1996 than in the  comparable  period in
         the prior fiscal year, a lower than anticipated level of net new orders
         was expected in the remainder of fiscal 1996 and net new orders for all
         of fiscal 1996 were anticipated to be lower than in prior fiscal years.
         Additionally,  a national  home builder is  developing  an active adult
         community  near Sun City  Palm  Desert,  which  will  cause  additional
         competitive  pressures  at that  community.  Based on these  and  other
         factors,  the Company  reduced  its  estimate  with  respect to net new
         orders and closings in the fiscal years ending June 30, 1997 and beyond
         to below the levels  achieved in the three  fiscal years ended June 30,
         1995. This resulted in expected future net cash flows (undiscounted and
         without  interest  charges) at Sun City Palm Desert being less than the
         book value of the asset.  As  required  by SFAS No.  121,  the  Company
         therefore  recorded in fiscal 1996 a non-cash  loss from  impairment of
         southern  California  real estate  inventories to reflect Sun City Palm
         Desert at its estimated fair value. Fair value was estimated based upon
         an  evaluation  of comparable  market  prices and  discounted  expected
         future cash flows.

(13)     CONTINGENT LIABILITIES AND COMMITMENTS

         The  Company is a party to  various  legal  proceedings  arising in the
         ordinary  course of  business.  While it is not feasible to predict the
         ultimate  disposition of these matters, it is the opinion of management
         that  their  outcome  will not have a  material  adverse  effect on the
         financial condition of the Company.

         The Company has issued surety bonds,  guarantees and standby letters of
         credit aggregating $139.4 million at June 30, 1996.

         The Company leases from third parties,  under operating leases,  office
         space,  apartment units which it rents to prospective  customers at its
         active adult communities,  automobiles and certain other equipment. The
         leases are generally  renewable at the Company's  option for additional
         periods.  Total rent expense  incurred by the Company was $6.9 million,
         $4.8 million and $3.7  million for the years ended June 30, 1996,  1995
         and 1994, respectively.

         Minimum lease  payments (in  thousands) to be made by the Company under
         non-cancelable lease agreements are as follows:

                  1997                                $         5,153
                  1998                                          3,702
                  1999                                          1,624
                  2000                                          1,555
                  2001                                          1,644
                  Later years                                   5,115
                                                      ----------------
                                                      $        18,782
                                                      ===============
                                       43
<PAGE>
(14)     QUARTERLY FINANCIAL INFORMATION (Unaudited)

         Quarterly  financial  information for the years ended June 30, 1996 and
         1995 is presented below.  The sum of the individual  quarterly data may
         not equal the annual data due to rounding and  fluctuations in weighted
         average shares outstanding on a quarter-to-quarter basis.
         <TABLE>
         <CAPTION>
                                                               In Thousands Except Per Share Data                    
                                                                       Three Months Ended                            
         ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------  
                                                 June 30,        March 31,       December 31,       September 30,    
                                                   1996            1996              1995                1995        
         ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------  
         <S>                                  <C>             <C>             <C>                 <C>                
         Revenues                             $      348,942  $      256,014  $          239,459  $         206,318  
         Net earnings (loss)                          11,945         (35,385)              9,155              6,534  
         Net earnings (loss) per share                   .67           (2.02)                .51                .39  
         ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------  
                                                                                                                     
                                                                                                                     
                                                 June 30,        March 31,       December 31,       September 30,    
                                                   1995            1995              1994               1994         
         ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------  
         Revenues                             $      268,796  $      195,383  $          176,058  $         162,882  
         Net earnings                                  9,580           6,995               6,609              5,307  
         Net earnings per share                          .62             .46                 .44                .35  
         ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------  
         </TABLE>
         
         The net loss in the  quarter  ended March 31,  1996  resulted  from the
         non-cash  loss from  impairment  of  southern  California  real  estate
         inventories  related to the  valuation of the  Company's  Sun City Palm
         Desert active adult community (see Note 12).
                                       44
<PAGE>
                      DEL WEBB CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES          SCHEDULE II
                        VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS            -----------
                    Years ended June 30, 1996, 1995 and 1994

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                            In Thousands
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                Additions     Additions
                                                  Balance at    Charged to   Charged to
                                                 Beginning of   Costs and       Other                   Balance at
                 Classification                      Year        Expenses     Accounts    Deductions   End of Year
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                               <C>           <C>           <C>          <C>          <C>         
1996
- ----
Reserve for residential land development project  $      8,264  $          -  $         -  $     1,138  $      7,126
Deferred tax asset valuation allowance                   3,862             -            -            -         3,862
Reserves for disposal costs of discontinued
   operations                                           27,855             -            -       15,646        12,209
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                  $     39,981  $          -  $         -  $    16,784  $     23,197
====================================================================================================================

1995
- ----
Reserve for residential land development project  $      6,738  $      1,526  $         -  $         -  $      8,264
Deferred tax asset valuation allowance                   6,606             -            -        2,744         3,862
Reserves for disposal costs of discontinued
   operations                                           29,155             -            -        1,300        27,855
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                  $     42,499  $      1,526  $         -  $     4,044  $     39,981
====================================================================================================================

1994
- ----
Reserve for residential land development project  $      7,710  $          -  $         -  $       972  $      6,738
Deferred tax asset valuation allowance                   7,721             -            -        1,115         6,606
Reserves for disposal costs of discontinued
   operations                                           32,314             -            -        3,159        29,155
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                  $     47,745  $          -  $         -  $     5,246  $     42,499
====================================================================================================================
</TABLE>
                                       45
<PAGE>
                              DEL WEBB CORPORATION
                           Report on Form 10-K For The
                            Year Ended June 30, 1996


                               10-K EXHIBIT INDEX
                               ------------------
                        NON-FINANCIAL STATEMENT EXHIBITS
                        --------------------------------

    Exhibit
    Number
    ------

     3.0          Amended  and  Restated  Certificate  of  Incorporation  of the
                  Registrant,  incorporated  by  reference  to  Exhibit  99.0 to
                  Registrant's  Report  on  Form  10-Q  for  the  quarter  ended
                  September 30, 1994.

     3.1          The Bylaws of the  Registrant  effective  November 1, 1994; as
                  amended on February 13, 1996.

     4.1          Indenture  dated as of April 15, 1992 between  Registrant  and
                  United States Trust Company of New York, as Trustee,  defining
                  the rights of holders  of the 10 7/8%  Senior  Notes due 2000,
                  incorporated  by  reference  to  Registration   Statement  No.
                  33-45703.

     4.2          Indenture  dated as of March 8, 1993  between  Registrant  and
                  Fidelity  Trust  Company,  New York, as Trustee,  defining the
                  rights  of  the  holders  of the 9  3/4%  Senior  Subordinated
                  Debentures due 2003, incorporated by reference to Registration
                  Statement No. 33-56898.

     4.3          Indenture dated as of February 4, 1994, between Registrant and
                  The Bank of New York,  as Trustee,  defining the rights of the
                  holders  of the 9%  Senior  Subordinated  Debentures  due 2006
                  incorporated  by  reference  to  Registration   Statement  No.
                  33-68732.

     10.1         Sample  Change of Control  Agreement  between  Registrant  and
                  certain  of its  officers  with  schedule  setting  forth  the
                  differences.

     10.2         Employment  and  Consulting  Agreement  dated  July 10,  1996,
                  between the Registrant and Philip J. Dion.

     10.6         Office Lease Agreement  between Western Plaza Investors,  L.P.
                  and Registrant dated April 20, 1994  incorporated by reference
                  to  Registrant's  Report on Form 10-K for the year  ended June
                  30,  1994;  as amended by the First  Amendment  to Lease dated
                  February 29, 1996.
<PAGE>
10-K Exhibit Index                                                      Page - 2

                                                                       
     10.7         Del Webb Corporation Deferred Compensation Plan effective June
                  1,  1993,   incorporated  by  reference  to  Exhibit  10.7  to
                  Registrant's  Report on Form 10-K for the year  ended June 30,
                  1993.

     10.8         Key  Executive  Life  Insurance  Plan II dated  April 1, 1992,
                  incorporated  by  reference  to Exhibit  10.8 to  Registrant's
                  Report  on Form  10-K for the year  ended  June 30,  1992;  as
                  amended November 8, 1994.

     10.9         Key  Executive   Life  Insurance  Plan  dated  May  15,  1991,
                  incorporated  by  reference to Exhibit  10.10 to  Registrant's
                  Report  on Form  10-K for the year  ended  June 30,  1991;  as
                  amended November 18, 1994.

     10.10        Del  Webb  Corporation   Executive  Long-Term  Incentive  Plan
                  adopted  November  20,  1991,  incorporated  by  reference  to
                  Registrant's  Report on Form 10-K for the year  ended June 30,
                  1992; and First Amendment to the Executive Long-Term Incentive
                  Plan dated June 30, 1993, incorporated by reference to Exhibit
                  10.10 to  Registrant's  Report on Form 10-K for the year ended
                  June 30, 1993.

     10.11        Del Webb  Corporation  1993 Executive Long Term Incentive Plan
                  dated March 17,  1994,  incorporated  by  reference to Exhibit
                  10.11 to  Registrant's  Report on Form 10-K for the year ended
                  June 30, 1994.

     10.12        Del Webb  Corporation  Management  Incentive  Plan Fiscal 1996
                  (July 1, 1995 - June 30, 1996).

     10.13        Del Webb Corporation  Supplemental  Executive  Retirement Plan
                  No. 1, as amended and restated April 20, 1993, incorporated by
                  reference to Exhibit 10.12 to Registrant's Report on Form 10-K
                  for the  year  ended  June  30,  1993;  as  amended  by  First
                  Amendment to the Del Webb Corporation  Supplemental  Executive
                  Retirement Plan No. 1 effective July 1, 1995,  incorporated by
                  reference to Exhibit 10.13 to Registrant's Report on Form 10-K
                  for the year ended June 30, 1995.

     10.14        Del Webb  Corporation  Director  Stock Plan dated November 20,
                  1991,   incorporated   by  reference   to  Exhibit   10.13  to
                  Registrant's  Report on Form 10-K for the year  ended June 30,
                  1993.

     10.15        Amended and Restated Revolving Loan Agreement by and among Del
                  Webb  Corporation  and  Bank of  America  National  Trust  and
                  Savings  Association  as Agent,  and Bank One Arizona,  NA, as
                  Co-Agent,  dated  
<PAGE>
10-K Exhibit Index                                                      Page - 3


                  June 27,  1995;  as  amended by the  Second  Amendment  to the
                  Amended and Restated  Revolving Loan Agreement  effective July
                  22, 1996.

     10.16        Del Webb Corporation  Supplemental  Executive  Retirement Plan
                  No. 2, as amended and restated April 20, 1993, incorporated by
                  reference to Exhibit 10.16 to Registrant's Report on Form 10-K
                  for the  year  ended  June  30,  1993;  as  amended  by  First
                  Amendment to the Del Webb Corporation  Supplemental  Executive
                  Retirement Plan No. 2 effective July 1, 1995,  incorporated by
                  reference to Exhibit 10.16 to Registrant's Report on Form 10-K
                  for the year ended June 30, 1995.

     10.17        Senior  Officer  Medical  and Dental  Reimbursement  Plan,  as
                  amended  and  restated  November  16,  1992,  incorporated  by
                  reference to Exhibit 10.17 to Registrant's Report on Form 10-K
                  for the year ended June 30, 1993.

     10.18        1981 Stock  Option  Plan,  as amended  October  29,  1981;  as
                  amended January 29, 1987, as amended by the Third Amendment to
                  the Del Webb Corporation 1981 Stock Option Plan dated June 30,
                  1993.

     10.19        1986 Stock Option and SAR Plan of the Del Webb Corporation, as
                  amended  January 27, 1987; as amended by the Second  Amendment
                  to the 1986 Stock Option and SAR Plan dated June 30, 1993.

     10.22        Del Webb  Corporation  Retirement  Savings  Plan  Amended  and
                  Restated effective January 1, 1995,  incorporated by reference
                  to Exhibit 10.22 to  Registrant's  Report on Form 10-K for the
                  year ended June 30, 1995; as amended by the First Amendment to
                  the  Retirement  Savings  Plan for the  Employees  of Del Webb
                  Corporation effective as of January 1, 1996.

     10.23        Del E. Webb Corporation Umbrella Trust dated June 11, 1987, as
                  amended by  Amendment  Number One to the Del Webb  Corporation
                  Umbrella Trust dated  February 8, 1989,  and Amendment  Number
                  Two to Del Webb  Corporation  Umbrella  Trust  dated March 14,
                  1990.

     10.24        Sample  Directors  and  Officers   Indemnification   Agreement
                  between  Registrant  and  its  directors  and  officers  dated
                  February 1, 1995 incorporated by reference to the Registrant's
                  Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 1995.

     10.25        Del Webb Corporation 1995 Executive  Long-Term  Incentive Plan
                  adopted  July 13, 1995,  incorporated  by reference to Exhibit
                  10.25 to Registrant's
<PAGE>
10-K Exhibit Index                                                      Page - 4

                  Report  on Form  10-K for the year  ended  June 30,  1995.

     10.26        Del Webb Corporation 1995 Director Stock Plan adopted July 13,
                  1995,   incorporated   by  reference   to  Exhibit   10.26  to
                  Registrant's  Report on Form 10-K for the year  ended June 20,
                  1995.

     10.27        Del Webb Corporation 1995 Executive  Management Incentive Plan
                  adopted  July 13, 1995,  incorporated  by reference to Exhibit
                  10.27 to  Registrant's  Report on Form 10-K for the year ended
                  June 30, 1995.

     10.28        Del Webb  Corporation  Management  Incentive  Plan Fiscal 1997
                  (July 1, 1996 - June 30, 1997).

     10.29        Amended and  Restated  Certificate  and  Agreement  of Limited
                  Partnership of New Mexico Asset Limited Partnership  effective
                  June 18, 1996.

     10.30        Supplemental  Executive  Retirement  Plan No. 1  Participation
                  Agreement  between the  Registrant  and Philip J. Dion Amended
                  and Restated effective July 25, 1996.

     10.31        1995/96  Executive  Management  Incentive Plan Award Agreement
                  between  the  Registrant  and Philip J. Dion  dated  August 8,
                  1995.

     10.33        Key Executive Life Plan 1995 dated October 5, 1995.

     10.34        Group Term Carve-Out Plan dated November 18, 1994.

     10.32        Key Executive Life Plan Plus dated August 23, 1995.

     21.0         List  of  Active  Subsidiaries  and  Associated  Companies  of
                  Registrant.

     23.0         Consent of Experts.

     27           Financial Data Schedule.

                                                                     Exhibit 3.1
                                     BY-LAWS

                                       OF

                              DEL WEBB CORPORATION

                               (the "Corporation")

                          (Effective November 1, 1994)


                                    ARTICLE 1

                                     OFFICES
                                     -------

                  Section 1.1 Registered  Office.  The registered  office of the
Corporation shall be in the City of Wilmington,  County of New Castle,  State of
Delaware.

                  Section  1.2  Other  Offices.  The  Corporation  may also have
offices at such other  places  both  within and without the State of Delaware as
the Board of Directors or the officers may from time to time determine.


                                    ARTICLE 2

                            MEETINGS OF STOCKHOLDERS
                            ------------------------

                  Section 2.1 Place of  Meetings.  Meetings of the  stockholders
for the  election of directors  or for any other  purpose  shall be held at such
time and place,  either  within or without  the State of  Delaware,  as shall be
designated  from time to time by the Board of Directors and stated in the notice
of the meeting or in a duly executed waiver of notice thereof.

                  Section   2.2  Annual   Meetings.   The  Annual   Meetings  of
Stockholders  shall be held on such date and at such time as shall be designated
from  time to time by the Board of  Directors  and  stated in the  notice of the
meeting,  at which  meetings the  stockholders  shall elect by a plurality  vote
members of the Board of  Directors  in the class whose term shall expire at such
Annual  Meeting,  and  transact  such other  business as may properly be brought
before the meeting. Written notice of the Annual Meeting stating the place, date
and hour of the meeting shall be given to each  stockholder  entitled to vote at
such  meeting  not less than ten nor more than sixty days before the date of the
meeting.

                  Section 2.3 Special Meetings.  Unless otherwise  prescribed by
law or by the Certificate of  Incorporation,  Special  Meetings of Stockholders,
for any  purpose  or  purposes,  may be  called by either  the  Chairman  or the
President  and shall be called by either such  officer at the 
<PAGE>
request in writing of a majority of the Board of  Directors.  Such request shall
state the purpose or  purposes  of the  proposed  meeting.  Written  notice of a
Special Meeting stating the place,  date and hour of the meeting and the purpose
or purposes for which the meeting is called shall be given not less than ten nor
more than sixty days before the date of the meeting to each stockholder entitled
to vote at such meeting.

                  Section 2.4 Quorum.  Except as otherwise provided by law or by
the Certificate of Incorporation, the holders of a majority of the capital stock
issued  and  outstanding  and  entitled  to vote  thereat,  present in person or
represented  by  proxy,  shall  constitute  a  quorum  at  all  meetings  of the
stockholders for the transaction of business. If, however, such quorum shall not
be present or represented at any meeting of the  stockholders,  the stockholders
entitled to vote thereat,  present in person or represented by proxy, shall have
power to  adjourn  the  meeting  from time to time,  without  notice  other than
announcement at the meeting, until a quorum shall be present or represented.  At
such adjourned  meeting at which a quorum shall be present or  represented,  any
business may be  transacted  which might have been  transacted at the meeting as
originally noticed. If the adjournment is for more than thirty days, or if after
the adjournment a new record date is fixed for the adjourned  meeting,  a notice
of the  adjourned  meeting  shall be given not less than ten nor more than sixty
days before the date of the adjourned  meeting to each  stockholder  entitled to
vote at the meeting.

                  Section  2.5 Voting.  Unless  otherwise  required by law,  the
Certificate of Incorporation  or these By-Laws,  any question brought before any
meeting  of  stockholders  shall  be  decided  by the vote of the  holders  of a
majority of the stock represented and entitled to vote thereat. Each stockholder
represented at a meeting of stockholders  shall be entitled to cast one vote for
each  share  of the  capital  stock  entitled  to  vote  thereat  held  by  such
stockholder.  Such votes may be cast in person or by proxy but no proxy shall be
voted on or after three years from its date,  unless such proxy  provides  for a
longer period. The Board of Directors, in its discretion,  or the officer of the
Corporation   presiding  at  a  meeting  of  stockholders,   in  such  officer's
discretion,  may require  that any votes cast at such  meeting  shall be cast by
written ballot.

                  Section 2.6 List of Stockholders Entitled to Vote. The officer
of the Corporation  who has charge of the stock ledger of the Corporation  shall
prepare and make,  at least ten days before  every  meeting of  stockholders,  a
complete list of the stockholders  entitled to vote at the meeting,  arranged in
alphabetical  order,  and showing the address of each stockholder and the number
of shares registered in the name of each stockholder. Such list shall be open to
the  examination  of any stock holder,  for any purpose  germane to the meeting,
during ordinary  business hours,  for a period of at least ten days prior to the
meeting,  either at a place  within  the city  where the  meeting is to be held,
which  place  shall be  specified  in the notice of the  meeting,  or, if not so
specified,  at the place where the meeting is to be held. The list shall also be
produced  and kept at the time and place of the  meeting  during  the whole time
thereof,  and may be  inspected by any  stockholder  of the  Corporation  who is
present.

                  Section 2.7 Stock Ledger.  The stock ledger of the Corporation
shall be the only  evidence as to who are the  stockholders  entitled to examine
the stock ledger, the list required by
                                        2
<PAGE>
Section 2.6 or the books of the Corporation, or to vote in person or by proxy at
any meeting of  stockholders.  Any good faith decision in regard to such matters
by the  officer of the  Corporation  who has  charge of the stock  ledger of the
Corporation,  which may be the Secretary,  any Assistant  Secretary or any other
appropriate officer of the Corporation, shall be final.

                  Section 2.8  Nomination  of  Directors.  Only  persons who are
nominated in  accordance  with the  following  procedures  shall be eligible for
election as directors of the Corporation. Nominations of persons for election to
the Board of Directors may be made at any Annual Meeting of Stockholders  (a) by
or at the direction of the Board of Directors (or any duly authorized commit tee
thereof) or (b) by any  stockholder of the  Corporation (i) who is a stockholder
of record on the date of the giving of the notice  provided  for in this Section
2.8 and on the record date for the  determination  of  stockholders  entitled to
vote at such Annual Meeting and (ii) who complies with the notice procedures set
forth in this Section 2.8.

                  In  addition  to  any  other  applicable  requirements,  for a
nomination to be made by a stockholder,  such stockholder must have given timely
notice thereof in proper written form to the Secretary of the Corporation.

                  To be timely, a stockholder's  notice to the Secretary must be
delivered to or mailed and received at the  principal  executive  offices of the
Company (a) in the case of an Annual Meeting,  not less than sixty days nor more
than  ninety days prior to the  anniversary  date of the  immediately  preceding
Annual Meeting of Stockholders;  provided,  however,  that in the event that the
Annual  Meeting is called for a date that is not within  thirty  days  before or
after such  anniversary  date,  notice by the  stockholder in order to be timely
must be so  received  not  later  than the  close of  business  on the tenth day
following  the day on which such  notice of the date of the Annual  Meeting  was
mailed or such  public  disclosure  of the date of the Annual  Meeting was made,
whichever first occurs; and (b) in the case of a special meeting of stockholders
called  for the  purpose  of  electing  directors,  not later  than the close of
business on the tenth day  following  the day on which notice of the date of the
special  meeting  was  mailed or public  disclosure  of the date of the  special
meeting was made, whichever first occurs.
                  To be in proper  written form, a  stockholder's  notice to the
Secretary must set forth (a) as to each person whom the stockholder  proposes to
nominate  for  election as a director (i) the name,  age,  business  address and
residence address of the person, (ii) the principal  occupation or employment of
the person,  (iii) the class or series and number of shares of capital  stock of
the Company which are owned beneficially or of record by the person and (iv) any
other information  relating to the person that would be required to be disclosed
in a proxy  statement or other filings  required to be made in  connection  with
solicitations of proxies for election of directors pursuant to Section 14 of the
Securities  Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act"), and the rules
and regulations promulgated thereunder; and (b) as to the stockholder giving the
notice (i) the name and record  address of such  stockholder,  (ii) the class or
series  and  number of shares of capital  stock of the  Company  which are owned
beneficially  or of  record  by such  stockholder,  (iii) a  description  of all
arrangements  or  understandings  between  such  stockholder  and each  proposed
nominee and any other  person or persons  (including  their  names)  pursuant to
which  the  nomination(s)   are  to  be  made  by  such   stockholder,   (iv)  a
                                       3
<PAGE>
representation  that such stockholder intends to appear in person or by proxy at
the  meeting  to  nominate  the  persons  named in its  notice and (v) any other
information relat ing to such stockholder that would be required to be disclosed
in a proxy  statement or other filings  required to be made in  connection  with
solicitations of proxies for election of directors pursuant to Section 14 of the
Exchange Act and the rules and regulations promulgated  thereunder.  Such notice
must be accompanied by a written consent of each proposed nominee to being named
as a nominee and to serve as a director if elected.

                  Notwithstanding  compliance with the foregoing provisions, the
Board of  Directors  shall not be  obligated  to include  information  as to any
stockholder  nominee for director in any proxy statement or other  communication
sent to stockholders.

                  No person  shall be eligible for election as a director of the
Corporation unless nominated in accordance with the procedures set forth in this
Section 2.8. If the Chairman of the meeting determines that a nomination was not
made in accordance with the foregoing procedures,  the Chairman shall declare to
the meeting that the  nomination  was  defective and such  defective  nomination
shall be disregarded.

                  Section 2.9  Business at Annual  Meetings.  No business may be
transacted  at an Annual  Meeting of  Stockholders,  other than business that is
either (a) specified in the notice of meeting (or any supplement  thereto) given
by or at the  direction  of the  Board  of  Directors  (or any  duly  authorized
committee thereof),  (b) otherwise properly brought before the Annual Meeting by
or at the direction of the Board of Directors (or any duly authorized  committee
thereof) or (c)  otherwise  properly  brought  before the Annual  Meeting by any
stockholder of the Corporation (i) who is a stockholder of record on the date of
the giving of the notice provided for in this Section 2.9 and on the record date
for the  determination  of stockholders  entitled to vote at such Annual Meeting
and (ii) who complies with the notice procedures set forth in this Section 2.9.

                  In addition to any other applicable requirements, for business
to  be  properly  brought  before  an  Annual  Meeting  by a  stockholder,  such
stockholder  must have given timely notice thereof in proper written form to the
Secretary of the Corporation.

                  To be timely, a stockholder's  notice to the Secretary must be
delivered to or mailed and received at the  principal  executive  offices of the
Company  not less  than  sixty  days  nor more  than  ninety  days  prior to the
anniversary  date of the immediately  preceding  Annual Meeting of Stockholders;
provided,  however,  that in the event that the  Annual  Meeting is called for a
date that is not  within  thirty  days  before or after such  anniversary  date,
notice by the  stockholder  in order to be timely must be so received  not later
than the close of  business  on the tenth day  following  the day on which  such
notice of the date of the Annual Meeting was mailed or such public disclosure of
the date of the Annual Meeting was made, whichever first occurs.

                  To be in proper  written form, a  stockholder's  notice to the
Secretary  must set forth as to each matter such  stockholder  proposes to bring
before the Annual Meeting (i) a brief  
                                       4
<PAGE>
description of the business  desired to be brought before the Annual Meeting and
the reasons for conducting  such business at the Annual  Meeting,  (ii) the name
and record address of such stockholder,  (iii) the class or series and number of
shares of capital stock of the  Corporation  that are owned  beneficially  or of
record  by  such  stockholder,   (iv)  a  description  of  all  arrangements  or
understandings  between  such  stockholder  and  any  other  person  or  persons
(including their names) in connection with the proposal of such business by such
stockholder and any material  interest of such  stockholder in such business and
(v) a  representation  that such  stockholder  intends to appear in person or by
proxy at the Annual Meeting to bring such business before the meeting.

                  No  business  shall be  conducted  at the  Annual  Meeting  of
Stockholders  except  business  brought  before the Annual Meeting in accordance
with the procedures set forth in this Section 2.9, provided, however, that, once
business has been properly  brought before the Annual Meeting in accordance with
such  procedures,  nothing  in this  Section  2.9 shall be  deemed  to  preclude
discussion by any stockholder of any such business. If the Chairman of an Annual
Meeting  determines  that  business was not properly  brought  before the Annual
Meeting in accordance with the foregoing procedures,  the Chairman shall declare
to the meeting that the business was not properly brought before the meeting and
such business shall not be transacted.


                                    ARTICLE 3

                                    DIRECTORS
                                    ---------

                  Section 3.1 Election of Directors.  Directors shall be elected
by a  plurality  of the  votes  cast at Annual  Meetings  of  Stockholders.  Any
director may resign at any time upon notice to the  Corporation.  Directors need
not be stockholders.

                  Section 3.2 Duties and Powers. The business of the Corporation
shall be managed by or under the  direction of the Board of Directors  which may
exercise  all such  powers of the  Corporation  and do all such  lawful acts and
things as are not by statute or by the Certificate of  Incorporation or by these
By-Laws directed or required to be exercised or done by the stockholders.

                  Section  3.3   Meetings.   The  Board  of   Directors  of  the
Corporation may hold meetings both regular and special, either within or without
the State of Delaware.  Regular  meetings of the Board of Directors  may be held
without  notice  at such  time and at such  place  as may  from  time to time be
determined by the Board of Directors. Special meetings of the Board of Directors
may be called by the Chairman or the President or by a majority of the directors
then in office.  Notice thereof stating the place,  date and hour of the meeting
shall be given to each director either by mail not less than  forty-eight  hours
before  the  date  of the  meeting,  by  telephone,  facsimile  or  telegram  on
twenty-four  hours'  notice,  or on such shorter notice as the person or persons
calling such meeting may deem necessary or appropriate in the circumstances.
                                       5
<PAGE>
                  Section 3.4 Quorum.  Except as may be  otherwise  specifically
provided by law, the  Certificate  of  Incorporation  or these  By-Laws,  at all
meetings of the Board of Directors,  a majority of the entire Board of Directors
shall  constitute  a quorum for the  transaction  of  business  and the act of a
majority  of the  directors  present at any  meeting at which  there is a quorum
shall be the act of the Board of Directors.  If a quorum shall not be present at
any meeting of the Board of Directors, the directors present thereat may adjourn
the meeting from time to time,  without  notice other than  announcement  at the
meeting, until a quorum shall be present.

                  Section 3.5 Actions of Board. Unless otherwise provided by the
Certificate of Incorporation or these By-Laws,  any action required or permitted
to be taken at any meeting of the Board of Directors or of any committee thereof
may be taken without a meeting,  if all the members of the Board of Directors or
committee,  as the case may be, consent  thereto in writing,  and the writing or
writings are filed with the minutes of  proceedings of the Board of Directors or
committee.

                  Section 3.6 Meetings by Means of Conference Telephone.  Unless
otherwise provided by the Certificate of Incorporation or these By-Laws, members
of the Board of Directors of the Corporation, or any committee designated by the
Board of Directors,  may  participate  in a meeting of the Board of Directors or
such  committee  by means of a conference  telephone  or similar  communications
equipment  by means of which all persons  participating  in the meeting can hear
each other,  and  participation  in a meeting pursuant to this Section 3.6 shall
constitute presence in person at such meeting.

                  Section  3.7  Committees.  The  Board  of  Directors  may,  by
resolution passed by a majority of the entire Board of Directors,  designate one
or more committees, each committee to consist of one or more of the directors of
the  Corporation.  The Board of Directors may designate one or more directors as
alternate  members of any committee,  who may replace any absent or disqualified
member at any meeting of any such committee.  In the absence or disqualification
of a member of a committee,  and in the absence of a designation by the Board of
Directors of an alternate  member to replace the absent or disqualified  member,
the member or members thereof present at any meeting and not  disqualified  from
voting,  whether or not he or they constitute a quorum, may unani mously appoint
another  member of the Board of  Directors to act at the meeting in the place of
any absent or  disqualified  member.  A majority of the members of a  committee,
including any alternate  members,  shall  constitute a quorum of such committee.
Any  committee,  to the extent  allowed by law and  provided  in the  resolution
establishing  such  committee,  shall have and may  exercise  all the powers and
authority  of the Board of  Directors  in the  management  of the  business  and
affairs of the Corpora  tion.  Each  committee  shall keep  regular  minutes and
report to the Board of Directors when required.

                  Section  3.8  Compensation.  The  directors  may be paid their
expenses,  if any, of  attendance  at each meeting of the Board of Directors and
may be paid a fixed sum for attendance at each meeting of the Board of Directors
or a stated salary as director. No such payment shall preclude any director from
serving  the  Corporation  in any  other  capacity  and  receiving  compensation
therefor.  Members  of  special  or  standing  committees  may be  allowed  like
                                       6
<PAGE>
compensation  for  attending  committee  meetings.  In  addition,  the  Board of
Directors may adopt one or more director  compensation plans using securities of
the Corporation.

                  Section 3.9 Interested  Directors.  No contract or transaction
between the Corporation and one or more of its directors or officers, or between
the Corporation and any other corporation,  partnership,  association,  or other
organization  in which one or more of its directors or officers are directors or
officers,  or have a financial  interest,  shall be void or voidable  solely for
this  reason,  or solely  because  the  director  or  officer  is  present at or
participates in the meeting of the Board of Directors or committee thereof which
authorizes the contract or  transaction,  or solely because such director's vote
is counted  for such  purpose if (i) the  material  facts as to such  director's
relationship  or interest and as to the contract or transaction are disclosed or
are known to the Board of Directors or the committee, and the Board of Directors
or  committee  in good faith  authorizes  the  contract  or  transaction  by the
affirmative votes of a majority of the disinterested directors,  even though the
dis interested directors be less than a quorum; or (ii) the material facts as to
such  director's  relationship or interest and as to the contract or transaction
are disclosed or are known to the stockholders entitled to vote thereon, and the
contract or  transaction is  specifically  approved in good faith by vote of the
stockholders; or (iii) the contract or transaction is fair as to the Corporation
as of  the  time  it is  authorized,  approved  or  ratified,  by the  Board  of
Directors, a committee thereof or the stockholders.  Interested directors may be
counted in  determining  the  presence  of a quorum at a meeting of the Board of
Directors or of a committee which authorizes the contract or transaction.


                                    ARTICLE 4

                                    OFFICERS
                                    --------

                  Section 4.1 General.  The officers of the Corporation shall be
chosen by the Board of Directors and may include a President,  a Secretary and a
Treasurer. The Board of Directors, in its discretion, may also choose a Chairman
of the  Board  of  Directors  (who  must be a  director)  and  one or more  Vice
Presidents, Assistant Secretaries,  Assistant Treasurers and other officers. Any
number of offices may be held by the same person, unless otherwise prohibited by
law, the  Certificate of  Incorporation  or these  By-Laws.  The officers of the
Corporation  need not be stockholders of the Corporation nor, except in the case
of the Chairman of the Board of  Directors,  need such  officers be directors of
the Corporation.  The officers of the Corporation may sign and execute documents
on  behalf of the  Corporation,  whether  requiring  a seal or  otherwise,  when
authorized by these By-Laws, the Board of Directors, the Chairman or President.

                  Section  4.2  Election.  The Board of  Directors  at its first
meeting held after each Annual Meeting of Stockholders  shall elect the officers
of the  Corporation  who  shall  hold  their  offices  for such  terms and shall
exercise such powers and perform such duties as shall be determined from time to
time by the Board of Directors;  and all officers of the Corporation  shall hold
office until their  successors are chosen and qualified,  or until their earlier
resignation  or removal.  
                                       7
<PAGE>
Any officer  elected by the Board of Directors may be removed at any time by the
affirmative vote of a majority of the Board of Directors.  Any vacancy occurring
in any office of the Corporation shall be filled by the Board of Directors.  The
salaries  of all  officers  of the  Corporation  shall be fixed by the  Board of
Directors or by a committee thereof.

                  Section 4.3 Voting Securities Owned by the Corporation. Powers
of  attorney,  proxies,  waivers  of  notice  of  meeting,  consents  and  other
instruments  relating to securities  owned by the Corporation may be executed in
the name of and on behalf of the  Corporation by the Chairman,  President or any
Vice  President  and any such  officer  may, in the name of and on behalf of the
Corporation, take all such action as any such officer may deem advisable to vote
in person or by proxy at any meeting of security  holders of any  corporation in
which the  Corporation  may own securities and at any such meeting shall possess
and may exercise any and all rights and power  incident to the ownership of such
securities and which, as the owner thereof, the Corporation might have exercised
and possessed if present.  The Board of Directors may, by resolution,  from time
to time confer like powers upon any other person or persons.

                  Section 4.4 Chairman of the Board of  Directors.  The Chairman
of the Board of Directors, if there be one, shall preside at all meetings of the
stockholders  and of the Board of Direc tors.  The  Chairman  shall be the Chief
Executive  Officer of the Corporation,  and except where by law the signature of
the President is required,  the Chairman of the Board of Directors shall possess
the same power as the President to sign all  contracts,  certificates  and other
instruments  of  the  Corporation  which  may be  authorized  by  the  Board  of
Directors.  During the absence or disability of the  President,  the Chairman of
the Board of  Directors  shall  exercise  all the powers and  discharge  all the
duties of the  President.  The  Chairman  of the Board of  Directors  shall also
perform  such other  duties and may  exercise  such other powers as from time to
time may be  assigned  to the  Chairman  by  these  By-Laws  or by the  Board of
Directors. All officers of the Corporation shall be under the supervision of the
Chairman,  if there be one,  and  shall  perform  all  such  duties  as shall be
assigned by the Chairman.

                  Section 4.5 President.  The President,  if there shall be one,
shall,  subject to the control of the Board of  Directors  and, if there be one,
the Chairman of the Board of Directors, have general supervision of the business
of the Corporation and shall see that all orders and resolutions of the Board of
Directors are carried into effect.  In the absence or disability of the Chairman
of the Board of Directors,  or if there be none, the President  shall preside at
all  meetings of the  stockholders  and the Board of  Directors.  If there be no
Chairman of the Board of Directors,  the President  shall be the Chief Executive
Officer of the  Corporation.  The President shall also perform such other duties
and may  exercise  such other powers as from time to time may be assigned to the
President by these ByLaws, by the Board of Directors or by the Chairman.

                  Section 4.6 Vice  Presidents.  At the request of the President
or in the President's  absence or in the event of the  President's  inability or
refusal to act (and if there be no Chairman of the Board of Directors), the Vice
President  or the  Vice  Presidents  if there  is more  than  one (in the  order
designated by the Board of Directors) shall perform the duties of the President,
and 
                                       8
<PAGE>
when  so  acting,  shall  have  all  the  powers  of and be  subject  to all the
restrictions  upon the President.  Each Vice Presi dent shall perform such other
duties and have such other powers as the Board of Directors, Chairman and/or the
President from time to time may prescribe.

                  Section 4.7 Secretary. The Secretary shall attend all meetings
of the Board of Directors  and all meetings of  stockholders  and record all the
proceedings  thereat  in a book  or  books  to be kept  for  that  purpose;  the
Secretary  shall also  perform  like  duties for the  standing  committees  when
requested or appropriate. The Secretary shall give, or cause to be given, notice
of all  meetings  of the  stockholders  and  special  meetings  of the  Board of
Directors, and shall perform such other duties as may be prescribed by the Board
of Directors,  Chairman or President.  If the Secretary shall be unable or shall
refuse  to cause to be given  notice of all  meetings  of the  stockholders  and
special  meetings  of the  Board of  Directors,  and if  there  be no  Assistant
Secretary,  then  either  the Board of  Directors  or the  President  may choose
another  officer  to cause such  notice to be given.  The  Secretary  shall have
custody of the seal of the  Corporation,  if there is one, and the  Secretary or
any  Assistant  Secretary,  shall  have  authority  to  affix  the  same  to any
instrument requiring it and when so affixed, it may be attested by the signature
of the Secretary or by the signature of any  Assistant  Secretary.  The Board of
Directors  may give general  authority to any other officer to affix the seal of
the  Corporation  and to attest the affixing by such  officer's  signature.  The
Secretary shall see that all books, reports, statements,  certificates and other
documents  and records  required by law to be kept or filed are properly kept or
filed, as the case may be.

                  Section 4.8  Treasurer.  The  Treasurer  shall  supervise  the
maintenance  of the  corporate  funds and  securities  and  shall  keep full and
accurate  accounts of  receipts  and  disbursements  in books  belonging  to the
Corporation and shall deposit all moneys and other valuable  effects in the name
and to the credit of the  Corporation in such  depositories as may be designated
by the Board of Directors or Chairman. The Treasurer shall disburse the funds of
the  Corporation  as may be  ordered  by the  Board of  Directors,  Chairman  or
President for such  disbursements,  and shall render to the Chairman,  President
and the  Board of  Directors,  at its  regular  meetings,  or when the  Board of
Directors or Chairman so requires,  an account of all  transactions as Treasurer
and of the financial  condition of the Corporation.  The Treasurer shall perform
such  other  duties  and have such  powers as the Board of  Directors,  Chairman
and/or  President from time to time may  prescribe.  If required by the Board of
Directors or Chairman,  the Treasurer  shall give the Corporation a bond in such
sum and with such surety or sureties  as shall be  satisfactory  to the Board of
Directors or Chairman for the faithful  performance of the duties of such office
and for the restoration to the  Corporation,  in case of the Treasurer's  death,
resignation,  retirement or removal from office, of all books, papers, vouchers,
money and other property of whatever kind in the Treasurer's possession or under
such officer's control belonging to the Corporation.

                  Section 4.9 Assistant Secretaries.  Assistant Secretaries,  if
there be any,  shall  perform  such  duties and have such powers as from time to
time may be  assigned  to them by the  Board of  Directors,  the  Chairman,  the
President,  any Vice  President,  if there be one, or the Secretary,  and in the
absence of the Secretary or in the event of such officer's disability or 
                                       9
<PAGE>
refusal to act, shall perform the duties of the  Secretary,  and when so acting,
shall have all the powers of and be  subject  to all the  restrictions  upon the
Secretary.

                  Section 4.10 Assistant Treasurers.  Assistant  Treasurers,  if
there be any,  shall  perform  such  duties and have such powers as from time to
time may be  assigned  to them by the  Board of  Directors,  the  Chairman,  the
President,  any Vice  President,  if there be one, or the Treasurer,  and in the
absence of the Treasurer or in the event of such officer's disability or refusal
to act,  shall perform the duties of the  Treasurer,  and when so acting,  shall
have  all  the  powers  of and be  subject  to all  the  restrictions  upon  the
Treasurer.  If required by the Board of  Directors  or  Chairman,  an  Assistant
Treasurer  shall give the Corporation a bond in such sum and with such surety or
sureties as shall be  satisfactory to the Board of Directors or Chairman for the
faithful  performance  of the  duties  of  such  officer's  office  and  for the
restoration  to the  Corporation,  in case of the Assistant  Treasurer's  death,
resignation,  retirement or removal from office, of all books, papers, vouchers,
money and other property of whatever kind in such officer's  possession or under
such officer's control belonging to the Corporation.

                  Section 4.11 Other Officers.  Such other officers as the Board
of Directors  may choose shall  perform such duties and have such powers as from
time to time may be assigned  to them by the Board of  Directors,  Chairman,  or
President.  The Board of  Directors  may  delegate  to any other  officer of the
Corporation  the power to choose  such other  officers  and to  prescribe  their
respective duties and powers.


                                    ARTICLE 5

                                      STOCK
                                      -----

                  Section 5.1 Form of Certificates. Every holder of stock in the
Corporation  shall be entitled to have a certificate  signed, in the name of the
Corporation  (i) by the Chairman of the Board of  Directors,  the President or a
Vice  President  and (ii) by the  Treasurer  or an Assistant  Treasurer,  or the
Secretary or an Assistant Secretary of the Corporation, certifying the number of
shares owned by such holder in the Corporation.

                  Section 5.2 Signatures.  Where a certificate is  countersigned
by (i) a transfer agent other than the  Corporation  or its employee,  or (ii) a
registrar other than the Corporation or its employee, any other signature on the
certificate may be a facsimile. In case any officer, transfer agent or registrar
who has signed or whose  facsimile  signature has been placed upon a certificate
shall have ceased to be such officer,  transfer  agent or registrar  before such
certificate is issued,  it may be issued by the Corporation with the same effect
as if such person were such officer,  transfer agent or registrar at the date of
issue.

                  Section 5.3 Lost Certificates.  The Secretary may direct a new
certificate to be issued in place of any certificate  theretofore  issued by the
Corporation  alleged to have been lost, stolen or destroyed,  upon the making of
an affidavit of that fact by the person  claiming the 
                                       10
<PAGE>
certificate  of stock to be lost,  stolen or destroyed.  When  authorizing  such
issue of a new certificate,  the Secretary may, in such officer's discretion and
as a condition  precedent  to the  issuance  thereof,  require the owner of such
lost, stolen or destroyed certificate, or such owner's legal representative,  to
advertise the same in such manner as the Secretary  shall require and/or to give
the  Corporation  a bond in such sum as it may direct as  indemnity  against any
claim that may be made against the  Corporation  with respect to the certificate
alleged to have been lost, stolen or destroyed.

                  Section  5.4  Transfers.  Stock  of the  Corporation  shall be
transferable in the manner prescribed by law and in these By-Laws.  Transfers of
stock shall be made on the books of the Corporation  only by the person named in
the  certificate or by such person's  attorney  lawfully consti tuted in writing
and upon the  surrender of the  certificate  therefor,  which shall be cancelled
before a new certificate shall be issued.

                  Section 5.5 Record  Date.  In order that the  Corporation  may
determine  the  stockholders  entitled to notice of or to vote at any meeting of
stockholders or any adjournment  thereof,  or entitled to receive payment of any
dividend  or other  distribution  or  allotment  of any  rights,  or entitled to
exercise any rights in respect of any change,  conversion  or exchange of stock,
or for the purpose of any other lawful  action,  the Board of Directors may fix,
in advance, a record date, which shall not be more than sixty days nor less than
ten days before the date of such meeting,  nor more than sixty days prior to any
other action. A determination of stockholders of record entitled to notice of or
to vote at a meeting  of  stockholders  shall  apply to any  adjournment  of the
meeting;  provided,  however,  that the Board of Directors  may fix a new record
date for the adjourned meeting.

                  Section  5.6  Beneficial  Owners.  The  Corporation  shall  be
entitled to recognize the exclusive right of a person registered on its books as
the owner of shares to receive dividends, and to vote as such owner, and to hold
liable for calls and  assessments a person  registered on its books as the owner
of shares,  and shall not be bound to recognize  any equitable or other claim to
or interest in such share or shares on the part of any other person,  whether or
not it shall have express or other notice thereof,  except as otherwise provided
by law.


                                    ARTICLE 6

                                STOCK REPURCHASES
                                -----------------

                  Section   6.1  In  addition   to  any   affirmative   vote  of
stockholders   required  by  any  provision  of  law  or  the   Certificate   of
Incorporation  of this  Corporation or by these By-Laws,  the Corporation  shall
not,  directly or indirectly,  purchase or agree to purchase any equity security
of a class of  securities  which is  registered  pursuant  to  Section 12 of the
Exchange  Act issued by the  Corporation  from any Person or two or more Persons
who  act as a  partnership,  limited  partnership,  syndicate,  or  other  group
pursuant  to  any  agreement,  arrangement,   relationship,   understanding,  or
otherwise,  whether or not in writing, for the purpose of acquiring,  owning,
                                       11
<PAGE>
or voting shares of the  Corporation,  who is the Beneficial  Owner of more than
five percent of the aggregate  voting power of the Corporation for more than the
Average  Market  Price of the shares,  unless (i) the  purchase or  agreement to
purchase is approved at a meeting of the stockholders by the affirmative vote of
the holders of a majority of the aggregate  voting power of all shares  entitled
to vote,  except  that no  Interested  Shares  shall be  entitled to vote on the
question  of such  approval or (ii) the  Corporation  makes an offer of at least
equal  value per share to all  holders of shares of the same class or series and
to all  holders  of any  class  or  series  into  which  the  securities  may be
converted.


                  For purposes of this By-Law, the following definitions apply:

                  6.1.1.  "Average  Market Price" shall mean the average closing
sale price during the thirty trading days immediately  preceding the purchase of
the share in question, or if the Person or Persons have commenced a tender offer
or have  announced an intention to seek control of the  Corporation,  during the
thirty  trading days  preceding  the earlier of the  commencement  of the tender
offer or the making of the  announcement,  of a share on the composite  tape for
New York stock ex change  listed  shares or, if the shares are not quoted on the
composite  tape or not listed on the New York stock  exchange,  on the principal
United States securities exchange registered under the Exchange Act on which the
shares are listed or, if the shares are not listed on any such exchange,  on the
national  association of securities dealers,  inc. automated quotations national
market  system or, if the shares are not quoted on the national  association  of
securities  dealers,  inc.  automated  quotations  national  market system,  the
average  closing bid  quotation,  during the thirty  trading days  preceding the
purchase  of the shares in question of a share on the  national  association  of
securities dealers,  inc. automated quotations system or any system then in use,
or if the Person or Persons have  commenced a tender offer or have  announced an
intention to seek  control of the  Corporation,  during the thirty  trading days
preceding the earlier of the  commencement  of the tender offer or the making of
the announcement,  except that if no quotation is available,  the average market
price is the fair market value on the date of purchase of the shares in question
of a share  as  determined  in good  faith  by the  Board  of  Directors  of the
Corporation.

                  6.1.2.  "Beneficial  Owner" shall have the meaning ascribed to
it in Rule 13d-3 and Rule 13d-5 of the General Rules and  Regulations  under the
Exchange Act, as in effect on June 30, 1994.

                  6.1.3.  "Interested  Shares" shall mean all outstanding shares
of capital stock of the  Corporation  entitled to vote generally in the election
of directors  that are  beneficially  owned by any Person or Persons that is the
direct or indirect  Beneficial  Owner of more than five percent of the aggregate
voting power of the Corporation.

                  6.1.4. "Person" shall mean any individual,  partnership, firm,
corporation, association, trust, unincorporated organization, or other entity,as
well as any  syndicate  or group  
                                       12
<PAGE>
deemed to be a Person  pursuant to Section  13(d)(3) of the Exchange  Act, as in
effect on June 30, 1994,  other than the  Corporation  or any  subsidiary of the
Corporation.


                                    ARTICLE 7

                                     NOTICES
                                     -------

                  Section 7.1 Notices.  Whenever  written  notice is required by
law, the  Certificate  of  Incorporation  or these  By-Laws,  to be given to any
director,  member of a  committee  or  stockholder,  such notice may be given by
mail, addressed to such director, member of a committee or stockholder,  at such
person's address as it appears on the records of the  Corporation,  with postage
thereon prepaid or such notice may be given personally, by facsimile,  overnight
delivery, telegram, telex, or cable at such address. Such notice shall be deemed
to be given at the  earlier of  receipt  of such  notice or at the time when the
same shall be deposited in the United States mail or otherwise transmitted.

                  Section 7.2 Waivers of Notice. Whenever any notice is required
by law, the Certificate of  Incorporation  or these By-Laws,  to be given to any
director,  member of a committee or  stockholder,  a waiver  thereof in writing,
signed,  by the person or persons  entitled to said  notice,  whether  before or
after the time stated therein, shall be deemed equivalent thereto.


                                    ARTICLE 8

                               GENERAL PROVISIONS
                               ------------------

                  Section 8.1 Dividends. Dividends upon the capital stock of the
Corporation,  subject to the provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation,  if
any,  may be  declared  by the Board of  Directors  at any  regular  or  special
meeting,  and may be paid in cash,  in  property,  or in shares  of the  capital
stock.  Before payment of any dividend,  there may be set aside out of any funds
of the  Corporation  available  for  dividends  such sum or sums as the Board of
Directors  from time to time,  in its  absolute  discretion,  deems  proper as a
reserve or  reserves  for any proper  purpose,  and the Board of  Directors  may
modify or abolish any such reserve.

                  Section 8.2 Disbursements. All checks or demands for money and
notes of the  Corporation  shall be signed by such  officer or  officers or such
other  person  or  persons  as the  Board of  Directors  may  from  time to time
designate.

                  Section 8.3 Fiscal  Year.  The fiscal year of the  Corporation
shall be fixed by resolution of the Board of Directors.

                  Section 8.4  Corporate  Seal.  The  Corporation  may  have   a
corporate seal, which shall have inscribed  thereon the words "Corporate  Seal".
The seal may be used by causing it 
                                       13
<PAGE>
or a facsimile  thereof to be impressed or affixed or  reproduced  or otherwise.
However,  nothing in these By-Laws or in the Certificate of Incorporation of the
Corporation  shall be construed to require a corporate seal to be affixed to any
document.


                                    ARTICLE 9

                                   AMENDMENTS
                                   ----------

                  Section 9.1 These By-Laws may be altered, amended or repealed,
in whole or in part, or new By-Laws may be adopted by the stockholders or by the
Board  of  Directors;   provided,  however,  that  notice  of  such  alteration,
amendment,  repeal or adoption of new By-Laws be contained in the notice of such
meeting  of  stockholders  or Board of  Directors  as the case may be.  All such
amendments  must  be  approved  by  either  the  holders  of a  majority  of the
outstanding  capital  stock  entitled  to vote  thereon or by a majority  of the
entire Board of Directors then in office.

                  Section 9.2 Entire Board of Directors. As used in this Article
and in these By-Laws  generally,  the term "entire Board of Directors" means the
total  number of  directors  which the  Corporation  would have if there were no
vacancies.

         I hereby  certify  that the above and  foregoing  Bylaws are a true and
correct copy of the Bylaws of Del Webb Corporation,  adopted effective  November
1, 1994.

                                                     /s/ Donald V. Mickus
                                                     ---------------------------
                                                     Donald V. Mickus, Secretary

                                       14
<PAGE>
                             SECRETARY'S CERTIFICATE
                             -----------------------


         I,  Robertson C. Jones,  do hereby  certify that I am the duly elected,
qualified and acting Assistant  Secretary of Del Webb  Corporation,  an Delaware
corporation,  and as such  Assistant  Secretary  have access to all the original
records  and  books of said  Corporation  and that the  following  is a true and
correct copy of a resolution adopted by the Executive  Committee of the Board of
Directors by unanimous  written  consent  effective  February 13, 1996, and that
such resolution has not been modified or rescinded and remains in full force and
effect:

                  WHEREAS,   the  Company  is  currently   an  "issuing   public
         corporation"  within the meaning of Section  10-2701(11) of the Arizona
         Revised Statutes; and

                  WHEREAS, Section 10-2721(A)(5) of the Arizona Revised Statutes
         allows an  issuing  public  corporation  to elect not to be  subject to
         Title 10,  Chapter  23,  Article  2 of the  Arizona  Revised  Statutes,
         relating to "Control Share Acquisitions," if such election is contained
         in the  corporation's  bylaws and is made within forty-five days of the
         effective date of Section 10-2721 of the Arizona Revised Statutes;

                  NOW, THEREFORE, BE IT RESOLVED,  Article 8, Section 8.5 of the
         Company's Bylaws is hereby added as follows:

                     SECTION  8.  ELECTION  NOT TO BE  SUBJECT  TO ARIZONA
                     CONTROL SHARE  ACQUISITION  STATUTE.  The Corporation
                     elects  not to be subject  to Title 10,  Chapter  23,
                     Article 2 of the Arizona Revised  Statutes,  relating
                     to "Control Share Acquisitions.

         IN  WITNESS  WHEREOF,  I have  hereunto  set my hand  as the  Assistant
Secretary of the Corporation on the 20th day of February, 1996.

                                         /s/ Robertson C. Jones
                                         ---------------------------------------
                                         Robertson C. Jones, Assistant Secretary

                                                                    Exhibit 10.1


                       Sample Change of Control Agreement


Date



Name
Address


Dear _____:

The Board of Directors of Del Webb Corporation (the "Corporation") and the Human
Resources Committee (the "Committee") of the Board have determined that it is in
the best interest of the Corporation and its shareholders for the Corporation to
agree, as provided herein, to pay you termination  compensation in the event you
should  leave  the  employ  of  the  Corporation  or  a  Subsidiary   under  the
circumstances described below. Reference in this letter to your employment by or
with  the  Corporation  shall  be  deemed  to  include  employment  by or with a
Subsidiary.

The Board and Committee recognize that the continuing possibility of a change in
the control of the Corporation is unsettling to you and other senior  executives
of the Corporation.  Therefore, these arrangements are being made to help assure
a continuing dedication by you to your duties to the Corporation notwithstanding
the  occurrence or potential  occurrence of a change in control.  In particular,
the Board and the Committee believe it important, should the Corporation receive
proposals from third parties with respect to its future,  to enable you, without
being influenced by the  uncertainties  of your own situation,  to assess and to
take such other action  regarding such proposals as the Board might determine to
be  appropriate.  The  Board  and the  Committee  also  wish to  demonstrate  to
executives of the  Corporation  and its  Subsidiaries  that the  Corporation  is
concerned  with the  welfare  of its  executives  and  intends to see that loyal
executives are provided with the benefits stated herein.

In  view  of the  foregoing  and in  further  consideration  of  your  continued
employment with the Corporation, the Corporation agrees with you as follows:

1.       Limited Right to Receive Severance  Benefits.  In the event that within
         twenty-four  (24) months  after a change of control of the  Corporation
         (as defined herein) your employment with the Corporation is terminated,
         you shall be entitled to the severance  benefits  provided in Section 3
         hereof unless:
<PAGE>
Name                                 - 2 -                                  Date



         (a)      at that time your employment is terminated by the Corporation,
                  you have a written  employment  contract with the  Corporation
                  extending at least _______ months from the date written Notice
                  of Termination is given you and the  Corporation  acknowledges
                  its breach of that  agreement  and  offers  you,  in cash,  an
                  amount  equal to all future  payments  called for  thereunder,
                  plus all  other  damages  suffered  by you as a result of such
                  termination; or

         (b)      such  termination  is (i) because of your death or retirement,
                  (ii)  by  the   Corporation   for  cause  or  your   permanent
                  disability,  or (iii) by you,  other  than for good  reason in
                  accordance with Section 2(e) hereof.

2.       Certain Definitions.  For purposes of this Agreement:
         -------------------
 
         (a)      Change in  Control.  "Change in  control  of the  Corporation"
                  shall  mean a change  in  control  of a nature  that  would be
                  required  to be  reported in response to Item 6(e) of Schedule
                  14A  of  Regulation  14A  promulgated   under  the  Securities
                  Exchange Act of 1934, as amended  ("Exchange  Act");  provided
                  that,  without  limitation,  such a change in control shall be
                  deemed to have  occurred if (i) any  "person" (as such term is
                  used in Sections 13(d) and 14(d)(2) of the Exchange Act) is or
                  becomes  the  beneficial  owner,  directly or  indirectly,  of
                  securities of the Corporation representing twenty-five percent
                  (25%)   or  more  of  the   combined   voting   power  of  the
                  Corporation's  then  outstanding  securities  ordinarily  (and
                  apart from rights accruing under special circumstances) having
                  the right to vote at  elections of  directors,  or (ii) within
                  two (2)  years of a tender  offer or  exchange  offer  for the
                  voting   stock  of  the   Corporation   (other   than  by  the
                  Corporation) or as a result of a merger,  consolidation,  sale
                  of assets or  contested  election  or any  combination  of the
                  foregoing,  the persons who were directors of the  Corporation
                  immediately prior thereto shall cease to constitute a majority
                  of  the  Board  of  Directors  of  the  Corporation  or of its
                  successor by merger, consolidation or sale of assets.

         (b)      Retirement.  Termination  by the  Corporation  or you of  your
                  employment  based on  "Retirement"  shall  mean (i)  voluntary
                  retirement by you from active  full-time  employment  with any
                  person  or   corporation   on  and  after  the  attainment  of
                  sixty-five (65) years,  (ii) voluntary  separation  because of
                  retirement  from  active  employment  in  accordance  with the
                  Corporation's  retirement  policy  in effect as of the date of
                  Change in Control  (including early retirement at your option)
                  generally  applicable to its salaried  employees,  or (iii) in
                  accordance with any written  retirement policy  established by
                  the Corporation for you with your written consent.
<PAGE>
Name                                 - 3 -                                  Date



         (c)      Permanent  Disability.  If, as a result of your incapacity due
                  to physical or mental illness, you shall have been absent from
                  your  duties  with  the  Corporation  or  a  Subsidiary  on  a
                  full-time  basis for six (6)  months or more and you apply for
                  and are approved for long-term  disability  payments under the
                  Corporation's  long-term  disability plan, the Corporation may
                  terminate this Agreement for "Permanent Disability".

                  Notwithstanding  the  foregoing,  this  Agreement  may  not be
                  terminated pursuant to this Section 2(c) unless the incapacity
                  giving rise to such Permanent  Disability  occurs prior to the
                  occurrence of an event which might cause amounts to be payable
                  to you under this Agreement. Once payments have begun pursuant
                  to any provision of this Agreement,  this Agreement may not be
                  terminated  pursuant  to this  Section  2(c) and such  payment
                  shall not  cease or  diminish  on  account  of your  Permanent
                  Disability.

         (d)      Cause.  The  Corporation  shall have "Cause" to terminate your
                  employment  upon  (i)  the  breach  by you  of any  employment
                  contract  between  you  and  the  Corporation,   or  (ii)  the
                  adjudication  that you are bankrupt,  or (iii) your conviction
                  of a felony or crime  involving  moral  turpitude  (meaning  a
                  crime that  necessarily  includes the  commission of an act of
                  gross depravity, dishonesty or bad morals).

         (e)      Good  Reason.  You may  terminate  your  employment  for  Good
                  Reason, and receive the benefits provided in Section 3 hereof,
                  only  if  you do so  within  one  hundred  twenty  (120)  days
                  following  the  occurrence  of any of the events  specified in
                  (i)-(iv)  below.  Termination  of your  employment  by you for
                  "Good Reason" shall mean:

               (i)     without your express written  consent,  the assignment to
                       you  of  any  duties  that  are  inconsistent  with  your
                       positions,  duties,  responsibilities and status with the
                       Corporation  immediately prior to a Change in Control, or
                       a  demotion,  or a change in your titles or offices as in
                       effect  immediately prior to a Change in Control,  or any
                       removal of you from or any failure to re-elect you to any
                       of  such   positions,   except  in  connection  with  the
                       termination  of  your  employment  for  Cause,  Permanent
                       Disability  or as a result of your death or by other than
                       for Good Reason;

               (ii)    a reduction by the  Corporation in your base salary as in
                       effect on the date hereof or as the same may be increased
                       from time to time;
<PAGE>
Name                                 - 4 -                                  Date



               (iii)   the failure by the  Corporation to continue in effect any
                       thrift,  incentive or compensation  plan, or any pension,
                       life insurance, health and accident or disability plan in
                       which  you are  participating  at the time of a Change in
                       Control of the  Corporation  (or plans providing you with
                       substantially similar benefits), the taking of any action
                       by the  Corporation  which  would  adversely  affect your
                       participation in or materially reduce your benefits under
                       any of such plans or deprive you of any  material  fringe
                       benefit  enjoyed  by you at the  time  of the  change  in
                       control, or the failure by the Corporation to provide you
                       with the  number of paid  vacation  days to which you are
                       then  entitled on the basis of years of service  with the
                       Corporation in accordance with the  Corporation's  normal
                       vacation policy in effect on the date hereof;

               (iv)    you are assigned to, or the Corporation's office at which
                       you are  principally  employed  immediately  prior to the
                       date of the  Change in  Control  of the  Corporation  are
                       relocated to, a location which would require a round-trip
                       commute to work from your present  residence of more than
                       one hundred twenty (120) miles per day:

               (v)     the  failure of the  Corporation  to obtain an  agreement
                       satisfactory  to you from any  successor to the business,
                       or  substantially  all the assets,  of the Corporation to
                       assume this  Agreement or issue a  substantially  similar
                       agreement;

               (vi)    your  termination  by the  Corporation,  purportedly  for
                       Cause, if it is thereafter  determined that cause did not
                       exist  under  this   Agreement   with   respect  to  your
                       termination.

         (f)      Notice of  Termination.  Any termination by the Corporation or
                  you shall be communicated by written notice to the other party
                  ("Notice of Termination").  With respect to any termination by
                  the  Corporation for Cause,  Retirement or Disability,  or any
                  termination by you for Good Reason,  the Notice of Termination
                  shall  set   forth  in   reasonable   detail   the  facts  and
                  circumstances claimed to provide a basis for such termination.

         (g)      Subsidiary.   "Subsidiary"   shall   mean   any   corporation,
                  partnership,  joint  venture  or other  entity  in  which  the
                  Corporation  has a  twenty  percent  (20%) or  greater  equity
                  interest.

3.       Effect  of  Termination.  If you  are  entitled  to  receive  severance
         benefits pursuant to Section 1 hereof, such severance benefits shall be
         as follows:
<PAGE>
Name                                 - 5 -                                  Date



         (a)      you will be entitled to a cash payment in lump sum (or, if you
                  make an  irrevocable  election  prior to a Change in  Control,
                  payable in equal semi- monthly  installments without interest)
                  equal to  ___________  times the highest annual base salary in
                  effect at any time during the twelve (12) months  prior to the
                  date  the  Notice  of  Termination   is  given   ("Termination
                  Salary"),  plus an amount equal to the greater of the value of
                  all bonuses  paid to you during the twelve  (12) month  period
                  prior  to  the  giving  of  such  Notice  of  Termination,  or
                  ________________ of the Termination Salary;

         (b)      any stock options to purchase  common stock of the Corporation
                  or  stock  appreciation  rights  held by you on the  date  the
                  Notice of  Termination  is  given,  which are not at that date
                  currently exercisable, shall on that date automatically become
                  exercisable;  and be  exercisable  for three (3) months  after
                  termination of employment;

         (c)      all  shares of  common  stock of the  Corporation  held by you
                  under the Corporation's Restricted Stock Plans which are still
                  subject to  restrictions on the date the Notice of Termination
                  is given shall, as of that date,  automatically become free of
                  all restrictions;

         (d)      a payment of twenty percent (20%) of your  Termination  Salary
                  in lieu of fringe benefits.

         The  Corporation  shall  be  obligated  to  amend,  if  necessary,  its
         Restricted Stock Plans and its plans pursuant to which you have been or
         may be granted stock  options or stock  appreciation  rights,  or grant
         instruments,  to be  consistent  with  Section  3(b)  and  3(c) of this
         Agreement.

         Should  you, at any time,  take legal  action,  including  arbitration,
         against the Corporation  for breach of this Agreement,  the Corporation
         shall  reimburse  you for all amounts spent by you to pursue such legal
         action,  regardless  of  the  outcome,  unless  a  court  of  competent
         jurisdiction  finds  your  action to have been  frivolous  and  without
         merit.

4.       Effect on Other Benefits.  Except to the extent  specified in Section 3
         hereof,   this  Agreement  shall  not  affect  your  participation  in,
         distributions from and vested rights under any pension,  profit sharing
         or  other  employee  benefit  plan  of  the  Corporation  or any of its
         Subsidiaries,  which will be governed by the terms of those  respective
         plans. Any forfeitures you experience under any pension, profit sharing
         or stock  bonus plans due to your  termination  shall be paid to you by
         the  Corporation  in  cash  in the  event  any  payment  is made to you
         pursuant to Section 3. In the event that
<PAGE>
Name                                 - 6 -                                  Date



         on the date your  employment  with the  Corporation is terminated  (and
         provided you are entitled to severance  benefits  pursuant to Section 3
         hereof) you are  provided or are  entitled to the use of an  automobile
         under the Corporation's executive automobile policy, you shall have the
         use of  such  automobile  for  one  (1)  year  after  the  date of such
         termination  of  employment,  on terms  no less  favorable  than  those
         contained in such policy prior to such  termination of  employment.  In
         addition,  for  a  twelve  (12)  month  period  after  any  termination
         entitling you to benefits under Section 3 hereof, the Corporation shall
         arrange to provide you with life, disability, accident and group health
         benefits and  coverages  substantially  similar to those which you were
         receiving  immediately prior to the Notice of Termination.  The cost to
         you of such coverage  shall be not more than the cost to you of similar
         coverage immediately prior to the Notice of Termination.  Your right to
         continued  life,  disability,  accident and health benefits shall be in
         addition  to and  not in lieu of your  rights  under  the  Consolidated
         Omnibus Reconciliation Act of 1986 ("COBRA").

5.       Continuation  of Employment.  This Agreement  shall not be construed to
         confer upon you any right to continue in the employ of the  Corporation
         or the  Operating  Company,  and  shall  not  limit  any  right  of the
         Corporation or the Operating  Company to terminate  your  employment at
         any time in its sole discretion.

6.       Entire  Agreement.  This Agreement  supersedes all other agreements and
         understandings  between  us  with  respect  to  benefits  due to you in
         connection with a Change in Control. In the event of the termination of
         your employment  under  circumstances  entitling you to the termination
         payments  hereunder,  the arrangements  provided for by this Agreement,
         together  with any  written  employment  contract  between  you and the
         Corporation  and any applicable  benefit plan of the Corporation or any
         of its  subsidiaries  in  effect  at the  time  (as  modified  by  this
         Agreement),  would constitute the entire  obligation of the Corporation
         to you and performance  thereof would constitute full settlement of any
         claim  that you might  otherwise  assert  against  the  Corporation  on
         account of such termination.

7.       Successors and Assigns.  This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure
         to the  benefit  of  you,  your  estate  and  the  Corporation  and any
         successor of the Corporation, but neither this Agreement nor any rights
         arising hereunder may be assigned or pledged by you.

8.       Miscellaneous.  No provisions of this Agreement may be modified, waived
         or discharged  unless such waiver,  modification or discharge is agreed
         to in writing,  signed by you and such  officer as may be  specifically
         designated by the Board of Directors of the Corporation.
<PAGE>
Name                                 - 7 -                                  Date



         No waiver by either party hereto at any time of any breach by the other
         party hereto of, or compliance with, any condition or provision of this
         Agreement  to be performed by such other party shall be deemed a waiver
         of similar or  dissimilar  provisions or conditions at the same time or
         at any prior or subsequent time. No agreements or representations, oral
         or otherwise,  express or implied,  with respect to the subject  matter
         hereof have been made by either party which are not set forth expressly
         in this  Agreement.  The  validity,  interpretation,  construction  and
         performance  of this  Agreement  shall be  governed  by the laws of the
         State of Arizona.

9.       Termination  of this  Agreement.  Prior to a Change in  Control  of the
         Corporation,  this  Agreement  may be  unilaterally  terminated  by the
         Corporation upon twelve (12) months prior written notice to you.

10.      Arbitration  and  Litigation.  In the event that  following a Change in
         Control of the Corporation, the Corporation terminates you by reason of
         your Permanent  Disability or for Cause and you dispute the accuracy of
         such  assertion of Permanent  Disability or Cause,  or in the event you
         terminate your employment for Good Reason, and the Corporation disputes
         the accuracy of such  assertion  of Good  Reason,  the accuracy of such
         assertion shall be submitted to arbitration in accordance with the then
         current  commercial  arbitration  rules  of  the  American  Arbitration
         Association  ("Association")  or  its  successor,  provided  you or the
         Corporation  file a written demand for arbitration at a regional office
         of the Association  within thirty (30) calendar days following the date
         of termination.  The Corporation shall continue to pay all benefits due
         to you under this Agreement during  arbitration until a final,  binding
         determination has been entered relieving the Corporation of its duty to
         provide benefits hereunder. In the event the Corporation shall elect to
         insure all or part of its liability for providing  health and long-term
         disability  benefits  under this  paragraph,  you shall  submit to such
         reasonable physical examination as the Company may request. Arbitration
         shall be the sole remedy  hereunder and the decision of the  arbitrator
         shall be final and binding.

11.      Severability.  If any one (1) or more of the  provisions  or parts of a
         provision  contained in this Agreement  shall for any reason be held to
         be invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any respect, such invalidity or
         enforceability  shall  not  affect  any  other  provision  or part of a
         provision of this  Agreement,  but this Agreement shall be reformed and
         construed as if such invalid or illegal or  unenforceable  provision or
         part of a provision had never been contained herein and such provisions
         or part thereof shall be reformed so that it would be valid,  legal and
         enforceable  to  the  maximum   extent   permitted  by  law.  Any  such
         reformation  shall be read as  narrowly as possible to give the maximum
         effect to our mutual intentions.
<PAGE>
Name                                 - 8 -                                  Date



12.      Mitigation.  In the  event  that  your  employment  is  terminated  and
         payments become due pursuant to this Agreement,  you shall have no duty
         to mitigate damages or to become re-employed by another employer.

If you are in agreement  with the  foregoing,  please so indicate by signing and
returning to the  Corporation  the enclosed copy of this letter,  whereupon this
letter shall constitute a binding  agreement  between you and the Corporation in
accordance with its terms.

Very truly yours,







PJD/sd
Enclosure

                                            AGREED:



                                            _________________________________
                                            Name



                                            Date:  __________________________
<PAGE>
                  ELECTION FOR RECEIPT OF INSTALLMENT PAYMENTS
                  --------------------------------------------




Pursuant to the terms of the Change in Control  Agreement dated  ________,  19__
between Del Webb Corporation and the  undersigned,  I elect to have the payments
due me  under  Section  3(a)  of  this  letter  agreement  paid  to me in  equal
semi-monthly installments over a period of eighteen (18) months.

                                             ________________________________
                                             Name

                                             Date:  _________________________




State of Arizona               )
                               )  ss.
County of Maricopa             )


The  foregoing  instrument  was  acknowledged  before  me  this  _______  day of
____________________, 19___, by [Name].



My Commission Expires ________________.      ___________________________________
                                             Notary
<PAGE>
Exhibit 10.1      Sample  Change of Control  Agreements  for  certain  officers.
                  Schedule of differences:


1.       Limited Right to Receive Severance  Benefits.  In the event that within
         twenty-four  (24) months  after a change of control of the  Corporation
         (as defined herein) your employment with the Corporation in terminated,
         you shall be entitled to the severance  benefits  provided in Section 3
         hereof unless:

         (a)      at  that   time  your   employment   is   terminated   by  the
                  Corporation,you  have a written  employment  contract with the
                  Corporation   extending   at  least   ________   months   (see
                  differences  attached  hereto  as #1) from  the  date  written
                  Notice  of  Termination  is  given  you  and  the  Corporation
                  acknowledges  it s breach of that agreement and offers you, in
                  cash,  an  amount  equal to all  future  payments  called  for
                  thereunder, plus all other damages suffered by you as a result
                  of such termination;

3.       Effect  of  Termination.  If you  are  entitled  to  receive  severance
         benefits pursuant to Section 1 hereof, such severance benefits shall be
         as follows:

         (a)      you will be entitled to a cash payment in lump sum (or, if you
                  make an  irrevocable  election  prior to a Change in  Control,
                  payable in equal semi- monthly  installments without interest)
                  equal to __________ times (see differences  attached hereto as
                  #2) the  highest  annual  base  salary  in  effect at any time
                  during the twelve (12) months  prior to the date the Notice of
                  Termination is given  ("Termination  Salary"),  plus an amount
                  equal to the greater of the value of all  bonuses  paid to you
                  during the twelve  (12)  month  period  prior to the giving of
                  such  Notice  of  Termination,   or  __________  percent  (see
                  differences attached hereto as #3)of the Termination Salary;
<PAGE>
                              Contract          OR               PLUS           
                Date of       Extension         Base Salary      Bonus          
Name            Agreement     in Months (1)     in Years (2)     Computation (3)
- ----            ---------     -------------     ------------     ---------------
                                                                                
John                                                                            
Spencer          5-20-88           24                2               35%        
                                                                                
Don                                                                             
Mickus           5-20-88           24                2               35%        
                                                                                
Frank                                                                           
Pankratz         5-20-88           18                1.5             40%        
                                                                                
LeRoy                                                                           
Hanneman         5-17-89           18                1.5             35%        
                                                                                
Anne                                                                            
Mariucci         5-20-88           18                1.5             35%        
                                                                                
Dave                                                                            
Rau              5-20-88           18                1.5             35%        
                                                                                
Chuck                                                                           
Roach            5-17-89           18                1.5             35%        
                                                                                
Dennis                                                                          
Wilkins          7-01-89           18                1.5             35%        
                                                                                
Jack                                                                            
Gleason          2-01-90           18                1.5             35%        
                                                                                
Joe                                                                             
Contadino       10-20-92           18                1.5             35%        
                                                                                
Rob                                                                             
Jones           11-16-92           18                1.5             35%        
                                                                                
Dave                                                                            
Schreiner       12-21-92           18                1.5             35%        
                                                                                
Lynn                                                                            
Schuttenberg     4-29-93           18                1.5             35%        
                                                                                
Bob                                                                             
Wagoner          1-26-94           18                1.5             35%        
                                                                                
John                                                                            
Murray           9-25-95           18                1.5             35%        

                                                                    Exhibit 10.2
                       EMPLOYMENT AND CONSULTING AGREEMENT
                       -----------------------------------


         This Employment and Consulting  Agreement (the  "Agreement") is entered
into as of the 10th day of July, 1996 between DEL WEBB  CORPORATION,  a Delaware
corporation (the "Company"), and PHILIP J. DION ("Dion").

1.       DEFINITIONS
         -----------

         Throughout this Agreement,  certain defined terms will be identified by
the  capitalization  of the first letter of the defined word or the first letter
of each substantive word in a defined phrase. Whenever used, these terms will be
given the indicated meaning.

2.       TERM OF AGREEMENT; DUTIES
         -------------------------

         (a)      Employment Period
                  -----------------

         The  "Employment  Period"  shall  begin  on July  10,  1996  and end on
November 30, 1999. During the Employment  Period,  Dion shall perform the duties
of  Chairman  of the Board and Chief  Executive  Officer  of  Company.  As Chief
Executive  Officer,  Dion shall  supervise  and direct the entire  operation  of
Company  and,  to  the  extent  practicable,  its  "Subsidiaries".   During  the
Employment Period, Dion also shall perform such additional duties related to the
business and affairs of Company and its  Subsidiaries as may be delegated to him
from  time to time by the Board of  Directors  of  Company  (the  "Board").  Any
additional duties delegated to Dion by the Board shall be consistent with Dion's
position as Chief  Executive  Officer and  Chairman of the Board and shall be of
the type customarily assigned to the Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the
Board of a  comparable  corporation.  For purposes of this  Agreement,  the term
"Subsidiary" shall mean any corporation,  partnership,  joint venture,  or other
entity in which  Company  directly  or  indirectly  has a 20% or greater  equity
interest.

         (b)      Consulting Period
                  -----------------

         Dion's  status as an  "employee"  of Company  shall end on November 30,
1999, the last day of the Employment Period, unless this Agreement is terminated
previously  pursuant to the  provisions  hereof.  If this Agreement has not been
previously  terminated,  Dion shall become a part-time  consultant to Company on
December  1, 1999 and  shall  continue  to serve as a  part-time  consultant  to
Company until  November 30, 2001.  The period  beginning on December 1, 1999 and
ending on November  30, 2001 shall be  referred to as the  "Consulting  Period".
During the  Consulting  Period,  Dion shall  serve as  Chairman  of the Board of
Company if he is elected to the Board of  Directors by the  stockholders  and is
appointed  as  Chairman by the  directors,  in each case  pursuant to  Company's
Bylaws.  In such case, Dion shall perform the duties assigned to the Chairman of
the Board by  Company's  Bylaws.  If he is  serving  as a member of the Board of
Directors during the Consulting
<PAGE>
Period Mr. Dion shall  receive,  in addition to the  Consulting Fee set forth in
Section  5, the same fees for  attendance  and  committee  assignments  as other
non-employee Board members; provided, that during the Consulting Period he shall
not receive any additional  fee for acting as Chairman of the Board.  Regardless
of whether  Dion is  serving  as  Chairman  of the Board  during the  Consulting
Period, Dion shall perform such additional or other duties as may be assigned to
him by the Board as long as such duties are of the type customarily  assigned to
a  retired  Chief  Executive  Officer  acting  as a  part-time  consultant  to a
comparable  corporation.  Dion shall not be  required  to perform  more than 600
hours of consulting services in either of the 12-month periods (December 1, 1999
to November 30, 2000 and December 1, 2000 to November 30, 2001)  included in the
Consulting  Period.  The Consulting Period shall not commence and Dion shall not
be a  consultant  if this  Agreement  is  terminated  prior to  December 1, 1999
pursuant to the provisions  hereof. The Consulting Period may be extended for an
additional one-year period on such terms and conditions as the parties may agree
to.

         (c)      Board Nomination
                  ----------------

         Company  will  recommend  to the  Nominating  Committee  that  Dion  be
submitted to the  stockholders as a Board candidate  following the expiration of
his term on the Board that begins in calendar year 1996.  Dion's nomination will
be left to the  discretion  of the  Nominating  Committee,  which shall act in a
manner that it deems to be in the best interests of Company's  stockholders.  As
provided in Section 11(b)(1), if Dion is not nominated and elected to the Board,
or is elected to the Board but not the  Chairmanship,  he shall have Good Reason
to terminate this Agreement.

         (d)      General
                  -------

         Dion agrees that at all times during both the Employment Period and the
Consulting  Period  he will  faithfully,  industriously,  and to the best of his
ability, experience, and talents, perform all of the duties that may be required
of and from him and fulfill all of his  responsibilities  hereunder  pursuant to
the express and explicit  terms hereof,  to the reasonable  satisfaction  of the
Board.  Dion also  agrees  that  during the  Employment  Period,  he will devote
substantially  all of his  undivided  time,  attention,  knowledge,  and skills,
during  customary  business  hours,  to the business  and  interests of Company,
subject to such  reasonable  vacations and sick leave as are provided  under the
general  policies of Company as they may exist from time to time and  consistent
with past practice.  During the Employment Period,  Dion also shall maintain his
residence  at a location  within the city or in or near a suburban  community of
the city in which the executive offices of Company are located.

3.       DEATH BENEFIT
         -------------

         In  addition to any other  benefits  to which Dion may become  entitled
pursuant to any plan or program  sponsored  by  Company,  if this  Agreement  is
terminated  during the Employment  Period by reason of the death of Dion, Dion's
widow or, if she shall not survive him, his estate shall be paid at
                                       -2-
<PAGE>
the rate of Dion's  "Base  Salary" (as  determined  pursuant to Section 4) as in
effect at the time of his death for a period of 12 calendar months following the
date of his death.

4.       COMPENSATION FOR EMPLOYMENT PERIOD
         ----------------------------------

         Dion shall receive the following  compensation  for services during the
Employment Period.

         (a)      Base Salary
                  -----------

         Dion shall receive "Base Salary"  during the  Employment  Period at the
rate of $500,000 per year. Base Salary shall be payable as nearly as possible in
equal bi-weekly installments.  The Base Salary may be adjusted from time to time
in accordance with the procedures  established by Company for salary adjustments
for executive officers, but it may not be reduced below the Base Salary provided
above.

         (b)      Incentive and Benefit Plans
                  ---------------------------

         During the Employment  Period,  Dion shall participate in any incentive
compensation  plans,  pension or profit  sharing plans,  stock  purchase  plans,
executive  retirement  plans, any annuity or group benefit plans and any medical
plans and other benefit plans that are now or in the future may be maintained by
Company  for its  executive  officers,  all in  accordance  with the  terms  and
conditions  of the plans.  Dion shall not be  entitled to  participate  in these
plans  during  the   Consulting   Period   except  to  the  extent  that  Dion's
participation is continued pursuant to other provisions of this Agreement (e.g.,
Section 6) because of the  circumstances  pursuant  to which his  employment  is
terminated.  During  the  Employment  Period  (but not the  Consulting  Period),
Company will  provide  Dion with an  automobile  and an active  membership  in a
country club of Dion's  choice in  accordance  with the  policies and  practices
applicable  to the Chief  Executive  Officer.  The  automobile  and country club
policies  for  executive  officers  may be  modified  from time to time,  but no
reduction in the level of benefits provided or expenses reimbursed will apply to
Dion in the absence of his consent.  At the conclusion of the Employment Period,
Dion  shall  retain  the  country  club  membership  in his  name  and  shall be
responsible for dues and other expenses associated therewith.

5.       CONSULTING FEE
         --------------

         Dion shall receive a  "Consulting  Fee" of $200,000 per year during the
Consulting  Period. The Consulting Fee shall be payable as nearly as possible in
equal bi-weekly  installments or in such other  installments as Company and Dion
may agree. Except as provided elsewhere in this Agreement, the Consulting Fee is
the only  compensation  to which Dion will be  entitled  for  services  rendered
during the  Consulting  Period.  The Consulting Fee will represent a payment for
services  rendered  by an  independent  contractor  and will not be  subject  to
withholding or employment taxes.
                                       -3-
<PAGE>
6.       RETIREE MEDICAL COVERAGE
         ------------------------

         If  Dion's   employment  is  continued  until  the  expiration  of  the
Employment Period, or if Dion's employment is terminated prior to the expiration
of the Employment  Period by Company without Cause pursuant to Sections 10 or 12
or by Dion for Good  Reason  pursuant  to  Sections 11 or 12, Dion also shall be
entitled to  continued  coverage  under any and all health  plans  sponsored  by
Company for the benefit of its executive level employees (the "Executive  Health
Plans"),  with such coverage to continue until the later of the death of Dion or
his spouse.  The coverage  afforded to Dion and his spouse  under the  Executive
Health Plans and the premiums  they will be required to pay shall be the same as
the coverage  afforded to and the premiums charged to any active executive level
employee,  provided  that the benefits  may be reduced by any  benefits  payable
pursuant to Part A or Part B of Medicare  or any  replacement  national or state
health care  program  (all of which  programs  are  collectively  referred to as
"Medicare").

         After Dion  becomes  eligible  for  Medicare  coverage,  in lieu of the
continued coverage of Dion under the Executive Health Plans, Company may, at its
expense,  purchase a Medicare supplement for Dion, with such Medicare supplement
to provide the best coverage available under any Medicare  supplement  generally
available in the location in which Dion resides; provided, however, that Company
may  elect to  provide  a  Medicare  supplement  other  than the best  available
supplement  as long as such  supplement  provides  Dion (when  combined with the
coverage  afforded to Dion by Medicare) with coverage  reasonably  comparable to
the coverage  offered to executive level  employees  under the Executive  Health
Plans. If Dion becomes eligible to receive  Medicare  coverage prior to the date
on which Dion's spouse becomes  eligible to receive  Medicare  coverage,  Dion's
spouse shall continue to receive coverage under Company's Executive Health Plans
until she,  too, is eligible for Medicare  coverage,  at which point Company may
purchase a  Medicare  supplement  for Dion's  spouse on the same terms set forth
above for Dion.

         Notwithstanding anything in this Section to the contrary,  Company will
exert its best  efforts to assure  that any  coverage  afforded  to Dion and his
spouse pursuant to this Section under the Executive Health Plans or any Medicare
supplement  allows Dion and his spouse to choose their own  physicians and other
medical care providers.

         If Company,  after a good faith effort,  is unable to provide continued
coverage to Dion and/or his spouse under the  Executive  Health Plans because of
restrictions  imposed by any insurance  carrier that  provides  coverage for any
claims  incurred  under the  Executive  Health  Plans,  in lieu of the continued
coverage of Dion and/or his spouse, Company may pay Dion or his spouse a monthly
amount  equal to 150% of the cost of  providing  coverage  under  the  Executive
Health  Plans to executive  level  employees  with covered  families the size of
Dion's.  Such cost shall be determined  conclusively  by Company.  Such payments
shall continue  unless or until the Company  provides Dion and his spouse with a
Medicare supplement in accordance with the preceding provisions of this Section.
                                       -4-
<PAGE>
         Company  intends to provide Dion and his spouse with  medical  coverage
that is the same as or  comparable  to the coverage  offered to its senior level
executives  until such time as they  become  eligible  for  Medicare.  Following
eligibility for Medicare,  Company intends to provide Dion and his spouse with a
high  quality  Medicare  supplement.  If  due to  changes  in  medical  programs
available to Company or in Medicare the preceding  provisions of this Section do
not  accomplish  this  objective,  Company  and  Dion  (or  his  spouse  if Dion
predeceases her) will enter into good faith negotiations to reach an alternative
agreement that will carry out this intention.

7.       CONFIDENTIALITY
         ---------------

         Dion  covenants  and agrees to hold in  strictest  confidence,  and not
disclose to any person, firm or corporation, without the express written consent
of Company,  any and all of Company's  or any  Subsidiary's  confidential  data,
including but not limited to information and documents  concerning  Company's or
any Subsidiary's  business,  customers,  and suppliers,  market methods,  files,
trade  secrets,  or other  "know-how"  or  techniques  or  information  not of a
published  nature which shall come into his  possession,  knowledge,  or custody
concerning the business of Company or any Subsidiary,  except as such disclosure
may be required by law or in connection with Dion's employment  hereunder.  This
covenant and agreement of Dion shall  survive this  Agreement and continue to be
binding upon Dion after the expiration or termination of this Agreement, whether
by  passage  of time or  otherwise  so long as such  information  and data shall
remain confidential.

         Dion   acknowledges   that,   in  the  event  of  his   breach  of  the
confidentiality   provisions   of  this  Section  7,  money   damages  will  not
sufficiently  compensate  Company or the  applicable  Subsidiary for its injury.
Dion  accordingly  agrees that in addition  to such money  damages,  Dion may be
restrained and enjoined from continuing breach of the provisions of this Section
7 without any bond or other  security  being  required  by any court.  Dion also
acknowledges  that any  breach  of this  Section 7 would  result in  irreparable
damage to Company or the applicable Subsidiary.

8.       TERMINATION DUE TO DEATH OR DISABILITY
         --------------------------------------

         (a)      Death
                  -----

         This Agreement shall  terminate upon Dion's death.  Dion's estate shall
be entitled to receive the Base Salary,  or Consulting Fee, due through the date
of his death,  but no Base Salary,  Consulting  Fee, or other payment or benefit
will be payable in the future  except as  expressly  provided  elsewhere in this
Agreement.

         (b)      Permanent Disability
                  --------------------

         At Company's  option,  this Agreement also shall terminate in the event
of Dion's "Permanent  Disability" upon notice in writing to Dion to that effect.
For purposes of this Agreement,  "Permanent  Disability" shall mean that because
of physical or mental illness or disability, with or without
                                       -5-
<PAGE>
accommodation,  Dion shall have been  continuously  unable to perform his duties
hereunder for a consecutive period of 180 days.

         If this  Agreement is terminated  during the  Employment  Period due to
Dion's Permanent Disability, Dion shall receive all of the payments and benefits
called for by Section 10, other than the benefits called for by Section 10(b)(8)
and (9) relating to stock  options,  stock  appreciation  rights and  restricted
stock.  If this  Agreement is  terminated  during the  Consulting  Period due to
Dion's  Permanent  Disability,  Dion shall be entitled to receive the Consulting
Fee  throughout  the  balance  of the  Consulting  Period  and Dion shall not be
entitled to receive any other amounts or benefits except to the extent expressly
provided in other provisions of this Agreement (e.g., Section 6).

         (c)      Lapse of Provisions
                  -------------------

         This Section 8 shall cease to apply following the termination of Dion's
employment pursuant to Sections 10, 11, or 12.

9.       TERMINATION FOR CAUSE
         ---------------------

         (a)      General
                  -------

         Company may terminate this Agreement for "Cause" upon written notice to
Dion. If Company  terminates  this Agreement for "Cause",  Dion's Base Salary or
Consulting Fee, whichever is applicable at the time, shall immediately cease and
Dion  shall be  entitled  to no other  payments  or  benefits  pursuant  to this
Agreement,  except for any vested rights  pursuant to any benefit plans in which
Dion participates.

         (b)      "Cause" Defined
                  ---------------
         Termination  of this Agreement for "Cause" shall mean (i) breach of any
material  provision  of this  Agreement  by Dion  which  is not  cured  within a
reasonable  time after  receipt by Dion of written  notice of such  breach  from
Company,  or (ii) conviction of Dion of any felony, or any other crime involving
moral turpitude (meaning a crime that necessarily  includes the commission of an
act of gross depravity, dishonesty, or bad morals).

10.      TERMINATION WITHOUT CAUSE
         -------------------------

         (a)      General
                  -------

         Termination  of this  Agreement  by Company for reasons  other than (i)
death,  (ii) Permanent  Disability,  (iii) Cause, or (iv) upon expiration of the
Employment  Period  and  the  Consulting  Period  shall  be  referred  to  as  a
termination "without Cause". If this Agreement is terminated without Cause,
                                       -6-
<PAGE>
Dion is entitled to receive 30 days advance written notice. This Agreement shall
continue  during such notice period.  The termination of this Agreement shall be
effective on the 30th day (the  "Termination  Date")  following the day on which
the notice is given (the "Notice Date").

         (b)      Payments and Benefits
                  ---------------------

         If Company  terminates  this  Agreement  without Cause pursuant to this
Section:

                  (1)      If the Termination  Date occurs during the Employment
                           Period,  Company will pay Dion his Base Salary as set
                           forth in  Section 4 (or as it may be  increased  from
                           time to time),  plus  16-2/3%  of the Base  Salary in
                           lieu of  employee  benefits  referred  to in  Section
                           4(b), in equal bi-weekly installments. With each such
                           payment,   Company  also  shall  make  an  "Incentive
                           Compensation   Payment"  to  Dion.   The   "Incentive
                           Compensation  Payment" shall equal the average annual
                           "Incentive  Compensation"  paid to  Dion  by  Company
                           during the five  fiscal  years  preceding  the fiscal
                           year in which the Termination  Date occurs divided by
                           26.  For   purposes  of  this   Section,   "Incentive
                           Compensation"  refers to the amounts  payable to Dion
                           pursuant to any management incentive  compensation or
                           bonus program  sponsored by Company during the fiscal
                           years included in the five-year averaging period. The
                           payments  called for by the  preceding  provisions of
                           this Section shall continue throughout the Employment
                           Period.  Company  then shall pay Dion the  Consulting
                           Fee  in  equal  bi-weekly  payments   throughout  the
                           Consulting Period.

                  (2)      If the Termination  Date occurs during the Consulting
                           Period,  Company shall continue to pay the Consulting
                           Fee for the balance of the Consulting Period.

                  (3)      If the  Notice  Date  occurs  during  the  Employment
                           Period (but not the Consulting Period),  Company will
                           pay  any  reasonable  expenses  incurred  by  Dion in
                           finding new employment  and any  reasonable  costs of
                           moving Dion and his family and  possessions  to a new
                           location, with such expenses not to exceed $50,000 in
                           the  aggregate.  Alternatively,  Dion  may  elect  to
                           receive  a lump sum  payment  of  $50,000  in lieu of
                           reimbursement for such expenses.

                  (4)      Company will pay Dion's  automobile  expenses for the
                           remainder of the Employment Period in accordance with
                           the provisions of Section 4(b).

                  (5)      Company will pay the dues of the club  referred to in
                           Section  4(b)  for the  remainder  of the  Employment
                           Period in accordance  with the  provisions of Section
                           4(b).
                                       -7-
<PAGE>
                  (6)      Company will pay any expenses  incurred in connection
                           with any conventions,  seminars,  or travel scheduled
                           prior to the Notice Date,  regardless  of whether the
                           Notice Date occurs  during the  Employment  Period or
                           the Consulting Period.

                  (7)      If  the  termination  occurs  during  the  Employment
                           Period,  Dion will continue to accrue  benefits under
                           Company's  Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan No.
                           1 (the "SERP") until the end of the Employment Period
                           to the same extent and on the same basis as if Dion's
                           actual  employment  were  continued to the end of the
                           Employment  Period.  At the  end  of  the  Employment
                           Period,  Dion  will  be  entitled  to  begin  to draw
                           benefits  pursuant to the  provisions of the SERP and
                           his SERP Participation Agreement.

                  (8)      If the  Notice  Date  occurs  during  the  Employment
                           Period,  any  stock  options  or  stock  appreciation
                           rights to purchase  or  relating  to Common  Stock of
                           Company held by Dion on the Notice Date which are not
                           at the Notice Date currently exercisable shall on the
                           Notice Date  automatically  become exercisable and be
                           exercisable for 90 days thereafter.

                  (9)      If the  Notice  Date  occurs  during  the  Employment
                           Period, all shares of Common Stock of Company held by
                           Dion under any Company  Restricted  Stock Plans which
                           are still subject to  restrictions on the Notice Date
                           shall as of that date  automatically  become  free of
                           all restrictions.

         (c)      Office Space and Services
                  -------------------------

         If Company  terminates  this  Agreement  without Cause pursuant to this
Section 10, from the Notice Date until the "Benefit  Termination  Date"  Company
will provide Dion with suitable office space  (substantially  equivalent to that
occupied by Dion on the Notice Date) and private secretarial  services away from
Company's offices in an office complex of Dion's choice in Phoenix, Arizona. The
"Benefit  Termination  Date" shall be the date  following the  Termination  Date
which is the later of (i) the  expiration of both the  Employment and Consulting
Periods as provided in Section 2 hereof,  or (ii) the first  anniversary  of the
Termination Date.

         (d)      Non-Disparagement
                  -----------------

         Provided that Company duly performs all of its  obligations  arising by
virtue of a termination of Dion pursuant to this Section, Dion will not publicly
disparage  Company or its  officers,  directors,  employees,  or agents and will
refrain from any action  which would  reasonably  be expected to cause  material
adverse public  relations or embarrassment to Company or to any of such persons.
Similarly,  provided that Dion duly performs all of his  obligations to Company,
Company  (including  its officers,  directors,  employees,  and agents) will not
disparage Dion and will refrain from any action which
                                       -8-
<PAGE>
would reasonably be expected to result in embarrassment to Dion or to materially
and  adversely  affect his  opportunities  for  employment.  The  preceding  two
sentences shall not apply to disclosures required by applicable law, regulation,
or order of court or governmental agency.

         (e)      Other Plans
                  -----------

         Except to the extent specified in this Section 10, this Agreement shall
not affect Dion's  participation in,  distributions from and vested rights under
any pension, profit sharing, or other employee benefit plan of Company or any of
its Subsidiaries, which will be governed by the terms of those respective plans.

         (f)      Minimum Benefit Period; COBRA
                  -----------------------------

         At a minimum, if Dion's employment is terminated without Cause pursuant
to this  Section 10 during  the  Employment  Period,  until the later of (i) the
expiration of the Employment  Period or (ii) for one year after the  Termination
Date, Company shall arrange to provide Dion with life, disability, accident, and
group health  benefits and coverages  substantially  similar to those which Dion
was  receiving  immediately  prior to the Notice Date.  The cost to Dion of such
coverage shall not be more than the cost to Dion of similar coverage immediately
prior to the Notice Date. The benefits  provided by this Section 10(f) shall not
be due for any period for which Dion is entitled to receive a payment of 16-2/3%
of his Base Salary for the Employment  Period pursuant to Section  10(b)(1).  In
addition,  the parties do not intend to duplicate any benefits. As a result, the
provisions of this Section shall not apply with respect to a particular  benefit
if and so long as the  benefit  is  continued,  or if a  payment  in lieu of the
benefit is due, pursuant to any other provision of this Agreement.  Dion's right
to  continued  life,  disability,  accident,  and  health  benefits  shall be in
addition  to and not in lieu of Dion's  rights  under the  Consolidated  Omnibus
Reconciliation Act of 1986 ("COBRA").

11.      TERMINATION BY DION
         -------------------

         (a)      General
                  -------
   
         Dion may terminate  this  Agreement at any time,  with or without "Good
Reason".  If Dion  terminates this Agreement  without "Good Reason",  Dion shall
provide  Company with 90 days advance  written  notice.  If Dion terminates this
Agreement  with Good  Reason,  Dion shall  provide  Company with 30 days advance
written notice.

         (b)      Good Reason Defined
                  -------------------

         For purposes of this  Agreement,  "Good  Reason" shall mean and include
each of the following:
                                       -9-
<PAGE>
                  (1)      Without   Dion's   express   written   consent,   the
                           assignment to him of any duties that are inconsistent
                           with his  positions,  duties,  responsibilities,  and
                           status  with  Company  as in effect on the  "Relevant
                           Date",  or  demotion,  or a change  in his  titles or
                           offices as in effect on the Relevant  Date (except as
                           specifically  contemplated by this Agreement), or any
                           removal of him from or any failure to  re-appoint  or
                           re-elect  him to any of  such  positions,  except  in
                           connection with the termination of this Agreement for
                           Cause,  Permanent  Disability,  as a  result  of  his
                           death,  by him  other  than  for Good  Reason,  or by
                           Company upon the  expiration  of the  Employment  and
                           Consulting Periods.

                  (2)      A  reduction  by  Company  in Dion's  Base  Salary or
                           Consulting  Fee as in effect on the date hereof or as
                           the same may be increased from time to time.

                  (3)      During  the  Employment  Period,  the  taking  of any
                           action by Company which would adversely affect Dion's
                           participation  in or  materially  reduce his benefits
                           under any thrift, incentive, or compensation plan, or
                           any pension,  life insurance,  health and accident or
                           disability plan in which Dion is participating on the
                           Relevant  Date,   unless  a  comparable   replacement
                           program is offered to Dion.

                  (4)      Assignment of Dion to, or the relocation of Company's
                           office at which Dion is  principally  employed  as of
                           the Relevant Date to, a location  which would require
                           a  round-trip  commute  to work from  Dion's  present
                           residence of more than 120 miles per day.

                  (5)      Failure   of   Company   to   obtain   an   agreement
                           satisfactory  to  Dion  from  any  successor  to  the
                           business, or substantially all the assets, of Company
                           to assume  this  Agreement  or issue a  substantially
                           similar agreement.

                  (6)      The  termination of this Agreement by Company without
                           Cause  or  any  attempted   termination   by  Company
                           purportedly for Cause if it is thereafter  determined
                           that Cause did not exist  under this  Agreement  with
                           respect to the termination.

                  (7)      Breach of any material  provisions of this  Agreement
                           by  Company  which is not cured  within 30 days after
                           receipt by Company of written  notice of such  breach
                           from Dion.

For purposes of this Section 11, the "Relevant Date" is the date of execution of
this  Agreement.  For  purposes of Section 12, the  "Relevant  Date" is the date
specified in Section 12(d).
                                      -10-
<PAGE>
         (c)      Effect of Good Reason Termination
                  ---------------------------------

         If Dion  terminates  this  Agreement  for Good  Reason,  Dion  shall be
entitled to receive all of the payments  and benefits  provided by Section 10 to
the same extent as if this  Agreement  had been  terminated  by Company  without
Cause.

         (d)      Effect of Termination without Good Reason
                  -----------------------------------------

         If Dion  terminates this Agreement  without Good Reason,  Dion shall be
entitled  to  receive  his Base  Salary or  Consulting  Fee (as the case may be)
through the effective date of his termination. Dion's entitlement to receive any
other  amount shall be  determined  in  accordance  with the  provisions  of any
incentive or benefit plans in which Dion  participates  on the effective date of
the termination.

12.      CHANGE IN CONTROL OF COMPANY
         ----------------------------

         (a)      General
                  -------
         The Board  recognizes  that the continuing  possibility of a "Change in
Control"  of  Company  is  unsettling  to Dion and other  senior  executives  of
Company.  Therefore,  the  arrangements  set forth  below are being made to help
assure a continuing dedication by Dion to his duties to Company, notwithstanding
the occurrence or potential  occurrence of a "Change in Control." In particular,
the Board  believes it important,  should Company  receive  proposals from third
parties with respect to its future, to enable Dion,  without being influenced by
the  uncertainties of his own situation,  to assess and advise the Board whether
such proposals  would be in the best  interests of Company and its  stockholders
and to take such  other  action  regarding  such  proposals  as the Board  might
determine to be appropriate.  The Board also wishes to demonstrate to executives
of Company  that  Company is concerned  with the welfare of its  executives  and
intends to see that loyal executives are treated fairly.

         (b)      Eligibility to Receive a Severance Benefit
                  ------------------------------------------

         In  view  of the  foregoing  and in  further  consideration  of  Dion's
continued employment with Company, Company agrees that if a Change in Control of
Company occurs during the Employment Period (but not the Consulting Period) Dion
shall be entitled to the severance benefits provided in subparagraph (f) of this
Section 12 if prior to the  expiration  of 24 months after the Change in Control
of Company  Dion  terminates  his  employment  with  Company  for Good Reason or
Company  terminates  Dion's  employment  without  Cause.  If Dion  triggers  the
application of this Section by terminating  employment for Good Reason,  he must
do so  within  120  days  following  the  occurrence  of  the  last  event  that
constitutes Good Reason.  The full severance  benefits  provided by this Section
shall  be  payable  regardless  of the  period  remaining  until  the end of the
Employment Period.
                                      -11-
<PAGE>
         (c)      Change in Control Defined
                  -------------------------

         For purposes of this  Agreement,  a "Change in Control"  shall  include
both an "Actual Change in Control" and a "Potential Change in Control".

         An "Actual  Change in Control"  shall be deemed to have occurred in any
or all of the following instances:

                  (1)      Any  "person" as such term is used in Sections  13(d)
                           and 14(d) of the Securities  Exchange Act of 1934, as
                           amended,  other  than a  trustee  or other  fiduciary
                           holding  securities under an employee benefit plan of
                           Company or a corporation owned directly or indirectly
                           by the stockholders of Company in  substantially  the
                           same  proportions  as  their  ownership  of  stock of
                           Company,  is or becomes  the  "beneficial  owner" (as
                           defined in Rule 13d-3  under said Act),  directly  or
                           indirectly, of securities of Company representing 20%
                           or more of the  total  voting  power  represented  by
                           Company's  then  outstanding  Voting  Securities  (as
                           defined below); or

                  (2)      During   any   period  of  two   consecutive   years,
                           individuals  who  at the  beginning  of  such  period
                           constitute  the Board of Directors of Company and any
                           new director whose election by the Board of Directors
                           or nomination for election by Company's  stockholders
                           was approved by a vote of at least  two-thirds of the
                           directors  then  still  in  office  who  either  were
                           directors  at the  beginning  of the  period or whose
                           election or nomination for election was previously so
                           approved,  cease  for  any  reason  to  constitute  a
                           majority thereof; or

                  (3)      The  stockholders  of  Company  approve  a merger  or
                           consolidation of Company with any other  corporation,
                           other  than a merger  or  consolidation  which  would
                           result   in  the   Voting   Securities   of   Company
                           outstanding  immediately prior thereto  continuing to
                           represent  (either  by  remaining  outstanding  or by
                           being   converted  into  Voting   Securities  of  the
                           surviving  entity)  at least 80% of the total  voting
                           power represented by the Voting Securities of Company
                           or  such  surviving  entity  outstanding  immediately
                           after such merger or consolidation; or

                  (4)      The   stockholders  of  Company  approve  a  plan  of
                           complete  liquidation  of Company or an agreement for
                           the  sale  or  disposition  by  Company  of  (in  one
                           transaction  or a  series  of  transactions)  all  or
                           substantially all Company's assets.

         A "Potential Change in Control" shall be deemed to have occurred in any
or all of the following instances:
                                      -12-
<PAGE>
                  (1)      Company enters into an agreement, the consummation of
                           which  would  result in the  occurrence  of an Actual
                           Change in Control;

                  (2)      Any person (including  Company) publicly announces an
                           intention to take or to consider taking actions which
                           if consummated would constitute a Change in Control;

                  (3)      Any person  other  than a trustee or other  fiduciary
                           holding  securities under an employee benefit plan of
                           Company  or  a   corporation   owned,   directly   or
                           indirectly,   by  the   stockholders  of  Company  in
                           substantially the same proportions as their ownership
                           of stock of Company who is or becomes the  beneficial
                           owner,  directly  or  indirectly,  of  securities  of
                           Company  representing  10% or  more  of the  combined
                           voting power of the Company's then outstanding Voting
                           Securities,   increases   such  person's   beneficial
                           ownership  of  such  securities  by  five  percentage
                           points (5%) or more over the  percentage  so owned by
                           such person; or

                  (4)      The Board of  Directors  adopts a  resolution  to the
                           effect  that,  for  purposes  of  this  Agreement,  a
                           Potential Change in Control has occurred.

         For purposes of this Section,  the term "Voting  Securities" shall mean
and include any  securities of the Company which vote generally for the election
of directors.

         (d)      Good Reason Defined
                  -------------------

         For  purposes of this  Section,  "Good  Reason"  shall have the meaning
assigned to it in Section  11,  except  that for  purposes  of this  Section the
"Relevant  Date" shall be the day prior to the Change in Control  and  paragraph
(3) of Section 11(b) shall read as follows:

         (3)      The  failure  by  Company to  continue  in effect any  thrift,
                  incentive,   or  compensation  plan,  or  any  pension,   life
                  insurance,  health and  accident or  disability  plan in which
                  Dion is participating on the Relevant Date (or plans providing
                  Dion with substantially  similar benefits),  the taking of any
                  action  by  Company  which  would   adversely   affect  Dion's
                  participation  in or materially  reduce his benefits under any
                  of such plans or deprive him of any  material  fringe  benefit
                  enjoyed  by him as of the  Relevant  Date  or any  later  date
                  (except for  acceleration of stock options or restricted stock
                  as contemplated by this Agreement).
                                      -13-
<PAGE>
         (e)      Notice of Termination by Dion
                  -----------------------------

         Any  termination by Dion under this Section 12 shall be communicated by
written  notice to Company which shall set forth in reasonable  detail the facts
and circumstances claimed to provide a basis for such termination.

         (f)      Effect of Termination
                  ---------------------

         If Dion is entitled to receive a severance  benefit pursuant to Section
12(b) hereof, Company will provide Dion with the following severance benefits in
addition to the benefits to which Dion is entitled pursuant to Section 10 or 11:

                  (1)      Within five days following Dion's termination, a lump
                           sum severance payment equal to the difference between
                           (i) the sum of three  years  of  Dion's  yearly  Base
                           Salary  as set  forth  in  Section  4 or as it may be
                           increased  from time to time,  three  years of fringe
                           benefits  calculated  at 16-2/3% of such Base  Salary
                           and three year's of Incentive  Compensation  Payments
                           calculated in accordance with Section  10(b)(1);  and
                           (ii) the total amounts due to Dion, if any,  pursuant
                           to Section 10(b)(1).

                  (2)      The amounts due to Dion pursuant to Section  10(b)(1)
                           will be accelerated  and paid to Dion in one lump sum
                           within five days following Dion's termination without
                           any discount for early payment.

                  (3)      The office  space and  secretarial  services to which
                           Dion is entitled  pursuant to Section  10(c) shall be
                           provided   until  the   earlier  of  (i)  the  second
                           anniversary  of Dion's  Notice Date or (ii) when Dion
                           secures suitable other employment.

         (g)      Excise and Income Tax Gross-Up
                  ------------------------------

         The Internal Revenue Code of 1986 (the "Code") imposes  significant tax
burdens  on Dion and  Company  if the total  amounts  received  by Dion due to a
change  in  control  exceed  prescribed  limits.  These  tax  burdens  include a
requirement that Dion pay a 20% excise tax on certain amounts received in excess
of the prescribed limits and a loss of deduction for Company. If, as a result of
these Code  provisions,  Dion is  required  to pay such  excise  tax,  then upon
written  notice from Dion to Company,  Company shall pay Dion an amount equal to
the total excise tax imposed on Dion  (including  the excise taxes on any excise
tax  reimbursements  due  pursuant to this  sentence and the excise taxes on any
federal and state tax  reimbursements  due  pursuant to the next  sentence).  If
Company is obligated to pay Dion  pursuant to the  preceding  sentence,  Company
also shall pay Dion an amount  equal to the "total  presumed  federal  and state
taxes"  that  could  be  imposed  on  Dion  with   respect  to  the  excise  tax
reimbursements  due to Dion pursuant to the  preceding  sentence and the federal
and state tax reimbursements due to Dion pursuant to this sentence. For purposes
of the preceding sentence, the
                                      -14-
<PAGE>
"total presumed  federal and state taxes" that could be imposed on Dion shall be
conclusively  calculated  using a  combined  tax  rate  equal  to the sum of the
maximum marginal  federal and state income tax rates and the hospital  insurance
(or "HI") portion of FICA.  Based on rates in effect as of the date of execution
of this Agreement,  the "total presumed  federal and state taxes" rate is 46.65%
(39.6% federal income tax rate plus 5.6% state income tax rate plus 1.45% HI tax
rate).  No  adjustments  will be made in this combined rate for the deduction of
state  taxes  on  the  federal  return,  the  loss  of  itemized  deductions  or
exemptions,  or for any other purpose.  Dion shall be responsible for paying the
actual  taxes.  The  amounts  payable  to Dion  pursuant  to  this or any  other
agreement or  arrangement  with  Company  shall not be limited in any way by the
amount that may be paid pursuant to the Code without the imposition of an excise
tax or the loss of  Company  deductions.  Either  Dion or  Company  may elect to
challenge any excise taxes imposed by the Internal  Revenue Service and Dion and
Company agree to cooperate with each other in prosecuting  such  challenges.  If
Dion elects to litigate or otherwise  challenge  the  imposition  of such excise
tax,  however,  Company will join Dion in such  litigation or challenge  only if
Company's  General  Counsel  determines  in good faith that Dion's  position has
substantial merit and that the issues should be litigated from the standpoint of
Company's best interest.

13.      COMPETITION
         -----------

         (a)      Restrictive Covenant
                  --------------------

         In  consideration  of  Company's  agreements  contained  herein and the
payments to be made by it to Dion pursuant hereto,  Dion agrees that, during the
duration of this restrictive covenant he will not:

                  (1)      Without  the prior  written  consent  of the Board of
                           Directors of Company,  engage in a Competing Business
                           within the geographical  limits of any state (or such
                           lesser  geographical area as may be set by a court of
                           competent   jurisdiction)   in   which   any  of  the
                           businesses of Company are being conducted on the date
                           of  termination  of  this  Agreement  or  within  the
                           geographical  limits  of any  state  (or such  lesser
                           geographical  area  as  may  be  set  by a  court  of
                           competent   jurisdiction)   in  which  the  Company's
                           business  plan,  as in effect on the  earlier  of the
                           date of the competitive  activity by Dion or the date
                           of  termination  of  this   Agreement,   contemplates
                           conducting  business  within two years  following the
                           date of termination of this Agreement; or

                  (2)      Directly or indirectly, for himself, or on behalf of,
                           or in  conjunction  with, any other person or entity,
                           seek to hire and/or hire any  individual  employed by
                           Company or any Subsidiary  immediately  prior to such
                           hiring or  solicitation  or during the prior one-year
                           period.
                                      -15-
<PAGE>
         (b)      Duration of Covenant.
                  --------------------

         Generally,  this restrictive covenant shall apply during the Employment
Period and the Consulting  Period and for the one-year period following the date
of  termination  of this  Agreement and any renewals  thereof.  If the Competing
Business in which Dion engages or intends to engage is a business  involving the
development  or  management  of  an  age-restricted   community,   however,  the
limitations of Section 13(a)(1) shall apply during the Employment Period and the
Consulting  Period  and  for  the  two-year  period  following  the  date of the
termination of this Agreement and any renewals thereof.

         (c)      Remedies; Reasonableness.
                  ------------------------

         Dion acknowledges and agrees that a breach by Dion of the provisions of
this Section will  constitute  such damage as will be irreparable  and the exact
amount of which will be  impossible  to ascertain  and, for that reason,  agrees
that  Company  will be  entitled to an  injunction  to be issued by any court of
competent  jurisdiction  restraining  and  enjoining  Dion  from  violating  the
provisions of this Section.  The right to an injunction  shall be in addition to
and not in lieu of any other  remedy  available  to Company  for such  breach or
threatened breach, including the recovery of damages from Dion.

         Dion  expressly  acknowledges  and  agrees  that (i)  this  Restrictive
Covenant is reasonable as to time and  geographical  area and does not place any
unreasonable  burden upon him;  (ii) the general  public will not be harmed as a
result of enforcement of this restrictive  covenant;  and (iii) Dion understands
and  hereby  agrees to each and every  term and  condition  of this  Restrictive
Covenant.

         (d)      Survival of Provision.
                  ---------------------

         Termination of this Agreement,  whether by passage of time or any other
cause,  shall not constitute a waiver of Company's rights under this Section 13,
nor a release of Dion from his obligations thereunder.

         (e)      Competing Business
                  ------------------

         For purposes of this Agreement, Dion shall be deemed to be engaged in a
"Competing  Business"  if,  in  any  capacity,  including  but  not  limited  to
proprietor, partner, officer, director, or employee, he engages or participates,
directly or  indirectly,  in the  operation,  ownership,  or  management  of any
proprietorship,   partnership,  corporation,  or  other  business  entity  which
competes,  in whole or in part,  with the then actual business of Company or any
business  contemplated by Company's business plan as in effect on the earlier of
the date of the competitive  activity by Dion or the date of termination of this
Agreement.  Indirect  participation  in the  operation  or ownership of any such
entity shall include any investment by Dion in any such entity,  by way of loan,
guaranty, or stock ownership (other than ownership of 1% or less of any class of
equity or other securities of a company
                                      -16-
<PAGE>
which is listed and  regularly  traded on any  national  securities  exchange or
which is regularly traded over-the-counter). At the written request of Dion from
time to time,  Company  shall  furnish  Dion with a written  description  of the
business or businesses in which Company is then actively engaged.

         (f)      Change of Control.
                  -----------------

         The  provisions  of this Section shall lapse and be of no further force
or effect if Dion's  employment is terminated by Company  without  Cause,  or by
Dion for Good Reason, following a Change in Control.

14.      DISPUTE RESOLUTION
         ------------------

         (a)      Mediation
                  ---------

         Any and all disputes arising under, pertaining to or touching upon this
Agreement  (excepting  the  Confidentiality  provisions  of  Section  7 and  the
Restrictive  Covenant and Competing  Business  provisions of Section 13), or the
statutory rights or obligations of either party hereto, shall, if not settled by
negotiation,  be subject to non-binding mediation before an independent mediator
selected by the  parties  pursuant to Section  14(d).  Any demand for  mediation
shall be made in writing  and served  upon the other  party to the  dispute,  by
certified mail,  return receipt  requested,  at the address specified in Section
18. The  demand  shall set forth with  reasonable  specificity  the basis of the
dispute and the relief  sought.  The mediation  hearing will occur at a time and
place convenient to the parties in Maricopa County,  Arizona,  within 30 days of
the date of selection or appointment of the mediator.

         (b)      Arbitration
                  -----------

         In the event that the dispute is not  settled  through  mediation,  the
parties  shall  then  proceed  to  binding  arbitration  before a panel of three
independent  arbitrators  selected pursuant to Section 14(d). The mediator shall
not serve as an arbitrator.  ALL DISPUTES INVOLVING ALLEGED UNLAWFUL  EMPLOYMENT
DISCRIMINATION,  TERMINATION BY ALLEGED BREACH OF CONTRACT OR POLICY, OR ALLEGED
EMPLOYMENT TORT COMMITTED BY COMPANY OR A REPRESENTATIVE  OF COMPANY,  INCLUDING
CLAIMS OF  VIOLATIONS  OF FEDERAL  OR STATE  DISCRIMINATION  STATUTES  OR PUBLIC
POLICY,  SHALL BE RESOLVED  PURSUANT TO THIS PARAGRAPH (b) AND THERE SHALL BE NO
RECOURSE TO COURT,  WITH OR WITHOUT A JURY TRIAL. The arbitration  hearing shall
occur at a time and place convenient to the parties in Maricopa County, Arizona,
within 30 days of selection or appointment of the last of the three arbitrators.
If  Company  has  adopted  a policy  that is  applicable  to  arbitrations  with
executives, the arbitration shall be conducted in accordance with said policy to
the extent that the policy is  consistent  with this  Agreement  and the Federal
Arbitration Act, 9 U.S.C.  ss.ss. 1-16. If no such policy has been adopted,  the
arbitration  shall be  governed  by the then  current  arbitration  rules of the
American   Arbitration   Association  or  its  successor  (the   "Association").
Notwithstanding any provisions in such rules to the contrary, the
                                      -17-
<PAGE>
arbitrators  shall issue findings of fact and  conclusions of law, and an award,
within 15 days of the date of the hearing unless the parties otherwise agree.

         (c)      Damages
                  -------

         In case of breach of  contract or policy,  damages  shall be limited to
contract damages.  In cases of intentional  discrimination  claims prohibited by
statute,  the  arbitrators  may direct  payment  consistent  with 42 U.S.C.  ss.
1981(a)  and the Civil  Rights Act of 1991.  In cases of  employment  tort,  the
arbitrators  may award  punitive  damages  if  proved  by clear  and  convincing
evidence. Issues of procedure,  arbitrability, or confirmation of award shall be
governed by the Federal Arbitration Act, 9 U.S.C. ss.ss. 1-16, except that Court
review of the arbitrators' award shall be that of an appellate court reviewing a
decision of a trial judge sitting without a jury.

         The  arbitrators  may  not  award   reinstatement.   Instead,   if  the
arbitrators  find  that  the  termination  by  Company  was  not  for  Permanent
Disability or not for Cause or that the termination by Dion was for Good Reason,
Dion shall only be entitled to the  benefits of Section 10 or 12 (in the case of
termination  by Company)  and Sections 11 or 12 (in the case of  termination  by
Dion) and, in either  case,  payment of his  reasonable  legal  expenses in such
arbitration.  Until a final,  binding  determination  has been entered relieving
Company of its duty to provide  payments  hereunder,  Company shall pay Dion all
amounts  to which he would be  entitled  under  Section  10,  calculated  on the
assumption that Dion's employment had been terminated without Cause.

         (d)      Selection of Mediator or Arbitrators
                  ------------------------------------

         The parties shall select the mediator from a panel list made  available
by the Association.  If the parties are unable to agree to a mediator within ten
days of  receipt  of a demand  for  mediation,  the  mediator  will be chosen by
alternatively  striking from a list of five  mediators  obtained by Company from
the Association. Executive shall have the first strike.

         The parties  also shall select the  arbitrators  from a panel list made
available by the Association.  Company and Dion each shall select one arbitrator
from such panel list within ten days of receipt of such list.  After Company and
Dion have each selected an  arbitrator,  the two  arbitrators  so selected shall
select the third arbitrator from such list within the next ten days.

         (e)      Expenses
                  --------

         The costs and  expenses of any  arbitration  shall be borne by Company.
Should Dion or Company,  at any time,  initiate  mediation  or  arbitration  for
breach of this Agreement,  Company shall reimburse Dion for all amounts spent by
Dion to pursue such mediation or arbitration,  regardless of the outcome, unless
the  mediator or  arbitrator  finds  Dion's  action to have been  frivolous  and
without merit.
                                      -18-
<PAGE>
15.      OFFICE AND CLERICAL SUPPORT.
         ---------------------------

         Company  shall  provide Dion with an  appropriate  office and part-time
secretarial  and other  support  during the  Consulting  Period.  Company  shall
continue to provide  such office and  part-time  secretarial  and other  support
after the  expiration of the  Consulting  Period until the earlier of the Annual
Meeting  that  occurs in 2005 or the last day of Dion's  service  as a member of
Company's Board of Directors. This Section shall survive the termination of this
Agreement,  but only if the  termination  occurs  due to the  expiration  of the
Consulting  Period on November 30, 2001 (or November 30, 2002 if the  Consulting
Period is extended pursuant to Section 2(b)).

16.      BENEFIT AND BINDING EFFECT
         --------------------------

         This  Agreement  shall  inure to the  benefit  of and be  binding  upon
Company,  its  successors  and  assigns,   including  but  not  limited  to  any
corporation,  person, or other entity which may acquire all or substantially all
of the assets and  business  of  Company or any  corporation  with or into which
Company  may  be  consolidated  or  merged,  and  Dion,  his  heirs,  executors,
administrators, and legal representatives, provided that the obligations of Dion
may not be delegated.

17.      OTHER AGREEMENTS OF DION
         ------------------------

         Dion  represents  that the execution and  performance of this Agreement
will not result in a breach of any of the terms and conditions of any employment
or other agreement between Dion and any third party.

18.      NOTICES
         -------

         All notices  hereunder shall be in writing and delivered  personally or
sent by registered or certified mail, postage prepaid:

         If to Company, to:                 Del Webb Corporation
                                            6001 North 24th Street
                                            Phoenix, Arizona  85016
                                            Attention:  General Counsel

         If to Dion, to:                    Philip J. Dion
                                            6110 East Caballo Lane
                                            Paradise Valley, Arizona  85253

Either  party may change the  address to which  notices  are to be sent to it by
giving 10 days'  written  notice of such change of address to the other party in
the  manner  above  provided  for  giving  notice.  Notices  will be  considered
delivered  on personal  delivery or on the date of deposit in the United  States
mail in the manner provided for giving notice by mail.
                                      -19-
<PAGE>
19.      ENTIRE AGREEMENT
         ----------------

         The entire  understanding  and  agreement  between the parties has been
incorporated  into  this  Agreement,  and this  Agreement  supersedes  all other
agreements  and  understandings  between  Dion and Company  with  respect to the
relationship of Dion with Company.

20.      GOVERNING LAW
         -------------

         This Agreement  shall be governed by and interpreted in accordance with
the laws of the State of Arizona.

21.      CAPTIONS
         --------

         The  captions  included  herein  are  for  convenience  and  shall  not
constitute a part of this Agreement.

22.      SEVERABILITY
         ------------

         If any one or more of the provisions or parts of a provision  contained
in this  Agreement  shall  for any  reason  be held to be  invalid,  illegal  or
unenforceable  in any respect,  such  invalidity or  unenforceability  shall not
affect any other  provision or part of a provision of this  Agreement,  but this
Agreement  shall be  reformed  and  construed  as if such  invalid or illegal or
unenforceable  provision or part of a provision had never been contained  herein
and such provisions or part thereof shall be reformed so that it would be valid,
legal  and  enforceable  to the  maximum  extent  permitted  by  law.  Any  such
reformation  shall be read as narrowly as possible to give the maximum effect to
the mutual intentions of Dion and Company.

23.      MITIGATION
         ----------

         In the event that Dion's  employment is terminated and payments  become
due to Dion  pursuant  to this  Agreement,  Dion shall have no duty to  mitigate
damages or to become re-employed by another employer.

24.      TERMINATION OF EMPLOYMENT
         -------------------------

         The  termination of this Agreement by either party also shall result in
the termination of Dion's employment and consulting relationship with Company in
the absence of an express written agreement  providing to the contrary.  Neither
party intends that any oral employment or consulting relationship continue after
the termination of this Agreement.
                                      -20-
<PAGE>
25.      NO CONSTRUCTION AGAINST COMPANY
         -------------------------------

         This  Agreement is the result of negotiation  between  Company and Dion
and both have had the opportunity to have this Agreement reviewed by their legal
counsel and other advisors.  Accordingly,  this Agreement shall not be construed
for or against Company or Dion,  regardless of which party drafted the provision
at issue.

                                      DEL WEBB CORPORATION



                                      By: /s/ Mary Lynn Schuttenberg
                                         ---------------------------------------

                                      Its: V.P. Human Resources
                                          --------------------------------------
                                             7/10/96
                                                             COMPANY



                                            /s/ Philip J. Dion
                                           -------------------------------------
                                               PHILIP J. DION      
                                                             DION 
                                             7/10/96
                                      -21-

                                                                    Exhibit 10.6

                            FIRST AMENDMENT TO LEASE


         THIS AMENDMENT  (hereinafter  referred to as this "Amendment") made the
29th day of February,  1996,  between WESTERN PLAZA INVESTORS,  L.P., a Delaware
limited  partnership  (hereinafter  referred to as "Landlord")  whose address is
3030 LBJ Freeway, Suite 1500, Dallas, Texas 75234, and DEL WEBB CORPORATION,  an
Arizona corporation (hereinafter referred to as  "Tenant") whose address is 6001
North 24th Street, Phoenix, Arizona 85016;

                              W I T N E S S E T H:

         WHEREAS,  Landlord and Tenant entered into a lease dated April 20, 1994
(hereinafter  referred  to as the  "Lease"),  whereby  Lessee  is  presently  in
possession  of  premises  containing  85,000 net  rentable  square feet of space
(hereinafter  referred to as the  "Premises")  in the building  known as The Del
Webb Building (hereinafter referred to as the "Building"); and

         WHEREAS,  the  parties  hereto  desire to  clarify  and  amend  certain
responsibilities  under the Lease and resolve  certain  disagreements  that have
arisen in interpreting provisions of the Lease; and

         WHEREAS,  the parties  hereto desire to modify and amend the Lease only
in the respects and on the conditions hereinafter stated.
  
         NOW, THEREFORE, Lessor and Lessee agree as follows:

         1. For  purposes of this  Amendment,  capitalized  terms shall have the
meanings ascribed to them in the Lease unless otherwise defined herein.
  
         2. Landlord and Tenant hereby confirm that the Commencement Date of the
Term of the Lease is December 1, 1994 and that the  expiration  date is November
30, 2004.

         3.  Section  4.1(d)  of the  Lease  shall be  amended  effective  as of
November 1, 1995 to read as follows:

                  "Cleaning.   Tenant  shall  assume   responsibility,   and  be
         reimbursed by Landlord as hereinafter provided,  for providing cleaning
         services to the Leased Premises, which at a minimum shall be comparable
         to the  standard  of  cleaning  provided  at other  first-class  office
         buildings in the Camelback  corridor.  For this  purpose,  Tenant shall
         engage a cleaning  contractor  or service  acceptable  to Tenant in its
         sole discretion.  Tenant shall be directly and exclusively  responsible
         for monitoring the performance of said contractor.  In consideration of
         Tenant  relieving  Landlord of  responsibility  for providing  cleaning
         services to the Leased  Premises,  Landlord shall pay to Tenant the sum
         of  Fifty-five  Thousand  ($55,000)  Dollars per year (the  "Janitorial
         Allowance") in monthly  installments in arrears of Four Thousand,  Five
         Hundred and Eighty-three  and 33/100's Dollars ($4,583.33) Dollars each
         on the tenth (10th) day of each month  commencing on February 10, 1996.
         Tenant shall render  Landlord a monthly bill for the installment of the
         Janitorial  Allowance due each month.  The  annualized  amounts paid by
         Landlord  to Tenant on  account  of the  Janitorial  Allowance  will be
         included in Operating  Costs for the Base Year and each subsequent year
         during the Term.  Except  for  payment by  landlord  of the  Janitorial
         Allowance,  Landlord shall have no  responsibility  or obligation  with
         respect to rendering  cleaning services to the Leased Premises.  Tenant
         shall be solely  responsible for the cost of such cleaning  services to
         the  Leased  Premises,  and  Tenant  shall  indemnify,  defend and hold
         Landlord  harmless  with  respect  to any and all  claims  or causes of
         action
<PAGE>
         resulting  from Tenant  assuming the  obligation of providing  cleaning
         services  to the  Leased  Premises,  except to the  extent  proximately
         caused  by the  negligence  or wilful  misconduct  of  Landlord  or its
         agents,  servants,  contractors or employees acting within the scope of
         their authority or employment."
 
         4. Tenant shall also assume,  subject to reimbursement from Landlord as
hereinafter provided,  responsibility for providing landscaping services for the
Land on which the  Leased  Premises  are  located,  which at a minimum  shall be
comparable to the standard of landscaping services provided at other first-class
office  buildings in the Camelback  corridor.  Such  landscaping  services shall
include,  but not be limited to,  regular  maintenance  and  replacement  of all
grass,  plants,  trees,  shrubs, other vegetation and landscape materials now on
the Land; and such regular  maintenance  shall  include,  but not be limited to,
watering,  mowing,  trimming and prevention of soil erosion, all to be performed
as frequently as necessary to maintain the  appearance of the Project as a first
class office building in the Camelback corridor. For this purpose,  Tenant shall
engage a landscaping  contractor or service  reasonably  acceptable to Landlord,
and Landlord shall grant to Tenant and its  landscaping  contractor or service a
nonexclusive  right of ingress,  egress and access over, under,  across and upon
the Land.  Tenant shall be directly and  exclusively  responsible for monitoring
the  performance  of said  contractor.  In  consideration  of  Tenant  relieving
Landlord  of  responsibility  for  providing  landscaping  services to the Land,
Landlord  shall pay to Tenant  the sum of  Thirty-five  Thousand,  Five  Hundred
($35,500) Dollars per year (the "Landscaping Allowance") in monthly installments
in arrears of Two Thousand,  Nine Hundred and Fifty-eight  and 33/100's  Dollars
($2,958.33)  Dollars  each on the tenth (10th) day of each month  commencing  on
February 10, 1996. In addition,  to the extent that aggregate annual landscaping
costs  actually  incurred by Tenant exceed  Thirty-five  Thousand,  Five Hundred
($35,500) Dollars per year and Landlord is able, using due diligence, to recover
a portion of such excess landscaping costs directly  attributable to landscaping
services  performed  by Tenant  from other  tenants of the  Project  through the
pass-through of Operating Costs to such tenants,  Landlord shall pay the amounts
so recovered over to Tenant. Tenant shall render Landlord a monthly bill for the
installment of the Landscaping  Allowance due each month. The annualized amounts
paid by  Landlord  to Tenant on account  of the  Landscaping  Allowance  will be
included in Operating  Costs for the Base Year and each  subsequent  year during
the  Term.  Landlord  and  Tenant  acknowledge  and agree  that the  Landscaping
Allowance is intended to encompass the costs of maintenance  and  replacement of
grass (including annual replanting of winter lawns),  small plants and shrubs as
well as the cost of mowing,  trimming,  watering and prevention of soil erosion.
If, in order to maintain the  appearance  of the Project as a first class office
building in the Camelback corridor, it becomes necessary, for reasons other than
negligence  or  wilful  misconduct  of  Tenant  or its  agents,  contractors  or
employees,  to replace any large  shrubs,  trees or large patches of winter lawn
during any year  subsequent  to the Base Year,  then Tenant  shall  replace such
items at  Tenant's  expense,  but the costs  thereof  shall be  reported  to and
treated by Landlord as  additional  landscaping  expenses  included in Operating
Costs for such  year,  and  Landlord  shall  promptly  reimburse  Tenant for the
portion of such costs so incurred by Tenant which exceeds Tenant's Project Share
thereof  (whether  or not  Landlord  is able to recover  such  excess from other
tenants of the  Project  through the  pass-through  of  Operating  Costs to such
tenants). Tenant shall indemnify, defend and hold Landlord harmless with respect
to any  claims  or  causes  of  action  resulting  from  Tenant's  assuming  the
obligation  of  providing  said  landscape   services,   except  to  the  extent
proximately  caused by the  negligence  or wilful  misconduct of Landlord or its
agents,  servants,  contractors  or employees  acting  within the scope of their
authority or employment. In the event Tenant does not perform landscape services
consistent with  maintaining the Project as a first class office building in the
Camelback  corridor,  Landlord may takeover  responsibility  for furnishing said
services,  include any costs of  providing  said  services as part of  Operating
Costs,  and bill  Tenant for a portion of such costs to the extent  they  exceed
Thirty-five Thousand,  Five Hundred ($35,500) Dollars per year equal to Tenant's
Project Share. 
                                       2
<PAGE>
         5. Tenant  hereby  agrees that it shall be solely  responsible  for the
maintenance and repair of the landscaping  irrigation system at the Project.  In
consideration  therefor,  Landlord  hereby  grants to Tenant an allowance in the
amount of One  Thousand  ($1,000)  Dollars per  calendar  year (the  "Irrigation
Allowance")  toward the cost of irrigation  system  maintenance and repairs.  As
Tenant  incurs out of pocket costs and expenses in connection  with  maintenance
and repairs of said irrigation  system,  Tenant may submit to Landlord copies of
paid invoices  reflecting  the amounts  incurred by Tenant,  and Landlord  shall
reimburse  Tenant  for such costs and  expenses  within  thirty  (30) days after
receipt of Tenant's request for payment, the amount of such reimbursement in any
calendar  year  not to  exceed,  however,  the  Irrigation  Allowance.  All such
reimbursements  by Landlord shall be Operating  Costs pursuant to Section 3.2(C)
of the Lease.

         6.  (a)  Landlord  hereby  agrees  that  as  part  of its  Common  Area
maintenance  requirement  it shall perform the following  services at the Leased
Premises as provided in paragraph 6(b) through 6(e) below, all of which shall be
Operating Costs pursuant to Section 3.2(c)of the Lease.

         (b) Landlord shall wash the exterior of all windows (including the roof
windows)  three (3) times per year  pursuant  to a schedule  to be  provided  to
Tenant.  In addition,  Landlord  shall wash the exterior of the roof windows and
all other  windows a fourth  (4th) time during the year on a date  requested  by
Tenant upon not less than fifteen (15) business days written notice.

         (c)  Landlord  shall  power  wash the  entrances  to the  Building  and
exterior  balconies  three (3)  times  per year  pursuant  to a  schedule  to be
provided to Tenant. In addition,  Landlord shall power wash those areas a fourth
(4th) time  during  the year on a date  requested  by Tenant  upon not less than
fifteen (15) business days written notice.

         (d)  Landlord  shall  power  wash  the  granite  exterior  walls of the
Building  one (1) time per year on one (1) of the same  occasions  that it power
washes the entrances to the Building and exterior balconies.

         (e) Landlord shall power wash the garage floor three (3) times per year
pursuant to a schedule to be provided to Tenant.

         (f) Landlord shall paint all exterior metal and stucco  surfaces of the
Project as necessary to maintain and preserve the appearance of the Project as a
first class office building in the Camelback corridor.

         (g) To the  extent  that  the  frequency  of  services  to be  provided
pursuant to paragraph  6(b) and 6(d) exceeds the frequency of such  service,  if
any, provided in the Base Year, the imputed amount it would have cost to provide
those  services  more  frequently  in the Base Year shall be added to  Operating
Costs for the Base Year.

         7. Section 4.1(e) of the Lease shall be amended by adding the following
language at the end thereof:

                  "Landlord  shall also inspect the Common Area at the beginning
         of each Building Day for general cleanliness and cause any debris to be
         removed from said Common Areas and the costs therefor shall be included
         as an Operating Cost."

         8. Landlord and Tenant hereby agree that the  maintenance and repair of
elevators in the Building  serving the Tenant,  to include the  elevators  which
provides access to the garage,  shall be the  responsibility of Tenant who shall
bear the entire cost thereof.  Tenant shall maintain the elevators in accordance
with all applicable  state,  federal and local rules and  regulations.  For this
purpose,  Tenant may enter into a maintenance  and service  agreement  with U.S.
ELEVATOR, MONTGOMERY
                                        3
<PAGE>
ELEVATOR or OTIS  ELEVATOR,  and Landlord shall grant to Tenant and its elevator
service  contractor a  nonexclusive  right of ingress,  egress and access to the
Project.  The  provisions  of ARTICLE II,  Section 6 of Exhibit C-I to the Lease
pertaining  to the  filing  of  liens  are  herein  incorporated  and  shall  be
applicable  with  respect  to  any  maintenance  or  service  performed  on  the
elevators.

         9. Section 4.3 of the Lease shall be amended by adding the following at
the end thereof:

                  "Except as specifically set forth herein,  Landlord shall have
         no  obligation  to make any repairs,  including  but not limited to any
         equipment  to service  or  redistribute  Utility  Service to the Leased
         Premises.  However,  in the event Tenant  encounters a problem with any
         Utility Service which has been  redistributed  to the Leased  Premises,
         Landlord  shall use its best  efforts  to  determine  the source of the
         problem.  In the event the source of such  problem is outside the point
         of  redistribution  to the Leased  Premises,  Landlord  shall repair or
         cause the problem  with the Utility  Service to be repaired  (except to
         the extent the source of the  problem is located  within  interior  (as
         distinguished  from exterior) space currently  leased to another tenant
         that has not agreed to make such repairs or permit  Landlord  access to
         its space for the purpose of making such  repairs,  in which  situation
         Landlord  shall only be obliged to use best  efforts to repair or cause
         the problem to be repaired).  (Landlord represents to Tenant,  however,
         that none of the  equipment  or lines  required to  distribute  Utility
         service to the Lease  Premises  is located  within any  interior  space
         currently  leased to  another  tenant.)  In the event the source of the
         problem is at or beyond the point of redistribution to Tenant,  whether
         or not it is within the Leased  Premises,  Tenant shall be  responsible
         for such repairs.  For this purpose,  Landlord hereby grants Tenant and
         its contractors a nonexclusive  right of ingress,  egress and access to
         the Project  (but not to any interior  space  leased to another  tenant
         that has not agreed to make such repairs or permit  Landlord  access to
         its space for the purpose of making such  repairs),  and agrees to make
         its personnel  available in accordance  with provisions of paragraph 12
         of the First  Amendment of this Lease so that Tenant may coordinate its
         repairs with the proper operation of the Plant."

         10.  (a) Tenant  has  provided  Landlord  with a  punchlist  of alleged
deficiencies  which exist or existed in connection  with the  landscaping of the
Land  attached  hereto as Annex I.  Landlord  has denied the  existence  of such
deficiencies  or its  responsibility  with respect to same.  In order to resolve
said  dispute,  and without  acknowledging  the  existence of any  deficiencies,
Landlord  hereby agrees to pay the sum of Three Thousand  ($3,000)  Dollars upon
the signing of this  Amendment in full  satisfaction  of all claims of Tenant in
connection with landscaping of the Project. In exchange therefor,  Tenant agrees
to release  Landlord from all claims which Tenant may now have against  Landlord
and any  future  claims  with  respect to Project  landscaping  (other  than for
payment  of the  Landscaping  and  Irrigation  Allowances  or other  obligations
provided  for in  paragraphs  4 and 5 of this  Amendment).  Furthermore,  Tenant
agrees to cure all deficiencies noted on Annex I at its sole cost and expense.

         (b) In addition to those items  described  in  paragraph  10(a)  above,
Tenant has forwarded to Landlord certain letters identified on Annex II alleging
that other defects exist or existed at the Leased  Premises which Tenant alleges
were  Landlord's  obligation.  Landlord has denied the existence of such defects
and/or its  responsibility  with  respect to the same.  In order to resolve said
dispute, and without acknowledging the existence of any defects, Landlord hereby
agrees to pay the sum of Fifteen Thousand  ($15,000.00) Dollars upon the signing
of this  Amendment  in full  satisfaction  of all  claims of Tenant  related  to
defects  which exist or existed at the Leased  Premises.  In exchange  therefor,
Tenant  hereby  releases  Landlord  from any and all claims which Tenant may now
have  against  Landlord  and any and all claims  Tenant may have in the  future,
whether or not raised in the  letters  identified  on Annex II,  relating  to or
resulting from any defects which
                                        4
<PAGE>
exist or existed at the Leased  Premises.  Furthermore,  Tenant  agrees that any
defect  discovered  after the  signing of this  Amendment  shall be  repaired or
remedied  at the sole  cost and  expense  of  Tenant.  However,  Landlord  shall
continue  to be liable for  Capital  Repairs  specifically  assumed by  Landlord
pursuant to Section 4.3 of the Lease subject to the provisions set forth therein
with respect to repayment therefor.

         11. Tenant shall assume sole  responsibility  for the  maintenance  and
repair of all interior  landscaping,  including the pools and  extensions on the
east side of the exterior of the  Building,  in a manner  comparable  to that of
other first class office buildings in the Camelback corridor.  For this purpose,
Landlord shall grant Tenant and its contractors a nonexclusive right of ingress,
egress and access over, under,  across and upon the Land, and Landlord shall pay
to Tenant an allowance equal to Twelve Thousand  ($12,000) Dollars per year (the
"Pool Allowance") in equal monthly installments of One Thousand ($1,000) Dollars
per month  payable in arrears on the tenth  (10th) day of each month  commencing
February  10,  1996.  Tenant  shall  render  Landlord  a  monthly  bill  for the
installment of the Pool Allowance due each month. The annualized amounts paid by
Landlord  to  Tenant  on  account  of the Pool  Allowance  will be  included  in
Operating  Costs for the Base Year and each  subsequent  year  during  the Term.
Landlord  and  Tenant  acknowledge  that the pools  have had a  chronic  leakage
problem which has required  repeated minor  repairs;  and that the recurrence of
leaks will not  constitute a breach by Tenant of its  obligation to maintain and
repair the pools so long as Tenant promptly repairs, controls, mitigates, and/or
manages the leaks as and when they reoccur.

         12. Landlord hereby agrees to make its on-site  personnel  available to
Tenant for making  minor  repairs and  changing  light bulbs and ballasts to the
extent  said work is within  said  personnel's  expertise.  In the event  Tenant
utilizes such  services it shall pay to Landlord as  additional  Rent within ten
(10) days of receipt of a bill,  Landlord's cost plus ten (10%) percent for such
bulbs,  ballasts  and other  materials  plus the current  hourly rate charged by
Landlord  to  tenants  for use of its  personnel  computed  at the  hourly  cost
inclusive of benefits of operating said employee. Any payments so made allocable
for the  current  hourly  rate of  employees  whose  salary  is part of  Project
Operating Costs shall be a credit against  Project  Operating Costs in computing
Tenant's Project Share of such Project Operating Costs.

         13.  Wherever  the Lease shall  require the  consent of  Landlord,  the
following provisions shall apply.

         (a) Tenant shall  request  such written  consent of the Landlord in the
manner prescribed by Section 6.15 of the Lease.

         (b)  Landlord  shall have  twenty-five  (25) days from  receipt of such
notice to respond to such request.

         (c) In the event Landlord fails to respond within such twenty-five (25)
day  period,  Tenant  shall send a second copy of such notice to Landlord in the
manner prescribed by Section 6.15 of the Lease.

         (d)In the event  Landlord fails to respond to such second notice within
seven (7) days of receipt, Landlord shall be deemed to have given its consent.

         14.  Section  6.11(b)(i) and (ii) of the Lease shall be amended to read
as follows:

                  "(b) By Tenant.  The Tenant,  at its cost,  shall  provide and
         keep in force during the Term of the Lease the following insurance:

                           (i) A commercial general liability policy in standard
                  form  (containing the so-called  "occurrence  clause") against
                  claims for personal
                                        5
<PAGE>
                  injury  and  property  damage  occurring  on,  in or about the
                  Leased  Premises in the combined  single limit amount of Three
                  Million  ($3,000,000)  Dollars,  and  include  an  endorsement
                  naming  Landlord as an additional  insured with respect to its
                  vicarious  liability for Tenant's operation,  maintenance, use
                  and control of the Leased  Premises and Common Areas including
                  but not limited to the assigned and unassigned  Parking Areas.
                  The  commercial  general  liability  policy  shall be  primary
                  insurance  coverage  for  Landlord  with  respect to any other
                  insurance  Landlord  may have  available  for  such  vicarious
                  liability  and,  at  Tenant's   option,   may  provide  for  a
                  deductible   amount  or  for  a  retention   amount   under  a
                  self-insurance  program not  exceeding  Five Hundred  Thousand
                  ($500,000) Dollars per occurrence  provided Tenant's net worth
                  is and  continues to be at least equal to One Hundred  Million
                  ($100,000,000) Dollars.

                           (ii) The policy of insurance  shall be from a company
                  rated in the A.M. Best Key Rating Guide with a  policyholder's
                  service rating of A- and a financial  rating of X. The company
                  shall be  licensed  by the State of Arizona and a true copy of
                  the policy (or a  certificate  thereof)  shall be delivered to
                  the Landlord,  together with evidence of the payment of the 20
                  premiums  therefor,  not less than  fifteen (15) days prior to
                  the Commencement  Date of the Term. At least fifteen (15) days
                  prior to the expiration or termination date of any policy, the
                  Tenant shall deliver to Landlord a  certificate  issued by the
                  insurer confirming that the policy has been renewed."


         15. No credit,  allowance or payment of any kind  pursuant to the terms
of  this  Amendment  shall  reduce  Base  Rental,  Base  Rental  adjustments  or
additional  Rent for purposes of computing  the  management  fees under  Section
3.2(c)(iii)  of the Lease,  and any  payments  made by Tenant,  inclusive of any
Landlord  contribution,  for services  described  in  paragraphs 3 and 4 of this
First Amendment shall be considered for purposes of calculating  management fees
payable to Landlord. Any installment of the Janitorial,  Landscaping, Irrigation
and/or  Pool  Allowances  provided  for in this  Amendment  which is not paid by
Landlord  within three (3) days after written notice from Tenant to Landlord and
any  Designated  Parties  specified  in Section  7.7 of the Lease  shall  accrue
interest and be subject to  collection  by Tenant as provided and subject to the
limitations set forth in - the last two sentences of Section 7.7 of the Lease.

         16.  Landlord  agrees that Tenant shall have the right to construct and
maintain,  at Tenant's  sole cost and expense,  a covering over a portion of the
existing  parking  area on the eastern  side of the Project at the  location set
forth on Exhibit X attached  hereto and made a part hereof;  provided,  however,
that (i) that Tenant  complies with all applicable  governmental  ordinances and
regulations and receives all necessary governmental and ARIZONA BILTMORE ESTATES
VILLAGE  ASSOCIATION  ("ABEVA")  approvals  required  for the  construction  and
maintenance  of the  covering;  (ii) that the plans  and  specifications  of the
covering,  as well as the  contractors  to perform  said work,  are  approved in
advance and in writing by the Landlord;  and (iii) at the option of the Landlord
exercised by at least ninety (90) days prior  written  notice to Tenant,  at the
end of the Term Tenant shall, at its sole cost and expense,  remove the covering
and promptly repair all damage to the parking area caused by such removal,  said
repairs to be performed in a good and  workmanlike  manner,  in conformity  with
law, and in conformity with all applicable  provisions of this Lease,  such that
the  area  involved  be  restored  to  the  condition   existing  prior  to  the
construction of the covering,  reasonable wear and tear excepted.  Tenant agrees
that  Tenant  shall  be  responsible  for  paying  for:  (i)  the  costs  of all
electricity  consumed  within the covered  parking  area (now  existing or to be
constructed)  and (ii) the costs of installing and  maintaining the check meters
measuring the  consumption of  electricity,  including any necessary  electrical
wiring.
                                       6
<PAGE>
         Tenant agrees that, until the submeters are in place,  Tenant shall pay
for Tenant's  electrical  consumption  with the parking area as determined by an
independent  electrical  engineering consultant selected by the Landlord, but at
Tenant's  cost,  who shall  make a survey of the  electric  power  demand of the
electric  lighting  fixtures  and the  electric  equipment of Tenant used in the
covered  parking area  inclusive of an  allocation of the costs of operating the
plant to determine  the average  monthly  electric  consumption  thereof.  After
Landlord's  consultant  has submitted its report,  Tenant shall pay to Landlord,
within ten (10) days after demand therefor by Landlord, the amount determined by
said consultant as owing from the date that construction of the covering for the
parking area commenced, and the then expired months, to include the then current
month and thereafter,  on the first day of every month,  in advance,  the amount
set forth as the monthly  consumption  in said report until the  electric  check
meters are in the rate schedule (including surcharges or demand adjustments), of
the public  utility  servicing the area in which the Project is located,  or the
imposition  of any tax with  respect to such service or increase in any such tax
following the commencement of the construction of the parking area covering, the
payments due  hereunder  shall be adjusted  equitably to reflect the increase or
decrease  in  rate  or  imposition  or  increase  in  the  aforesaid   tax.  All
computations shall be made on the basis of Tenant's surveyed usage as if a meter
exclusively  measuring  such  usage to the  covered  parking  area was in place.
Tenant covenants that it shall notify Landlord immediately upon the introduction
of any equipment or lighting  different from that in the covered parking area as
of Landlord's  electrical  survey or in addition to the  aforesaid  equipment or
lighting in the covered parking area as of said survey.  The introduction of any
new or  different  equipment  or  lighting  shall be cause  for,  at  Landlord's
election,  a  resurveying  of the  covered  parking  area at  Tenant's  expense.
Landlord  reserves  the right to  inspect  the  covered  parking  area to insure
compliance with this provision.  Once the meters are in place,  Tenant shall pay
to  Landlord  the amount of  electricity  consumed as  determined  by said meter
calculated at the rate structure then existing of the utility company  supplying
electrical energy to the Project,  but adjusted to include an allocable share of
the costs of operating the plant. The aforesaid amounts payable to Landlord with
respect to electrical  consumption shall be treated as Additional Rent due under
the Lease.

         17.  In  accordance  with  Section  5.5 of the  Lease  and  subject  to
compliance with applicable ABEVA and governmental restrictions and requirements,
Tenant shall be permitted to install and maintain, at its sole cost and expense,
(a) a flagpole  to fly one or more flags and (b) one or more  exterior  signs to
identify the Building and Tenant's  occupancy  thereof,  all in accordance  with
plans and  specifications  listed on Annex III previously  submitted to Landlord
for approval, which approval is hereby granted.

         18.  Except  as  modified  by this  Amendment,  the  Lease  and all the
covenants,  agreements, terms, provisions and conditions thereof shall remain in
full force and  effect and are hereby  ratified  and  affirmed.  The  covenants,
agreements,  terms,  provisions and conditions contained in this Amendment shall
bind and  inure to the  benefit  of the  parties  hereto  and  their  respective
successors  and except as  otherwise  provided  in the Lease as modified by this
Amendment,  their respective  assigns.  In the event of any conflict between the
terms  contained in this  Amendment  and the Lease,  the terms herein  contained
shall supersede and control the obligations and liabilities of the parties.

         19. This Amendment shall not be binding upon Landlord's mortgage holder
until approved or consented to by such  mortgagee.  Promptly after the execution
and delivery of this Amendment,  Landlord shall seek and use reasonable  efforts
to obtain approval of and/or consent to this Amendment from its mortgage holder.
In the event such  approval  and/or  consent is denied or not obtained  within a
period of sixty (60) days after the date of this Amendment,  then this Amendment
will be subject to  cancellation  by either party by written notice to the other
party given within ninety (90) days after the date of this Amendment.
                                        7
<PAGE>
                                     Annex I
                                     -------

                           Landscape Punchlist Items
                           -------------------------


            1.        Arizona Biltmore Streetscape

                      - Add greater  variety  and  quantity of shrubs and ground
                        cover per original plan)

            2.        Building Entry

                      - Add 1/4" sized rock ground cover to planters, both sides
                      - Add annuals
                      - Add  Oleanders  and Indian  Hawthorn  Ballerinas at wall
                        location (per plan) 
                      - Add Indian  Hawthorn  Ballerinas to planter at northwest
                        (per plan)

            3.        Building Southeast Corner

                      - Install additional ground cover between walk and planter

            4.        Building South Side

                      - Add 1/4" sized rock ground cover
                      - Provide  drain  inlet and pipe  installation  to resolve
                        drainage issue

            5.        Building Southwest Corner

                      - Remove conduit and wire from planting bed

                      - Add natal plums at wing wall and by Building (per plan)

            6.        Building Northeast Corner

                      - Rework entire landscape to eliminate  erosion where rain
                        falls

            7.        Generally

                      -  Replace  all  substandard  size 1  gallon  and 5 gallon
                         plants
    
                                    Annex II
                                    --------

               List of Letters describing alleged Building Defects
               ---------------------------------------------------


                                    Annex III
                                    ---------

             List of Plans and Specifications for Flagpole and Signs
             -------------------------------------------------------

                                       9

                                                                    Exhibit 10.8

Key Executive Life Plan II


Number of Participants: 55

Total Initial Death Benefit: $12,875,000
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Amended and Restated - Key Executive Life Plan (KELP II)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

          THIS AGREEMENT, is made as of the day of _______________, 19__, by and
between  Del Webb  Corporation,  and its  successors  and  assigns,  of Phoenix,
Arizona, hereinafter called the Corporation, and __________________________

          WHEREAS, ___________________________, hereinafter called the Employee,
has rendered service to the Corporation, and,

          WHEREAS,  the  Corporation  wishes to provide a death  benefit for the
Employee  and/or the Employee's  designee  through a Key Executive Life Plan II,
and,

          WHEREAS, the Employee agrees to participate in such plan to the extent
hereinafter provided,

          NOW THEREFORE, it is mutually agreed that:

Insurance Policies                   1. In  furtherance  of the  purpose of this
                                     Agreement,   life   insurance   is   to  be
                                     purchased      on     the      life      of
                                     _____________________________   hereinafter
                                     called the Insured,  from  Security Life of
                                     Denver   Insurance   Company  under  Policy
                                     Number  ___________  hereinafter called the
                                     Policy.

Security                             2. As  security   for   the   Corporation's
                                     interest  in the Cash Value of the  Policy,
                                     the  Employee  shall  execute,  on  a  form
                                     acceptable  to  the  insurance  company,  a
                                     collateral assignment to the Corporation of
                                     certain  specified rights in the Policy, as
                                     set forth in Article 5.  Except as provided
                                     in Article  5,  ownership  of the  Policy's
                                     rights,  including  but not  limited to the
                                     right to name the  beneficiary,  shall rest
                                     with the Employee.

Premiums                             3. All  premiums due on the Policy shall be
                                     paid  by  the  Corporation.   However,  the
                                     Employee  shall  reimburse the  Corporation
                                     each year in an amount that is equal to the
                                     value,   as  determined   for  federal  tax
                                     purposes, of the "economic benefit" derived
                                     by the  Employee  from  the  Policy's  life
                                     insurance  protection.  The  Employee  will
                                     receive  Compensation in addition to annual
                                     salary each year in an amount equal to this
                                     reimbursement.

                                        1
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Amended and Restated - Key Executive Life Plan (KELP II)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

Termination                          4.   This   Agreement   shall   immediately
                                     terminate for any of the following reasons:
                                     termination  of the  Employee's  employment
                                     for  any  reason;   submission  of  written
                                     notice to terminate by either party to this
                                     Agreement to the other party;  the death of
                                     the   Insured;   or  any   action   by  the
                                     Corporation which would impair,  reduce, or
                                     defeat  the  Employee's   interest  in  the
                                     Policy.  Such  action  by  the  Corporation
                                     might   include   but  is  not  limited  to
                                     surrender   or  lapse  of  the  Policy  for
                                     nonpayment of premiums.

                                         If  this  Agreement   terminates,   the
                                     Employee shall have the right,  exercisable
                                     within 90 days,  to obtain a release of the
                                     Corporation's  interest  in the  Policy  by
                                     paying to the  Corporation  its interest in
                                     the Policy as  determined  in Article 6(2).
                                     Upon   receipt   of   such   amount,    the
                                     Corporation   shall  either   transfer  the
                                     Policy to the  Employee  or  transfer  such
                                     interest  to the  party  designated  by the
                                     Employee. The Corporation agrees to execute
                                     all  documents  necessary  to transfer  the
                                     Policy to the Employee or his/her  assigns.
                                     If the  Employee  does not timely  exercise
                                     this right,  the  Corporation  may exercise
                                     its rights under Article 5.

Corporation's Rights                 5.  Under  the  terms  of  the   collateral
                                     assignment of the Policy,  the  Corporation
                                     shall have the following rights:  the right
                                     to  receive,   upon   termination  of  this
                                     Agreement,   an   amount   equal   to   the
                                     Corporation's interest in the Policy's Cash
                                     Value,  as determined  in  accordance  with
                                     Articles  6(1)  and  6(2);   the  right  to
                                     release  the  collateral  assignment;   the
                                     right to surrender  or partially  surrender
                                     the  Policy  upon  the  giving  of 14  days
                                     advance written notice of the Corporation's
                                     exercise  of its  right  to  surrender  the
                                     Policy;  and the right to make and  receive
                                     loans  against  the Policy to the extent of
                                     its interest as defined in Article 6(4).

                                         Any rights to Policy values or proceeds
                                     in  excess  of the  Corporation's  interest
                                     shall  be owned by and  payable  to,  or as
                                     designated by, the Employee.

                                        2
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Amended and Restated - Key Executive Life Plan (KELP II)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

                                         Any    designation    or    change   of
                                     beneficiary   or  change  in   election  of
                                     settlement  options or  exercise  of policy
                                     rights   shall  be  made  subject  to  this
                                     Agreement  and  the  Corporation's   rights
                                     hereunder.

                                         Policy rights shall be  exercisable  by
                                     the  sole  signature  of a duly  authorized
                                     representative of the Corporation.

                                         The Corporation  agrees to refrain from
                                     making loans or partial  surrenders against
                                     the  Policy in an amount  greater  than its
                                     interest  under the  Policy as  defined  in
                                     Article   6(4).   The  parties  agree  that
                                     Security Life of Denver  Insurance  Company
                                     is     authorized    to    recognize    the
                                     Corporation's  right to borrow  without the
                                     insurance company being responsible for the
                                     calculation  of  amounts  permitted  to  be
                                     borrowed and without  investigation  of the
                                     validity  or amount of the  request  by the
                                     Corporation  to borrow.  The sole signature
                                     of a duly authorized  representative of the
                                     Corporation  shall  be  sufficient  for the
                                     exercise  of  the  Corporation's  right  to
                                     borrow  and shall be a full  discharge  and
                                     release   to   Security   Life  of   Denver
                                     Insurance  Company.  The Employee shall not
                                     have the right to make a loan  against  the
                                     Policy  or  otherwise  have  access to cash
                                     values  unless  and until  such time as the
                                     Employee's  employment is terminated or the
                                     Corporation's   interest   in  the   Policy
                                     terminates   in   accordance    with   this
                                     Agreement.

Corporation's Interest               6. For  purposes  of  Articles 4 and 5, the
                                     amount  receivable by the Corporation  upon
                                     (1) death of the Insured,  (2)  termination
                                     of this  Agreement  for  reason  other than
                                     death  of the  Insured,  (3)  surrender  or
                                     partial  surrender  of the  Policy,  or (4)
                                     exercise   of  the   loan   right   by  the
                                     Corporation shall be as follows:

                                        3
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Amended and Restated - Key Executive Life Plan (KELP II)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

                                         (1)Upon  termination  of this Agreement
                                     resulting  from death of the  Insured,  the
                                     Corporation's  share of the Policy's  death
                                     proceed  shall  be an  amount  equal to its
                                     Aggregate  Premiums  paid,  as  defined  in
                                     Article 6(5),  plus any death proceeds paid
                                     under the  Policy  that  exceed  the amount
                                     payable to the Insured's named  beneficiary
                                     based  on the  current  schedule  of  Death
                                     Benefits   as  set  forth  on   Appendix  A
                                     attached to this Agreement.

                                         (2)Upon  termination  of this Agreement
                                     for  reasons  other  than the  death of the
                                     Insured,  the  Corporation's  share  of the
                                     Policy's  Cash  Value  shall  be an  amount
                                     equal to its Aggregate  Premiums  paid. The
                                     excess,  if any, of the Policy's Cash Value
                                     shall be paid to the Employee.

                                         (3)Upon the Corporation's  surrender or
                                     partial   surrender   of  the   Policy   in
                                     accordance     with    Article    5,    the
                                     Corporation's  share of the  Policy's  Cash
                                     Value  shall  be an  amount  equal  to  its
                                     Aggregate  Premiums  paid.  The excess,  if
                                     any,  of the  Policy's  Cash Value shall be
                                     paid to the Employee.

                                         (4)If the Corporation obtains any loans
                                     against the Policy, the amount of the loans
                                     together with the interest thereon shall at
                                     no time exceed the Aggregate Premiums paid.

                                         (5)"Aggregate  Premiums" shall mean all
                                     premiums paid by the Corporation, including
                                     premiums paid for any extra benefit  riders
                                     or  agreements  issued under the Policy and
                                     shall be  reduced by any  indebtedness  and
                                     any accrued unpaid interest incurred by the
                                     Corporation on the Policy and the amount of
                                     any  Policy  dividends  used to  reduce  or
                                     offset such  premiums.  "Cash  Value" shall
                                     mean  the  guaranteed  cash  value  of  the
                                     Policy, plus the cash value of any dividend
                                     additions as of the date to which  premiums
                                     have  been  paid and any  dividend  credits
                                     outstanding,    and    reduced    by    any
                                     indebtedness   and   any   accrued   unpaid
                                     interest incurred by the Corporation on the
                                     Policy.

                                        4
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Amended and Restated - Key Executive Life Plan (KELP II)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

Application for Additional           7.  Should the  parties  to this  Agreement
Agreements or Riders                 deem it desirable,  application may be made
                                     for  a  supplemental   agreement  or  rider
                                     providing for the waiver of Policy premiums
                                     in  the  event  of  the   Insured's   total
                                     disability.    Any    additional    premium
                                     attributable  to such  agreement  or  rider
                                     shall  be paid by the  Corporation.  Waived
                                     premiums  shall not be  treated  as paid by
                                     the Corporation.

Named Fiduciary                      8. For purposes of the Employee  Retirement
                                     Income    Security   Act   of   1974,   the
                                     Corporation is the "named fiduciary" of the
                                     Key  Executive  Life  Plan for  which  this
                                     Agreement is hereby  designated the written
                                     plan instrument.

Claims and Review                    9. At the Insured's  death, the Corporation
Procedure                            and the  beneficiary  designated to receive
                                     proceeds   shall  execute  such  forms  and
                                     furnish such other documents or information
                                     as are  required to receive  payment  under
                                     the  Policy.  The  Corporation  shall  also
                                     furnish   to   Security   Life  of   Denver
                                     Insurance  Company an affidavit  specifying
                                     the amount of death proceeds payable to the
                                     Corporation as defined in Article 6(1).

                                         With  respect  to  claims  against  the
                                     Corporation  arising under this  Agreement,
                                     the following procedure shall be used:

                                         The  claimant  shall  file a claim  for
                                     benefits by notifying  the  Corporation  in
                                     writing.   If  the   claim  is   wholly  or
                                     partially  denied,  the  Corporation  shall
                                     provide  a  written  notice  within 90 days
                                     specifying  the reason for the denial,  the
                                     provisions  of this  Agreement on which the
                                     denial is based and additional  material or
                                     information  necessary to receive benefits,
                                     if any.  Also,  such  written  notice shall
                                     indicate  the steps to be taken if a review
                                     of the denial is desired.

                                        5
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Amended and Restated - Key Executive Life Plan (KELP II)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

                                         If a claim is  denied  and a review  is
                                     desired,  the  claimant  shall  notify  the
                                     Corporation in writing within 60 days after
                                     receipt  of  written  notice of a denial of
                                     claim. In requesting a review, the claimant
                                     may review  plan  documents  and submit any
                                     written  issues and  comments  he/she feels
                                     are appropriate. The Corporation shall then
                                     review  the  claim  and  provide  a written
                                     decision  within  60 days of  receipt  of a
                                     request for a review.  This decision  shall
                                     state the specific reasons for the decision
                                     and shall  include  references  to specific
                                     provisions on which the decision is based.

                                     The  Corporation's   liability  under  this
                                     Agreement  shall not  exceed  the amount of
                                     proceeds it has received from the insurance
                                     company.

Payment of Proceeds                  10.  In lieu of the  lump  sum  payable  at
                                     Insured's   death,  the  Employee  may,  in
                                     accordance   with  the  procedures  of  the
                                     insurance   company,   elect   any  of  the
                                     optional  modes of  payment  for the  death
                                     proceeds  as  enumerated  in the Policy and
                                     known as "settlement  options" with respect
                                     to  the  portion  of  the  Policy's   death
                                     proceeds   that   become   payable  to  the
                                     beneficiary.  If  no  such  election  is in
                                     effect   at  the   Insured's   death,   the
                                     beneficiary  shall  have the right to elect
                                     such  settlement  options.  The Corporation
                                     shall  have a  similar  right  to  elect  a
                                     settlement    option   for   the   proceeds
                                     attributable to its interest in the Policy.

Amendment/Assignment                 11. This Agreement may be altered, amended,
                                     or modified,  including the addition of any
                                     extra  Policy  provisions,   by  a  written
                                     agreement  signed  by the  parties  to this
                                     Agreement.  In  addition,  either party may
                                     assign   his/her   rights,   interests  and
                                     obligations under this Agreement,  provided
                                     however,  that any assignment shall be made
                                     subject to the terms of this Agreement.

                                        6
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Amended and Restated - Key Executive Life Plan (KELP II)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

Interpretation                       12. Where  appropriate  in this  Agreement,
                                     words used in the  singular  shall  include
                                     the plural and words used in the  masculine
                                     shall include the feminine and  vice-versa.
                                     Headings    and    subheadings    are   for
                                     convenience   purposes  only  and  have  no
                                     effect   on   the   construction   of   the
                                     Agreement.  The internal  laws of the State
                                     of Arizona shall govern this Agreement.




          IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the parties  hereto have executed this Agreement
the day and year First hereinabove written.


                                                   -----------------------------
                                                   (Assignor)

                                                   -----------------------------
                                                   (Corporation)


- ---------------------------                        -----------------------------
(Witness)                                          (By)

                                        7
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan II
Split-Dollar Collateral Assignment - Equity Method

================================================================================

- -----------------------------                     ------------------------------
Policy Number                                     Insured

Both copies of this Assignment should be forwarded to the Home Office.  One copy
will be retained by the Company (hereafter called the Insurer) which is Security
Life of Denver Insurance Company.

The  undersigned  owner/applicant  of  the  policy  to  be  issued  pursuant  to
application  Part I  number  _____________  and  dated  ___________________  for
insurance  on the life of the  insured  named  above  authorizes  the Insurer to
insert the policy number in this Assignment after said policy is issued.

                                 -----------------------------------------------
                                 Owner/Applicant

ASSIGNOR________________________________________________________________________
ASSIGNEE:          Del Webb Corporation
                   2231 East Camelback Road, Suite 400
                   Phoenix, Arizona 85016

FOR VALUE  RECEIVED,  the  undersigned  owner  (hereafter  called the  assignor)
assigns,  transfers  and sets over to the assignee,  its  successors or assigns,
certain rights in the policy numbered above,  including any and all supplemental
extra benefit riders or agreements issued under said policy,  subject to all the
terms and  conditions  of the policy  and this  Assignment  and to all  superior
liens,  if any,  which the Insurer or any prior  assignee  may have against this
policy.  The assignor by this  instrument and the assignee by acceptance of this
Assignment  jointly and severally agree to the conditions and provisions  herein
set forth.  This  Assignment  is made and the policy is to be held as collateral
security for any and all liabilities of the assignor to the assignee, either now
existing or that may hereafter  arise between the assignor or any  successors or
assigns and the assignee in  conjunction  with a Split-Dollar  arrangement  with
regard to this policy.

1.(a)    It is  expressly  agreed  that the  assignee  shall have the  following
         rights:

    (1)  the right to make and receive loans against the policy to the extent of
         aggregate premiums paid by the assignee;


    (2)  the  right to  release  this  Assignment  to the  assignor  or  his/her
         assigns;


    (3)  the right,  upon 14 days  advance  written  notice to the  Insured,  to
         surrender  or  partially  surrender  the policy and to receive the cash
         values  and any  dividend  credits  outstanding  (but not in  excess of
         Aggregate Premiums (as defined below) paid by the assignee); and


    (4)  the right to receive  from the death  proceeds,  and to elect an income
         settlement  option  with  respect  thereto,  an  amount  equal  to  the
         aggregate premiums paid by the assignee until the date of the insured's
         death  plus any death  proceeds  paid by the  Insurer  pursuant  to the
         application  numbered  above,  that  exceed the  amount  payable to the
         Insured's  named  beneficiary  based on the schedule of Death  Benefits
         attached (see Appendix A).

                                       1
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan II
Split-Dollar Collateral Assignment - Equity Method

================================================================================

     (b)  Assignor shall not have the right to make a loan against the policy or
          otherwise have access to cash values unless and until such time as the
          Assignor's  employment is terminated or the Assignor's interest in the
          Policy  terminates.  Except as modified by paragraph  1(a),  all other
          rights  in the  policy,  including  but not  limited  to the  right to
          designate and change the beneficiary and the right to receive any cash
          values  and  dividend  credits  outstanding  in  excess  of  aggregate
          premiums  paid by the  assignee,  are  reserved  to the  assignor  and
          excluded from this Assignment.

     (c)  Notwithstanding   any  other  provision  of  this  Assignment  or  the
          Split-Dollar  Life Insurance  Agreement  entered into between assignor
          and  assignee,  for all  purposes,  the assignee  shall furnish to the
          insurer an  affidavit  specifying  the  amount(s)  to be paid,  or the
          rights to be  exercised,  by each  party.  Both the  assignor  and the
          assignee  acknowledge that, between themselves,  they are bound by the
          limitations  of  the  Assignment.   The  Insurer  will  recognize  the
          signature of the assignee and the insurer is  authorized  to recognize
          the  assignee's  claims to rights granted by this  Assignment  without
          investigating the reason for any action taken by the assignee,  or the
          validity  or the amount of any  liabilities  or the  existence  of any
          default  therein.  Payment by the Insurer of the sums set forth in the
          affidavit  shall  be a full  discharge  and  release  therefor  to the
          Insurer.

          This  assignment  does not impede or change the Insurer's  right under
          the "Policy Loan"  provision to charge interest on any policy loan. If
          interest  is not paid under the terms of the  policy,  the Insurer has
          the right to add such  interest to the unpaid loan from  whatever cash
          value  remains  regardless of who owns that cash value under the terms
          of the Assignment.

     2.   Aggregate premiums paid by the assignee shall include premiums for any
          extra  benefit   riders  or  agreements   issued  under  this  policy.
          "Aggregate  Premiums" shall mean all premiums paid by the Corporation,
          including  premiums  paid for any extra  benefit  riders or agreements
          issued under the Policy and shall be reduced by any  indebtedness  and
          any accrued unpaid interest  incurred by the Corporation on the Policy
          and the amount of any Policy  dividends  used to reduce or offset such
          premiums.

     3.   Any death  proceeds  in excess of the amount  payable to the  assignee
          shall  be paid by the  Insurer  to the  beneficiary  named  under  the
          policy.

     4.   All  provisions  of this  Assignment  are binding upon the  executors,
          administrators, successors or assigns of the assignor.

     5.   All  options  and  designations  in  effect  as of the  date  of  this
          Assignment shall remain in effect unless specifically  changed by this
          Assignment  or  by  action  taken   thereafter   consistent  with  the
          Assignment.

     6.   The Insurer shall not be responsible  for the  sufficiency or validity
          of this  Assignment and Il not a party to any  split-dollar  agreement
          (or  any  other  similar  agreement)  between  the  assignee  and  the
          assignor.


Signed at____________________________________ on________________________________
                (City and State)                           (Date)

                          SIGN ORIGINAL AND DUPLICATE


- ------------------------------                 ---------------------------------
Witness Signature                              Signature of Owner of Policy



                                        2

                                                                    Exhibit 10.9

Key Executive Life Plan I


Number of Participants: 55

Total Initial Death Benefit: $12,875,OOO
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Amended and Restated - Key Executive Life Plan (KELP)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

         THIS AGREEMENT,  is made as of the _____ day of _______________,  l9__,
by and between Del Webb Corporation, and its successors and assigns, of Phoenix,
Arizona, hereinafter called the Corporation, and ___________________________

         WHEREAS,  _________________________,  hereinafter  called the Employee,
has rendered service to the Corporation, and,

         WHEREAS,  the  Corporation  wishes to provide a death  benefit  for the
Employee and/or the Employee's designee through a Key Executive Life Plan, and,

         WHEREAS,  the Employee agrees to participate in such plan to the extent
hereinafter provided,

         NOW THEREFORE, it is mutually agreed that:

Insurance Policies                  1. In  furtherance  of the  purpose  of this
                                    Agreement, life insurance is to be purchased
                                    on the life of _____________________________
                                    hereinafter   called   the   Insured,   from
                                    Security  Life of Denver  Insurance  Company
                                    under Policy Number  __________  hereinafter
                                    called the Policy.

Security                            2. As   security   for   the   Corporation's
                                    interest  in the Cash  Value of the  Policy,
                                    the  Employee  shall  execute,   on  a  form
                                    acceptable  to  the  insurance   company,  a
                                    collateral  assignment to the Corporation of
                                    certain  specified rights in the Policy,  as
                                    set forth in Article 5.  Except as  provided
                                    in  Article  5,  ownership  of the  Policy's
                                    rights,  including  but not  limited  to the
                                    right to name the  beneficiary,  shall  rest
                                    with the Employee.

Premiums                            3. All  premiums  due on the Policy shall be
                                    paid  by  the  Corporation.   However,   the
                                    Employee  shall  reimburse  the  Corporation
                                    each year in an amount  that is equal to the
                                    value,   as   determined   for  federal  tax
                                    purposes,  of the 'economic benefit" derived
                                    by  the  Employee  from  the  Policy's  life
                                    insurance  protection.   The  Employee  will
                                    receive  Compensation  in addition to annual
                                    salary each year in an amount  equal to this
                                    reimbursement.

                                        1
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Amended and Restated - Key Executive Life Plan (KELP)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

Termination                         4.   This   Agreement   shall    immediately
                                    terminate for any of the following  reasons:
                                    termination of the Employee's employment for
                                    any reason;  submission of written notice to
                                    terminate by either party to this  Agreement
                                    to  the  other  party;   the  death  of  the
                                    Insured;  or any  action by the  Corporation
                                    which would  impair,  reduce,  or defeat the
                                    Employee's  interest  in  the  Policy.  Such
                                    action by the Corporation  might include but
                                    is not limited to  surrender or lapse of the
                                    Policy for nonpayment of premiums.

                                         If  this  Agreement   terminates,   the
                                    Employee  shall have the right,  exercisable
                                    within 90 days,  to obtain a release  of the
                                    Corporation's  interest  in  the  Policy  by
                                    paying to the  Corporation  its  interest in
                                    the Policy as  determined  in Article  6(2).
                                    Upon receipt of such amount, the Corporation
                                    shall  either  transfer  the  Policy  to the
                                    Employee  or transfer  such  interest to the
                                    party   designated  by  the  Employee.   The
                                    Corporation  agrees to execute all documents
                                    necessary  to  transfer  the  Policy  to the
                                    Employee or his/her assigns. If the Employee
                                    does not timely  exercise  this  right,  the
                                    Corporation  may  exercise  its rights under
                                    Article 5.

Corporation's Rights                5.   Under  the  terms  of  the   collateral
                                    assignment  of the Policy,  the  Corporation
                                    shall have the following  rights:  the right
                                    to  receive,   upon   termination   of  this
                                    Agreement,    an   amount   equal   to   the
                                    Corporation's  interest in the Policy's Cash
                                    Value,  as  determined  in  accordance  with
                                    Articles 6(1) and 6(2); the right to release
                                    the  collateral  assignment;  the  right  to
                                    surrender or partially  surrender the Policy
                                    upon the giving of 14 days  advance  written
                                    notice of the Corporation's  exercise of its
                                    right to surrender the Policy; and the right
                                    to make and receive loans against the Policy
                                    to the extent of its  interest as defined in
                                    Article 6(4).

                                         Any rights to Policy values or proceeds
                                    in  excess  of  the  Corporation's  interest
                                    shall  be  owned by and  payable  to,  or as
                                    designated by, the Employee.

                                        2
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Amended and Restated - Key Executive Life Plan (KELP)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

                                         Any    designation    or    change   of
                                    beneficiary   or  change  in   election   of
                                    settlement  options  or  exercise  of policy
                                    rights   shall  be  made   subject  to  this
                                    Agreement  and  the   Corporation's   rights
                                    hereunder.

                                         Policy rights shall be  exercisable  by
                                    the  sole  signature  of a  duly  authorized
                                    representative of the Corporation.

                                         The Corporation  agrees to refrain from
                                    making loans or partial  surrenders  against
                                    the  Policy  in an amount  greater  than its
                                    interest  under  the  Policy as  defined  in
                                    Article   6(4).   The  parties   agree  that
                                    Security Life of Denver Insurance Company is
                                    authorized  to recognize  the  Corporation's
                                    right  to  borrow   without  the   insurance
                                    company    being    responsible    for   the
                                    calculation  of  amounts   permitted  to  be
                                    borrowed  and without  investigation  of the
                                    validity  or  amount of the  request  by the
                                    Corporation to borrow. The sole signature of
                                    a  duly  authorized  representative  of  the
                                    Corporation  shall  be  sufficient  for  the
                                    exercise  of  the  Corporation's   right  to
                                    borrow  and  shall be a full  discharge  and
                                    release to Security Life of Denver Insurance
                                    Company.  The  Employee  shall  not have the
                                    right to make a loan  against  the Policy or
                                    otherwise  have access to cash values unless
                                    and  until  such  time  as  the   Employee's
                                    employment     is    terminated    or    the
                                    Corporation's   interest   in   the   Policy
                                    terminates   in    accordance    with   this
                                    Agreement.

Corporation's Interest              6. For  purposes  of  Articles  4 and 5, the
                                    amount  receivable by the  Corporation  upon
                                    (1) death of the Insured, (2) termination of
                                    this  Agreement  for reason other than death
                                    of the  Insured,  (3)  surrender  or partial
                                    surrender of the Policy,  or (4) exercise of
                                    the loan right by the  Corporation  shall be
                                    as follows:

                                        3
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Amended and Restated - Key Executive Life Plan (KELP)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

                                         (1)Upon  termination  of this Agreement
                                    resulting  from  death of the  Insured,  the
                                    Corporation's.  share of the Policy's  death
                                    proceed  shall  be an  amount  equal  to its
                                    Aggregate   Premiums  paid,  as  defined  in
                                    Article 6(5),  plus any death  proceeds paid
                                    under the  Policy  that  exceed  the  amount
                                    payable to the Insured's  named  beneficiary
                                    based  on  the  current  schedule  of  Death
                                    Benefits as set forth on Appendix A attached
                                    to this Agreement.

                                         (2)Upon  termination  of this Agreement
                                    for  reasons  other  than  the  death of the
                                    Insured,  the  Corporation's  share  of  the
                                    Policy's Cash Value shall be an amount equal
                                    to its Aggregate  Premiums paid. The excess,
                                    if any, of the Policy's  Cash Value shall be
                                    paid to the Employee.

                                         (3)Upon the Corporation's  surrender or
                                    partial   surrender   of   the   Policy   in
                                    accordance with Article 5, the Corporation's
                                    share of the Policy's Cash Value shall be an
                                    amount equal to its Aggregate Premiums paid.
                                    The  excess,  if any, of the  Policy's  Cash
                                    Value shall be paid to the Employee.

                                         (4)If the Corporation obtains any loans
                                    against the Policy,  the amount of the loans
                                    together with the interest  thereon shall at
                                    no time exceed the Aggregate Premiums paid.

                                         (5) "Aggregate Premiums" shall mean all
                                    premiums paid by the Corporation,  including
                                    premiums paid for any extra  benefit  riders
                                    or  agreements  issued  under the Policy and
                                    shall be reduced by any indebtedness and any
                                    accrued  unpaid  interest  incurred  by  the
                                    Corporation  on the Policy and the amount of
                                    any  Policy  dividends  used  to  reduce  or
                                    offset such  premiums.  "Cash  Value"  shall
                                    mean  the  guaranteed   cash  value  of  the
                                    Policy,  plus the cash value of any dividend
                                    additions  as of the date to which  premiums
                                    have  been  paid  and any  dividend  credits
                                    outstanding, and reduced by any indebtedness
                                    and any accrued unpaid interest  incurred by
                                    the Corporation on the Policy.

                                        4
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Amended and Restated - Key Executive Life Plan (KELP)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

Application for Additional          7. Should the parties to this Agreement deem
Agreements or Riders                it desirable,  application may be made for a
                                    supplemental  agreement  or rider  providing
                                    for the  waiver  of Policy  premiums  in the
                                    event of the Insured's total disability. Any
                                    additional  premium   attributable  to  such
                                    agreement  or  rider  shall  be  paid by the
                                    Corporation.  Waived  premiums  shall not be
                                    treated as paid by the Corporation.

Named Fiduciary                     8. For purposes of the  Employee  Retirement
                                    Income Security Act of 1974, the Corporation
                                    is  the   "named   fiduciary"   of  the  Key
                                    Executive Life Plan for which this Agreement
                                    is  hereby   designated   the  written  plan
                                    instrument.

Claims and Review                   9. At the Insured's  death,  the Corporation
Procedure                           and the  beneficiary  designated  to receive
                                    proceeds   shall   execute  such  forms  and
                                    furnish such other  documents or information
                                    as are required to receive payment under the
                                    Policy.  The Corporation  shall also furnish
                                    to Security Life of Denver Insurance Company
                                    an affidavit  specifying the amount of death
                                    proceeds   payable  to  the  Corporation  as
                                    defined in Article 6(1).

                                         With  respect  to  claims  against  the
                                    Corporation  arising  under this  Agreement,
                                    the following procedure shall be used:

                                         The  claimant  shall  file a claim  for
                                    benefits by  notifying  the  Corporation  in
                                    writing. If the claim is wholly or partially
                                    denied,  the  Corporation  shall  provide  a
                                    written notice within 90 days specifying the
                                    reason for the  denial,  the  provisions  of
                                    this  Agreement on which the denial is based
                                    and   additional   material  or  information
                                    necessary to receive benefits, if any. Also,
                                    such written notice shall indicate the steps
                                    to be  taken if a review  of the  denial  is
                                    desired.

                                        5
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Amended and Restated - Key Executive Life Plan (KELP)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

                                         If a claim is  denied  and a review  is
                                    desired,   the  claimant  shall  notify  the
                                    Corporation  in writing within 60 days after
                                    receipt  of  written  notice  of a denial of
                                    claim. In requesting a review,  the claimant
                                    may  review  plan  documents  and submit any
                                    written issues and comments he/she feels are
                                    appropriate.   The  Corporation  shall  then
                                    review  the  claim  and  provide  a  written
                                    decision  within  60  days of  receipt  of a
                                    request for a review.  This  decision  shall
                                    state the specific  reasons for the decision
                                    and shall  include  references  to  specific
                                    provisions on which the decision is based.

                                    The   Corporation's   liability  under  this
                                    Agreement  shall not  exceed  the  amount of
                                    proceeds it has received  from the insurance
                                    company.

Payment of Proceeds                 10. In  lieu  of the  lump  sum  payable  at
                                    Insured's   death,   the  Employee  may,  in
                                    accordance   with  the   procedures  of  the
                                    insurance company, elect any of the optional
                                    modes of payment  for the death  proceeds as
                                    enumerated   in  the  Policy  and  known  as
                                    "settlement  options"  with  respect  to the
                                    portion of the Policy's  death proceeds that
                                    become  payable  to the  beneficiary.  If no
                                    such  election is in effect at the Insured's
                                    death, the beneficiary  shall have the right
                                    to  elect  such  settlement   options.   The
                                    Corporation  shall  have a similar  right to
                                    elect a  settlement  option for the proceeds
                                    attributable to its interest in the Policy.

Amendment/Assignment                11. This Agreement may be altered,  amended,
                                    or modified,  including  the addition of any
                                    extra  Policy   provisions,   by  a  written
                                    agreement  signed  by the  parties  to  this
                                    Agreement.  In  addition,  either  party may
                                    assign   his/her   rights,   interests   and
                                    obligations  under this Agreement,  provided
                                    however,  that any assignment  shall be made
                                    subject to the terms of this Agreement.

                                        6
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Amended and Restated - Key Executive Life Plan (KELP)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

Interpretation                      12.  Where  appropriate  in this  Agreement,
                                    words used in the singular shall include the
                                    plural and words used in the masculine shall
                                    include   the   feminine   and   vice-versa.
                                    Headings and subheadings are for convenience
                                    purposes  only  and  have no  effect  on the
                                    construction of the Agreement.  The internal
                                    laws of the State of  Arizona  shall  govern
                                    this Agreement.




         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Agreement the
day and year first hereinabove written.


                                             -----------------------------------
                                             (Assignor)


                                              ----------------------------------
                                              (Corporation)


- ---------------------------                   ----------------------------------
(Witness)                                     (By)

                                        7
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan
Split-Dollar Collateral Assignment - Equity Method

================================================================================

- ---------------------------                   ----------------------------------
Policy Number                                                  Insured

Both copies of this Assignment should be forwarded to the Home Office.  One copy
will be retained by the Company (hereafter called the Insurer) which is Security
Life of Denver Insurance Company.

The  undersigned  owner/applicant  of  the  policy  to  be  issued  pursuant  to
application  Part I  number  _____________  and  dated  ___________________  for
insurance  on the life of the  insured  named  above  authorizes  the Insurer to
insert the policy number in this Assignment after said policy is issued.

                                           ------------------------------------
                                           Owner/Applicant
ASSIGNOR________________________________________________________________________
ASSIGNEE:         Del Webb Corporation
                  2231 East Camelback Road, Suite 400
                  Phoenix, Arizona 85016

FOR VALUE  RECEIVED,  the  undersigned  owner  (hereafter  called the  assignor)
assigns,  transfers  and sets over to the assignee,  its  successors or assigns,
certain rights in the policy numbered above,  including any and all supplemental
extra benefit riders or agreements issued under said policy,  subject to all the
terms and  conditions  of the policy  and this  Assignment  and to all  superior
liens,  if any,  which the Insurer or any prior  assignee  may have against this
policy.  The assignor by this  instrument and the assignee by acceptance of this
Assignment  jointly and severally agree to the conditions and provisions  herein
set forth.  This  Assignment  is made and the policy is to he held as collateral
security for any and all liabilities of the assignor to the assignee, either now
existing or that may hereafter  arise between the assignor or any  successors or
assigns and the assignee in  conjunction  with a Split-Dollar  arrangement  with
regard to this policy.

1. (a)   It  is  expressly  agreed  that  the  assignee shall have the following
         rights:

     (1) the right to make and receive loans against the policy to the extent of
         aggregate premiums paid by the assignee;

     (2) the  right to  release  this  Assignment  to the  assignor  or  his/her
         assigns;

     (3) the right,  upon 14 days  advance  written  notice to the  Insured,  to
         surrender  or  partially  surrender  the policy and to receive the cash
         values  and any  dividend  credits  outstanding  (but not in  excess of
         Aggregate Premiums (as defined below) paid by the assignee); and

     (4) the right to receive  from the death  proceeds,  and to elect an income
         settlement  option  with  respect  thereto,  an  amount  equal  to  the
         aggregate premiums paid by the assignee until the date of the insured's
         death  plus any death  proceeds  paid by the  Insurer  pursuant  to the
         application  numbered  above,  that  exceed the  amount  payable to the
         Insured's  named  beneficiary  based on the schedule of Death  Benefits
         attached (see Appendix A).

                                        1
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan
Split-Dollar Collateral Assignment - Equity Method

================================================================================

   (b)   Assignor  shall not have the right to make a loan against the policy or
         otherwise  have access to cash values unless and until such time as the
         Assignor's  employment is terminated or the Assignor's  interest in the
         Policy  terminates.  Except as modified by  paragraph  1(a),  all other
         rights  in the  policy,  including  but not  limited  to the  right  to
         designate and change the  beneficiary and the right to receive any cash
         values and dividend credits outstanding in excess of aggregate premiums
         paid by the  assignee,  are reserved to the assignor and excluded  from
         this Assignment.

   (c)   Notwithstanding   any  other   provision  of  this  Assignment  or  the
         Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement entered into between assignor and
         assignee,  for all purposes,  the assignee shall furnish to the insurer
         an affidavit  specifying  the amount(s) to be paid, or the rights to be
         exercised,   by  each  party.   Both  the  assignor  and  the  assignee
         acknowledge that, between themselves, they are bound by the limitations
         of the  Assignment.  The Insurer will  recognize  the  signature of the
         assignee  and the insurer is  authorized  to recognize  the  assignee's
         claims to rights granted by this Assignment  without  investigating the
         reason for any action  taken by the  assignee,  or the  validity or the
         amount of any  liabilities  or the  existence  of any default  therein.
         Payment by the Insurer of the sums set forth in the affidavit  shall be
         a full discharge and release therefor to the Insurer.

         This assignment does not impede or change the Insurer's right under the
         "Policy  Loan"  provision  to charge  interest on any policy  loan.  If
         interest is not paid under the terms of the policy, the Insurer has the
         right to add such  interest to the unpaid loan from whatever cash value
         remains  regardless  of who owns that cash value under the terms of the
         Assignment.

2.       Aggregate  premiums paid by the assignee shall include premiums for any
         extra benefit riders or agreements issued under this policy. "Aggregate
         Premiums"  shall mean all premiums paid by the  Corporation,  including
         premiums paid for any extra benefit  riders or agreements  issued under
         the Policy and shall be reduced  by any  indebtedness  and any  accrued
         unpaid  interest  incurred  by the  Corporation  on the  Policy and the
         amount of any Policy dividends used to reduce or offset such premiums.

3.       Any death  proceeds  in excess of the amount  payable  to the  assignee
         shall be paid by the Insurer to the beneficiary named under the policy.

4.       All  provisions  of this  Assignment  are binding  upon the  executors,
         administrators, successors or assigns of the assignor.

5.       All  options  and  designations  in  effect  as of  the  date  of  this
         Assignment shall remain in effect unless  specifically  changed by this
         Assignment  or  by  action  taken   thereafter   consistent   with  the
         Assignment.

6.       The Insurer shall not be responsible for the sufficiency or validity of
         this  Assignment and is not a party to any  split-dollar  agreement (or
         any other similar agreement) between the assignee and the assignor.

Signed at__________________________________ on______________________________
                   (City and State)                       (Date)

                          SIGN ORIGINAL AND DUPLICATE


- ---------------------------                         ----------------------------
Witness Signature                                   Signature of Owner of Policy


                                        2

                                                                   Exhibit 10.12

                              DEL WEBB CORPORATION

                            MANAGEMENT INCENTIVE PLAN

                   Fiscal 1996 (July 1, 1995 - June 30, 1996)


Plan Objectives
- ---------------

o        To motivate key  management  personnel  to achieve or exceed  Corporate
         financial goals and to contribute to the short and longer term interest
         of shareholders.


o        To provide a competitive bonus program necessary to attract, retain and
         motivate high quality management.


Administration
- --------------


1.       Bonuses may be paid in cash or in stock, less applicable deductions and
         subject to prior deferral  agreements as soon as practicable  after the
         end of the Fiscal Year.


2.       In order to  receive a bonus,  the  participant  must be on the  active
         payroll at the time the bonus is paid  unless  approval  for a pro rata
         bonus is granted by the Chairman/Chief Executive Officer (CEO).


3.       At the  discretion of the CEO and upon approval of the Human  Resources
         Committee, financial objectives may be adjusted upward or downward as a
         result of  significant  windfalls  or  disasters  beyond the control of
         management.  In  addition,  the Human  Resources  Committee  can revise
         financial  objectives during the year if significant  events occur that
         were not included in the profit plan.


4.       Bonuses  are  recommended  by  the  participant's  immediate  superior,
         reviewed by the CEO and the Human Resources  Department,  and presented
         to the Human Resources Committee of the Board for final approval.


5.       All  terms and conditions of the Plan and its very existence are at the
         sole  discretion  of  the  Human  Resources  Committee  of the Board of
         Directors.
                                        1
<PAGE>
Eligibility
- -----------

Key Management personnel:

         o        whose  duties  and responsibilities can  materially affect the
                  growth, development and profitability of the Corporation and,

         o        who are nominated by a Company officer and are approved by the
                  CEO, and

         o        who are assigned to an eligible position on or before July 1st
                  unless otherwise approved by the CEO.


Bonus Opportunity Levels
- ------------------------

Each  participant  will have a Target Bonus which will be the amount  earned for
meeting the Plan objectives.  The Target Bonus will be expressed as a percentage
of actual  base salary  earned  throughout  the 1995/96  fiscal year and will be
established by the CEO and the Human Resources  Department  based on competitive
compensation data and internal equity.

Target Bonuses
- --------------

Target  bonus  levels  will  range  from  10%  to  60% of  salary  based  on the
participant's  salary grade and  organizational  level and recommendation of the
CEO. No bonuses will be payable until the minimum acceptable  threshold earnings
target is achieved unless specifically approved by the Human Resources Committee
of the Board of  Directors.  A bonus of 100% of the target bonus will be payable
for achieving 100% of Plan  objectives.  A maximum bonus of 200% of Target Bonus
will be payable for attaining the maximum expected performance.

Bonus Objectives
- ----------------

Bonus  objectives  will be comprised of the  financial  objectives  relating the
participants' area of responsibility and/or non-financial performance objectives
as specified in the annual performance appraisal.

o        Depending  upon the community or the division of the company  involved,
         financial  objectives  for a participant  may be based on Corporate net
         after-tax earnings, budgeted Group or Project operating earnings before
         interest and cash  discounts  and/or  community/project  cash flow. The
         minimum  acceptable  threshold,  target and maximum  expected  earnings
         levels will be  determined by the CEO based on the degree of difficulty
         and the level of acceptability of the budget.
                                        2
<PAGE>
Non-Financial  performance  objectives  are the most  significant  non-financial
goals which the individual participant is expected to accomplish during the Plan
year.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                     Corporate           Project         Project          Non-Financial
                                                     After Tax           Operating       Cash             Performance
                                                     Earnings            Earnings(1)     Flow             Objectives
                                                     --------            -----------     -------          ----------
<S>                                                      <C>                 <C>              <C>             <C>
I.   Target Bonus
     35% and above
     (Corporate officers,
     Coventry Division Managers
     Associate GMS & Fairmount
     Operations VP)

     A.  Headquarters                                    100%                0                0               0

     B.  Operating Sun City Communities                   25%               60%              15%              0
         Coventry/Coventry Tucson
         So. CA Conventional
         Terravita

II.  Target Bonus below 35%
     A.  Headquarters                                     80%                0                0              20%

     B.  Operating Sun City Communities                   20%               50%              15%             15%
         Coventry
         Coventry Tucson/Las Vegas
         Terravita
         So. CA Conventional

     C.  Foothills(2)                                     30%                0               50%             20%

     D.  Coventry Verde Valley                            20%                                20%             60%
</TABLE>
(1)  Before interest and cash discounts

(2) 35% of Foothills  cash flow total is related to  generation of budgeted cash
    flow.  15% of  Foothills  cash  flow  total is  related  to  monitoring  and
    communication of cash flow.


Non-financial  performance objectives will be included in the annual performance
appraisal  conducted near the beginning of the fiscal year and will be submitted
to  the  CEO  for  final  approval.  Objectives  must  be  specific,  realistic,
quantifiable and time-limited before they will be approved.  The objectives will
be designed to improve  short- and  long-term  performance  and will be mutually
agreed to by the participant and management.
                                        3
<PAGE>
In the event  circumstances or directions  change,  affecting any  participant's
pre-established  performance objectives, the manager is responsible for revising
them or establishing new objectives during the year.

Financial Objectives
- --------------------

A minimum  bonus will be paid upon a  community/project  achieving the threshold
community/project earnings forecast. For results between a threshold and maximum
expected earnings, the bonus percent will increase incrementally to a maximum of
200% of target bonus based upon  community/project  earnings and the achievement
of the other  formula  targets.  (See  attached for net  after-tax  earnings and
operating income schedules.)

Non-Financial Performance Objectives
- ------------------------------------

The  achievement  of  performance  objectives  is measured by the  participant's
immediate superior based upon documented evaluation of results.  Accomplishments
will be evaluated using the following scale:


                                           Threshold     Target        Maximum
                                           ---------     ------        -------

     Overall Rating             Poor       Good          Excellent     Superior

     Percent of Target          0          50 - 75       75 - 125      125 - 200


Evaluation of results should take into account the difficulty the objective, the
timeliness  of  accomplishment,  the  effectiveness  of results  and the overall
impact on the individual's organizational unit. Achievement of community/project
financial earnings is paramount in the bonus computation formula;  non-financial
performance  objectives  are reviewed  and  evaluated  only if minimum  earnings
objectives  have been met or if  specifically  approved  by the Human  Resources
Committee.

Rating Definitions
- ------------------

     Maximum               A  "superior"  rating is achieved if the  participant
     -------               accomplishes highly challenging  objectives resulting
                           in  significant   contribution   to  the  Company  or
                           business  unit.  This  rating  incorporates  superior
                           reaction  to  crisis  and  superior  exploitation  of
                           unanticipated opportunities.

     Target                An "excellent"  rating is achieved if the participant
     ------                accomplishes all objectives in a timely and effective
                           manner  and  overall  performance  for  the  year  is
                           considered    standard   or,   if   the   participant
                           accomplished  most of a  number  of  significant  and
                           highly challenging objectives and overall performance
                           is considered above standard.

     Threshold             A  "good"  rating  is  achieved  if  the  participant
     ---------             accomplished  most of the objectives in an acceptable
                           manner  or all of a group  of  objectives  that  were
                           minimally  challenging.  Overall  performance  of the
                           year is considered standard.
                                        4

                                                                   Exhibit 10.15

                         SECOND AMENDMENT TO AMENDED AND
                         -------------------------------
                        RESTATED REVOLVING LOAN AGREEMENT
                        ---------------------------------

         This Second Amendment to Amended and Restated  Revolving Loan Agreement
("Second  Amendment")  is entered into as of July 22, 1996 by and among DEL WEBB
CORPORATION,  a Delaware corporation  ("Borrower"),  each bank whose name is set
forth on the signature pages of this Second Amendment (collectively, the "Banks"
and  individually  a  "Bank"),  BANK  OF  AMERICA  NATIONAL  TRUST  AND  SAVINGS
ASSOCIATION, a national banking association (the "Agent") and BANK ONE, ARIZONA,
NA, a national banking  association (the  "Co-Agent").  This Second Amendment is
one of the Loan Documents  referred to in the Loan Agreement  defined below. All
terms  and  agreements  set  forth in the Loan  Agreement  which  are  generally
applicable  to  the  Loan  Documents  shall  apply  to  this  Second  Amendment.
Capitalized  terms not otherwise  defined  herein shall have the meanings  given
them in the Loan Agreement.

                                    RECITALS
                                    --------

         A. Borrower, the Banks, the Agent and the Co-Agent have previously made
and entered into that certain  Amended and Restated  Revolving  Loan  Agreement,
dated as of June 27, 1995, as amended by that certain First Amendment to Amended
and Restated Revolving Loan Agreement,  dated as of December 15, 1995 (the "Loan
Agreement"),  pursuant  to which the Banks  agreed  to make  revolving  loans to
Borrower in the original  aggregate  principal amount of up to $300,000,000 (the
"Loan").  The Loan is  evidenced  by the Loan  Agreement  and the various Line A
Notes and Line B Notes executed by Borrower in favor of the Banks.

         B.  Borrower  has  requested  that an  additional  $50,000,000  be made
available as part of the Line A  Commitment,  that the maturity date of the Loan
be extended and that certain other  modifications  and amendments be made to the
Loan Agreement and, subject to the terms and conditions  contained  herein,  the
Banks and the Agent have  agreed to such  increase  and such  modifications  and
amendments, as more fully set forth below.

         C.  Concurrently  with this Second  Amendment,  FLEET NATIONAL BANK has
executed a Commitment  Assignment and Acceptance to become a Bank under the Loan
Agreement concurrently with the effectiveness of this Second Amendment. Borrower
and the Agent hereby approve Fleet National Bank becoming a Bank.

         NOW, THEREFORE,  for good and valuable  consideration,  the receipt and
adequacy  of which are hereby  acknowledged,  Borrower,  the Banks and the Agent
hereby agree as follows:

    1.   Amendments to Loan Agreement.

         1.1      Section 1.1  Section 1.1 of  the  Loan Agreement is amended as
follows:

              (a) The definition  of "Commitment Reduction Date" is  restated in
    its entirety to read as follows:

                      "'Commitment Reduction Date' means June 30, 1998."
                                       -1-
<PAGE>
              (b) The last  sentence of the  definition  of  "Current  Operating
    Projects" is restated to read as follows:

                  "Also,  Current Operating Projects shall include a replacement
                  for one of the  foregoing  projects if such project is located
                  within  the same  general  metropolitan  area as the  replaced
                  project and if  construction of such project is commenced at a
                  time that the  replaced  project  has less  than a three  year
                  expected  sell-out  term  based  upon its  current  absorption
                  rate."

              (c) The  definition  of "Line A  Commitment"  is  restated  in its
    entirety to read as follows:

                      "'Line A Commitment' means,  subject  to  Sections 2.4 and
                      2.5, $272,000,000.  The respective Pro Rata  Shares of the
                      Banks with respect to the  Line A Commitment are set forth
                      in Schedule 1.2."

              (d) The definition of "Maturity  Date" is restated in its entirety
    to read as follows:

                      "'Maturity Date' means December 31, 2000."

         1.2  Section 6.13.  The table in Section 6.13 of the  Loan Agreement is
amended as follows:

                        "Period                             Ratio
                        -------                             -----

                  April 1, 1996 through
                    March 31, 1997                        2.55:1.00

                  April 1, 1997 through
                    March 31, 1998                        2:35:1.00

                  April 1, 1998 and
                    thereafter                            2.15:1.00"

         1.3  Section 6.14.  The table in  Section 6.14 of the Loan Agreement is
amended as follows:

                        "Period                             Ratio
                        -------                             -----

                  April 1, 1996 through
                    March 31, 1997                        1.80:1.00

                  April 1, 1997 through
                    March 31, 1998                        1.70:1.00

                  April 1, 1998 through
                    March 31, 1999                        1.50:1.00

                  April 1, 1999 and
                    thereafter                            1.30:1.00"
                                       -2-
<PAGE>
         1.4 Schedule 1.1.  Schedule 1.2 ("Bank Group  Commitments") to the Loan
Agreement is amended and  restated in its  entirety in the schedule  attached to
this Second Amendment as Annex I.

         1.5 Schedule 4.4. Schedule 4.4  ("Subsidiaries")  to the Loan Agreement
is amended and restated in its entirety in the schedule  attached to this Second
Amendment as Annex IV.

    2.   Underwriting Fees.  On  the  effective  date of this  Second Amendment,
Borrower agrees to pay Underwriting Fees as follows:

              (a)  Borrower  agrees  to pay  to the  Agent  for  the  respective
    accounts of the Banks,  pro-rata,  according to their  pro-rata share of the
    additional  $50,000,000 portion of the Line A Commitment,  as shown on Annex
    III hereto, a fee of $62,500; and

              (b)  Borrower  agrees to pay a $10,000  fee to each  Bank,  except
    Fleet National Bank, payable to the Agent for the account of each such Bank.

These  Underwriting  Fees are  fully  earned  upon such  effective  date and are
nonrefundable.

    3.  Adjusting  Purchase  Payments.  The Agent shall  notify the Banks on the
first Banking Day that the  conditions  specified in Sections  5(a)-5(f)  hereof
have been satisfied (the "Notice"). On the following Banking Day, certain of the
Banks shall purchase,  and certain of the Banks shall sell, to one another,  the
percentage  interests in the  Commitments  as  reflected in Annex II hereto,  in
order to  reallocate  the then  outstanding  Advances  under the Notes among the
Banks to  correspond  to the revised Pro Rata Shares of the Banks  specified  in
Annex I hereto. The applicable purchase price payments are specified on Annex II
hereto  and  referred  to  herein  as the  "Adjusting  Purchase  Payments."  The
Adjusting  Purchasing  Payments  shall be made to the  Agent  by the  applicable
purchasing  Banks by Federal  Reserve  wire  transfer  initiated by the payor no
later than 9:00 a.m.  California  time on the Banking Day  following the Notice.
Upon receipt of all such  payments,  the Agent shall  promptly send  appropriate
portions thereof to the selling Banks by Federal Reserve wire transfer.  The new
Pro Rata Shares shall become effective after the close of business on the day of
transfer of such funds.

    4. Borrower's Representations and Warranties. Borrower hereby represents and
warrants that except as previously disclosed to the Banks in writing, all of the
representations  and  warranties  contained in the Loan  Documents  are true and
correct on and as of the date of this  Second  Amendment  as though made on that
date and after giving effect to this Second  Amendment no Event of Default shall
be continuing.

    5.  Conditions  Precedent.  The  effectiveness  of this Second  Amendment is
conditioned  upon  the  satisfaction  by  Borrower  of  each  of  the  following
conditions on or before July 31, 1996:

              (a) Borrower shall have delivered or caused to be delivered to the
    Agent executed  original  counterparts of this Second  Amendment and Exhibit
    "A" hereto,  sufficient in number for  distribution to the Agent,  the Banks
    and Borrower;

              (b) Borrower shall have  delivered to the Agent executed  original
    replacement  Line A Notes and Line B Notes,  for each Bank,  in the forms of
    Exhibit "B" and Exhibit "C" hereto. Such replacement notes
                                       -3-
<PAGE>
    shall  reflect the increase in the Line A  Commitment  herein as well as the
    alteration of the Pro Rata Share of each Bank reflected on Annex I hereto;

              (c) Borrower  shall have paid the  Underwriting  Fees  required in
    Section 2 hereof;

              (d) The Agent shall have received from Borrower such documentation
    as may be  required  to  establish  the  authority  of  Borrower to execute,
    deliver  and  perform  any of the  Loan  Documents  to  which it is a Party,
    including,  without  limitation,  this Second  Amendment and the replacement
    Line A Notes and Line B Notes.  Such  documentation  shall include certified
    corporate resolutions,  incumbency certificates, and such other certificates
    or documents as the Agent shall reasonably require;

              (e) The Agent  shall  have  received  a written  legal  opinion of
    counsel(s)   to  Borrower  and  each   Guarantor,   in  form  and  substance
    satisfactory to the Agent,  regarding the execution,  delivery,  performance
    and enforceability of this Second Amendment,  the Guarantors' Consent hereto
    and the replacement Line A Notes and Line B Notes;

              (f) The Agent shall have received a written  certification  from a
    Responsible  Official of Borrower that Borrower and its  Subsidiaries are in
    compliance with all the terms and provisions of the Loan Documents and after
    giving effect to this Second  Amendment no Default or Event of Default shall
    be continuing;

and the satisfaction by the Banks of the following condition:

              (g) The  applicable  Banks shall have made the Adjusting  Purchase
    Payments as specified in Section 3 hereof.

    6. Return of Canceled  Notes to  Borrower.  Upon the  effectiveness  of this
Second Amendment in accordance  herewith,  including the delivery by Borrower of
all documents required under Section 6 hereof, the Banks shall return the Line A
Notes and Line B Notes that have been  replaced  pursuant to Section 5(b) hereof
to Borrower, in each case marked "Canceled."

    7. Amendment to Other Loan  Documents.  Each of the Loan Documents is hereby
amended such that all references to the Loan Agreement  contained  therein shall
be deemed to be made with respect to the Loan Agreement as amended hereby.  Each
of the Loan  Documents  are  hereby  further  amended  such  that any  reference
contained therein to any document amended hereby shall be deemed to be made with
respect to such document as amended  hereby.  Each  reference to Loan  Documents
generally shall be deemed to include this Second Amendment.

    8. Loan Documents in Full Force and Effect.  Except as modified hereby,  the
Loan Documents remain in full force and effect.

    9. Effective Dates.  Unless otherwise  specified herein,  and subject to the
satisfaction  of all  conditions  specified  in  Section 5, each  amendment  and
modification  identified herein shall be deemed effective as of the date of this
Second Amendment,  provided that the changes to the Pro Rata Shares of the Banks
identified  on  Annex I  hereto  shall be  deemed  effective  on the date of the
Adjusting Purchase Payments described in Section 3 of this Second Amendment.
                                       -4-
<PAGE>
    10. Governing Law. This Second Amendment shall be governed by, and construed
in accordance with, the Laws of the State of California.

    11. Severability.  If any provision of this Second Amendment is held invalid
or unenforceable by any court of competent jurisdiction,  such holding shall not
invalidate or render unenforceable any other provision hereof.

    12. Counterparts.  This Second Amendment may be executed in counterparts and
any party may  execute any  counterpart,  each of which shall be deemed to be an
original  and all of which,  taken  together,  shall be deemed to be one and the
same document.  The execution  hereof by any parties shall not become  effective
until this Second  Amendment,  and Exhibit "A" hereto, is executed and delivered
by all parties hereto and thereto.

    13. Prior  Agreements.  This Second Amendment  contains the entire agreement
between  Borrower,  the Banks and the Agent with  respect to the subject  matter
hereof, and all prior negotiations,  understandings, and agreements with respect
thereto are superseded by this Second Amendment.
                                       -5-
<PAGE>
         IN  WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the  parties  hereto  have  caused  this  Second
Amendment to be duly executed as of the date first above written.

"Borrower"                                   
                                             
DEL WEBB CORPORATION                         
                                             
                                             
By:________________________________          
           John A. Spencer                   
        Senior Vice President                
                                             
                                             
                                             
"Agent"                                      
                                             
BANK OF AMERICA NATIONAL TRUST               
AND SAVINGS ASSOCIATION, as Agent            
                                             
                                             
By:________________________________          
            Derik J. Hart                    
           Vice President                    
                                             
                                             
                                             
"Co-Agent"                                   
                                             
BANK ONE, ARIZONA, NA, as Co-Agent           
                                             
                                             
By:________________________________          
           James A. Warner                   
           Vice President                    
                                             
                                             
                                             
"Banks"                                      
                                             
BANK ONE, ARIZONA, NA, as a Bank             


By:________________________________
            James A. Warner
            Vice President



BANK OF AMERICA NATIONAL TRUST        
AND SAVINGS ASSOCIATION, as a Bank    
                                      
                                      
By:________________________________   
            Carol E. Settles          
             Vice President           
                                      
                                      
                                      
THE FIRST NATIONAL BANK OF BOSTON     
                                      
                                      
By:________________________________   
             Kevin C. Hake            
            Vice President            
                                      
                                      
                                      
GUARANTY FEDERAL BANK, F.S.B.         
                                      
                                      
By:________________________________   
          Richard V. Thompson         
            Vice President            
                                      
                                      
                                      
CREDIT LYONNAIS CAYMAN ISLAND         
BRANCH                                
                                      
                                      
By:________________________________   
           Thierry F. Vincent         
          Authorized Signatory        

                                      -6-
<PAGE>
CREDIT LYONNAIS LOS ANGELES                 
BRANCH                                      
                                            
                                            
By:________________________________         
          Thierry F. Vincent                
      Vice President and Manager            
                                            
                                            
                                            
NATIONSBANK, N.A.,                          
formerly known as NationsBank, N.A.         
(Carolinas)                                 
                                            
                                            
By:________________________________         
         Robert L. Whittemore               
         Senior Vice President              
                                            
                                            
 BANK OF HAWAII                       
                                      
                                      
 By:________________________________  
          Joseph T. Donalson          
            Vice President            
                                      
                                      
                                      
 FIRST UNION NATIONAL BANK OF         
 NORTH CAROLINA                       
                                      
                                      
 By:________________________________  
            R. Steven Hall            
            Vice President            
                                      
                                      
                                      
 FLEET NATIONAL BANK                  
                                      
                                      
 By:________________________________   
            Michael A. Cope            
            Vice President             

                                       -7-

<PAGE>
                                   EXHIBIT "A"
                                   -----------

                              GUARANTORS' CONSENTS
                              --------------------



                  The  undersigned  do each hereby (a)  consent to that  certain
Second Amendment to Amended and Restated  Revolving Loan Agreement,  dated as of
July 22, 1996, by and among Del Webb Corporation  ("Borrower"),  the Banks named
therein,  Bank of America National Trust and Savings Association,  as Agent, and
Bank One, Arizona, NA, as Co-Agent, including the increase of $50,000,000 in the
Line A  Commitment  contained  therein  and (b)  reaffirm  (i) their  respective
obligations under that certain Subsidiary  Guaranty,  dated as of June 27, 1995,
and (ii) that the Subsidiary Guaranty remains in full force and effect and that,
without limitation,  any indebtedness of Borrower represented by the $50,000,000
increase  in  the  Line  A  Commitment  constitutes   "Guarantied   Obligations"
thereunder.

Dated: July 22, 1996

Asset One Corp., an Arizona corporation     
                                            
                                            
By:________________________________         
         Donald V. Mickus                   
          its treasurer                     
                                            
                                            
                                            
Coventry of California, Inc.,               
an Arizona corporation                      
                                            
                                            
By:________________________________         
         Donald V. Mickus                   
          its treasurer                     
                                            
                                            
                                            
Del Webb California Corp.,                  
an Arizona corporation                      
                                            
                                            
By:________________________________         
         Donald V. Mickus                   
            Treasurer                       
                                            

Del Webb Commercial Properties Corporation,
an Arizona corporation      
                                         
                                         
By:________________________________      
         Donald V. Mickus                
            Treasurer                    
                                         
                                         
                                         
Del Webb Communities, Inc.,              
an Arizona corporation                   
                                         
                                         
By:________________________________      
         Donald V. Mickus                
            Treasurer                    
                                         
                                         
                                         
Del Webb Conservation Holding Corp., an
Arizona corporation                   
                                         
                                         
By:________________________________      
         Donald V. Mickus                
          its treasurer                  

                                   EXHIBIT "A"
                                   Page 1 of 5
<PAGE>
Del Webb Home Construction, Inc.,
an Arizona corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
            Treasurer



Del Webb Homes, Inc., an Arizona corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
            its treasurer



Del Webb Communities of Nevada, Inc.
(formerly known as Del Webb Kingswood
Parke, Inc.), an Arizona corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
            its treasurer



The Villages at Desert Hills, Inc. (formerly
known as Del Webb Lakeview Corporation),
an Arizona corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
            Treasurer

Del Webb's Coventry Homes Construction Co.,
an Arizona corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
            Treasurer



Del Webb's Coventry Homes, Inc.,
an Arizona corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
            Treasurer



Del Webb's Coventry Homes of Nevada, Inc., an
Arizona  corporation  
(formerly known as Del Webb of Nevada, Inc.)


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
             Treasurer



Del Webb's Coventry Homes Construction
of Tucson Co., an Arizona corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
            Treasurer

                                   EXHIBIT "A"
                                   Page 2 of 5
<PAGE>
Del Webb's Coventry Homes of Tucson, Inc., an
Arizona corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
             Treasurer



Del E. Webb Cactus Development Corp.,
an Arizona corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
             Treasurer



Del E. Webb Development Co., L.P.,
a Delaware limited partnership


By:   Del Webb Communities, Inc., general
      partner


      By:_______________________________
                  Donald V. Mickus
                    Treasurer



Del E. Webb Foothills Corporation,
an Arizona corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
            Treasurer



Del E. Webb Glen Harbor Development
Corporation, an Arizona corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
            Treasurer



DW Aviation Co., an Arizona corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
           its treasurer



Fairmount Mortgage, Inc., an Arizona
corporation


By:________________________________
         Richard W. Day
           Treasurer



Glen Harbor Joint Venture, an Arizona general
partnership

      By:  Del E. Webb Glen Harbor Development
           Corporation, general partner


           By:  _________________________
                    Donald V. Mickus
                       Treasurer


                                   EXHIBIT "A"
                                   Page 3 of 5
<PAGE>
Terravita Commercial Corp., an Arizona
corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
           its treasurer



Terravita Corp., an Arizona corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
            Treasurer



Terravita Home Construction Co.,
an Arizona corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
            Treasurer



Trovas Company, an Arizona corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
            its treasurer



Trovas Construction Co., an Arizona
corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
            its treasurer


Del Webb Limited Holding Co.,
an Arizona corporation


By:________________________________
          Donald V. Mickus
            its treasurer



Del Webb Southwest Co.,
an Arizona corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
           its treasurer



New Mexico Asset Corporation,
an Arizona corporation


By:________________________________
         Donald V. Mickus
           its treasurer



Del Webb Texas Limited Partnership,
an Arizona limited partnership

By:   Del Webb Southwest Co.,
           an Arizona corporation


           By:____________________________
                    Donald V. Mickus
                      its treasurer



                                   EXHIBIT "A"
                                   Page 4 of 5
<PAGE>
New Mexico Asset Limited Partnership
(formerly known as New Mexico Investment Co.
Limited Partnership), an Arizona limited
partnership

By:   Del Webb Corporation, a Delaware
      corporation


           By:____________________________
                     Donald V. Mickus
                       its treasurer



                                   EXHIBIT "A"
                                   Page 5 of 5
<PAGE>
                                   EXHIBIT "B"
                                   -----------


                                   LINE A NOTE
                                   -----------


$________________                                                  July 22, 1996
                                                         Los Angeles, California


           FOR VALUE RECEIVED,  the undersigned  promises to pay to the order of
__________________________________________________  (the "Bank"),  the principal
amount of _____________________________________________ ($_____________) or such
lesser  aggregate  amount of Advances as may be made by the Bank with respect to
the Line A Commitment under the Loan Agreement referred to below,  together with
interest on the  principal  amount of each Advance made  hereunder and remaining
unpaid  from time to time from the date of each such  Advance  until the date of
payment in full, payable as hereinafter set forth.

           Reference  is  made  to  the  Amended  and  Restated  Revolving  Loan
Agreement, dated as of June 27, 1995, as amended by the First Amendment thereto,
dated December 15, 1995,  and by the Second  Amendment  thereto,  dated July 22,
1996,  by and among the  undersigned,  as Borrower,  the Banks which are parties
thereto,  Bank One,  Arizona,  N.A., as Co-Agent,  and Bank of America  National
Trust and Savings  Association,  as Agent for the Banks (as  amended,  the "Loan
Agreement").  Terms  defined in the Loan  Agreement  and not  otherwise  defined
herein  are  used  herein  with  the  meanings  given  those  terms  in the Loan
Agreement.  This is one of the Line A Notes  referred to in the Loan  Agreement,
and any holder hereof is entitled to all of the rights,  remedies,  benefits and
privileges  provided for in the Loan  Agreement as originally  executed or as it
may from time to time be supplemented,  modified or amended. The Loan Agreement,
among other things,  contains provisions for acceleration of the maturity hereof
upon the  happening  of  certain  stated  events  upon the terms and  conditions
therein specified.

           The  principal  indebtedness  evidenced  by this Line A Note shall be
payable as provided in the Loan Agreement and in any event on the Maturity Date.

           Interest shall be payable on the outstanding  daily unpaid  principal
amount of Advances  from the date of each such Advance until payment in full and
shall  accrue and be payable at the rates and on the dates set forth in the Loan
Agreement  both  before and after  default  and before  and after  maturity  and
judgment,  with  interest on overdue  principal and interest to bear interest at
the rate set forth in Section 3.7 of the Loan  Agreement,  to the fullest extent
permitted by applicable Law.

           Each  payment  hereunder  shall be made to the  Agent at the  Agent's
Office for the account of the Bank in immediately available funds not later than
11:00 a.m. (San  Francisco  time) on the day of payment (which must be a Banking
Day).  All  payments  received  after  11:00 a.m.  (San  Francisco  time) on any
particular  Banking Day shall be deemed received on the next succeeding  Banking
Day. All payments shall be made in lawful money of the United States of America.

                                   EXHIBIT "B"
                                   Page 1 of 2
<PAGE>
           The Bank shall use its best efforts to keep a record of Advances made
by it and  payments  received by it with  respect to this Line A Note,  and such
record  shall be  presumptive  evidence of the  amounts  owing under this Line A
Note.

           The undersigned  hereby promises to pay all costs and expenses of any
rightful  holder hereof  incurred in collecting  the  undersigned's  obligations
hereunder or in enforcing or attempting  to enforce any of such holder's  rights
hereunder,  including reasonable  attorneys' fees and disbursements,  whether or
not an action is filed in connection therewith.

           The  undersigned  hereby  waives  presentment,  demand  for  payment,
dishonor, notice of dishonor, protest, notice of protest and any other notice or
formality, to the fullest extent permitted by applicable Laws.

           This Line A Note shall be  delivered  to and  accepted by the Bank in
the State of California, and shall be governed by, and construed and enforced in
accordance with, the local Laws thereof.

           [ . . . This Line A Note  replaces,  amends and restates that certain
Line  A  Note,   dated  as  of  June  27,  1995,  in  the  principal  amount  of
$____________,  heretofore  delivered by the undersigned to the Bank pursuant to
the Loan Agreement . . . .]


                                    DEL WEBB CORPORATION, a Delaware corporation



                                    By: ________________________________________

                                        ________________________________________
                                                    Printed Name and Title

                                   EXHIBIT "B"
                                   Page 2 of 2
<PAGE>
                                   EXHIBIT "C"
                                   -----------


                                   LINE B NOTE
                                   -----------



$_____________                                                     July 22, 1996
                                                         Los Angeles, California


               FOR VALUE RECEIVED,  the undersigned promises to pay to the order
of  ______________________________________________  (the "Bank"),  the principal
amount of  ________________________________________  DOLLARS  ($____________) or
such lesser aggregate amount of Advances as may be made by the Bank with respect
to the Line B Commitment  under the Loan Agreement  referred to below,  together
with  interest  on the  principal  amount of each  Advance  made  hereunder  and
remaining  unpaid from time to time from the date of each such Advance until the
date of payment in full, payable as hereinafter set forth.

               Reference  is made to the Amended  and  Restated  Revolving  Loan
Agreement, dated as of June 27, 1995, as amended by the First Amendment thereto,
dated December 15, 1995, and the Second Amendment thereto,  dated July 22, 1996,
by and among the undersigned,  as Borrower, the Banks which are parties thereto,
Bank One,  Arizona,  N.A., as Co-Agent,  and Bank of America  National Trust and
Savings Association,  as Agent for the Banks (as amended, the "Loan Agreement").
Terms defined in the Loan  Agreement and not otherwise  defined  herein are used
herein with the meanings given those terms in the Loan Agreement. This is one of
the Line B Notes  referred to in the Loan  Agreement,  and any holder  hereof is
entitled to all of the rights, remedies, benefits and privileges provided for in
the Loan  Agreement  as  originally  executed  or as it may from time to time be
supplemented,  modified  or amended.  The Loan  Agreement,  among other  things,
contains  provisions for  acceleration of the maturity hereof upon the happening
of certain stated events upon the terms and conditions therein specified.

               The principal indebtedness evidenced by this Line B Note shall be
payable as provided in the Loan Agreement and in any event on the Maturity Date.

               Interest  shall  be  payable  on  the  outstanding  daily  unpaid
principal amount of Advances from the date of each such Advance until payment in
full and shall  accrue and be payable at the rates and on the dates set forth in
the Loan  Agreement  both before and after default and before and after maturity
and judgment,  with interest on overdue  principal and interest to bear interest
at the rate set  forth in  Section  3.7 of the Loan  Agreement,  to the  fullest
extent permitted by applicable Law.

               Each payment  hereunder shall be made to the Agent at the Agent's
Office for the account of the Bank in immediately available funds not later than
11:00 a.m. (San  Francisco  time) on the day of payment (which must be a Banking
Day).  All  payments  received  after  11:00 a.m.  (San  Francisco  time) on any
particular  Banking Day shall be deemed received on the next succeeding  Banking
Day. All payments shall be made in lawful money of the United States of America.

                                   EXHIBIT "C"
                                   Page 1 of 2
<PAGE>
               The Bank shall use its best  efforts to keep a record of Advances
made by it and  payments  received by it with  respect to this Line B Note,  and
such record shall be presumptive evidence of the amounts owing under this Line B
Note.

               The undersigned  hereby promises to pay all costs and expenses of
any rightful holder hereof incurred in collecting the undersigned's  obligations
hereunder or in enforcing or attempting  to enforce any of such holder's  rights
hereunder,  including reasonable  attorneys' fees and disbursements,  whether or
not an action is filed in connection therewith.

               The undersigned  hereby waives  presentment,  demand for payment,
dishonor, notice of dishonor, protest, notice of protest and any other notice or
formality, to the fullest extent permitted by applicable Laws.

               This Line B Note shall be  delivered  to and accepted by the Bank
in the State of California, and shall be governed by, and construed and enforced
in accordance with, the local Laws thereof.

               [ . . . This  Line B Note  replaces,  amends  and  restates  that
certain  Line B Note,  dated  as of June 27,  1995 in the  principal  amount  of
$_______________ , heretofore  delivered by the undersigned to the Bank pursuant
to the Loan Agreement . . . . ]


                                    DEL WEBB CORPORATION, a Delaware corporation



                                    By: ________________________________________

                                        ________________________________________
                                                  Printed Name and Title


                                   EXHIBIT "C"
                                   Page 2 of 2
<PAGE>
                                     ANNEX I
                                     -------
                              DEL WEBB CORPORATION
                             BANK GROUP COMMITMENTS


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                          Line "A"               Line "B"              Total
Syndicate Bank                                 Pro Rata Share          $272,000,000            $78,000,000         $350,000,000
- --------------                                 --------------          ------------            -----------         ------------

<S>                                             <C>                    <C>                    <C>                  <C>         
Bank of America NT & SA                          24.28571429%          $ 66,057,143           $ 18,942,857         $ 85,000,000
Bank One, Arizona, NA                            18.57142857%            50,514,286             14,485,714           65,000,000
NationsBank, N.A.                                12.85714286%            34,971,429             10,028,571           45,000,000
Guaranty Federal, F.S.B.                         11.42857143%            31,085,714              8,914,286           40,000,000
The First National Bank of Boston                10.00000000%            27,200,000              7,800,000           35,000,000
First Union National Bank of North Carolina       7.14285714%            19,428,571              5,571,429           25,000,000
Bank of Hawaii                                    5.71428571%            15,542,857              4,457,143           20,000,000
Fleet National Bank                               5.71428571%            15,542,857              4,457,143           20,000,000
Credit Lyonnais                                   4.28571429%            11,657,143              3,342,857           15,000,000

TOTAL:                                          100.00000000%          $272,000,000           $ 78,000,000         $350,000,000
</TABLE>



                                     ANNEX I
                                   Page 1 of 1
<PAGE>
                                    ANNEX II
                                    --------
                           ADJUSTING PURCHASE PAYMENTS

Aggregate  Principal  Balance of existing  Promissory Notes immediately prior to
effective  date  of  Second  Amendment  -  $195,000,000   ("Carryover  Principal
Balance").
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Banks Making             Former Share                        New Share of
Adjusting                of Carryover          Former          Carryover            New       Adjusting Purchase  Adjusting Purchase
Purchase Payments      Principal Balance   Pro Rata Share  Principal Balance  Pro Rata Share    Payment to Pay    Payment to Receive
- -----------------      -----------------   --------------  -----------------  --------------  ------------------  ------------------
<S>                      <C>                 <C>             <C>              <C>                 <C>                  <C>
Bank of Hawaii           $  9,750,000          5.000000%     $ 11,142,857       5.71428571%       $ 1,392,857

First Union National        9,750,000          5.000000%       13,928,571       7.14285714%         4,178,571
Bank of North
Carolina

Fleet National Bank         -0-                -0-             11,142,857       5.71428571%        11,142,857

Banks Receiving Adjusting Purchase Payments
- -------------------------------------------

Bank of America            55,250,000         28.333333%       47,357,143      24.28571429%                            $ 7,892,857

Bank One,                  42,250,000         21.666667%       36,214,286      18.57142857%                              6,035,714
Arizona, NA

NationsBank, N.A.          26,000,000         13.333333%       25,071,429      12.85714286%                                928,571

Guaranty Federal,          22,750,000         11.666667%       22,285,714      11.42857143%                                464,286
F.S.B.

The First National         19,500,000         10.000000%       19,500,000      10.00000000%                                -0-
Bank of Boston

Credit Lyonnais             9,750,000          5.000000%        8,357,143       4.28571429%                              1,392,857

TOTAL:                   $195,000,000        100.000000%     $195,000,000     100.00000000%       $16,714,285          $16,714,285
</TABLE>


                                    ANNEX II
                                   Page 1 of 1
<PAGE>
                                    ANNEX III
                        SHARES OF INCREASE IN COMMITMENT

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                          Portion of                  Pro-Rata Share of
Syndicate Bank                                                      Increase in Commitment          Increase in Commitment
- --------------                                                      ----------------------          ----------------------

<S>                                                                     <C>                                   <C>
Bank of America NT & SA                                                      -0-                               -0-
Bank One, Arizona, NA                                                        -0-                               -0-
NationsBank, N.A.                                                       $ 5,000,000                            10%
Guaranty Federal, F.S.B.                                                  5,000,000                            10%
The First National Bank of Boston                                         5,000,000                            10%
First Union National Bank of North Carolina                              10,000,000                            20%
Bank of Hawaii                                                            5,000,000                            10%
Fleet National Bank                                                      20,000,000                            40%
Credit Lyonnais                                                              -0-                               -0-

TOTAL:                                                                  $50,000,000                           100%
</TABLE>


                                    ANNEX III
                                   Page 1 of 1
<PAGE>
                                    Annex IV

                                  Schedule 4.4

                      SUBSIDIARIES AND ASSOCIATED COMPANIES
                                       OF
                              DEL WEBB CORPORATION
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Name                                                      Shares Issued                  Shares Owned By:
<S>                                                             <C>                      <C>                    
Asset One Corp.*                                                    100                  Del Webb Corporation
Asset Four Corp.                                                    100                  Del Webb Corporation
Asset Five Corp.                                                    100                  Del Webb Corporation
Coventry of California, Inc.*                                     1,000                  Del Webb Corporation
Del Webb Architectural Services, Inc.                             1,000                  Del Webb Corporation
Del Webb California Corp.*                                          250                  Del Webb Corporation
Del Webb Commercial Properties Corporation*                       1,000                  Del Webb Corporation
Del Webb Communities, Inc.*                                     751,852                  Del Webb Corporation
Del Webb Communities of Nevada, Inc.*                             1,000                  Del Webb Corporation
Del Webb Community Management Co.                                   250                  Del Webb Corporation
Del Webb Conservation Holding Corp.*                              1,000                  Del Webb Communities, Inc.
Del Webb Construction Services Co                                   100                  Del Webb Corporation
Del Webb Home Construction, Inc.*                                   100                  Del Webb Communities, Inc.

Del Webb Homes, Inc.*                                             1,000                  Del Webb Corporation
Del Webb Limited Holding Co.*                                     1,000                  Del Webb Communities, Inc.
Del Webb Midatlantic Corp.                                          100                  Del Webb Corporation
Del Webb Property Corp.                                             100                  Del Webb Corporation
Del Webb Southwest Co.*                                           1,000                  Del Webb Construction
                                                                                            Services Co.
Del Webb Texas Limited Partnership*                                 -0-
Del Webb Texas Title Agency Co.                                   1,000                  Del Webb Southwest Co.
Del Webb's Contracting Services, Inc.                               100                  Del Webb Communities, Inc.
Del Webb's Contracting Services of  Tucson, Inc.                    100                  Del Webb Communities, Inc.
Del Webb's Coventry Homes Construction Co.*                       1,000                  Del Webb's Coventry Homes,
                                                                                            Inc.
Del Webb's Coventry Homes, Inc.*                                  1,000                  Del Webb Corporation
Del Webb's Coventry Homes of Nevada, Inc.*                        1,000                  Del Webb's Coventry Homes,
                                                                                            Inc.
Del Webb's Coventry Homes Construction of  Tucson Co.*            1,000                  Del Webb's Coventry Homes of
                                                                                            Tucson, Inc.
Del Webb's Coventry Homes of Tucson, Inc.*                        1,000                  Del Webb's Coventry Homes,
                                                                                            Inc.
Del Webb's Stetson Hills, Inc.                                    1,000                  Del Webb's Coventry Homes,
                                                                                            Inc.
Del Webb's Sun City Realty, Inc.                                  1,000                  Del Webb Corporation
Del E. Webb Cactus Development Corp.*                             1,000                  Del Webb Commercial
                                                                                            Properties Corporation
</TABLE>
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<S>                                                             <C>                      <C>
Del E. Webb Development Co., L.P.*                                  -0-
Del E. Webb Finance Company                                         100                  Del Webb Corporation
Del E. Webb Financial Corporation                                 1,000                  Del Webb Corporation
Del E. Webb Foothills Corporation*                                1,000                  Del Webb Commercial
                                                                                            Properties Corporation
Del E. Webb Glen Harbor Development  Corporation*                 1,000                  Del Webb Commercial
                                                                                            Properties Corporation
DW Aviation, Co.*                                                 1,000                  Del Webb Corporation
Fairmount Mortgage, Inc.*                                       400,000                  Del Webb Corporation
Glen Harbor Joint Venture*                                          -0-
Marina Operations Corp.                                             100                  Del Webb Corporation
New Mexico Asset Corporation*                                       100                  Del Webb Corporation
New Mexico Asset Limited Partnership*                               -0-
Risco Insurance Company, Ltd.                                   499,990                  Del Webb Corporation
Sun City Sales Corporation                                        1,000                  Del Webb Communities, Inc.
Sun City Title Agency Co.                                       100,000                  Del Webb Communities, Inc.
Sun State Insulation Co., Inc.                                    1,000                  Del Webb Communities, Inc.
Terravita Commercial Corp.*                                       1,000                  Del Webb Corporation
Terravita Corp.*                                                  1,000                  Del Webb Corporation
Terravita Home Construction Co.*                                  1,000                  Del Webb Corporation
Terravita Marketplace L.L.C.                                        -0-
The Villages At Desert Hills, Inc.*                                 100                  Del Webb Corporation
Trovas Company*                                                   1,000                  Del Webb's Coventry Homes, Inc.
Trovas Construction Co.*                                          1,000                  Del Webb's Coventry Homes, Inc.
</TABLE>


         o        Those  subsidiaries  designated  with an  asterisk  constitute
                  Guarantor Subsidiaries as defined in the Loan Agreement.

         o        All of these entities are corporations except:

                           o        Del  E.  Webb  Development  Co.,  L.P.  -  a
                                    Delaware limited partnership, which is owned
                                    by Del Webb  Communities,  Inc.  (99.9%) and
                                    Del Webb  Construction  Services Co.  (.1%).
                                    Del Webb  Communities,  Inc.  is the general
                                    partner.

                           o        Glen  Harbor  Joint  Venture  -  an  Arizona
                                    partnership owned by Del E. Webb Glen Harbor
                                    Development  Corporation  (50%),  and Del E.
                                    Webb Cactus Development Corp. (50%).

                           o        Del  Webb  Texas  Limited  Partnership  - an
                                    Arizona limited partnership,  which is owned
                                    by Del Webb  Southwest Co. (1%) and Del Webb
                                    Limited   Holding   Co.   (99%).   Del  Webb
                                    Southwest Co. is the general partner.

                           o        New Mexico Asset  Limited  Partnership  - an
                                    Arizona limited partnership,  which is owned
                                    by Del Webb Corporation (1%), and New Mexico
                                    Asset    Corporation    (99%).    Del   Webb
                                    Corporation is the general partner.

                           o        Terravita  Marketplace  L.L.C.  - an Arizona
                                    limited  liability company which is owned by
                                    Pederson   Group,   Inc.   (1%),   Terravita
                                    Commercial  Corp.  (59%),   Terravita  Corp.
                                    (1%),  and J&R  Holdings II,  L.L.C.  (39%).
                                    Pederson Group, Inc. is the general partner.
<PAGE>
         o        All corporations are Arizona corporations except:

                           o       Del Webb Corporation, a Delaware corporation.

         o        The company  also owns shares of stock in a number of publicly
                  held  companies  for  purposes of  obtaining  such  companies'
                  public reports. These holdings are immaterial.

                                                                   Exhibit 10.18

                                                                      As Amended
                                                                October 29, 1981
                                                                January 27, 1987
                                                                   June 30, 1993
                             DEL E. WEBB CORPORATION               June 20, 1996
                             -----------------------
                             1981 STOCK OPTION PLAN
                             ----------------------

1.   Purpose of Plan.

     The purpose of this Plan is to enable Del E. Webb  Corporation  and certain
of its  subsidiaries  to  continue to compete  successfully  in  attracting  and
retaining key  employees  with  outstanding  abilities by making it possible for
them to purchase  shares of the Company's  Common Stock on terms which will give
them a  more  direct  and  continuing  interest  in the  future  success  of the
Company's business.  It is intended that options granted hereunder may be either
incentive  stock  options  under  Section 422A of the  Internal  Revenue Code or
non-qualified options.

2.   Definitions.

     "Company" means Del E. Webb Corporation, an Arizona corporation.

     "Code"  means  the  Internal  Revenue  Code of  1954,  as  amended  and any
successor provision.

     "Committee" means a committee  established by the Board consisting of three
or more members of the Board,  none of whom is eligible to receive options under
the Plan. The Executive Compensation and Management Development Committee may be
this committee if it meets these qualifications.

     "Incentive  Stock Option" means an option designed to meet the requirements
of Section 422A(b) of the Code.

     "Subsidiary",  unless specified otherwise,  means a corporation of which at
least a majority of the outstanding  securities  having ordinary voting power to
elect all or a majority  of the  directors  of such  corporation  is at the time
owned or controlled directly or indirectly by the Company or a Subsidiary.

     "Employees" means employees,  (including employees who are directors and/or
officers)  regularly  employed  on  a  salary  basis  by  the  Company  or  by a
Subsidiary.

     "Shares" means shares of Common Stock of the Company.

     "Board" means the Board of Directors of the Company.

     "Optionee"  means a person to whom an option  has been  granted  under this
Plan which has not expired or been fully exercised, surrendered, or forfeited.
               
     "Plan" means the Del E. Webb Corporation 1981 Stock Option Plan.

3.   Administration.

     The Plan  shall be  administered  by the  Committee  which  shall  adopt by
resolution  Such Rules and  Regulations as may be required in order to carry out
<PAGE>
the purpose of the Plan, as well as the form of option agreement and other forms
required  in  connection  with  the  Plan.  All  questions  of   interpretation,
administration  and application of the Plan shall be determined by a majority of
the Committee and the  determination of such majority shall be final and binding
upon all persons in interest, including the Company and its shareholders and all
Optionees.

4.   Number of Shares.

     The grants of options to purchase  Common  Stock of the  Company  shall not
exceed in the  aggregate  600,000  shares of the  Common  Stock of the  Company;
provided,  however,  that in the event that options granted under the Plan shall
terminate or expire  without being  exercised,  in whole or in part,  the shares
subject to such  unexercised  options may again be  subjected to an option under
this Plan. Provided further,  the number of shares' shall be adjusted to reflect
changes or other adjustments in the number of outstanding  shares as hereinafter
provided  in Section  5. The shares of stock to be so made  subject to an option
under this Plan shall be shares of Common  Stock of the  Company  either held in
the Company's  treasury or authorized and unissued  Common Stock of the Company,
or some of each.  The  Company  shall be under no  obligation  to  reserve or to
retain in its  treasury  any  particular  number  of shares at any time,  and no
particular  shares,  whether  unissued  or held as  treasury  shares,  shall  be
identified as those optioned under this Plan.

5.   Change in Capitalization.

     In the event that the shares of Common Stock of the  Company,  as presently
constituted,  shall be changed into or exchanged for a different  number or kind
of shares of stock or other securities of the Company or of another  corporation
(whether by merger, consolidation, reorganization, recapitalization, combination
of shares or otherwise) then there shall be substituted for each share of Common
Stock of the Company heretofore  appropriated for use in the Plan the number and
kind of shares of stock or other  securities into which each such share shall be
exchanged. In the event that there should be any change in the number or kind of
outstanding shares of the Common Stock of the Company,  or of any stock or other
securities  into  which it shall have been  changed,  or for which it shall have
been exchanged by stock dividend or stock split,  or the stock of a wholly-owned
subsidiary  corporation  shall have been  distributed to the stockholders of the
Company,  and this action equitably requires an adjustment in the number or kind
of shares then subject to an option or Options or an adjustment in the number or
kind of shares  which may  become  subject  to an option  under this Plan and an
adjustment in the option prices therefor,  such adjustment or adjustments  shall
be made in  accordance  with the  determination  by the  Committee,  and  notice
thereof shall be given by the Company to each Optionee and such adjustment shall
be effective and binding for all purposes of this Plan.

6.   Granting of Options.

        The  Committee,  is authorized  to grant  options to selected  employees
pursuant to this Plan during the  calendar  year 1981 and in any  calendar  year
thereafter to May 31, 1991 but not thereafter.  The number of shares optioned in
each year,  the employees to whom options are granted,  and the number of Shares
optioned to each employee  selected shall be wholly within the discretion
<PAGE>
of the  Committee,  subject  to the  limitations  prescribed  in  Section  4 and
provided  that the  aggregate  fair  market  value of the  stock  for  which any
employee may be granted  incentive  stock options in any calendar year under the
Plan and all other  incentive  stock option plans  maintained by the Company and
its parent and subsidiary  corporations  shall not exceed the sum of One Hundred
Thousand Dollars  ($100,000) plus any unused limit carryover  applicable to such
year under Section 422A(c)(4) of the Code.

7.   Terms of Stock Options.

     The terms of stock options granted under this Plan shall be as follows:

     (a)  The Option price shall be fixed by the Committee but shall in no event
be less than 100 percent of the fair market  value of the shares  subject to the
option on the date the  option is  granted,  except in the case of an  incentive
stock  option  granted to an employee who at the time the option is granted owns
stock  possessing more than 10 percent of the total combined voting power of all
classes of stock of the Company or of its parent or subsidiary  corporation  the
option price shall be at least 110 percent of the fair market value of the stock
subject to the option.

     (b)  Options  shall not be  transferable  otherwise  than by will or by the
laws of descent and  distribution.  No option  shall be subject,  in whole or in
part, to attachment, execution or levy of any kind.

     (c)  Each option  shall expire and all rights  thereunder  shall end at the
expiration  of such period  (which  shall not be more than ten years)  after the
date on which it was granted as shall be fixed by the Committee,  subject in all
cases to  earlier  expiration  as  provided  in  paragraphs  (d) and (e) of this
Section 7 in the event of  termination  of  employment  or death,  and  provided
further that in the case of an incentive stock option granted to an employee who
at the time the option is granted owns stock  possessing more than 10 percent of
the total  combined  voting  power of all classes of stock of the Company or its
parent  or  subsidiary  corporations  such  option  by  its  terms  will  not be
exercisable  after the  expiration  of five  years  from the date the  option is
granted.

     (d)  During the  lifetime of an Optionee,  his option shall be  exercisable
only by him and only while  employed by the Company or a  Subsidiary,  or within
(i) one year after  termination of employment in the case of any employee who is
disabled  (within  the meaning of Section  105(d)(4)  of the Code) or (ii) three
months after he otherwise  ceases to be so employed  (but in any event not later
than  the end of the  period  fixed  by the  Committee  in  accordance  with the
provisions  of paragraph of this Section 7), if and to the extent the option was
exercisable by him on the last day of such employment.

     (e)  If an Optionee dies within a period during which his option could have
been exercised by him, his option may be exercised at any time during the period
in which Optionee could have exercised the option had Optionee survived (or such
other or shorter  period as may be provided by the Committee in accordance  with
applicable regulations issued with respect to the Code).

     (f)  Subject to the  foregoing  terms and to such  additional  or different
terms  regarding the exercise of the options as the Committee may fix at time of
<PAGE>
grant,  options  may be  exercised  in whole at one time or in part from time to
time.

     (g)  No incentive  stock option granted under the Plan shall be exercisable
while there is  outstanding  (within the  meaning of Section  422A(c)(7)  of the
Code) any incentive  stock option which was granted  before the granting of such
option,  to such Optionee to purchase stock in the Company or in any corporation
which (at the time of the  granting of such  option) was a parent or  subsidiary
Corporation   of  the  Company  or  a  predecessor   corporation   of  any  such
corporations.  Under Section 422A(c)(7) of the Code an incentive stock option is
treated as  outstanding  until such  option is  exercised  in full or expires by
reason of lapse of time.

8.   Reorganization of the Company.

         In the event that the Company is succeeded by another  corporation in a
re  organization,  merger,  consolidation,  acquisition  of  property  or stock,
separation  or  liquidation,   the  successor   corporation   shall  assume  the
outstanding  options granted under this Plan or shall substitute new options for
them

9.   Delivery of Shares.

     No shares  shall be  delivered  upon the  exercise  of an option  until the
option  price  has  been  paid  in full in cash  or,  at the  discretion  of the
Committee,  in  whole  or in part in the  Company's  Common  Stock  owned by the
Optionee valued at fair market value on the date of exercise. If required by the
Committee no shares will be  delivered  upon the exercise of an option until the
Optionee has given the Company (a) a satisfactory  written  statement that he is
purchasing  the  shares  for  investment  and  not  with a view  to the  sale or
distribution of any such shares,  (b) a written agreement not to sell any shares
received upon the exercise of the option or any other shares of the Company that
he may then own or thereafter  acquire except either (i) through a broker on the
New York Stock Exchange or another national securities exchange or (ii) with the
prior  written  agreement  of the Company and an agreement  satisfactory  to the
Committee  providing for either payment by Optionee to the Company or permitting
deduction by the Company  from any amounts  owing to Optionee of an amount equal
to any Federal,  state or local taxes of any kind required by law to be withheld
with respect to the shares subject to the option. The granting of any option and
the  obligation  of the Company to sell and deliver stock under any option shall
be subject to the approval of any  governmental  authority which may be required
in  connection  either  with the grant of the option or with the  authorization,
issuance or sale of such stock.

10.  Continuation of Employment.

         Neither this Plan nor any option  granted  hereunder  shall confer upon
any  employee  any right to  Continue  in the  employment  of the Company or any
Subsidiary or limit in any respect the right of the Company or any Subsidiary to
terminate his employment at any time.

11.     Amendments.

         The Board may from time to time alter,  amend,  suspend or  discontinue
the Plan and make rules for its administration;  provided, however, that subject
to 
<PAGE>
the provisions of Section 5, unless the  stockholders  of the Company shall have
first approved thereof, (i) the total number of shares authorized under the Plan
shall not be increased, (ii) the minimum option price specified in Section 7, or
the exercise  price (or formula for its  computation)  as to previously  granted
options,  shall not be changed,  except that  stockholder  approval shall not be
required if the minimum  option  price is  increased,  (iii) no option  shall be
exercisable  more  than ten (10)  years  after the date it is  granted,  (iv) no
change shall be made in the class of employees to whom options may be granted or
awards made, and (v) the expiration date of this Plan shall not be extended. The
expiration date shall be May 31, 1991, or such earlier date as the Board, In its
discretion,  may determine. Any option outstanding under the Plan at the date of
termination  shall  remain in effect  until it shall have been  exercised  or it
shall have expired as herein otherwise provided.

12.  Effective Date.

     The Plan shall become effective June 1, 1981,  provided,  however,  that no
option may be exercised  unless this Plan is approved by the stockholders at the
next annual meeting of the  stockholders  or at a special  meeting held for that
purpose  within  twelve  months after the  effective  date.  No  termination  or
amendment may adversely affect the rights of an Optionee without his consent.
          
                                    EXHIBIT B

                             1981 Stock Option Plan

1.   Paragraph 6 shall be amended as follows:

     The Committee is authorized to grant options to selected Employees pursuant
to this Plan during the calendar year 1986 and any calendar  year  thereafter to
December 31, 1991,  but not  thereafter.  The number of shares  optioned in each
year,  the  Employees  to whom  options  are  granted,  and the number of Shares
optioned to each Employee  selected shall be wholly within the discretion of the
Committee,  subject to the limitations  described in Section 4 and provided that
the aggregate  fair market value of option stock  (determined at the time of the
Incentive  Stock Option grant) for which Incentive Stock Options are exercisable
for the first  time  under the terms of the Plan and all other  Incentive  Stock
Option  plans   maintained  by  the  Company  and  its  parent  and   Subsidiary
corporations,  by any employee during any calendar year after December 31, 1986,
cannot exceed $100,000.


2.   Paragraph 7(g) shall be amended by inserting the language "prior to January
     1, 1987" into the first sentence thereof as follows:

     7(g) No Incentive  Stock Option  granted under the Plan prior to January 1,
     1987 shall be exercisable while there is outstanding (within the meaning of
     Section  422A(c)(7)  of the  Code) any  Incentive  Stock  Option  which was
     granted before the granting of such option . . .
<PAGE>
                                 THIRD AMENDMENT
                           TO THE DEL WEBB CORPORATION
                             1981 STOCK OPTION PLAN
                  
     1.   This Third  Amendment shall only amend that Section  specified  herein
and the remaining  provisions of the Plan not so amended are hereby ratified and
affirmed.

     2.   Section 9 of the Plan is hereby amended and restated as follows:

          No shares shall be delivered  upon the exercise of an option
          until the price,  if any, that is due upon exercise has been
          paid  in  full  in  cash,  or,  at  the  discretion  of  the
          Committee, in whole or in part in the Company's common stock
          owned by the  Optionee  valued at fair  market  value on the
          date of exercise.  if required by the  Committee,  no Shares
          will be  delivered  upon the exercise of an option until the
          Optionee  has given the Company (a) a  satisfactory  written
          statement  that he is purchasing  the Shares for  investment
          and not with a view to the sale or  distribution of any such
          Shares,  or (b) a written  agreement  not to sell any Shares
          received upon the exercise of the option or any other Shares
          that he may then own or thereafter acquire except either (i)
          through a broker on the New York Stock  Exchange  or another
          national  securities exchange or (ii) with the prior written
          agreement  of  the  Company.  With  respect  to  withholding
          required  upon the  exercise  of an option or upon any other
          taxable event,  Optionees  shall satisfy all Federal,  state
          and local taxes required by law to be withheld by having the
          Company  withhold  Shares  (to the  extent  that  Shares are
          issued) having a fair market value on the date the tax is to
          be determined  equal to the maximum marginal total tax which
          would be imposed on the  transaction.  The  granting  of any
          option and the obligation of the Company to sell and deliver
          stock under any option  shall be subject to the  approval of
          any   governmental   authority  which  may  be  required  in
          connection  either  with the grant of the option or with the
          authorization, issuance or sale of such stock.

     3.   This Third Amendment shall be effective June 30, 1993.

                                                                   Exhibit 10.19


                                                                      As Amended
                                                                January 27, 1987
                                                                   June 30, 1993
                                                                   June 20, 1996

                                  


                        STOCK OPTION AND SAR PLAN OF THE
                        --------------------------------
                             DEL E. WEBB CORPORATION
                             -----------------------


1.   Purpose of Plan
     ---------------

     The purpose of this Plan is to enable Del E. Webb  Corporation  and certain
     of its  Subsidiaries to continue to compete  successfully in attracting and
     retaining key employees  with  outstanding  abilities by making it possible
     for them to obtain Shares of the Company's common stock on terms which will
     give them a more direct and  continuing  interest in the future  success of
     the Company's  business.  It is intended that options granted hereunder may
     be either  Incentive  Stock  Options  under  section  422A of the  Internal
     Revenue  Code or  nonqualified  options  and that SARs may be  granted  and
     exercised   together   with  either  of  these  two  types  of  options  or
     independently  from any such  option,  subject to the terms and  conditions
     specified hereinafter.

2.   Definition
     ----------

     When used in the Plan, the following terms shall have the meaning specified
     below.

     (a)  "Board" means the Board of Directors of the Company.

     (b)  "Code"  means the Internal  Revenue  Code of 1954,  as amended and any
          successor provision.

     (c)  "Committee"  means a committee  established by the Board consisting of
          three  or more  members  of the  Board,  none of whom is  eligible  to
          receive  options under the Plan and each of whom is a  "disinterested"
          person  (within  the  meaning of Rule 16b-3 of the  General  Rules and
          Regulations  under the  Securities  Exchange  Act of 1934).  The Human
          Resources   Committee  may  be  this   committee  if  it  meets  these
          qualifications.
                                       -1-
<PAGE>
     (d)  "Company" means Del E. Webb Corporation, an Arizona corpo ration.

     (e)  "Employees"  means employees,  (including  employees who are directors
          and/or officers)  regularly  employed on a salary basis by the Company
          or by a Subsidiary.

     (f)  "Incentive  Stock  Option"  means  an  option  designed  to  meet  the
          requirements of Section 422A(b) of the Code.

     (g)  "Optionee" means a person to whom an option or an SAR has been granted
          under  this  Plan  which  has not  expired  or been  fully  exercised,
          surrendered, or forfeited.

     (h)  "Plan"  means the Del E. Webb  Corporation  1986 Stock  Option and SAR
          Plan.

     (i)  "SARs" means stock appreciation rights granted under the Plan.

     (j)  "Shares"  means shares of common  stock of the Company,  or such other
          substituted shares as may replace them pursuant to section 5 hereof.

     (k)  "Subsidiary" means a subsidiary corporation of the Company (within the
          meaning of section 425(f) of the Code).

3.   Administration
     --------------

     The Plan  shall be  administered  by the  Committee  which  shall  adopt by
     resolution  such rules and regulations as may be required in order to carry
     out  the  purpose  of the  Plan,  as well as the  form  of  option  and SAR
     agreements  and any other forms  required in connection  with the Plan. All
     questions of  interpretation,  administration  and  application of the Plan
     shall be determined by a majority of the Committee and the determination of
     such majority
                                      -2-
<PAGE>
     shall be final and binding  upon all  persons in  interest,  including  the
     Company and its shareholders and all Optionees.

4.   Number of Shares
     ----------------

     The grants of options or SARs to obtain  common stock of the Company  shall
     not permit the  acquisition  of a number of Shares  which in the  aggregate
     exceeds 600,000 Shares;  provided,  however, that in the event that options
     or SARs  granted  under the Plan shall  terminate or expire  without  being
     exercised,  in whole or in part,  the Shares  subject  to such  unexercised
     options  may  again be  subjected  to an option  or SAR  under  this  Plan.
     Provided further, the number of Shares shall be adjusted to reflect changes
     or other  adjustments  in the number of  outstanding  Shares as hereinafter
     provided in section 5. The Shares to be so made subject to an option or SAR
     under this Plan shall be shares of common stock of the Company  either held
     in the Company's  treasury or authorized  and unissued  common stock of the
     Company,  or some of each.  The  Company  shall be under no  obligation  to
     reserve or to retain in its treasury any particular number of Shares at any
     time,  and no  particular  Shares,  whether  unissued  or held as  treasury
     Shares, shall be identified as those subject to an option or SAR under this
     Plan.

5.   Change in Capitalization
     ------------------------

     In  the  event  that  the  common  stock  of  the  Company,   as  presently
     constituted,  shall be changed into or exchanged for a different  number or
     kind of shares of stock or other  securities  of the  Company or of another
     corporation    (whether   by   merger,    consolidation,    reorganization,
     recapitalization,  combination of shares or otherwise), then there shall be
     substituted for each Share heretofore  appropriated for use in the Plan the
     number and kind of shares of stock or other securities into which each such
     Share shall be  exchanged.  In the event that there should be any change in
     the  number  or kind of  outstanding  Shares  of the  common  stock  of the
     Company,  or of any stock or other securities into which it shall
                                      -3-
<PAGE>
     have been  changed,  or for which it shall  have  been  exchanged  by stock
     dividend  or  stock  split,  or  the  stock  of a  wholly-owned  Subsidiary
     corporation shall have been distributed to the stockholders of the Company,
     and this action  equitably  requires an adjustment in the number or kind of
     Shares then  subject to options or SARs or an  adjustment  in the number or
     kind of Shares which may become subject to an option or SAR under this Plan
     and an  adjustment  in the option or SAR  exercise  prices  therefor,  such
     adjustment  or   adjustments   shall  be  made  in   accordance   with  the
     determination  by the  Committee,  and notice thereof shall be given by the
     Company to each Optionee and such adjustment shall be effective and binding
     for all purposes of this Plan.

6.   Granting of Options
     -------------------

     The Committee is authorized to grant options to selected Employees pursuant
     to this  Plan  during  the  calendar  year  1986 and in any  calendar  year
     thereafter  to December 31, 1995 but not  thereafter.  The number of Shares
     optioned in each year,  the Employees to whom options are granted,  and the
     number of Shares optioned to each Employee selected, shall be wholly within
     the discretion of the Committee,  subject to the limitations  prescribed in
     section 4 and provided  that the  aggregate  fair market value of the stock
     for which any  Employee  may be  granted  Incentive  Stock  Options  in any
     calendar  year under the Plan and all other  Incentive  Stock  Option plans
     maintained by the Company and its parent and Subsidiary  corporations shall
     not exceed the sum of $100,000 plus any unused limit  carryover  applicable
     to such year under section 422A(c) (4) of the Code.

7.   Terms of Stock Options
     ----------------------

     Stock  options  granted  under  this Plan shall be  evidenced  by a written
     agreement indicating whether the option being granted is an Incentive Stock
     Option, a nonqualified option, or a combination of these two types and also
     whether or not the option is initially
                                      -4-
<PAGE>
     coupled with an SAR.  Nonqualified  options  shall not be granted in tandem
     with an Incentive  Stock Option under terms  providing that the exercise of
     one affects the right to exercise the other.  Each stock  option  agreement
     shall  specify  the  number of Shares  subject  to the  option,  the option
     exercise  price  per  Share,  and the  times at  which  the  option  may be
     exercised.  In addition,  each such agreement  shall ensure that the option
     complies with the following  conditions and shall explicitly  include terms
     indicating compliance with the rules in paragraphs (b), (c), and (g) below.

     (a)  The option exercise price shall be fixed by the Committee but shall in
          no event be less  than 100  percent  of the fair  market  value of the
          Shares subject to the option on the date the option is granted, except
          in the case of an Incentive Stock Option granted to an Employee who at
          the time the option is  granted  owns  stock  possessing  more than 10
          percent of the total combined  voting power of all classes of stock of
          the Company or of its parent or  Subsidiary  corporations,  the option
          price shall be at least 110  percent of the fair  market  value of the
          stock subject to the option.

     (b)  Options  shall not be  transferable  otherwise  than by will or by the
          laws of descent and distribution. No option shall be subject, in whole
          or in part, to attachment, execution or levy of any kind.

     (c)  Each option  shall expire and all rights  thereunder  shall end at the
          expiration  of such  period  (which  shall  not be more than ten years
          after  the  date on  which  it was  granted)  as shall be fixed by the
          Committee,  provided  that in the case of an  Incentive  Stock  Option
          granted to an  Employee  who at the time the  option is  granted  owns
          stock  possessing  more than 10 percent of the total  combined  voting
          power  of all  classes  of  stock  of the  Company  or its  parent  or
          Subsidiary   corporations  such  option  by  its  terms  will  not  be
          exercisable  after  the  expiration  of five  years  from the date the
          option is granted.
                                      -5-
<PAGE>
     (d)  During the  lifetime of an Optionee,  his option shall be  exercisable
          only by him and only while employed by the Company or a Subsidiary, or
          within (i) one year after termination of employment in the case of any
          Employee who is disabled  (within the meaning of section  105(d)(4) of
          the Code) or (ii)  three  months  after he  otherwise  ceases to be so
          employed  (but in any event not later than the end of the period fixed
          by the Committee in accordance with the provisions of paragraph (c) of
          this  section 7), if and to the extent the option was  exercisable  by
          him on the last day of such employment.

     (e)  If an Optionee dies within a period during which his option could have
          been  exercised by him, his option may be exercised at any time during
          the  period in which  Optionee  could  have  exercised  the option had
          Optionee  survived (or such other or shorter period as may be provided
          by the Committee in accordance with applicable regulations issued with
          respect to the Code).

     (f)  Subject to the  foregoing  terms and to such  additional  or different
          terms  regarding  the exercise of the options as the Committee may fix
          at time of grant,  options may be exercised in whole at one time or in
          part from time to time.

     (g)  No Incentive  Stock Option granted under the Plan shall be exercisable
          while there is outstanding  (within the meaning of Section  422A(c)(7)
          of the Code) any Incentive  Stock Option which was granted  before the
          granting of such  option,  to such  Optionee to purchase  stock in the
          Company or in any  corporation  which (at the time of the  granting of
          such option) was a parent or Subsidiary  corporation of the Company or
          a prede cessor  corporation  of any such  corporations.  Under section
          422A(c)(7)  of the Code,  an  Incentive  Stock  Option is  treated  as
          outstanding  until  such  option is  exercised  in full or  expires by
          reason  of  lapse  of  time.  These  rules  shall  not  apply  to  any
          nonqualified options granted under the Plan.
                                      -6-
<PAGE>
8.   Granting of SARs
     ----------------
          
     The Committee may from time to time grant SARs in  conjunction  with all or
     any part of any option granted under the Plan either (i) at the time of the
     initial option grant (not including any subsequent modification that may be
     treated as a new grant of an  Incentive  Stock  Option for purposes of Code
     section 425(h)) or (ii) with respect to nonqualified  options,  at any time
     thereafter  while the nonqualified  option is outstanding.  At any time and
     for any period  during which options could have been granted and allowed to
     be  exercised  under this Plan,  stand-alone  SARs may also be granted  and
     allowed to be exercised  other than in  conjunction  with an option granted
     under the Plan.

9.   Terms of SARs
     -------------   

     SARs granted under the Plan shall comply with the following  conditions and
     also with the  terms of the  agreement  governing  the SARs or an option in
     conjunction with which the SARs may be granted.

     (a)  Upon the exercise of an SAR, the Optionee shall be entitled to receive
          payment equal to the excess of the aggregate  fair market value of the
          Shares  with  respect  to  which  the  SAR  is  then  being  exercised
          (determined  as of the date of such  exercise)  over (i) the aggregate
          option  exercise  price  of such  Shares,  or  (ii)  in the  case of a
          stand-alone  SAR,  the fair market value of such Shares on the date of
          the SAR grant.  Payment  may be made in  Shares,  valued at their fair
          market value on the date of  exercise,  or in cash or partly in Shares
          and partly in cash, as set forth in the governing agreement.

     (b)  SARs  shall  be  exercisable  only  during  such  periods  as  may  be
          permissible  without  causing the  Optionee to incur  liability  under
          Section  16(b) of the  Securities  Exchange Act of 1934.  In addition,
          SARs that are tied to a related option shall be  exercisable  (i) only
          at such time or times and only to the
                                      -7-
<PAGE>
          extent that the option to which they relate shall be exercisable; (ii)
          only when the fair market  value of the Shares  subject to the related
          option exceeds the exercise price of that option;  and (iii) only upon
          surrender  of the related  option or any part  thereof with respect to
          the Shares for which the SARs are then being exercised.

     (c)  All  SARs  granted  under  the  Plan  shall  by  their  terms  not  be
          transferable  otherwise  than by will or by the  laws of  descent  and
          distribution  and shall be  exercisable  during  the  lifetime  of the
          Optionee,  only by the  Optionee  or, in the event he becomes  legally
          incompetent, his legal representative.

     (d)  Upon exercise of an SAR, a  corresponding  number of Shares subject to
          the SAR (or to the related  option,  if there is such an option) shall
          be canceled.  Such canceled Shares shall be charged against the Shares
          reserved  for the Plan to the extent of the SAR  exercise  (or, in the
          case of a related option,  as if the option had been exercised to such
          extent)  and shall not be  available  for future  option or SAR grants
          under the Plan.

10.  Reorganization of the Company
     -----------------------------

     In the event that the  Company is  succeeded  by another  corporation  in a
     reorganization,  merger,  consolidation,  acquisition of property or stock,
     separation  or  liquidation,  the  successor  corporation  shall assume the
     outstanding options granted under this Plan or shall substitute new options
     for them.

11.  Delivery of Shares
     ------------------

     No Shares  shall be  delivered  upon the exercise of an option or SAR until
     the price, if any, that is due upon exercise has been paid in full in cash,
     or,  at the  discretion  of the  Committee,  in  whole  or in  part  in the
     Company's common stock owned by the Optionee valued at fair market value on
     the date of  exercise.  If  required  by the 
                                      -8-
<PAGE>
     Committee,  no Shares will be  delivered  upon the exercise of an option or
     SAR until the  Optionee  has given the Company (a) a  satisfactory  written
     statement  that he is purchasing  the Shares for  investment and not with a
     view  to the  sale  or  distribution  of any  such  Shares,  (b) a  written
     agreement  not to sell any Shares  received upon the exercise of the option
     or SAR or any  other  Shares  that he may  then own or  thereafter  acquire
     except  either  (i)  through a broker  on the New York  Stock  Exchange  or
     another  national  securities  exchange  or (ii)  with  the  prior  written
     agreement  of  the  Company,  and  (c)  an  agreement  satisfactory  to the
     Committee  providing  for either  payment by the Optionee to the Company or
     permitting  deduction by the Company from any amounts  owing to Optionee of
     an amount equal to any Federal,  state or local taxes of any kind  required
     by law to be  withheld  with  respect to the Shares  being  acquired by the
     Optionee.  The  granting  of any  option or SAR and the  obligation  of the
     Company to sell and deliver  stock under any option or SAP shall be subject
     to the  approval  of any  governmental  authority  which may be required in
     connection  either  with  the  grant  of the  option  or SAR  or  with  the
     authorization, issuance or sale of such stock.

12.  Continuation of Employment
     --------------------------

     Neither this Plan nor any option or SAR granted hereunder shall confer upon
     any  Employee  any right to  continue  in the employ of the  Company or any
     Subsidiary  or  limit  in any  respect  the  right  of the  Company  or any
     Subsidiary to terminate his employment at any time.

13.  Amendments
     ----------

     The Board may from time to time alter,  amend,  suspend or discontinue  the
     Plan and make rules for its administration; provided, however, that subject
     to the  provisions  of Section 5,  unless the  stockholders  of the Company
     shall  have  first  approved  thereof,  (i)  the  total  number  of  Shares
     authorized under the Plan shall not be increased, (ii) the minimum exercise
     price  specified  in section 7,
                                      -9-
<PAGE>
     the SAR settlement  formula  specified in section 9, and the exercise price
     (or formula for its computation) as to previously  granted options or SARs,
     shall  not be  changed,  except  that  stockholder  approval  shall  not be
     required if the minimum option price is increased, (iii) no option shall be
     exercisable  more than ten  years  after  the date it is  granted,  (iv) no
     change  shall be made in the  class of  Employees  to whom  options  may be
     granted or awards made, and (v) the expiration  date of this Plan shall not
     be  extended.  The  expiration  date shall be December  31,  1995,  or such
     earlier date as the Board,  in its  discretion,  may determine.  Any option
     outstanding  under  the Plan at the date of  termination  shall  remain  in
     effect  until it shall  have been  exercised  or it shall  have  expired as
     herein otherwise provided.

14.  Effective Date
     --------------

     The Plan is effective January 1, 1986;  provided that this Plan is approved
     by the  stockholders at the next annual meeting of the stockholders or at a
     special  meeting  held for that  purpose  within  twelve  months  after the
     effective  date of the Plan.  No  termination  or amendment of the Plan may
     adversely  affect the rights of an  Optionee as to any  previously  granted
     option or SAP without his consent.
                                      -10-
<PAGE>
                                    EXHIBIT A

                         1986 Stock Option and SAR Plan

1.   Paragraph 6 shall be amended as follows:

     The Committee is authorized to grant options to selected Employees pursuant
to this Plan during the calendar year 1986 and any calendar  year  thereafter to
December 31, 1995,  but not  thereafter.  The number of shares  optioned in each
year,  the  Employees  to whom  options  are  granted,  and the number of Shares
optioned to each Employee  selected shall be wholly within the discretion of the
Committee,  subject to the limitations  described in Section 4 and provided that
the aggregate  fair market value of option stock  (determined at the time of the
Incentive  Stock Option grant) for which Incentive Stock Options are exercisable
for the first  time  under the terms of the Plan and all other  Incentive  Stock
Option  plans   maintained  by  the  Company  and  its  parent  and   Subsidiary
corporations,  by any employee during any calendar year after December 31, 1986,
cannot exceed $100,000.

2.   Paragraph 7(g) shall be amended by inserting the language "prior to January
     1, 1987" into the first sentence thereof as follows:

     7(g) No Incentive  Stock Option  granted under the Plan prior to January 1,
     1987 shall be exercisable while there is outstanding (within the meaning of
     Section  422A(c)(7)  of the  Code) any  Incentive  Stock  Option  which was
     granted before the granting of such option . .
<PAGE>
                      AMENDMENTS TO DEL E. WEBB CORPORATION
                             1981 STOCK OPTION PLAN
                                       AND
                         1986 STOCK OPTION AND SAR PLAN

     RESOLVED,  that in accordance with the respective  provisions of each Plan,
the Board of Directors proposes to exercise its retained authority to amend each
Plan by adding a provision to each Plan to the following effect:

          "Cancellation  of  Options.  With  the  written  consent  of
          consent of an  Optionee,  the Company may at any time cancel
          all or any part of any  unexercised  Stock  Option  [or SAR]
          previously granted  hereunder,  whereupon any Shares subject
          to such canceled  Stock Option or SAR may again be subjected
          to a Stock Option or SAR granted under this Plan."
<PAGE>
                                SECOND AMENDMENT
                                     TO THE
                         1986 STOCK OPTION AND SAR PLAN
                           OF THE DEL WEBB CORPORATION


     1. This Second Amendment shall only amend that Section specified herein and
the  remaining  provisions  of the Plan not so amended are hereby  ratified  and
affirmed.

     2. Section 11 of the Plan is hereby amended and restated as follows:

          No Shares shall be delivered  upon the exercise of an option
          or SAR until the price,  if any,  that is due upon  exercise
          has been paid in full in cash,  or, at the discretion of the
          Committee, in whole or in part in the Company's common stock
          owned by the  Optionee  valued at fair  market  value on the
          date of exercise.  If required by the  Committee,  no Shares
          will be  delivered  upon the  exercise  of an  option or SAR
          until the Optionee has given the Company (a) a  satisfactory
          written  statement  that he is  purchasing  the  Shares  for
          investment  and not with a view to the sale or  distribution
          of any such Shares,  or (b) a written  agreement not to sell
          any Shares  received  upon the exercise of the option or SAR
          or any  other  Shares  that he may  then  own or  thereafter
          acquire  except  either (i) through a broker on the New York
          Stock Exchange or another  national  securities  exchange or
          (ii) with the prior written  agreement of the Company.  With
          respect to  withholding  required  upon the  exercise  of an
          option  or upon any other  taxable  event,  Optionees  shall
          satisfy all Federal,  state and local taxes  required by law
          to be withheld by having the Company withhold Shares (to the
          extent that Shares are issued) having a fair market value on
          the date the tax is to be  determined  equal to the  maximum
          marginal   total  tax  which   would  be   imposed   on  the
          transaction.  The  granting  of any  option  or SAR  and the
          obligation  of the Company to sell and delivery  stock under
          any option or SAR shall be subject 
<PAGE>
          to the approval of any  governmental  authority which may be
          required in  connection  either with the grant of the option
          or SAR or with the  authorization,  issuance or sale of such
          stock.

     3.   This Second Amendment shall be effective June 30, 1993.
                                 -2-

                                                                  Exhibit 10.22


                             FIRST AMENDMENT TO THE
                             RETIREMENT SAVINGS PLAN
                    FOR THE EMPLOYEES OF DEL WEBB CORPORATION

         Effective  January 1, 1976,  Del E. Webb  Corporation  established  the
"Retirement  Savings  Plan for the  Employees of Del E. Webb  Corporation",  now
known as the "Retirement Savings Plan For the Employees of Del Webb Corporation"
(the  "Plan").  Del E.  Webb  Corporation  later  changed  its  name to Del Webb
Corporation and recently merged into a Delaware  corporation that bears the same
name and  assumed  its role as  sponsor of the Plan and is  referred  to in this
document as the  "Company".  The Company most recently  amended and restated the
Plan in its entirety  effective  January 1, 1995.  By this First  Amendment  the
Company  intends to  incorporate  certain  technical  changes  requested  by the
Internal  Revenue  Service in  connection  with the  Company's  Application  For
Determination with respect to the Plan filed on September 8, 1995.

         1.    The provisions of this First  Amendment  shall be effective as of
January 1, 1996.  This First  Amendment  shall amend only the  provisions of the
Plan as set forth herein,  and those  provisions  not expressly  amended  hereby
shall be considered in full force and effect.

         2.    Section  2.1(z) of the Plan is hereby amended and restated in its
entirety to provide as follows:

         (z)   "On Call  Employee"  shall mean an Employee who is a member of an
               administrative  or clerical pool who does not have a regular work
               schedule and who works on an as needed basis.  An Employee who is
               temporarily  absent  from work due to a  seasonal  adjustment  or
               layoff is not an On Call Employee.  For the purposes of this Plan
               only, an "ask me employee"  shall also be considered to be an "On
               Call Employee".  An "ask me employee" is a resident of a Del Webb
               community who is intermittently  available to answer questions of
               prospective   residents.   For   example,   "ask  me   employees"
               occasionally  man  lemonade  stands at model home sites and field
               questions of prospective residents.

         3.  Section 2. 1(hh) of the Plan is hereby  amended and restated in its
entirety to provide as follows:

         (hh)  "Temporary  Employee" shall mean any Employee who, at the time he
               commences employment, 1) has a known end date, or (2) is hired to
               perform  a  specific   short-term  task.  Examples  of  Temporary
               Employees  include  summer interns and golf course  seeders.  Any
               determination  as to whether an Employee is a Temporary  Employee
               shall be made in a uniform  and  nondiscriminatory  manner by the
               Company  or  the  Affiliate   that  employs  the  Employee.   Any
               determination so made shall be final and binding on all parties.

         4.  Section  9.3  of  the  Plan  is  hereby  amended  by  adding  a new
subparagraph (C) to the end thereof as follows:

         (c)   Notwithstanding  anything  herein to the  contrary,  the  maximum
               amount  that  may  be   returned  to  the  Company   pursuant  to
               subparagraphs (a) and (b) above is limited to the portion of such
               contribution  attributable  to the mistake of fact or the portion
               of  such   contribution   deemed   non-deductible   (the  "excess
               contribution").  Earnings attributable to the excess contribution
               will not be  returned  to the  Company,  but losses  attributable
               thereto will reduce the amount returned.

         IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the Company has caused this First Amendment to be
signed by its duly authorized representative as of this 10th day of June, 1996.

                                DEL WEBB CORPORATION



                                By: /s/ Lynn Schuttenberg, Vice President
                                    -------------------------------------
                                    Its: Chairman, Benefits Advisory Committee

                                       


                                 AMENDMENT No. 2                   Exhibit 10.23
                                       TO

                            THE DEL WEBB CORPORATION

                                 UMBRELLA TRUST


         THIS  AMENDMENT to the Del Webb  corporation  Umbrella Trust is entered
into by and  between  Del  Webb  Corporation  and The  Valley  National  Bank of
Arizona,  N.A., is effective as of January 1, 1990,  and has been executed as of
this 14 day of March, 1990.

         WHEREAS,  Del Webb  Corporation (the "COMPANY") has established the Del
Webb Corporation  Umbrella Trust (the "Trust")  effective June 11, 1987 with The
Valley National Bank of Arizona, N.A. as Trustee (the "Trustee"), and

         WHEREAS,  the  Company  intends to include the  Supplemental  Executive
Retirement Plan II within the Trust; and

         WHEREAS,  the  Trust  inadvertently  fails  to  provide  a means to add
additional plans to the Trust; and

         WHEREAS,  pursuant to Section 7.02 of the Trust, the right to amend the
Trust is reserved to the Company and the  Trustee,  with the Written  Consent of
Participants; and

         WHEREAS,  the  Company  and  Trustee,   with  the  Written  Consent  of
Participants, have approved the amendment to the Trust;

         NOW, THEREFORE, the Trust is amended as follows:

         Section 1.05 shall be added as follows:

         1.05 Plans Covered.
              --------------

                  1.05-1  The  following  Plans are  subject  to the  Trust:  a)
         Supplemental  Executive  Retirement Plan I; b)  Supplemental  Executive
         Retirement Plan II.

                  1.05-2  Prior  to the  occurrence  of a  Triggering  Event  as
         described  in Section  2.01-2 or a Change in Control  as  described  in
         Section 1.04-2,  the Company,  in its sole discretion,  shall designate
         such benefit plans as it may determine  from time to time to be subject
         to the Trust.
<PAGE>
                                 AMENDMENT NO. 2

                                       TO

                            THE DEL WEBB CORPORATION

                                 UMBRELLA TRUST
                                   (Continued)

         Except  as  herein  before  amended,  all of the  remaining  terms  and
provisions of the Trust shall remain in full force and effect.




                                            DEL WEBB CORPORATION

                                       By: /s/ David E. Rau
                                           --------------------------------
                                       Its: Vice President - Taxes
                                           --------------------------------

                                           THE VALLEY NATIONAL BANK OF
                                           ARIZONA, N.A..

                                           By: /s/ Verna M. Hegeman
                                           --------------------------------
                                           Its: Assistant Vice President
                                           --------------------------------
<PAGE>
                              DEL WEBB CORPORATION

                                 UMBRELLA TRUST

                         WRITTEN CONSENT OF PARTICIPANTS




Consent to Amendment No. 2 to the Del Webb  Corporation  Umbrella Trust pursuant
to Section 7.02 is hereby given:



Date_________________________        /s/ Philip J. Dion
                                     -----------------------------------
                                         Philip J. Dion

Date_________________________       /s/ Ernest E. East
                                     -----------------------------------
                                        Ernest E. East

Date_________________________      /s/ John A. Spencer
                                     -----------------------------------
                                       John A. Spencer
<PAGE>
                                 AMENDMENT NO. 1

                                       TO

                            THE DEL WEBB CORPORATION

                               UMBRELLA TRUST (TM)




         THIS  AMENDMENT  to the Del Webb  Corporation  Umbrella  Trust  (TM) is
entered into by and between Del Webb Corporation and The Valley National Bank of
Arizona,  N.A., is effective as of January 1, 1989,  and has been executed as of
this 8th day of February, 1989

         WHEREAS,  Del Webb  Corporation (the "Company") has established the Del
Webb Corporation  Umbrella Trust (TM) (the "Trust") effective June 11, 1987 with
the Valley National Bank of Arizona, N.A. as Trustee (the "Trustee"); and

         WHEREAS,  the Trust  document was  submitted  to the  Internal  Revenue
Service ("IRS") for a letter ruling; and

         WHEREAS,  the IRS requested  certain revisions to the document prior to
issuing a favorable letter ruling; and

         WHEREAS, the Company has received a favorable letter ruling conditioned
on making the amendment to the Trust set forth below; and

         WHEREAS,  pursuant to Section 7.02 of the Trust, the right to amend the
Trust is reserved to the Company and the  Trustee,  with the Written  Consent of
Participants; and

         WHEREAS,  the  Company  and  Trustee,   with  the  Written  Consent  of
Participants, have approved the amendment of the Trust as follows:

         FIRST:  Article  I,  Section  1.02  paragraph  3 of the Trust  shall be
amended by adding a new first sentence to read as follows:

             1.02-3 This trust is intended to be unfunded for purposes of ERISA.

         SECOND:  Article  II,  Section  2.01  paragraph 2 of the Trust shall be
amended by replacing "shall" with "may" to read as follows:
                                                                             (1)
<PAGE>
                                 AMENDMENT NO. 1

                                       TO

                            THE DEL WEBB CORPORATION

                               UMBRELLA TRUST (TM)
                                   (Continued)


             2.01-2 The Company may,  upon the  occurrence  of any of the events
         described in 2.01-3 ("triggering  event"),  contribute to the trust the
         sum of the following:

         THIRD:  Article  V,  Section  5.01  paragraph  2 of the Trust  shall be
restated in its entirety to read as follows:

             5.01-2 The Chief  Executive  Officer and the Board of  Directors of
         the Company  shall  promptly  give notice to the Trustee upon  becoming
         Insolvent.  If the Trustee  receives  such notice or receives  from any
         other  person  claiming  to be a  creditor  of the  Company  a  written
         allegation   that  the  Company  is   Insolvent,   the  Trustee   shall
         independently determine whether such insolvency exists. The expenses of
         such determination  shall be allowed as administrative  expenses of the
         trust.

         FOURTH:  Article V,  Section  5.01  paragraph  3 of the Trust  shall be
restated in its entirety to read as follows:

             5.01-3  Upon  receipt  of the  notice of  allegation  described  in
         5.01-2,  the Trustee shall  discontinue  making payments from the trust
         fund to  participants  under the Plans,  and the Trustee shall commence
         Insolvency Administration under 5.02.


         EXCEPT  AS  HEREIN  BEFORE  AMENDED,  all of the  remaining  terms  and
provisions of the Trust shall remain in full force and effect.


                                     DEL WEBB CORPORATION

                                     By:/s/ David E. Rau
                                        --------------------------------------
                                        Its Vice President

                                     THE VALLEY NATIONAL BANK OF ARIZONA, N.A.

                                     By: /s/ Verna M. Hegeman
                                        --------------------------------------
                                         Its Assistant Vice President
                                                                             (2)
<PAGE>
                         WRITTEN CONSENT OF PARTICIPANTS


Consent  to amend the Del Webb  Corporation  Umbrella  Trust  (TM)  pursuant  to
Section 7.02 is hereby given:



Date:         2/9/89                      /s/Philip J. Dion
     ------------------------------       -------------------------------
                                             Philip J. Dion

Date:   February 9, 1989                  /s/Ernest E. East
     ------------------------------       -------------------------------
                                             Ernest E. East

Date:      2/9/89                         /s/John A. Spencer
     ------------------------------       -------------------------------
                                             John A. Spencer

Date:      2/9/89                         /s/Paul H. Tatz
     ------------------------------       -------------------------------
                                             Paul H. Tatz
<PAGE>
                             DEL E. WEBB CORPORATION

                                 UMBRELLA TRUST

                                   JUNE, 1987









Del E. Webb Corporation
3800 N. Central Avenue
Phoenix, Arizona  85038                                                 Company



The Valley National Bank
  of Arizona, N.A.
Trust Division
241 North Central Avenue
Phoenix, Arizona  85001                                                 Trustee
<PAGE>
                                TABLE OF CONTENTS




Preamble

                                                                            PAGE
                                                                            ----
ARTICLE I             Effective Date; Duration                                 2
                      1.01       Effective Date                                2
                      1.02       Duration                                      2
                      1.03       Revocability                                  4
                      1.04       Change in Control                             4

ARTICLE II            Trust      Fund                                          6
                      2.01       Contributions                                 6
                      2.02       Investments                                   9
                      2.03       Recapture of Excess Assets                   11
                      2.04       Subtrusts                                    11
                      2.05       Substitution of Other Property               12

ARTICLE III           Administration                                          12
                      3.01       Committee                                    12
                      3.02       Payment of Benefits                          13
                      3.03       Disputed Claims                              13
                      3.04       Records                                      15
                      3.05       Accountings                                  15
                      3.06       Expenses and Fees                            16

ARTICLE IV            Liability                                               16
                      4.01       Indemnity                                    16
                      4.02       Bonding                                      17
<PAGE>
                                TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                   (Continued)
                                                                            PAGE
                                                                            ----
ARTICLE V             Insolvency                                              17
                      5.01       Determination of Insolvency                  17
                      5.02       Insolvency Administration                    18
                      5.03       Termination of Insolvency
                                 Administration                               19
                      5.04       Creditors' Claims During Solvency            19

ARTICLE VI            Successor Trustees                                      20
                      6.01       Resignation and Removal                      20
                      6.02       Appointment of Successor                     20
                      6.03       Accountings; Continuity                      21

ARTICLE VII           General Provisions                                      22
                      7.01       Interests Not Assignable                     22
                      7.02       Amendment                                    22
                      7.03       Applicable Law                               23
                      7.04       Agreement Binding on All Parties             23
                      7.05       Notices and Directions                       23
                      7.06       No Implied Duties                            24


EXHIBIT A
<PAGE>
                                 INDEX OF TERMS



                  TERM                  PROVISION                    PAGE
- ---------------------------------       ---------                    ----

Act                                     1.04-2(a)                     5

Board                                   1.04-2(b)                     6

Change in Control                       1.04-2                        5
Committees                              Preamble                      1
Company                                 Heading                       1

ERISA Funding                           1.02-4                        4
Excess Assets                           2.03-2                       11

Insolvency Administration               5.02                         18
Insolvent                               5.01-1                       17

Plans                                   Preamble                      1

Solvency                                5.04-2                       20
Subtrusts                               2.04                         11

Trustee                                 Heading                       1
<PAGE>
                             DEL K. WEBB CORPORATION

                                 UMBRELLA TRUST

                                   JUNE, 1987


Del E. Webb Corporation
3800 N. Central Avenue
Phoenix, Arizona  85038                                           Company



The Valley National Bank 
  of Arizona, N.A.
Trust Division
241 North Central Avenue
Phoenix, Arizona  85001                                           Trustee


                   The Company has adopted the  following  plans (the Plans) for
the benefit of eligible executive employees and directors of the Company and its
affiliates:
                   Del K. Webb Corporation Executive Deferred 
                   Compensation Plan

                   Del E. Webb  Corporation  Supplemental  Executive
                   Retirement Plan

The Plans are  administered  by the Company's  Benefits  Advisory  Committee and
Human  Resources  Committee,  respectively  (the  Committees),  appointed by the
Company. The purpose of this trust is to give Plan participants greater security
by  placing  assets  in trust for them for use only to pay  benefits  or, if the
Company  becomes  insolvent,  to pay  creditors.  The trust is  intended to be a
grantor  trust,  the  income  of which is  taxable  
<PAGE> 
to the Company.  No  contribution  to or income of the trust is to be taxable to
Plan participants until benefits are distributed to them.

                   The parties  therefore  establish this trust on the following
terms:

                                    ARTICLE I

                            Effective Date: Duration
                            ------------------------

         1.01 Effective Date
              --------------

              This trust shall be effective June 11, 1987. The  trust year shall
coincide with the Company's fiscal year, which is the calendar year.

         1.02 Duration
              --------

              1.02-1 This trust shall continue in effect until all the assets of
the trust fund are exhausted  through  distribution of benefits to participants,
payment to general  creditors  in the event of  insolvency,  payment of fees and
expenses of the Trustee  and return of remaining  funding of a Subtrust pursuant
to 1.02-2.

              1.02-2 Except as provided in 1.03,  the trust shall be irrevocable
with respect to amounts  contributed  to it for a Plan until all benefit  rights
covered by the  Subtrust  for that Plan are  satisfied.  The Trustee  shall then
return to the Company any assets remaining in the Subtrust for that Plan.

              1.02-3 If the  existence of this trust is held to be ERISA Funding
by a federal  court and appeals from that  holding are no longer  timely or have
been exhausted,  this 
<PAGE>
trust  shall  terminate.  Upon such  termination,  the  assets of each  Subtrust
remaining  after payment of the Trustee's fees and expenses shall be distributed
as follows:

                           (a) If none of the events  described  in 2.01-3  have
                  occurred,  such assets shall be returned to the  Company.  The
                  Company  shall then either (i)  transfer  such assets to a new
                  trust  which is not deemed to be ERISA  Funding,  but which is
                  similar in all other respects to this Trust;  or (ii) if it is
                  not  possible to  establish  the trust in (i) above,  then the
                  assets  returned  to the  Company  shall  be  retained  by the
                  Company.

                           (b) If any of the  events  described  in 2.01-3  have
                  occurred,  and more than  twenty-four  (24) months has elapsed
                  without a Change in Control, as defined in 1.04-2,  occurring,
                  then (a) above shall apply.

                           (c) If any of the  events  described  in 2.01-3  have
                  occurred  and  either  twenty-four  (24)  months  or less  has
                  elapsed or there has been a Change in  Control,  as defined in
                  1.04- 2, then such assets shall be allocated in  proportion to
                  the accrued benefit rights of the participants and distributed
                  to them in lump sums. Any assets  remaining  shall be returned
                  to the Company.
<PAGE>
              1.02-4 This trust is ERISA Funding if it prevents any of the Plans
from meeting the "unfunded"  criterion of the exceptions to various requirements
of Title I of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 for plans that
are  unfunded and  maintained  primarily  for the purpose of providing  deferred
compensation for a select group of management or highly compensated employees.

         1.03 Revocability
              ------------

              1.03-1 This trust shall  become  irrevocable  upon the issuance by
the Internal  Revenue Service of a private letter ruling  establishing  that its
existence  and  ownership  of  assets  do  not  cause  the  benefit   rights  of
participants under the Plans to be taxable currently. If such a ruling is denied
or if the Internal  Revenue Service declines to issue such a ruling  the Company
may revoke the trust and take  possession  of all assets held by the Trustee for
the trust.

              1.03-2  Notwithstanding  the  provisions of 1.03-1,  if any of the
events described in 2.01-3(a),  (b) or (c) has occurred, the Company may declare
the trust to be irrevocable.

         1.04 Change in Control
              -----------------

              1.04-1 On a Change in Control described in 1.04-2 the trust assets
shall be held for participants who had benefit rights under the Plans before the
Change in Control occurred. If the Company makes contributions for benefits owed
to new participants  under a Plan, such  contributions  and 
<PAGE> 
any insurance  contracts or other assets  purchased with them shall be held in a
new Subtrust separate from the existing Subtrust for previous participants.  The
existing  Subtrust  shall  cover  all the  benefits  provided  by the Plan for a
previous participant, including benefits accrued after the Change in Control.

              1.04-2  "Change in Control"  means a change in control of a nature
that would be required  to be reported in response to Item 6(e) of Schedule  14A
of Regulation  14A  promulgated  under the  Securities  Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended (the "Act"); provided that, without limitation, such a change in control
shall be deemed to have occurred if:

                           (a) Any  "person"  (as such term is used in  Sections
                  13(d) and  14(d)(2) of the Act) is or becomes  the  beneficial
                  owner,  directly or  indirectly,  of securities of the Company
                  representing  25% or more of the combined  voting power of the
                  Company's then  outstanding  securities  ordinarily (and apart
                  from rights accruing under special  circumstances)  having the
                  right to vote at elections of Directors; or

                           (b)  Within two years of a tender  offer or  exchange
                  offer for the voting  stock of the Company  (other than by the
                  Company)  or as a result of a merger,  consolidation,  sale of
                  assets or contested
<PAGE>
                  election or any combination of the foregoing,  the persons who
                  were Directors of the Company  immediately prior thereto shall
                  cease to  constitute  a majority  of the Board of the  Company
                  (the "Board") or of its successor by merger,  consolidation or
                  sale or assets.

         With  respect to  employees of any  subsidiary  corporation  "Change in
Control"  shall be deemed to have occurred upon  disposition of more than 50% of
the outstanding capital stock of that subsidiary by Del E. Webb Corporation, but
shall not include,  however, a "spinoff" distribution by Del E. Webb Corporation
to its shareholders,  pro rata, of any or all of its shares of the capital stock
of the subsidiary.

                                   ARTICLE II

                                   Trust Fund
                                   ----------

         2.01 Contributions
              -------------

              2.01-1 The Company  shall  contribute to the trust such amounts as
the Committees shall  reasonably  decide are necessary to purchase the insurance
contracts  and to pay premiums and loan interest  payments,  all as described in
2.02-1. The time of payment of contributions shall be decided by the Committees,
except as provided in 2.01-2.

              2.01-2 The Company shall, upon the occurrence of any of the events
described in 2.01-3 ("triggering event"), contribute to the trust the sum of the
following:
<PAGE>
                           (a) The present value of the  remaining  premiums and
                  the interest on any policy loans on insurance  contracts  held
                  in the trust.

                           (b) The  amount  by which  the  present  value of all
                  benefits  payable  under  the Plans  exceeds  the value of all
                  trust  assets.  Each  participant's  benefit  for  purposes of
                  calculating  present  value shall be the  highest  benefit the
                  participant  would  have  under the Plan  within the 24 months
                  following the triggering  event,  assuming that no changes are
                  made in the  participant's  level  of  income  deferral,  that
                  employment  continues  for 24  months  at  the  same  rate  of
                  compensation,  and that the  participant  receives any benefit
                  enhancement provided by the Plan upon a Change in Control. The
                  insurance contracts shall be valued at cash surrender value.

                           (c) A reasonable  estimate provided by the Trustee of
                  its fees due over the remaining duration of the trust.

              2.01-3  The  events  referred  to  in  2.01-2  shall  include  the
following:

                           (a) The  delivery to the  Company by any  person,  as
                  defined  in  Section  13(d)(3)  of  the  Act,  of a  statement
                  containing the information required by Schedule 13-D under the
                  Act, or any amendment to any such  statement,  that shows that
                  such  person  has  acquired,   directly  or  indirectly,   the
                  beneficial
<PAGE>
                  ownership  or (i) more than 20  percent or any class of equity
                  security  of tne  Company  entitled  to vote as a class in the
                  election  or removal  from office or  directors,  or (ii) more
                  than 20 percent of the voting power of any group of classes or
                  equity  securities of the Company entitled to vote as a single
                  class in the election of removal from office directors.

                           (b) The Company  becomes  aware that  preliminary  or
                  definitive   copies  of  a  proxy  statement  and  information
                  statement  or  other  information  have  been  filed  with the
                  Securities and Exchange Commission pursuant to Rule 4a-6, Rule
                  14c-5,  or rule  14f-1  under the Act  relating  to a proposed
                  change in control of the Company.

                           (c) The  delivery  to the  Company  pursuant  to Rule
                  14d-3 under the Act of a Tender  Offer  Statement  relating to
                  equity securities of the Company.

                           (d) The  termination  of  either  of the Plans by the
                  Company or any  amendment  to either of the Plans  which would
                  reduce the benefits currently provided for under such Plan.

                           (e) Failure by the Company to  contribute,  within 60
                  days of receipt of a written notice from the Trustee, the full
                  amount of any  insufficiency  in trust assets that is required
                  to pay any benefit
<PAGE>

                  that is payable upon a direction  from the Committee  pursuant
                  to 3.02-2 or  upon  resolution of a disputed claim pursuant to
                  3.03-2.

              2.01-4 The  calculations  required  under 2.01-2 shall be based on
the actuarial assumptions set forth in the attached Exhibit A, which, prior to a
Change in  Control,  may be  revised  by the  Committee  from time to time.  For
purposes of  2.01-2(a),  the discount rate shall be the same as the rate applied
to determine the present value of the Benefit Liability.

              2.01-5 The  Trustee  shall  accept the  contributions  made by the
Company and shall hold them as a trust fund for the  payment of  benefits  under
the Plans.  The Trustee shall not be responsible  for  determining  the required
amount of contributions or for collecting any contribution not voluntarily paid.
Contributions  may be in cash or in kind,  subject to approval and acceptance by
the Trustee.

         2.02 Investments
              -----------

              2.02-1 The trust fund shall be  invested  primarily  in  insurance
contracts. Such contracts may be purchased by the Company and transferred to the
Trustee as in-kind  contributions  or may be  purchased  by the Trustee with the
proceeds of cash contributions. The purchase and holding of such contracts shall
be an  investment  directed by the Company,  pursuant to 2.02-2.  The  Company's
contributions  to the  trust  
<PAGE>
shall  include  sufficient  cash  to make  projected  premium  payments  on such
contracts and payments of any interest due on loans secured by the cash value of
such contracts.

              2.02-2 The Trustee shall invest the trust fund in accordance  with
written  directions  by  the  Committee.  The  Trustee  shall  act  only  as  an
administrative  agent in carrying out the directed  investment  transactions and
shall not be responsible for the investment decision.  If a directed transaction
violates  the duty to  diversify,  to  maintain  liquidity  or to meet any other
investment   standard   under  this  trust  or   applicable   law,   the  entire
responsibility shall rest upon the Company.

              2.02-3  If the  Trustee  does not  receive  instructions  from the
Committee for the investment of part or all of the trust fund, the Trustee shall
invest it in securities or other  property in accordance  with  applicable  law.
Permissible investments shall include, but not be limited to, the following:

                           (a) Preferred or common  stocks,  notes,  debentures,
                  bonds or other securities.

                           (b) Mutual  funds,  money market  funds,  com mercial
                  paper, savings and loan accounts,  certificates of deposit and
                  savings accounts, including deposits bearing a reasonable rate
                  of interest in the savings department of the Trustee.

                           (c) Real estate or mortgages.

                           (d) Common or collective  investment funds maintained
                  by the Trustee.
<PAGE>
         2.03 Recapture Of Excess Assets
              --------------------------

              2.03-1 In the event any  Subtrust  shall hold Excess  Assets,  the
Committee,  at its option,  may direct the Trustee to return part or all of such
Excess Assets to the Company.

              2.03-2  "Excess  Assets" are assets of any Subtrust  exceeding one
hundred  seventy-five  percent  (175%) of the present  value of the benefits due
participants in such Subtrust.

              2.03-3 The  calculation  required by 2.03-2  shall be based on the
actuarial assumptions set forth in Exhibit A, and shall be made by The Company.

         2.04 Subtrusts
              ---------

              2.04-1 The Trustee  shall  establish  a Subtrust  for each Plan to
which it shall credit  contributions for that Plan. The account shall reflect an
undivided  interest  in  assets of the trust  fund and  shall  not  require  any
segregation of particular  assets,  except that an insurance  contract  covering
benefits of a particular Plan shall be held in the subtrust for that Plan.

              2.04-2 The Trustee shall allocate  investment  earnings and losses
of the trust fund among the Subtrusts in proportion  to their  balances,  except
that  changes in the value of an  insurance  contract  shall be allocated to the
Subtrust for which it is held.  Payments to general  creditors during insolvency
administration  under 5.02 shall be charged  against the Subtrusts in proportion
to their  balances,  except the payment of benefits to a Plan  participant  as a
general creditor shall be charged against the Subtrust for that Plan.
<PAGE>
         2.05 Substitution of Other Property
              ------------------------------

              2.05-1 The Company  shall have the power to reacquire  part or all
of the  trust  fund at any  time,  by  substituting  for it  other  property  of
equivalent value. Such power is exercisable in a nonfiduciary capacity.

              2.05-2 The value of any  insurance  contracts  reac  quired  under
2.05-1  shall be the  present  value of future  projected  cash flow of benefits
payable under the contract. The projection shall include death benefits based on
reasonable  mortality  assumptions.  The value of all other  assets in the trust
fund shall be fair market value. Values shall be determined by the Trustee.

                                   ARTICLE III

                                 Administration
                                 --------------

         3.01 Committee
              ---------

              3.01-1 The  Committees are the plan  administrators  for the Plans
and have full  responsibility to interpret the Plans and determine the rights of
participants and beneficiaries.

              3.01-2  The  Trustee   shall  be  given  the  names  and  specimen
signatures of the Chairman, Secretary and members of each Committee. The Trustee
shall accept and rely upon the names and  signatures  until  notified of change.
Instructions to the Trustee shall be signed for the Committee by the Chairman or
such other person as the Committee may designate. 
<PAGE>
         3.02 Payment of Benefits
              -------------------

              3.02-1  The  Trustee  shall  pay  benefits  to  participants   and
beneficiaries on behalf of the Company in satisfaction of its obligations  under
the Plans.  Benefit  payments  from a  Subtrust  shall be made in full until the
assets of the Subtrust are  exhausted.  Payments due on the date the Subtrust is
exhausted  shall be made pro rata in proportion to the accrued benefit rights of
the participants and beneficiaries to the extent of the remaining assets in such
Subtrust.  The Company's obligation shall not be limited to the trust fund and a
participant  shall have a claim  against the Company for any payment not made by
the Trustee.

              3.02-2 The Trustee shall make payments in accordance  with written
direction from the Committee, except as provided in 3.03. The Trustee shall make
any required  income tax  withholding  and shall pay amounts  withheld to taxing
authorities  on the  Company's  behalf or determine  that such amounts have been
paid by the Company.

              3.02-3 A  participant's  entitlement  to benefits  under the Plans
shall be  determined  by the  Committee.  Any claim for such  benefits  shall be
considered and reviewed under the claims procedures set out in the Plans.

         3.03 Disputed Claims
              ---------------

              3.03-1 A participant with an account in this trust whose claim has
been denied by the Committee or who has received no response to the claim within
30 days after submission, may submit the claim to the Trustee. The Trustee
<PAGE>
shall give  notice of the claim to the  Committee,  If the  Trustee  receives no
notice  of  response  from  the  Committee  within  30 days  after  the date the
Committee is given the notice of claim,  the Trustee  shall pay the  participant
the amount claimed. If a notice of response is received within such 30 days, the
Trustee shall consider the claim,  including the  Committee's  response.  If the
merits  of the  claim  depend  on  compensation,  service  or other  data in the
possession  of the  Company  and it is not  provided,  the Trustee may rely upon
information provided by the participant.

              3.03-2 The Trustee  shall give notice to the  participant  and the
Committee of its decision on the claim.  Either the participant or the Committee
may  challenge  the  Trustee's  decision by filing suit in a court of  competent
jurisdiction.  If no such  suit is filed  within  30 days  after  notice  of the
Trustee's decision,  the decision shall become final and binding on all parties.
If the  decision is to grant the claim,  the Trustee  shall make  payment to the
participant.

              3.03-3 The Trustee may decline to decide a claim and may file suit
to have the matter  resolved by a court of  competent  jurisdiction.  All of the
Trustee's expenses in the court proceeding,  including  attorneys fees, shall be
allowed as administrative expenses of the trust.

              3.03-4 If the Committee opposes a claim presented under 3.03-1 and
the Trustee  ultimately pays the claim from the trust assets,  the Company shall
reimburse the Participant's  expenses in pursuing the claim, Including attorneys
fees at the trial and appellate level. 
<PAGE>
         3.04 Records
              -------

              The Trustee shall keep complete  records on the trust fund open to
inspection by the Company and the Committee at all reasonable times. In addition
to  accounts  required  below,  the  Trustee  shall  furnish to the  Company and
Committee any information requested about the trust fund.

         3.05 Accountings
              -----------

              3.05-1.  The Trustee shall furnish each  Committee with a complete
statement  of accounts  annually  within 60 days after the end of the trust year
showing  assets and  liabilities  and income  and  expense  for the year of each
Subtrust.  The form and  content  of the  account  shall be  sufficient  for the
Company to include in  computing  its  taxable  income and  credits  the income,
deductions and credits against tax that are attributable to the trust fund.

              3.05-2 A  Committee  may  object to an  accounting  within 60 days
after it is  furnished  and require  that it be settled by audit by a qualified,
independent  certified  public  accountant.  The auditor  shall be chosen by the
Trustee from a list of at least five such accountants furnished by the Committee
at the time the audit is  requested.  Either the  Committee  or the  Trustee may
require  that the account be settled by a court of  competent  jurisdiction,  in
lieu of or in  conjunction  with the audit.  All  expenses of any audit or court
proceedings,   including  reasonable   attorneys'  fees,  shall  be  allowed  as
administrative expenses of the trust.
<PAGE>
              3.05-3 If the Committee  does not object to an  accounting  within
the time provided, the account shall be settled for the period covered by it.

              3.05-4 When an account is  settled,  it shall be final and binding
on all parties, including all participants and persons claiming through them.

         3.06 Expenses and Fees
              -----------------

              3.06-1 The Trustee shall be reimbursed  for all expenses and shall
be paid a reasonable  fee fixed by it from time to time.  No increase in the fee
shall be effective  before 60 days after the Trustee gives notice to the Company
of the increase. The Trustee shall notify the Committee periodically of expenses
and fees.

              3.06-2 The fees and  expenses  shall be paid from the trust  fund.
The Company shall reimburse the trust fund for any fees and expenses paid out of
it,  unless,  immediately  after the payment of any such fees and expenses,  the
Trust shall have Excess Assets, as determined under 2.03-2.

                                   ARTICLE IV

                                    Liability
                                    ---------

         4.01 Indemnity
              ---------

              The Company shall indemnify and defend the Trustee from any claim,
loss, liability or expense arising from any action or inaction in administration
of this trust based on  direction  or  information  from the  Committee,  absent
willful misconduct or bad faith.
<PAGE>
         4.02 Bonding
              -------

              The  Trustee  need  not  give  any  bond  or  other  security  for
performance of its duties under this trust.

                                    ARTICLE V

                                   Insolvency
                                   ----------

         5.01 Determination of Insolvency
              ---------------------------

              5.01-1 The Company is Insolvent for purposes of this trust if:

                           (a) The  Company  is  persistently  unable to pay its
                  debts as they come due; or

                           (b)  The   Company  is  the   subject  of  a  pending
                  proceeding as a debtor under the Bankruptcy Code.


              5.01-2 The Chief  Executive  Officer or the Board of  Directors of
the Company shall  promptly give notice to the Trustee upon becoming  Insolvent.
If the Trustee  receives such notice or receives from any other person  claiming
to be a  creditor  of the  Company  a written  allegation  that the  Company  is
Insolvent,  the Trustee shall request the Company's then  independent  certified
public  accountants to determine whether such insolvency exists. The expenses of
such determination shall be allowed as administrative expenses of the trust.

              5.01-3 The Trustee shall continue  making  payments from the trust
fund to participants  under the Plans while the existence of insolvency is being
determined.  Such payments shall cease and the Trustee shall commence Insolvency
Administration under 5.02 upon the earlier of:
<PAGE>
                           (a) A determination by the Company's then independent
                  certified public accountants that the company is Insolvent; or

                           (b) 30  days  after  the  notice  or   allegation  of
                  insolvency is received under 5.01-2, unless the Company's then
                  independent  certified public accountants have determined that
                  the Company is not  Insolvent  since receipt of such notice or
                  allegation.

              5.01-4 The Trustee  shall have no obligation  to  investigate  the
financial  condition of the Company prior to receiving a notice or allegation of
insolvency under 5.01-2.


         5.02 Insolvency Administration
              -------------------------

              5.02-1 During  Insolvency  Administration,  the Trustee shall hold
the trust fund for the benefit of the general  creditors of the Company and make
payments  only in  accordance  with  5.02-2.  The  Trustee  shall  continue  the
investment of the trust fund in accordance with 2.02.

              5.02-2 The Trustee  shall make  payments  out of the trust fund in
one or more of the following ways:

                           (a) To  general    creditors   in   accordance   with
                  instructions  from a court, or a person  appointed by a court,
                  having   jurisdiction   over  the   Company's   condition   of
                  insolvency;

                           (b) To Plan   participants   and   beneficiaries   in
                  accordance with such instructions; or

                           (c) In payment of its own fees or expenses.
<PAGE>
              5.02-3 The  Trustee  shall be a secured  creditor  with a priority
claim to the trust fund with respect to its own fees and expenses.

         5.03 Termination of Insolvency Administration
              ----------------------------------------

              5.03-1   Insolvency   Administration   shall  terminate  when  the
Company's  then  independent  certified  public  accountants  determine that the
Company:

                           (a) Is not  Insolvent,  in  response  to a notice  or
                  allegation of insolvency under 5.01- 2; or

                           (b) Has ceased to be Insolvent.

              5.03-2 Upon termination of Insolvency  Administration under 5.03-1
the trust fund shall continue to be held for the benefit of the  participants in
the Plans.  Benefit payments due during the period of Insolvency  Administration
shall be made as soon as practicable,  together with interest from the due dates
at the following rates:

                           (a) For the  Deferred  Compensation  Plan,  the  rate
                  credited on the participant's account under the Plan.

                           (b) For the Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan, a
                  rate equal to the interest  rate fixed by the Pension  Benefit
                  Guaranty  Corporation for valuing  immediate  annuities in the
                  preceding month.

         5.04 Creditors Claims During Solvency
              --------------------------------

                  5.04.1 During periods of Solvency,  the Trustee shall hold the
trust fund  exclusively  to pay benefits and fees 
<PAGE>
              5.04-2 A period of Solvency is any period not covered by 5.02.

                                   ARTICLE VI

                               Successor Trustees
                               ------------------


         6.01 Resignation and Removal
              -----------------------


              6.01-1  The  Trustee  may  resign  at any  time by  notice  to the
Committee,  which shall be  effective  in 60 days unless the  Committee  and the
Trustee agree otherwise.

              6.01-2 The  Trustee  may be removed by the  Committee  on 60 days'
notice or shorter notice accepted by the Trustee.

              6.01-3 When resignation or removal is effective, the Trustee shall
begin  transfer of assets to the  successor  Trustee  immediately.  The transfer
shall be completed within 60 days, unless the Committee extends the time limit.

              6.01-4 If the Trustee  resigns or is removed,  the Committee shall
appoint a successor by the effective date of resignation or removal under 6.01-1
or 6.01-2.  If no such  appointment  has been made,  the  Trustee may apply to a
court  of  competent   jurisdiction  for  appointment  of  a  successor  or  for
instructions.  All  expenses of the Trustee in  connection  with the  proceeding
shall be allowed as administrative expenses of the trust.

         6.02 Appointment of Successor
              ------------------------

              6.02-1  The  Committee  may  appoint  any  national  bank or trust
company  that is unrelated to the Company and that has total assets in excess of
$500,000,000 as a successor to
<PAGE>
replace the  Trustee  upon  resignation  or removal.  The  appointment  shall be
effective when accepted in writing by the new Trustee, who shall have all of the
rights and powers of the former Trustee including  ownership rights in the trust
assets. The former Trustee shall execute any instrument  necessary or reasonably
requested by the Committee or the successor Trustee to evidence the transfer.

              6.02-2 The successor Trustee need not examine the records and acts
of any prior Trustee and may retain or dispose of existing trust assets, subject
to Article  II.  The  successor  Trustee  shall not be  responsible  for and the
Company  shall  indemnify  and defend the  successor  Trustee  from any claim or
liability  because of any action or inaction  of any prior  Trustee or any other
past event, any existing condition or any existing assets.

         6.03 Accounts; Continuity
              --------------------

              6.03-1 A Trustee  who resigns or is removed  shall  submit a final
accounting  to  the Committee as soon as practicable.  The  accounting  shall be
received and settled as provided in 3.04 for regular accounts.

              6.03-2 No  resignation  or  removal  of the  Trustee  or change in
identity of the Trustee for any reason shall cause a termination  of the Plan or
this trust.
<PAGE>
                                   ARTICLE VII

                               General Provisions
                               ------------------

         7.01 Interests Not Assignable
              ------------------------

              7.01-1 The interest of a participant  in the trust fund may not be
assigned, seized by legal process, transferred or subjected to the claims of the
participant's creditors in any way.

              7.01-2 The Company may not create a security interest in the trust
fund in favor of any of its creditors.  The Trustee shall not make payments from
the trust  fund of any  amounts to  creditors  of the  Company  who are not Plan
participants, except as provided in 5.02.

              7.01-3 The  participants  shall have no  interest in the assets of
the trust  fund  beyond  the  right to  receive  payment  of Plan  benefits  and
reimbursement  of expenses  from such  assets  subject to the  instructions  for
insolvency   administration   referred   to   in   5.02-2.   During   Insolvency
Administration the participants' rights to trust assets shall not be superior to
those of any other general creditor of the Company.

         7.02 Amendment
              ---------

               The Company and the Trustee may amend this trust at any time by a
written  instrument  executed by both  parties and  consented to in writing by a
majority of all the  participants in the Plans to whom benefit payments are owed
at the time the amendment is adopted.
<PAGE>
         7.03 Applicable Law
              --------------

              This trust  shall be  construed  according  to the Laws of Arizona
except as preempted by federal law.

         7.04 Agreement Binding on All Parties
              --------------------------------

               This  agreement  shall  be  binding  upon  the  heirs,   personal
representatives,  successors  and  assigns  of any and all  present  and  future
parties.

         7.05 Notices and Directions
              ----------------------

              Any notice or  direction  under this trust shall be in writing and
shall be  effective  when  actually  delivered  or, if  mailed,  when  deposited
postpaid as first-class  mail.  Mail to a party shall be directed to the address
stated in this trust or to such other  address  as either  party may  specify by
notice to the other party. Notices to the Committee shall be sent to the address
of the Company.  Notices to participants  who have submitted claims under 3.02-2
shall be mailed to the address shown in the claim submission.
<PAGE>
         7.06 No Implied Duties
              -----------------

              The duties of the Trustee shall be those stated in this trust, and
no other duties shall be implied.

                   Company:              DEL WEBB CORPORATION


                                         By /s/ Alan B. O'Connor
                                            -------------------------------
                                            Its  Vice President, Human Resources

                                         Executed: June 11,  1987
                                                  ---------------    

                   Trustee:              THE VALLEY NATIONAL BANK OF
                                           ARIZONA, N.A.

                                         By   /s/ Verna M. Hegeman
                                            -------------------------------
                                            Its Assistant Vice President

                                         Executed: July 22,  1987
                                                   --------------
<PAGE>
                                    EXHIBIT A



                         Assumptions and Methodology for

                   Calculation Required Under 2.01-2 and 2.03



1.      The liability will be calculated  using two different  assumptions as to
        when the employee terminates employment and receives a change of control
        benefit:

        a)     As of the trigger date,

        b)     24 months after the trigger  date  assuming  future  compensation
               continues at current levels

        The Benefit Liability will be the greater of the liabilities  calculated
        in accordance with a) and b) above.

2.      Calculations  will be  based  upon the most  valuable  optional  form of
        payment available to the participant.

3.      The  Benefit  Liability  is  equal  to the  present  value  of  benefits
        discounted to the trigger date at 12% per annum.

4.      No mortality is assumed prior to the  commencement  of benefits.  Future
        mortality is assumed to occur in accordance  with the 1983 Group Annuity
        Table Male rates after the commencement of benefits.

5.      Where left  undefined  by 1.  through  4.  above,  calculations  will be
        performed in accordance with generally accepted actuarial principles.

6.      For the purpose of projecting  deferral account  balances,  Moody's bond
        rate is  assumed  to  remain  at the last  published  rate  prior to the
        Trigger Date.

                                                                   Exhibit 10.28

                              DEL WEBB CORPORATION
                            MANAGEMENT INCENTIVE PLAN
                   Fiscal 1997 (July 1, 1996 - June 30, 1997)


Plan Objectives
- ---------------

o        To motivate key  management  personnel  to achieve or exceed  Corporate
         financial goals and to contribute to the short and longer term interest
         of shareholders.


o        To provide a competitive bonus program necessary to attract, retain and
         motivate high quality management.

Administration
- --------------


1.       Bonuses may be paid in cash or in stock, less applicable tax deductions
         and subject to prior deferral  agreements as soon as practicable  after
         the end of the Fiscal Year.


2.       In order to  receive a bonus,  the  participant  must be on the  active
         payroll at the time the bonus is paid  unless  approval  for a pro rata
         bonus is granted by the Chairman/Chief Executive Officer (CEO).


3.       At the  discretion of the CEO and upon approval of the Human  Resources
         Committee, financial objectives may be adjusted upward or downward as a
         result of  significant  windfalls  or  disasters  beyond the control of
         management.  In  addition,  the Human  Resources  Committee  can revise
         financial  objectives during the year if significant  events occur that
         were not included in the budget.


4.       Bonuses are computed  under the plan criteria for  corporate  earnings,
         community  earnings  and cash  flow  approved  by the  Human  Resources
         Committee of the Board. The portion of the bonus computation related to
         project   milestones   and  personal   goals  is   recommended  by  the
         participant's  immediate  superior.  Bonus calculations are reviewed by
         the CEO and the Human Resources Department,  and presented to the Human
         Resources Committee of the Board for final approval.


5.       All terms and  conditions of the Plan and its very existence are at the
         sole  discretion  of the  Human  Resources  Committee  of the  Board of
         Directors.
                                        1
<PAGE>
Eligibility
- -----------

Key Management personnel:

         o        whose duties and  responsibilities  can materially  affect the
                  growth, development and profitability of the Company and,

         o        who are nominated by a subsidiary  or Company  officer and are
                  approved by the CEO, and

         o        who are assigned to an eligible position on or before July 1st
                  unless otherwise approved by the CEO.


Bonus Opportunity Levels
- ------------------------

Each  participant  will have a Target Bonus which will be the amount  earned for
meeting the Plan objectives.  The Target Bonus will be expressed as a percentage
of actual  base salary  earned  throughout  the 1995/96  fiscal year and will be
established by the CEO and the Human Resources  Department  based on competitive
compensation data and internal equity.

Target Bonuses
- --------------

Target  bonus  levels  will  range  from  10%  to  60% of  salary  based  on the
participant's  salary grade and  organizational  level and recommendation of the
CEO. No bonuses will be payable until the minimum acceptable  threshold earnings
target is achieved unless specifically approved by the Human Resources Committee
of the Board of  Directors.  A bonus of 100% of the target bonus will be payable
for achieving 100% of Plan  objectives.  A maximum bonus of 200% of Target Bonus
will be payable for attaining the maximum expected performance.

Bonus Objectives
- ----------------

Bonus objectives will be comprised of the financial  objectives  relating to the
participant's area of responsibility and/or non-financial performance objectives
as specified in the annual performance appraisal.

o        Depending  upon  the  operation  of  the  company  involved,  financial
         objectives  for a  participant  may be based on Corporate net after-tax
         earnings,  budgeted Group or Project operating earnings before interest
         and cash discounts and/or operations cash flow. The minimum  acceptable
         threshold,   target  and  maximum  expected  earnings  levels  will  be
         determined by the CEO based on the degree of  difficulty  and the level
         of acceptability of the budget.
                                        2
<PAGE>
o        Non-Financial   performance   objectives   are  the  most   significant
         non-financial  goals which the  individual  participant  is expected to
         accomplish during the Plan year.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                     Corporate                                            Non-Financial
                                                     After Tax           Operating        Cash            Performance
                                                     Earnings            Earnings(1)      Flow            Objectives
                                                     --------            -----------      ----            ----------
<S>                                                       <C>                <C>           <C>               <C>

I.   Target Bonus
     35% and above
     (Corporate officers,
     Coventry Division Managers
     Associate GMS & Fairmount
     Operations VP)

     A.  Headquarters                                     85%                  0           15%                 0

     B.  Operating Sun City Communities                   20%                60%           20%                 0
         Coventry/Coventry Tucson
         Coventry Las Vegas
         Terravita

II.  Target Bonus below 35%

     A.  Headquarters                                     75%                  0           15%               10%

     B.  Operating Sun City Communities                   20%                50%           20%               10%
         Coventry
         Coventry Tucson/Las Vegas
         Terravita
         So. CA Conventional
         Fairmount
         Coventry Verde Valley

     C.  Foothills(2)                                     30%                  0           60%               10%

</TABLE>

(1)  Operating  earnings  are  the  pre-tax,  pre-interest,  pre-cash  discounts
     earnings achieved at the operation where the individual is assigned.

(2)  40% of Foothills  cash flow total is related to generation of budgeted cash
     flow.  20% of  Foothills  cash flow  total is  related  to  monitoring  and
     communication of cash flow.
                                        3
<PAGE>
Financial Objectives
- --------------------

A minimum  bonus will be paid upon the  corporation  or operation  achieving the
threshold earnings forecast as shown on the income schedules included as part of
this  Management  Incentive  Plan.  For results  between a threshold and maximum
expected earnings, the bonus percent will increase incrementally to a maximum of
200% of target bonus based upon  operating  earnings and the  achievement of the
other formula  targets.  (See attached for net after-tax  earnings and operating
income schedules.)

Cash Flow Component
- -------------------

Cash flow will, of necessity,  vary from budget and previous  indicated  actuals
based upon sales and housing deposits collected,  closings, land development and
housing needs within each operation,  and decisions made on the timing of phases
and  amenities  of some  projects.  The  ultimate  recommendation  of cash  flow
component awards will be made by the chief executive officer with input from the
corporate chief financial officer and corporate  controller.  The recommendation
will  be  based  upon  how  well  cash  flow  is  being   managed  and  reported
acknowledging  the  business  decisions  by  Webb's  executive  management  team
affecting  cash  throughout  the year.  The cash flow  element of the Plan works
independently of all other Plan components, including the earnings component.

Operating Communities

The award of the portion of the incentive  formula  related to cash flow will be
based upon three criteria for operating  communities  and divisions:  quality of
cash flow  (accuracy and timing of cash flow  reporting);  quantity of cash flow
(percentage  of  budgeted  cash  flow  achieved);   and  overall  management  of
department/community  general  and  administrative  (G&A)  expense  budget.  For
operating  communities,  five percent of the overall  incentive  formula will be
earned based upon meeting department and/or community G&A budget with ability to
earn greater than 100% for operating under budget.

The chief financial officer and corporate controller will assign a percentage of
achievement to each operation for both quantity of cash flow generated  based on
agreed upon budget cash flow  targets,  and quality and  timeliness of cash flow
reporting. The percentages assigned to quality and quantity of cash flow will be
multiplied to arrive at an overall  percentage of success.  This percentage will
reflect the achievement of cash flow component other than G&A.

Headquarters

The cash flow component for Headquarters plan participants will be awarded based
upon  achievement  of  corporate  and  department  G&A  budgets  for  which  the
participant  has  responsibility.  The ability to earn  greater than 100% can be
achieved for operating under budget.

Non-Financial Performance Objectives
- ------------------------------------

Non-financial  performance objectives will be included in the annual performance
appraisal  conducted near the beginning of the fiscal year and will be submitted
to  the  CEO  for  final  approval.  Objectives  must  be  specific,  realistic,
quantifiable and time-limited before they will be approved.  The objectives will
be
                                        4
<PAGE>
designed to improve short- and long-term performance and will be mutually agreed
to by the participant and management.

In the event  circumstances or directions  change,  affecting any  participant's
pre-established  performance objectives, the manager is responsible for revising
them or establishing new objectives during the year.

The  achievement  of  performance  objectives  is measured by the  participant's
immediate superior based upon documented evaluation of results.  Accomplishments
will be evaluated using the following scale:


                                        Threshold     Target         Maximum
                                        ---------     ------         -------

     Overall Rating        Poor         Good          Excellent      Superior

     Percent of Target     0 - 49       50 - 75       76 - 125       126 - 200


Evaluation of results should take into account the difficulty the objective, the
timeliness  of  accomplishment,  the  effectiveness  of results  and the overall
impact  on  the  individual's  organizational  unit.  Achievement  of  operating
earnings  is  paramount  in  the  bonus   computation   formula;   non-financial
performance  objectives  are reviewed  and  evaluated  only if minimum  earnings
objectives  have been met or if  specifically  approved  by the Human  Resources
Committee.


Rating Definitions
- ------------------

     Maximum               A  "superior"  rating is achieved if the  participant
     -------               accomplishes highly challenging  objectives resulting
                           in  significant   contribution   to  the  Company  or
                           business  unit.  This  rating  incorporates  superior
                           reaction  to  crisis  and  superior  exploitation  of
                           unanticipated opportunities.

     Target                An "excellent"  rating is achieved if the participant
     ------                accomplishes all objectives in a timely and effective
                           manner  and  overall  performance  for  the  year  is
                           considered    standard   or,   if   the   participant
                           accomplished  most of a  number  of  significant  and
                           highly challenging objectives and overall performance
                           is considered above standard.

     Threshold             A  "good"  rating  is  achieved  if  the  participant
     ---------             accomplished  most of the objectives in an acceptable
                           manner  or all of a group  of  objectives  that  were
                           minimally  challenging.  Overall  performance  of the
                           year is considered standard.
                                        5

                                                                  2-13098
                                                                   FILED
                                                                  ARIZONA
                                                            SECRETARY OF STATE
                                                               JUNE 18, 1996


                              AMENDED AND RESTATED

                            CERTIFICATE AND AGREEMENT

                             OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

                                       OF

                      NEW MEXICO ASSET LIMITED PARTNERSHIP



         THIS  AMENDED  AND  RESTATED   CERTIFICATE  AND  AGREEMENT  OF  LIMITED
PARTNERSHIP (the  "Agreement") is entered into and shall be effective as of this
23rd  day  of  May,  1996,  by  and  among  Del  Webb  Corporation,  a  Delaware
corporation,  as the  General  Partner,  and New Mexico  Asset  Corporation,  an
Arizona corporation, as the Limited Partner.

         WHEREAS,  the  General  Partner  and  Limited  Partner  entered  into a
Certificate  and Agreement of Limited  Partnership  effective as of July 1, 1995
(the "Original Agreement"); and

         WHEREAS,  the General  Partner and Limited  Partner desire to amend and
restate the Certificate and Agreement of Limited Partnership by this Amended and
Restated  Certificate and Agreement of Limited  Partnership  effective as of May
23, 1996 (the "Agreement") as provided herein.

         NOW,  THEREFORE,  for  the  consideration  of  their  mutual  covenants
hereinafter  set forth,  the parties to this Agreement  hereby amend and restate
the Original Agreement, in its entirety, as follows:

                                    ARTICLE I
                                    ---------

                               General Definitions
                               -------------------

         The  following  terms,   which  are  used  generally   throughout  this
Agreement, shall have the following meanings:

         "Act" means the Arizona  Revised  Uniform  Limited  Partnership Act set
forth in Chapter 3 of Title 29 of the Arizona Revised Statutes,  as amended from
time to time.

         "Agreement"  or  "Partnership  Agreement"  means this  Certificate  and
Agreement of Limited  Partnership  of New Mexico Asset Limited  Partnership,  as
amended  from time to time.  Words such as  "herein,"  "hereinafter,"  "hereof,"
"hereto,"  and  "hereunder,"  refer to this  Agreement  as a whole,  unless  the
context otherwise requires.

         "Capital  Contribution"  means the amount of money and the  initial Net
Asset Value of any property (other than money) 
<PAGE>
contributed  to the capital of the  Partnership by a Partner.  "Initial  Capital
Contributions"   means  the  initial   contributions  to  the  capital  of  this
Partnership made pursuant to Section 3.1 of this Agreement.  "Additional Capital
Contributions" shall mean the contributions made pursuant to Section 3.2 of this
Agreement.

         "Code" means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended from time to
time.  References  in this  Agreement  to  specific  sections  of the Code shall
include the corresponding  sections of succeeding law following any amendment of
the Code.

         "Interest in the Partnership" or "Partnership Interest" means the right
under the  terms of the  Agreement  to share in the  Partnership's  Profits  and
Losses and to receive distributions of the Partnership's assets.

         "Limited  Partner"  means any Person who has been admitted as a Limited
Partner  pursuant to the terms of this  Agreement  for so long as such Person is
the owner of a Partnership Interest. "Limited Partners" means all such Persons.

         "Net  Available  Cash Flow" means,  for any period,  the  Partnership's
gross cash  receipts  derived  from any source  whatsoever  (including,  without
limitation,  from  borrowings,  sale  of  property,  or  the  release  of  funds
previously  set aside as a  reserve)  less the  portion  thereof  used to pay or
establish reasonable reserves for all Partnership expenses, debt payments (other
than  payments of Partner  loans),  asset  acquisitions,  capital  improvements,
expansions,  repairs,  replacements,  contingencies,  and any other  proper cash
expenditure of the Partnership as reasonably  determined by the General Partner.
"Net  Available Cash Flow" shall not be reduced by  depreciation,  amortization,
cost recovery deductions or similar allowances.

         "Partners"  means the  General  Partner and  Limited  Partner,  when no
distinction  is  required  by the  context  in which  the  term is used  herein.
"Partner" means any one of the Partners.

         "Partnership"  means the limited  partnership  formed  pursuant to this
Agreement.

         "Percentage  Interest" means the percentage interest of each Partner in
the  profits  and  losses of the  Partnership  as set forth on Exhibit A of this
Agreement.

         "Person"  means  any  individual,  partnership,   corporation,  limited
liability company, trust, or other legal entity.

         "Profits" or "Losses" means, for each Fiscal Year or other period,  the
taxable  income or taxable  loss of the  Partnership  as  determined  under Code
Section  703(a)  (including in such taxable  income or taxable loss all items of
income, gain, loss or deduction
                                        2
<PAGE>
required to be stated separately pursuant to Section 703(a)(1) of the Code) with
the following adjustments:

                           (a)      Any income of the Partnership that is exempt
         from federal income tax shall be added to such taxable income
         or loss; and

                           (b) Any  expenditures  of the  Partnership  that  are
         described in Code Section 705(a)(2)(B),  or treated as such pursuant to
         Regulations  Section  1.704-1(b)(2)(iv)(i),  and that are not otherwise
         taken into account in the  computation of taxable income or loss of the
         Partnership,  shall be  deducted  in the  determination  of  Profits or
         Losses.

         "Regulations"  means the regulations  promulgated and amended from time
to time by the  Department of the Treasury  pursuant to the Code.  References in
this  Agreement  to  specific  sections  of the  Regulations  shall  include the
corresponding sections of the Regulations following any amendments or changes of
the Regulations from time to time.

         "Substituted  Limited  Partner"  means a Person that is admitted to the
Partnership as a Limited Partner pursuant to Section 8.3 hereof.

                                   ARTICLE II
                                   ----------

                          Formation, Purpose, and Term
                          ----------------------------

         2.1 Formation.  The undersigned Partners hereby form the Partnership as
a limited partnership in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement and of
the Act.

         2.2 Name. The name of the Partnership shall be New Mexico Asset Limited
Partnership, or such other name as the General Partner shall designate from time
to time by written notice to all Partners.

         2.3 Office.  The principal  office of the  Partnership  (and the office
required to be  maintained  for keeping  Partnership  records under Arizona law)
shall be located at 6001 North 24th  Street,  Phoenix,  Arizona  85016,  or such
other place in the State of Arizona as the General  Partner may  designate  from
time to time, with written notice to the other Partners.

         2.4  Agent  for  Service  of  Process.  The  name  and  address  of the
Partnership's  initial  agent for service of process is Philip H.  Darrow,  6001
North 24th Street, Phoenix, Arizona 85016.

         2.5 Character of Business.  The character of the Partnership's business
shall be to acquire oil and gas interests.
                                        3
<PAGE>
The  Partnership  may also engage in and do any act concerning any or all lawful
businesses for which limited  partnerships  may be organized  under Arizona Law.
The Partnership shall have all of the powers permitted by law.

         2.6 Term.  The term of the  Partnership,  which will  commence upon the
filing of the  Certificate of Limited  Partnership,  shall continue  (subject to
Article  IX  hereof)  for a period of fifty  (50)  years  after the date of such
filing.

         2.7 Independent  Activities.  Unless  otherwise  provided,  the General
Partner and each Limited Partner may, notwithstanding this Agreement,  engage in
whatever  activities  they  choose,  whether the same are  competitive  with the
Partnership  or otherwise,  without  having or incurring any obligation to offer
any interest in such activities to the Partnership or to any Partner.

                                   ARTICLE III
                                   -----------

                              Capital Contributions
                              ---------------------

         3.1 Initial Capital Contributions.  On or before the acquisition by the
Partnership of the oil and gas interest,  the General  Partner shall notify each
Partner of the amount of its Initial Capital  Contribution and the date on which
such Initial Capital Contribution is required. The Partners' respective share of
such Initial  Capital  Contribution  shall be in  proportion  to their  relative
Percentage  Interests  on the date of such  notice.  On or  before  the due date
specified in such notice,  each Partner  shall  contribute to the capital of the
Partnership its share of the Initial Capital  Contribution.  The Partnership may
not assign the Partners'  obligation to make an Initial Capital  Contribution to
any creditor or other third party.

         3.2 Additional Capital Contributions. If the General Partner determines
at any time that the  Partnership  requires  additional  cash  contributions  to
capital in order to pay when due the obligations and expenses of the Partnership
or otherwise to accomplish the Partnership's purposes, the General Partner shall
give written  notice to each Partner of the  amount(s) and date(s) on which such
additional  contributions are required.  The Partners' respective shares of each
additional  contribution required in such notice shall be in proportion to their
relative Percentage  Interests on the date of such notice. On or before each due
date specified in such notice,  each Partner shall  contribute to the capital of
the  Partnership  its share of the total amount to be  contributed on that date.
The  Partnership  may not assign the  Partners'  obligation  to make  Additional
Capital Contributions to any creditor or other third party.

         3.3 Failure to  Contribute.  If a Partner  (the  "Defaulting  Partner")
fails to make an Additional Capital Contributions within
                                        4
<PAGE>
ten (10) days after the same becomes due, such failure shall constitute a breach
of this Agreement.

                                   ARTICLE IV
                                   ----------

                       Distributions Prior to Liquidation
                       ----------------------------------

         4.1  Distributions of Net Available Cash Flow. Prior to the dissolution
of the Partnership and the commencement of the liquidation and winding up of its
assets and affairs, the Net Available Cash Flow (if any) shall be distributed at
such  time(s) as the  General  Partner  may  determine  in  accordance  with the
following priorities:

                      (a) First, to the repayment of any accrued interest on any
         and all Partner loans;

                      (b) Second, to the repayment of the outstanding  principal
         on any and all Partner loans; and

                      (c)  Third,   to  the  Partners  in  proportion  to  their
         Percentage Interests.

         4.2  Distributions In Liquidation.  All Net Available Cash Flow arising
after the dissolution of the Partnership and  commencement of liquidation  shall
be applied and distributed in accordance with Section 9.2 hereof.

                                    ARTICLE V
                                    ---------

                        Allocation of Profits and Losses
                        --------------------------------

         5.1 Profits and Losses. The Profits and Losses shall be allocated among
the Partners in proportion to their Percentage  Interests as of the close of the
taxable year or other appropriate  period for which Profits and Losses are being
allocated.

         5.2 Tax  Allocations.  For  income tax  purposes,  all items of income,
gain, loss,  deduction and credit of the Partnership for any tax period shall be
allocated  among the Partners in accordance  with the  allocations of Profit and
Loss prescribed in this Article V.

                                   ARTICLE VI
                                   ----------

                                   Management
                                   ----------

         6.1  General  Authority.  Subject to Section  6.2  hereof,  the General
Partner  shall have full and exclusive  responsibility  and authority to control
the  management of the  Partnership's  business and assets,  with all rights and
powers  necessary,  incidental  or  convenient  to  such  management,  including
(without  limitation)  all of the  rights and powers  that may be  possessed  by
general partners
                                        5
<PAGE>
under the Act and the specific power and authority on behalf of the  Partnership
to:

                      (a) Acquire by purchase,  lease or  otherwise  any real or
         personal  property that may be necessary,  appropriate or incidental to
         the accomplishment of the purposes of the Partnership;

                      (b)  Operate,   manage,  maintain,   finance,   refinance,
         improve,  construct,  raze,  own,  grant options with respect to, sell,
         exchange,  convey, assign,  mortgage, lease or otherwise dispose of and
         deal  with  any  real  property  and any  personal  property  as may be
         necessary,  convenient  or  incidental  to  the  accomplishment  of the
         purposes of the Partnership;

                      (c) Grant  options,  easements,  licenses,  servitudes and
         rights  of way  with  respect  to the  real  and  personal  assets  and
         properties  of the  Partnership  and enter into  agreements  respecting
         their use;

                      (d)  Execute  and  deliver  any   agreements,   contracts,
         certificates,  deeds,  bills of  sale,  pledges,  assignments,  leases,
         subleases,  stock  powers  and other  instruments  and  documents  with
         respect  to  the  real  and  personal  assets  and  properties  of  the
         Partnership  and in connection with the management and operation of the
         business and affairs of the Partnership;

                      (e)  Borrow  money,  execute  loan  agreements  and  other
         contracts,  issue  evidences of  indebtedness  and issue  guarantees or
         grant security for the debts of others, as may be necessary,  desirable
         or convenient in order to accomplish  the purposes of the  Partnership,
         and  secure  the same by deed of trust,  mortgage,  security  interest,
         pledge or other lien on any property;

                      (f) Execute,  in furtherance of any or all of the purposes
         of the Partnership, any deed, lease, easement, mortgage, deed of trust,
         mortgage note,  guaranty,  security agreement,  assignment as security,
         promissory note, bill of sale, contract or other instrument  purporting
         to convey or encumber any or all of the Partnership's property;

                      (g)  Prepay  in  whole  or  in  part,  refinance,  recast,
         increase,  modify or extend any  liabilities  affecting the Partnership
         and, in  connection  therewith,  execute any  extensions or renewals of
         encumbrances on any or all of the Partnership's property;

                      (h) Invest,  care for and distribute funds to the Partners
         by  way of  cash,  income,  return  of  capital  or  otherwise,  all in
         accordance with the provisions of this
                                        6
<PAGE>
         Agreement,  and perform all matters in furtherance of the objectives of
         the Partnership or this Agreement;

                      (i) Contract for the  employment and services of employees
         and/or  independent  contractors  and  delegate  to  such  persons  the
         management  or  supervision  of any of the assets or  operations of the
         Partnership;

                      (j)  Prosecute,  defend,  settle  or  compromise,  at  the
         Partnership's expense, any suits, actions or claims at law or in equity
         to which the Partnership is a party or by which it is affected,  as may
         be  necessary  or  proper  to  enforce  or  protect  the  Partnership's
         interests, and to satisfy out of Partnership funds any judgment, decree
         or  decision  of  any  court,   board,   agency  or  authority   having
         jurisdiction  or any  settlement of any suit,  action or claim prior to
         judgment or final decision thereon;

                      (k) Pay the expenses of the Partnership  from the funds of
         the Partnership, provided that all of the Partnership expenses shall be
         billed directly to and paid by the Partnership to the extent reasonably
         practicable;

                      (l) Vote at any election or meeting of any  corporation in
         which the Partnership  holds an interest in person, or by proxy, and to
         appoint agents to do so in their or its place;

                      (m)  Invest  the funds of the  Partnership  and  establish
         bank,  money market and other  accounts for the deposit of  Partnership
         funds and permit  withdrawals  therefrom  upon such  signatures  as the
         General  Partner  shall   designate;   provided,   however,   that  the
         Partnership's funds shall not be commingled with the funds of any other
         Person or entity;

                      (n) Compromise,  without the consent of any of the Limited
         Partners,  the  obligation  to return money or other  property  paid or
         distributed in violation of the Act;

                      (o) Establish and maintain reserves for proper Partnership
         purposes in such amounts as may be reasonably  appropriate from time to
         time to accomplish the purposes of the Partnership;

                      (p) Engage in any kind of  activity  and perform and carry
         out contracts of any kind  (including  contracts of insurance  covering
         risks to Partnership  property and general partner liability) necessary
         or incidental  to, or in connection  with,  the  accomplishment  of the
         purposes  of  the  Partnership  and  the  performance  of  the  General
         Partner's duties under this Agreement; and
                                        7
<PAGE>
                      (q) Make any and all  elections  for  federal,  state  and
         local tax purposes,  including,  without limitation,  any election,  if
         permitted by  applicable  law, to: (i) adjust the basis of  Partnership
         property   pursuant  to  Code  Sections  754,  734(b)  and  743(b),  or
         comparable  provisions  of state or local law, in  connection  with the
         transfers or  liquidations  of Partnership  interests;  (ii) extend the
         statute of  limitations  for  assessment  of tax  deficiencies  against
         Partners  with respect to  adjustments  to the  Partnership's  federal,
         state or local tax returns;  and (iii)  represent the  Partnership  and
         Partners before taxing authorities or courts of competent  jurisdiction
         in tax matters  affecting  the  Partnership  and the  Partners in their
         capacity as Partners and to execute any  agreements or other  documents
         relating to or affecting  such tax  matters,  including  agreements  or
         other  documents  that  bind  the  Partners  with  respect  to such tax
         matters. The General Partner is specially authorized to act as the "Tax
         Matters  Partner"  under Code  Section  6231(a)(7)  and in any  similar
         capacity under state or local law.

         6.2 Matters Requiring Unanimous Consent.  The General Partner shall not
have the right or  authority  to do any of the  following  without  the  written
approval of all of the Limited Partners:

                      (a)  admit  any  Person  to the  Partnership  as a General
         Partner,  except  as  expressly  permitted  under  the  terms  of  this
         Agreement;

                      (b)  cause  the  Partnership  to sell or  transfer  all or
         substantially all of its assets; or

                      (c)  amend  this  Agreement  in  any  respect;   provided,
         however,  that the General Partner may amend this Agreement without the
         consent of any  Limited  Partners:  (i) to add to the  representations,
         duties or obligations of the General  Partner or surrender any right or
         power  granted to the General  Partner  herein,  for the benefit of the
         Limited  Partners;  and  (ii) to cure  any  ambiguity,  to  correct  or
         supplement any provision hereof that may be inconsistent with any other
         provisions  hereof,  or to make any other  provision  with  respect  to
         matters or questions arising under this Agreement not inconsistent with
         the intent of this Agreement.

         6.3 Liability and  Indemnification of the General Partner.  The General
Partner shall not be liable, responsible, or accountable in damages or otherwise
to the  Partnership  or to any of the Limited  Partners  for any act or omission
performed or omitted in good faith  pursuant to the  authority  granted to it by
this  Agreement  in a manner  reasonably  believed to be within the scope of the
authority granted to it by this Agreement;  provided,  however, that the General
Partner  shall not be relieved of  liability  in respect of any claim,  issue or
matter as to which the General
                                        8
<PAGE>
Partner  shall have been  adjudged to be liable for gross  negligence or willful
misconduct in the performance of its fiduciary duty to the Partnership or to the
Limited  Partners.  The Partnership  shall indemnify the General Partner and its
affiliates  against  any loss,  damage or  judgment  incurred by it, and against
expenses  (including   attorneys'  fees  as  and  when  incurred)  actually  and
reasonably  incurred by it in  connection  with the defense or settlement of any
threatened,  pending  or  completed  action  or  suit,  arising  out of any  act
performed or omitted to be performed by the General  Partner and its affiliates.
The satisfaction of any indemnification shall be from and limited to Partnership
assets,  and no Limited  Partner  shall have any  personal  liability on account
thereof.

                                   ARTICLE VII
                                   -----------

                                Books and Records
                                -----------------

         7.1 Books and Records. The General Partner shall keep at its office the
books  and  records  required  to be  kept  by  Section  29-  305 of the  Act as
hereinafter amended. Any Partner or its designated representative shall have the
right,  at any  reasonable  time, to have access to and may inspect and copy (at
such  Partner's   expense)  the  contents  of  such  books  or  records  at  the
Partnership's  office.  At the discretion of the General Partner,  the financial
records  of the  Partnership  may be  reviewed  or  audited as of the end of any
fiscal  year  by an  independent  firm of  accountants,  at the  expense  of the
Partnership.

         7.2  Tax   Information.   The  General   Partner  shall   instruct  the
Partnership's  accountants,  at the expense of the  Partnership,  to prepare and
deliver all necessary tax returns and  information to each Partner,  including a
copy of the Partnership's  federal income tax return, within a reasonable period
following the end of each fiscal year.

                                  ARTICLE VIII
                                  ------------

                        Transfer of Partnership Interests
                        ---------------------------------

         8.1 In General.  Except as otherwise  set forth in this Article VIII, a
Limited  Partner and a Person who may succeed to the  Partnership  Interest of a
Limited Partner shall not sell, assign,  transfer,  pledge or hypothecate all or
any  portion of its  Partnership  Interest  without  either  the  consent of the
General Partner or compliance with Section 8.2 hereof. The General Partner shall
not sell,  assign,  transfer,  pledge or hypothecate all or any portion of their
respective Partnership Interests to any Person without the consent of all of the
Limited Partners. Any sale, assignment,  transfer,  pledge or hypothecation that
does not comply with the provisions of this Article VIII shall be void and shall
not cause or constitute a dissolution of the Partnership.
                                        9
<PAGE>
         8.2  Exception.  A Limited  Partner may sell,  assign or  transfer  its
Interest in the  Partnership  without the consent of the General Partner if each
of the following conditions have been satisfied:

                      (a) The  Limited  Partner  shall  have  first  offered  in
         writing to sell its entire  Partnership  Interest  (or portion  thereof
         proposed to be  transferred)  to the General  Partner for the same cash
         purchase price and upon the same terms and conditions as set forth in a
         bona fide purchase offer executed by the proposed  transferee,  and the
         General  Partner  shall have failed to accept such written offer within
         sixty (60) days after receipt of a copy of such purchase offer; and

                      (b)  such  Limited  Partner  and its  transferee  execute,
         acknowledge  and deliver to the General  Partner  such  instruments  of
         transfer and assignment with respect to such transaction as are in form
         and substance satisfactory to the General Partner.

If a sale,  transfer or  assignment of an Interest in the  Partnership  complies
with the  provisions of this Section 8.2 but the Person  acquiring such interest
is not admitted as a Substituted Limited Partner pursuant to Section 8.3 hereof,
such Person  shall be entitled to receive  distributions  and  allocations  with
respect to such interest as set forth in this Agreement, but shall have no right
to any information or accounting of the affairs of the Partnership, shall not be
entitled  to inspect the books or records of the  Partnership,  and shall not be
entitled to any of the rights of the General  Partner or a Limited Partner under
the Act or this Agreement.

         8.3 Substituted Limited Partner.  Except in the case of a transfer by a
Limited Partner to an entity all of the equity or beneficial  interests of which
are held exclusively by the Limited Partner,  no Person taking or acquiring,  by
whatever means,  any Interest in the Partnership of any Limited Partner shall be
admitted  as a  Substituted  Limited  Partner  without the consent of all of the
other Partners and unless such Person:

                      (a)  Elects to become a  Substituted  Limited  Partner  by
         evidencing written notice of such election to the Partnership; and

                      (b) Executes, acknowledges and delivers to the Partnership
         such other  instruments  as the General  Partner may deem  necessary or
         advisable  to effect  the  admission  of such  Person as a  Substituted
         Limited Partner, including,  without limitation, the written acceptance
         and adoption of such person of the provisions of this Agreement.
                                       10
<PAGE>
The General  Partner shall amend Exhibit A attached  hereto from time to time to
reflect the admission of Substituted Limited Partners.

                                   ARTICLE IX
                                   ----------

                           Dissolution and Winding Up
                           --------------------------

         9.1  Dissolution.  No Partner shall take any action to dissolve (or any
action  that  would  cause  the  dissolution  of) the  Partnership  prior to the
expiration of the term of the Partnership,  except as expressly permitted by the
provisions of this Section 9.1. The Partnership shall dissolve upon the first to
occur of any of the following events:

                      (a) The unanimous written agreement of all Partners at any
         time;

                      (b)  The  expiration  of  the  term  of  the   Partnership
         specified in this Agreement as amended;

                      (c)  The   acquisition   by  one  Person  of  all  of  the
         outstanding Interests in the Partnership;

                      (d) The entry of a dissolution  decree with respect to the
         Partnership  by a court of competent  jurisdiction  pursuant to Section
         29-345 of the Act; or

                      (e) An event of withdrawal as described in Section  29-323
         with respect to a General Partner, unless at the time there is at least
         one other General Partner, or a new General Partner is elected pursuant
         to Section 10.3,  and the business of the  Partnership  is continued by
         the written  consent of such remaining or new General  Partners and the
         written  consent of a Majority in  Interest  of the  Limited  Partners,
         given within ninety (90) days of such event.

         9.2 Winding  Up. Upon a  dissolution  of the  Partnership,  the General
Partner shall take full account of the Partnership's liabilities and assets, and
the Partnership  shall be liquidated as promptly as is consistent with obtaining
the fair value thereof.  The proceeds of liquidation,  to the extent  sufficient
therefor, shall be applied and distributed in the following order:

                      (a) To the payment and discharge of all the  Partnership's
         debts  and  liabilities  (other  than  those to the  General  Partner),
         including the establishment of any necessary reserves;

                      (b) To the  payment of any debts and  liabilities  owed to
         the General Partner; and
                                       11
<PAGE>
                      (c) To the Partners in  accordance  with their  respective
         Percentage Interests.

                                    ARTICLE X
                                    ---------

                      Events Affecting the General Partner
                      ------------------------------------

         10.1  Cessation.  The  General  Partner  shall  cease to be the General
Partner upon the transfer of its entire  Interest in the Partnership or upon its
withdrawal in accordance  with Section 10.2 hereof,  or the occurrence of any of
the events set forth in Section  29-323 of the Act.  Upon the  occurrence of any
such event,  such Person or its  transferee  or other  successor  shall have the
right to receive  distributions  and allocations with respect to its Partnership
Interest,  shall be treated as the transferee of such  interest,  and shall have
the  right to  become a  General  Partner  only  with the  consent  of all other
Partners.

         10.2 Withdrawal of a General  Partner.  Upon thirty (30) days notice to
the Partners,  the General  Partner may withdraw as General Partner at any time,
provided  that the General  Partner  delivers to the  Partnership  an opinion of
competent  counsel to the effect that such withdrawal will not adversely  affect
the  classification  of the  Partnership as a partnership for federal income tax
purposes.

         10.3 Election of a New General Partner.  In the event any Person ceases
to be a General Partner  pursuant to Section 10.1, and as a consequence  thereof
the Partnership has no General Partner,  any Limited Partner may nominate one or
more Persons for election as the General Partner to continue the Partnership and
its business.  No Person so nominated  shall become the General  Partner  unless
elected by an affirmative vote of all of the Limited Partners.

                                   ARTICLE XI
                                   ----------

                                  Miscellaneous
                                  -------------

         11.1 Notices. Any notice or demand required or permitted to be given by
any  provision  of this  Agreement  shall be in writing  and shall be  delivered
personally to the Person to whom the same is directed (or to an officer, general
partner,  member,  manager  or  trustee of such  Person  that is a  corporation,
partnership,  limited  liability  company  or  trust) or sent by  registered  or
certified mail, addressed as follows: if to the Partnership,  to the Partnership
at the  address of its  principal  office;  if to the  General  Partner,  to the
address set forth in Exhibit A attached hereto,  or to such other address as the
General Partner may from time to time specify by notice to the Partners;  and if
to a Limited  Partner,  to such  Limited  Partner  at the  address  set forth in
Exhibit A attached hereto,  or to such other address as such Limited Partner may
from time to time specify by notice to the Partnership.
                                       12
<PAGE>
Any such notice  shall be deemed to be  delivered,  given and  received  for all
purposes as of the date so delivered, if delivered personally, or as of the date
on which the same was  deposited in a regularly  maintained  receptacle  for the
deposit of United States mail, if sent by registered or certified mail,  postage
and charges prepaid.

         11.2 Binding  Effect.  Except as otherwise  provided in this Agreement,
every  covenant,  term and provision of this Agreement shall be binding upon and
inure to the benefit of the Partners and their respective heirs, legatees, legal
representatives, successors, transferees and assigns.

         11.3 Construction. Every covenant, term and provision of this Agreement
shall be construed according to its fair meaning and not strictly for or against
any Partner.

         11.4 Headings.  Section and other headings  contained in this Agreement
are for  reference  purposes  only and are not intended to describe,  interpret,
define or limit the scope or  application  of this  Agreement  or any  provision
hereof.

         11.5 Severability.  Every provision of this Agreement is intended to be
severable.  If any term or provision hereof is illegal or invalid for any reason
whatsoever,  such  illegality  or  invalidity  shall not affect the  validity or
legality of the remainder of this Agreement.

         11.6  Incorporation  by  Reference.  Every  exhibit and other  appendix
attached to this Agreement and referred to herein is hereby incorporated in this
Agreement by reference.

         11.7  Additional  Documents.  Each  Partner,  upon the  request  of the
General Partner, agrees to perform all further acts and execute, acknowledge and
deliver any documents that may be reasonably necessary, appropriate or desirable
to carry out the provisions of this Agreement.

         11.8  Variation of Pronouns.  All pronouns and any  variations  thereof
shall be deemed to refer to masculine,  feminine or neuter,  singular or plural,
as the identity of the Person or Persons may require.

         11.9  Arizona  Law.  The laws of the State of Arizona,  without  giving
effect to its principles of conflicts of laws, shall govern the validity of this
Agreement,  the construction of its terms, and the  interpretation of the rights
and duties of the Partners.

         11.10 Waiver of Action for Partition.  Each of the Partners irrevocably
waives any right that he may have to  maintain  any  action for  partition  with
respect to any of the Partnership's assets and properties.
                                       13
<PAGE>
         11.11  Counterpart  Execution.  This  Agreement  may be executed in any
number of counterparts with the same effect as if all of the Partners had signed
the same  document.  All  counterparts  shall be  construed  together  and shall
constitute one agreement.

         11.12 Sole and Absolute  Discretion.  Except as  otherwise  provided in
this  Agreement,  all  actions  that  the  General  Partner  may  take  and  all
determinations  that the General Partner may make pursuant to this Agreement may
be taken and made at the sole and absolute discretion of the General Partner.

                      IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have entered into this
Agreement as of the day first above set forth.

                                             GENERAL PARTNER:
                                             ----------------


                                             DEL WEBB CORPORATION, a Delaware
                                             corporation



                                             By: /s/ Robertson C. Jones
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Robertson C. Jones
                                                Its: Vice President




                                             LIMITED PARTNER:
                                             ----------------


                                             NEW MEXICO ASSET CORPORATION, an
                                             Arizona corporation



                                             By: /s/ David E. Rau
                                                --------------------------------
                                                David E. Rau
                                                Its: Vice President

                                       14
<PAGE>
STATE OF ARIZONA                    )
                                    :ss.
COUNTY OF MARICOPA                  )

                  The foregoing  instrument was acknowledged before me this 23rd
day of May,  1996,  by  Robertson  C.  Jones,  the  Vice  President  of Del Webb
Corporation, a Delaware corporation, on behalf of the corporation.



My Commission Expires:                 /s/ Susan L. Davis                 
                                       -----------------------------------------
[SEAL]                                 NOTARY PUBLIC

   May 1, 1998                         Residing at Maricopa County, Arizona
- ----------------------                            ------------------------------






STATE OF ARIZONA                    )
                                    :ss.
COUNTY OF MARICOPA                  )

                  The foregoing  instrument was acknowledged before me this 23rd
day of May,  1996,  by David E. Rau,  the Vice  President  of New  Mexico  Asset
Corporation, an Arizona corporation, on behalf of the corporation.



My Commission Expires:                 /s/ Susan L. Davis                       
                                       -----------------------------------------
[SEAL]                                 NOTARY PUBLIC                            
                                                                                
   May 1, 1998                         Residing at Maricopa County, Arizona     
- ----------------------                            ------------------------------

                                       15
<PAGE>
                                    EXHIBIT A

                              SCHEDULE OF PARTNERS
                              --------------------





GENERAL PARTNER:

                                                     Percentage    First Capital
Name                        Address                   Interest     Contribution
- ----                        -------                   --------     ------------

Del Webb                    6001 North 24th Street        1%         $      .01
Corporation                 Phoenix, Arizona  85016




LIMITED PARTNER:

                                                     Percentage    First Capital
Name                        Address                   Interest     Contribution
- ----                        -------                   --------     ------------

New Mexico Asset            6001 North 24th Street       99%         $      .99
Corporation                 Phoenix, Arizona  85016   --------     -------------

                                                        100%         $     1.00

                                                                   Exhibit 10.30


                              DEL WEBB CORPORATION

                   SUPPLEMENTAL EXECUTIVE RETIREMENT PLAN NO.1

                             PARTICIPATION AGREEMENT
                         (Amended and Restated Effective
                              as of July 25, 1996)


         This  amended and restated  Participation  Agreement is entered into of
this  25th  day  of  July,  1996,  between  Del  Webb  Corporation,  a  Delaware
corporation ("Employer"), and Philip J. Dion ("Participant").

                                    RECITALS
                                    --------

         A.    Employer and Participant  previously entered into a Participation
Agreement  dated  as  of  December  5,  1986  providing  for   participation  by
Participant,  beginning  on  January  1,  1986,  in the Del E. Webb  Corporation
Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan (the "Plan").

         B.    The Plan was restated as of January 1, 1989 and  redesignated the
Supplemental  Executive  Retirement  Plan No.1 and was further  amended and then
further  amended  and  restated  as of April  20,  1993.  The Plan also has been
amended on two separate occasions since its 1993 restatement.

         C.    Employer  and  Participant   desire  to  amend  and  restate  the
Participation  Agreement and to modify and  supplement the Plan as it relates to
Participant,  all as set forth herein. 


         NOW, THEREFORE, the parties hereby agree as follows: 

1. GENERAL
   -------

         This   Agreement   restates  and   reaffirms   Participant's   original
Participation  Agreement,  which was entered into on December 5, 1986, and which
was effective as of January 1, 1986. Participant's  participation in the Plan is
hereby reaffirmed.

2. THE PLAN
   --------

         This  Participation  Agreement  is  subject  to all of  the  terms  and
provisions  of the Plan,  except to the  extent  that the Plan is  modified  and
supplemented  below  as  it  applies  to  Participant.  The  Plan  is  expressly
incorporated  by reference into this  Participation  Agreement.  By signing this
Participation Agreement,  Participant acknowledges receipt of a copy of the Plan
and confirms his  understanding  and acceptance of all of the terms,  conditions
and provisions of the Plan.
<PAGE>
3. MODIFICATIONS
   -------------

         Pursuant to paragraph  8.3 of the Plan,  the  provisions of the Plan as
they apply to Participant are modified and supplemented as follows:

         (a)   Years of  Service.  For each  "Year of  Service,"  as  defined in
paragraph 2.3(b) of the Plan, or portion  thereof,  on or after January 1, 1989,
Participant  shall be credited  with 1.5 times such Year of Service,  or portion
thereof, for all purposes under the Plan.

         (b)   Normal Retirement Date.  Participant's  "Normal Retirement Date,"
as defined in paragraph 4.1(b) of the Plan, shall be age 55.

         (C)   Normal Form of Benefit Payments.Notwithstanding  paragraph 4.5(a)
of the Plan, any benefits  payable to  Participant  pursuant to paragraph 4.2 of
the Plan (the Normal Retirement  Benefit  provision) will be payable in one lump
sum  within  thirty  (30) days  following  Participant's  termination  of active
employment.   Except  as  otherwise  provided  in  paragraph  3(f),  below,  the
provisions  of paragraph  4.5(a) of the Plan,  as it may be amended from time to
time,  will  apply to the  payment  of  benefits  to  Participant  if his active
employment  terminates prior to his Normal Retirement Date. For purposes of this
Participation  Agreement,  service as an  independent  contractor  consultant or
board member will not be considered to be "active employment."

         (d)   Actuarial  Equivalence.  For  purposes of  determining  actuarial
equivalence  pursuant to paragraph  4.5(b) of the Plan, the following  actuarial
factors and assumptions shall be utilized:

          Interest Rate:      The average Pension Benefit  Guaranty  Corporation
                              ("PBGC")  immediate  annuity interest rate for the
                              36 months prior to the month in which the payments
                              begin
                            
          Mortality Table:    The PBGC immediate  annuity  mortality table as in
                              effect for the month in which the payments begin

         (e)   Accelerated Distribution.  The ten percent (10%) penalty provided
by  paragraph  4.5(d) of the Plan  shall not apply to any  distribution  made to
Participant pursuant to paragraph 4.2 of the Plan (the Normal Retirement Benefit
provision) and paragraph 3(c), above.  Except as otherwise provided in paragraph
3(f),  below, the provisions of paragraph 4.5(d) of the Plan,  including the ten
percent (10%)  penalty,  shall apply to any  distribution  to Participant if his
active  employment (as such term is used and defined in paragraph  3(c),  above)
terminates prior to his Normal Retirement Date.

         (f)   Termination  Without  Cause or for Good Reason.  If prior to this
Normal  Retirement  Date  Participant's  employment  is  terminated  by Employer
without Cause or by 

                                      -2-
<PAGE>
Participant for Good Reason,  (i) Participant  shall continue to accrue benefits
under the Plan until his Normal  Retirement  Date to the same  extent and on the
same basis as if  Participant's  employment  were actually  continued  until his
Normal Retirement Date; (ii) Participant's employment will then be considered to
terminate on his Normal  Retirement Date; (iii)  Participant will be entitled to
begin to receive  payments  following  his Normal  Retirement  Date  pursuant to
paragraph  4.2 of the Plan;  and (iv) for purposes of  paragraphs  3(c) and (e),
above,  Participant  will be deemed to be in the active  employment  of Employer
until his Normal Retirement Date.

         (g)   Definitions  For  purposes  of the Plan  and  this  Participation
Agreement,  the terms "Cause",  "Change in Control" and "Good Reason" shall have
the meanings ascribed to those terms in the Employment and Consulting  Agreement
entered into between Employer and Participant,  dated as of the date hereof,  as
it may be amended  from time to time,  rather than the  definitions  included in
paragraph 4.6 of the Plan. The Employment and Consulting  Agreement includes two
definitions  of Good Reason,  the standard  definition  that applies  prior to a
Change  in  Control  and a special  definition  that  applies  after a Change in
Control.  The standard  definition  will apply for purposes of the Plan and this
Participation Agreement unless and until a Change in Control occurs, after which
the special post-Change in Control definition will apply.

                                    EMPLOYER:
                                    DEL WEBB CORPORATION


                                    By: /s/ Lynn Schuttenberg
                                       ----------------------
                                       Title: Vice President, Human Resources

                                    PARTICIPANT:

                                    /s/ Philip J. Dion
                                    ------------------
                                    Philip J. Dion

                                       -3-

                                                                   Exhibit 10.31

August 8, 1995


Mr. Philip J. Dion
Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer
Del Webb Corporation

         RE:      1995/96 Executive Management Incentive Plan Award Agreement

Dear Phil:

         Del  Webb   Corporation  (the  "Company")  has  adopted  the  Del  Webb
Corporation  1995 Executive  Management  Incentive Plan (the "Plan").  Under the
Plan, the Human Resources  Committee (the "Committee") of the Company's Board of
Directors is authorized to make awards of performance-based compensation to you.

         The Committee has decided to make an award to you pursuant to which you
may become entitled to receive  performance-based  compensation.  The payment of
the performance-based compensation is subject to the terms and provisions of the
Plan and this letter, which is the "Award Agreement".

         1.  Performance  Compensation:  The maximum amount of your  Performance
Compensation  will  depend  on the  level  at  which  the  Performance  Goal  is
satisfied.  For fiscal  year  ended June 30,  1996  ("Performance  Period")  the
Committee will evaluate  performance under one or more of the following specific
performance elements:  3.75% of after tax net earnings;  revenue growth relative
to the revenue growth of the proxy  comparator peer group;  and/or unit closings
growth relative to the unit closings growth of the proxy  comparator peer group.
The  Performance  Compensation  and  Performance  Goals  under which the 1995/96
Performance Award will be made are set forth in Exhibit A.

         If the Performance  Goals are satisfied during the Performance  Period,
you will be entitled to receive the  Performance  Compensation  provided by this
paragraph, subject to the discretionary adjustment provisions of paragraph 2. If
the Performance  Goal evaluation is not satisfied at the minimum level, you will
not be entitled to receive any performance-based compensation.

         Your Performance  Compensation,  if any, will be paid to you as soon as
administratively  feasible  following the date the Committee  certifies that the
Performance Goals for the Performance Period have been satisfied.
<PAGE>
Mr. Philip J. Dion
August 8, 1995
Page 2


         2. Discretionary Adjustments:  We have set the Performance Compensation
that could be  payable to you upon  attainment  of the  Performance  Goals at an
intentionally high level. We have followed this approach because under the terms
of the Plan the  Committee has the  discretion  to reduce or eliminate  (but not
increase) the amount of your Performance Compensation on the basis of subjective
factors the Committee determines to be appropriate.  The Committee reserves this
right.

         3.  Status  of Plan:  This  Award  Agreement  is made  pursuant  to the
provisions of the Plan. The Plan is  incorporated  herein and a copy is attached
as Exhibit B. In the event of any conflict  between the  provisions  of the Plan
and this Award Agreement, the provisions of the Plan control.

         4. Deferral of Payments: You may elect to defer all or a portion of the
Performance  Compensation payable to you pursuant to the terms and provisions of
the Del Webb Corporation  Deferred  Compensation Plan. Any such election must be
made on or before December 15, 1995.

         5.  Amendments:  This Award  Agreement may be amended only by a written
agreement  executed  by the Company  and you.  Any changes  required in order to
qualify the Performance  Compensation as performance-based  compensation for the
purposes of Section 162(m) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, however, may be
unilaterally adopted by the Company without your consent.

         Please  execute the  acknowledgment  in the enclosed extra copy of this
letter and return it in the enclosed self-addressed, stamped envelope.

                                             DEL WEBB CORPORATION

                                             By: _______________________________
                                             Chairman, Human Resources Committee

                                 ACKNOWLEDGMENT
                                 --------------

         I  acknowledge  receipt  of a copy of the  Del  Webb  Corporation  1995
Executive  Management Incentive Plan. I also acknowledge that no amounts will be
payable to me pursuant to the Plan or this Award  Agreement  if the  Performance
Goals referred to above are not attained within the Performance  Period.  I also
acknowledge  that  the  Committee  has  the  right  to  reduce  the  Performance
Compensation  in  the  exercise  of its  discretion.  I  accept  the  terms  and
provisions of this Award Agreement and the Plan.

DATED: ____________________, 1995            ___________________________________
                                             Your signature

<PAGE>
PERFORMANCE BASED INCENTIVE PLAN - EXHIBIT A
FY 96 DEL WEBB CORPORATION
PERFORMANCE GOALS
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

(1) 
                         3.75% AFTER-TAX EARNINGS
                        -------------------------
                                     Performance         (2)                      DEL WEBB
                                    Compensation                                  HOUSING       MAXIMUM
                        $$$         (Thousands)                                   REVENUE       --------------
                        ---         -------------                                 GROWTH        Performance
                                                                                                Compensation
                                                                                                (Thousands)
                                                                                  -----------   --------------
<S>                      <C>            <C>                                            <C>             <C>   
                         48,055         $1,800                                         +5.00%          $1,750
                         43,755         $1,640                                         +4.00%          $1,600
                         39,455         $1,480                                         +3.00%          $1,450
                         35,155         $1,320                                         +2.00%          $1,300
Budget                   30,855         $1,160                                         +1.00%          $1,150
                         26,855         $1,010           Peer Group Avg. Inc.        ----              $1,000
                         22,855           $860                                         -1.00%            $850
                         18,855           $710                                         -2.00%            $700
                         14,855           $560                                         -3.00%            $550
                         10,855           $410                                         -4.00%            $400
                          6,855           $260                                         -5.00%            $250


(3)
                  DEL WEBB
                  -----------       MAXIMUM
                   UNIT            Performance
                  CLOSINGS         Compensation
                  GROWTH           (Thousands)
                  -----------      -------------

                         +5.00%         $1,750
                         +4.00%         $1,600
                         +3.00%         $1,450
                         +2.00%         $1,300
                         +1.00%         $1,150
Peer Group Avg. Inc.  ----              $1,000
                         -1.00%           $850
                         -2.00%           $700
                         -3.00%           $550
                         -4.00%           $400
                         -5.00%           $250
</TABLE>
                                                        
NOTES:

(1)  After-tax  earnings  for FY 96 have been  budgeted  at  $30.9M.  Under this
criterion,  the  performance  compensation  is  computed  at 3.75%  of  achieved
results.  This chart depicts  various  performance  compensation  maximums under
several possible scenarios.

(2)  This  performance  compensation  criterion  will be based  upon the  actual
average  housing  revenue growth  experienced by the  homebuilder  peer group as
defined  below.  The  maximum  performance  compensation  will  then  vary by 1%
increments from the peer group average, calculated from the most recent trailing
four quarters of SEC filed  information,  within the stated maximum  performance
compensation  range of  $1.75M  to  $0.25M.  For FY 95,  the  Company's  housing
revenues totaled $764.5M.

(3)  This  performance  compensation  criterion  will be based  upon the  actual
average  unit  closings  growth  experienced  by the  homebuilder  peer group as
defined  below.  The  maximum  performance  compensation  will  then  vary by 1%
increments from the peer group average, calculated from the most recent trailing
four quarters of SEC filed  information,  within the stated maximum  performance
compensation  range of $1.75M to $0.25M.  For FY 95, the Company's unit closings
totaled 4,316.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Homebuilder Peer Group:  Centex  Corporation,  Continental  Homes Holding Corp.,
Hovnanian   Enterprises,   Inc.,  Kaufman  &  Broad  Home  Corporation,   Lennar
Corporation,  Pulte Corporation, The Ryland Group, Inc., Standard Pacific Corp.,
and Toll Brothers, Inc.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                                                   Exhibit 10.32

Key Executive Life Plan Plus                             


Number of Participants: 60

Total Initial Death Benefit: $23,500,000
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan PLUS (KELP PLUS)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

         THIS AGREEMENT,  is made as of the _____ day of______________  l9__, by
and between Del Webb  Corporation,  and its successors and assigns,  of Phoenix,
Arizona, hereinafter called the Corporation, and_________________

         WHEREAS,  ________________________ hereinafter called the Employee, has
rendered service to the Corporation, and,

         WHEREAS,  the  Corporation  wishes to provide a death  benefit  for the
Employee  and/or the  Employee's  designee  through the Key Executive  Life Plan
PLUS, and,

         WHEREAS,  the Employee agrees to participate in such plan to the extent
hereinafter provided,

         NOW THEREFORE, it is mutually agreed that:

Insurance Policies                  1. In  furtherance  of the  purpose  of this
                                    Agreement, life insurance is to be purchased
                                    on  the  life   of__________________________
                                    hereinafter  called  the  Insured,  from Sun
                                    Life  Assurance   Company  of  Canada  under
                                    Policy  Number__________  hereinafter called
                                    the Policy.

Security                            2.  As   security   for  the   Corporation's
                                    interest in the Cash Surrender  Value of the
                                    Policy,  the Employee  shall  execute,  on a
                                    form acceptable to the insurance  company, a
                                    collateral  assignment to the Corporation of
                                    certain  specified rights in the Policy,  as
                                    set forth in Article 5.  Except as  provided
                                    in  Article  5,  ownership  of the  Policy's
                                    rights,  including  but not  limited  to the
                                    right to name the  beneficiary,  shall  rest
                                    with the Employee

Premiums                            3. All  premiums  due on the Policy shall be
                                    paid  by  the  Corporation.   However,   the
                                    Employee  shall  reimburse  the  Corporation
                                    each year in an amount  that is equal to the
                                    value,   as   determined   for  federal  tax
                                    purposes,  of the "economic benefit" derived
                                    by  the  Employee  from  the  Policy's  life
                                    insurance  protection.   The  Employee  will
                                    receive  Compensation  in addition to annual
                                    salary each year in an amount  equal to this
                                    reimbursement  This additional  compensation
                                    and reimbursement may be in the form of book
                                    entries  rather than the actual  exchange of
                                    cash or checks.

                                       1
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan PLUS (KELP PLUS)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

Termination                         4.   This   Agreement   shall    immediately
                                    terminate for any of the following  reasons:
                                    termination of the Employee's employment for
                                    any reason;  submission of written notice to
                                    terminate by either party to this  Agreement
                                    to the other party; the death of the Insured
                                    and  the  payment  of  any  death   benefits
                                    pursuant  hereto;   or  any  action  by  the
                                    Corporation  which would impair,  reduce, or
                                    defeat  the   Employee's   interest  in  the
                                    Policy. Such action by the Corporation might
                                    include but is not limited to  surrender  or
                                    lapse  of  the  Policy  for   nonpayment  of
                                    premiums.

                                         If this  Agreement  terminates at least
                                    five   years   after   the   date   of  this
                                    Agreement)the Employee shall have the right,
                                    exercisable  within  90  days,  to  obtain a
                                    release of the Corporation's interest in the
                                    Policy  by  paying  to the  Corporation  its
                                    interest  in the  Policy  as  determined  in
                                    Article  6(2).  Upon receipt of such amount,
                                    the  Corporation  shall either  transfer the
                                    Policy  to the  Employee  or  transfer  such
                                    interest  to  the  party  designated  by the
                                    Employee.  The Corporation agrees to execute
                                    all  documents  necessary  to  transfer  the
                                    Policy to the  Employee or his/her  assigns.
                                    If the  Employee  does not  timely  exercise
                                    this right, the Corporation may exercise its
                                    rights under Article 5.

Corporation's Rights                5.   Under  the  terms  of  the   collateral
                                    assignment  of the Policy,  the  Corporation
                                    shall have the following  rights:  the right
                                    to  receive,   upon   termination   of  this
                                    Agreement,    an   amount   equal   to   the
                                    Corporation's  interest in the Policy's Cash
                                    Surrender Value, as determined in accordance
                                    with  Articles  6(1) and 6(2);  the right to
                                    release the collateral assignment; the right
                                    to  surrender  or  partially  surrender  the
                                    Policy  upon the  giving of 14 days  advance
                                    written notice of the Corporation's exercise
                                    of its right to  surrender  the Policy;  and
                                    the right to make and receive  loans against
                                    the Policy to the extent of its  interest as
                                    defined in Article 6(4).

                                         Any  rights to  Policy  values or death
                                    benefits  in  excess  of  the  Corporation's
                                    interest  shall be owned by and  payable to,
                                    or as designated by, the Employee.

                                         Any    designation    or    change   of
                                    beneficiary   or  change  in   election   of
                                    settlement  options  or  exercise  of policy
                                    rights   shall  be  made   subject  to  this
                                    Agreement  and  the   Corporation's   rights
                                    hereunder.

                                        2
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan PLUS (KELP PLUS)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

                                         Policy rights shall be  exercisable  by
                                    the  sole  signature  of a  duly  authorized
                                    representative of the Corporation.

                                         The Corporation  agrees to refrain from
                                    making loans or partial  surrenders  against
                                    the  Policy  in an amount  greater  than its
                                    interest  under  the  Policy as  defined  in
                                    Article 6(4) The parties agree that Sun Life
                                    Assurance Company of Canada is authorized to
                                    recognize the Corporation's  right to borrow
                                    without   the   insurance    company   being
                                    responsible  for the  calculation of amounts
                                    permitted   to  be   borrowed   and  without
                                    investigation  of the  validity or amount of
                                    the  request by the  Corporation  to borrow.
                                    The  sole  signature  of a  duly  authorized
                                    representative  of the Corporation  shall be
                                    sufficient   for   the   exercise   of   the
                                    Corporation's right to borrow and shall be a
                                    full  discharge  and  release  to  Sun  Life
                                    Assurance  Company of Canada.  The  Employee
                                    shall  not  have  the  right  to make a loan
                                    against the Policy or otherwise  have access
                                    to cash  surrender  values  unless and until
                                    such time as the  Employee's  employment  is
                                    terminated or the Corporation's  interest in
                                    the Policy  terminates  in  accordance  with
                                    this Agreement.

Corporation's Interest              6. For  purposes  of  Articles  4 and 5, the
                                    amount  receivable by the  Corporation  upon
                                    (1) death of the Insured, (2) termination of
                                    this  Agreement  for reason other than death
                                    of the  Insured,  (3)  surrender  or partial
                                    surrender of the Policy,  or (4) exercise of
                                    the loan right by the  Corporation  shall be
                                    as follows:

                                         (1) Upon  termination of this Agreement
                                    resulting  from  death of the  Insured,  the
                                    Corporation's  share of the  Policy's  death
                                    benefit  shall  be an  amount  equal  to its
                                    Aggregate   Premiums  paid'  as  defined  in
                                    Article  6(5),  plus  that  portion  of  the
                                    remaining  death  benefits  payable from the
                                    Policy,  if any, that exceeds the applicable
                                    amount set forth on  Appendix  A  determined
                                    for the Executive's plan year at the time of
                                    death, which Appendix is attached hereto and
                                    incorporated herein by this reference.

                                         (2) Upon  termination of this Agreement
                                    for  reasons  other  than  the  death of the
                                    Insured,  if such termination  occurs within
                                    the five-year  period  following the date of
                                    this Agreement,  the Corporation's  share of
                                    the  Policy  shall  be  the  Cash  Surrender
                                    Value. For terminations  occurring after the
                                    five-year period, the Corporation's share of
                                    the Policy's Cash  Surrender  Value shall be
                                    an amount  equal to its  Aggregate  Premiums
                                    paid;  the excess,  if any, of the  Policy's
                                    Cash

                                        3
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan PLUS (KELP PLUS)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

                                    Surrender   Value   shall   accrue   to  the
                                    Employee.  After the five-year  period,  the
                                    Employee shall have the options as stated in
                                    Article 4, paragraph 2.

                                         (3) Upon the Corporation's surrender or
                                    partial   surrender   of   the   Policy   in
                                    accordance with Article 5, if such surrender
                                    or  partial   surrender  occurs  within  the
                                    five-year  period following the date of this
                                    Agreement,  the  Corporation's  share of the
                                    Policy shall be the Cash Surrender Value For
                                    surrenders or partial  surrenders  occurring
                                    after    the    five-year    period,     the
                                    Corporation's  share  of the  Policy's  Cash
                                    Surrender  Value shall be an amount equal to
                                    its Aggregate  Premiums paid; the excess, if
                                    any, of the Policy's  Cash  Surrender  Value
                                    shall be paid to the Employee.

                                         (4)  If  the  Corporation  obtains  any
                                    loans against the Policy,  the amount of the
                                    loans  together  with the  interest  thereon
                                    shall  at  no  time  exceed  the   Aggregate
                                    Premiums paid.

                                         (5) "Aggregate Premiums" shall mean all
                                    premiums paid by the Corporation,  including
                                    premiums paid for any extra  benefit  riders
                                    or  agreements  issued  under the Policy and
                                    shall be reduced by any indebtedness and any
                                    accrued  unpaid  interest  incurred  by  the
                                    Corporation  on the Policy and the amount of
                                    any  Policy  dividends  used  to  reduce  or
                                    offset such premiums.

                                         (6) "Cash  Surrender  Value" shall mean
                                    an  amount  that  equals,  at any  specified
                                    time,  the  cash  surrender  value  provided
                                    under the Policy at that time.

                                         Notwithstanding   any  of  the   above,
                                    during  the  five-year  period   immediately
                                    following  the date of this  Agreement,  the
                                    Corporation  shall have the right,  upon the
                                    termination of this  Agreement,  or upon the
                                    surrender or partial surrender of the policy
                                    for reason  other than death of the insured,
                                    to cause to be transferred  all interests in
                                    the policy from the Employee, and to receive
                                    such from the  Employee or former  Employee,
                                    within  a  60  day  period   following  such
                                    termination,  surrender or partial surrender
                                    of the policy. The Employee hereby agrees to
                                    comply   with   such    request   from   the
                                    Corporation to initiate the transfer.

                                        4
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan PLUS (KELP PLUS)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

Application for Additional          7. Should the parties to this Agreement deem
Agreements or Riders                it desirable,  application may be made for a
                                    supplemental  agreement  or rider  providing
                                    for the  waiver  of Policy  premiums  in the
                                    event of the Insured's total disability,  if
                                    such   agreement   or   rider   is   now  or
                                    subsequently  made available by the Insurer.
                                    Any additional premium  attributable to such
                                    agreement  or  rider  shall  be  paid by the
                                    Corporation.  Waived  premiums  shall not be
                                    treated as paid by the Corporation.

Named Fiduciary                     8. For purposes of the  Employee  Retirement
                                    Income Security Act of 1974, the Corporation
                                    is  the   "named   fiduciary"   of  the  Key
                                    Executive  Life  Plan  PLUS for  which  this
                                    Agreement is hereby  designated  the written
                                    plan instrument.

Claims and  Review                  9. At the Insured's  death,  the Corporation
Procedure                           arid the  beneficiary  designated to receive
                                    death  benefits shall execute such forms and
                                    furnish such other  documents or information
                                    as are required to receive payment under the
                                    Policy.  The Corporation  shall also furnish
                                    to Sun Life  Assurance  Company of Canada an
                                    affidavit  specifying  the  amount  of death
                                    benefits   payable  to  the  Corporation  as
                                    defined in Article 6(1).

                                         With  respect  to  claims  against  the
                                    Corporation  arising  under this  Agreement,
                                    the following procedure shall be used:

                                         The  claimant  shall  file a claim  for
                                    benefits by  notifying  the  Corporation  in
                                    writing. If the claim is wholly or partially
                                    denied,  the  Corporation  shall  provide  a
                                    written notice within 90 days specifying the
                                    reason for the  denial,  the  provisions  of
                                    this  Agreement on which the denial is based
                                    and   additional   material  or  information
                                    necessary to receive benefits, if any. Also,
                                    such written notice shall indicate the steps
                                    to be  taken if a review  of the  denial  is
                                    desired.

                                         If a claim is  denied  and a review  is
                                    desired,   the  claimant  shall  notify  the
                                    Corporation  in writing within 60 days after
                                    receipt  of  written  notice  of a denial of
                                    claim In  requesting a review,  the claimant
                                    may  review  plan  documents  and submit any
                                    written issues and comments he/she feels are
                                    appropriate.   The  Corporation  shall  then
                                    review  the  claim  and  provide  a  written
                                    decision  within  60  days of  receipt  of a
                                    request for a review.  This  decision  shall
                                    state the specific  reasons for the decision
                                    and shall  include  references  to  specific
                                    provisions on which the decision is based.

                                        5
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan PLUS (KELP PLUS)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

                                         In no  event  shall  the  Corporation's
                                    liability  under this  Agreement  exceed the
                                    amount of the death  benefit as  provided in
                                    Appendix A.

Payment of Death                    10.  In  lieu of the  lump  sum  payable  at
Benefits                            Insured's   death,   the  Employee  may,  in
                                    accordance   with  the   procedures  of  the
                                    insurance company, elect any of the optional
                                    modes of payment  for the death  benefits as
                                    enumerated   in  the  Policy  and  known  as
                                    "settlement  options"  with  respect  to the
                                    portion of the Policy's  death benefits that
                                    become  payable  to the  beneficiary.  If no
                                    such  election is in effect at the Insured's
                                    death, the beneficiary  shall have the right
                                    to  elect  such  settlement   options.   The
                                    Corporation  shall  have a similar  right to
                                    elect a  settlement  option for the benefits
                                    attributable to its interest in the Policy.

Amendment Assignment                11. This Agreement may be altered,  amended,
                                    or modified,  including  the addition of any
                                    extra  Policy   provisions,   by  a  written
                                    agreement  signed  by the  parties  to  this
                                    Agreement  In  addition,  either  party  may
                                    assign   his/her   rights,   interests   and
                                    obligations  under this Agreement,  provided
                                    however,  that any assignment  shall be made
                                    subject to the terms of this Agreement

Binding Agreement                   12. This Agreement shall be binding upon the
                                    heirs, administrators, executors, successors
                                    and assigns of each party to this Agreement.

Validity                            13. In case any provision of this  Agreement
                                    shall be illegal or invalid  for any reason,
                                    said  illegality  or  invalidity  shall  not
                                    affect   the   remaining   Parts   of   this
                                    Agreement,   but  this  Agreement  shall  be
                                    construed and enforced as if such illegal or
                                    invalid provision had never been inserted in
                                    this Agreement.

No Contract of                      14.  The  terms  and   conditions   of  this
Employment                          Agreement  shall not be deemed to constitute
                                    a  contract   of   employment   between  the
                                    Corporation   and   the   Executive.    Such
                                    employment is hereby  acknowledged  to be an
                                    "at will" employment  relationship  that can
                                    be  terminated  at any time for any  reason,
                                    with  or  without  cause,  unless  expressly
                                    provided  in a separate  written  employment
                                    agreement.  Nothing in this Agreement  shall
                                    be deemed to give the Executive the right to
                                    be   retained   in   the   service   of  the
                                    Corporation  or to interfere  with the right
                                    of  the   Corporation   to   discipline   or
                                    discharge the Executive at any time.

                                        6
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan PLUS (KELP PLUS)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

Interpretation                      15. Where  appropriate  in  this  Agreement,
                                    words used in the singular shall include the
                                    plural and words used in the masculine shall
                                    include   the   feminine   and   vice-versa.
                                    Headings and subheadings are for convenience
                                    purposes  only  and  have no  effect  on the
                                    construction of the Agreement.  The internal
                                    laws of the State of  Arizona  shall  govern
                                    this Agreement

Entire Agreement                    16. This  Agreement  constitutes  the entire
                                    agreement  between the  parties  hereto with
                                    regard  to  the   subject   matter  of  this
                                    Agreement   and   supersedes   all  previous
                                    negotiations,  agreements and commitments in
                                    respect thereto. No oral explanation or oral
                                    information by either of the parties to this
                                    Agreement   shall   alter  the   meaning  or
                                    interpretation of this Agreement.


         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have signed this Agreement as of
the date first written above.


                                      ------------------------------------
                                      (Employee)

                                      ------------------------------------
                                      (Corporation)

- ---------------------------           ------------------------------------
(Witness)                             (By)


                                      Its:
                                          --------------------------------

                                        7
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan PLUS (KELP PLUS)
Split-Dollar Collateral Assignment - Equity Method

================================================================================

- ------------------------------                  --------------------------------
Policy Number                                   Insured

The original of this  Assignment  should be forwarded to the Home Office,  to be
retained  by the  Company  (hereafter  called  the  Insurer)  which  is Sun Life
Assurance Company of Canada.

The  undersigned  owner/applicant  of  the  policy  to  be  issued  pursuant  to
application number___________ and dated for insurance on the life of the insured
named above authorizes the Issuer to insert the policy number in this Assignment
after said policy is issued.

                                                 -------------------------------
                                                 Owner/Applicant

ASSIGNOR________________________________________________________________________
ASSIGNEE:         Del Webb Corporation
                  6001 N. 24th Street
                  Phoenix, AZ 85016

FOR VALUE  RECEIVED,  the  undersigned  owner  (hereafter  called the  assignor)
assigns,  t and sets over [0 the assignee,  its  successors or assigns,  certain
rights in the policy numbered above,  including any and all  supplemental  extra
benefit riders or agreements issued under said policy,  subject to all the terms
and conditions of the policy and this  Assignment and to all superior  liens, if
any,  which the Insurer or ally prior  assignee may have against this policy The
assignor by this t and the assignee by acceptance of this Assignment jointly and
severally  agree  10 the  conditions  and  provisions  herein  set  forth.  This
Assignment is made and the policy is to be held as  collateral  security for any
and all liabilities of the assignor to the assignee. either now existing or that
may hereafter  arise  between the assignor or any  successors or assigns and the
assignee in  conjunction  with a  Split-Dollar  arrangement  with regard to this
policy

1.(a)  It is expressly agreed that the assignee shall have the following rights:

         (1)  the right to make and  receive  loans  against  the  policy to the
              extent of aggregate premiums paid by the assignee;

         (2)  the right to release  this  Assignment  to the assignor or his/her
              assigns;


         (3)  the  right,  upon  14  days  advance  written  notice  to the t to
              surrender or  partially  surrender  the policy and to receive,  if
              such  surrender or partial  surrender  occurs within the five-year
              period immediately following the date of this Agreement,  the cash
              surrender value of the policy numbered above. if such surrender or
              partial  surrender  occurs after the five-year  period,  the right
              shall be limited to the cash  surrender  values (but not in excess
              of Aggregate Premiums, as defined below, paid by the assignee);

         (4)  the right to  receive  from the death  proceeds,  arid to elect an
              income settlement option with respect thereto,  an amount equal to
              the aggregate  premiums paid by the assignee until the date Of the
              insured's  death  plus  any  death  proceeds  paid by the  Insurer
              pursuant to the application numbered above, that exceed the amount
              payable to the Insured's named  beneficiary  based on the schedule
              of Death Benefits attached (see Appendix A).

                                        1
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan PLUS (KELP PLUS)
Split-Dollar Collateral Assignment - Equity Method

================================================================================

    (b)  Assignor  shall not have the right to make a loan against the policy or
         otherwise  have access to cash values unless and until such time as the
         Assignor's  employment is terminated or the Assignor's  interest in the
         Policy  terminates as modified by paragraph  1(a),  all other rights in
         the policy,  including  but not limited to the right to  designate  and
         change  the  beneficiary  and the right to receive  any cash  values in
         excess of aggregate premiums paid by the assignee,  are reserved to the
         assignor and excluded from this Assignment.

    (c)  Notwithstanding   any  other   provision  of  this  Assignment  or  the
         Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement entered into between assignor and
         assignee,  for all purposes,  the assignee shall furnish to the insurer
         an affidavit  specifying  the amount(s) to be paid, or the rights to be
         exercised,   by  each  party.   Both  the  assignor  and  the  assignee
         acknowledge that, between themselves, they are bound by the limitations
         of the  Assignment.  The insurer will  recognize  the  signature of the
         assignee  and the insurer is  authorized  to recognize  the  assignee's
         claims to rights granted by this Assignment  without  investigating the
         reason for any action  taken by the  assignee,  or the  validity or the
         amount of any  liabilities  or the  existence  of any default  therein.
         Payment by the Insurer of the sums set forth in the affidavit  shall be
         a full discharge and release therefor to the Insurer.

         This  assignment  does not impede or change the insuurer's  right under
         the "Policy  Loan"  provision to charge  interest on any policy loan if
         interest is not paid under the terms of the policy, the Insurer has the
         right to add such  interest to the unpaid loan from whatever cash value
         remains  regardless  of who owns that cash value under the terms of the
         Assignment.

2.   Aggregate  premiums  paid by the assignee  shall  include  premiums for any
     extra  benefit  riders or agreements  issued under this policy.  "Aggregate
     Premiums"  shall  mean  all  premiums  paid by the  Corporation,  including
     premiums paid for any extra benefit  riders or agreements  issued under the
     Policy and shall be  reduced by any  indebtedness  and any  accrued  unpaid
     inerest incurred by the Corporation on the Policy.

3.   Any death proceeds in excess of the amount payable to the assignee shall be
     paid by the Insurer to the bendiciary named under the policy.

4.   All  provisions  of  this   Assignment  are  binding  upon  the  executors,
     administrators, successors or assigns of the assignor.

5    All options and  designations  in effect as of the date of this  Assignment
     shall remain in effect unless specifically changed by this Assignment or by
     action taken thereafter consistent with the Assignment.

6    The insurer shall not be  responsible  for the  sufficiency  or validity of
     this  Assignment and is not a party to any  split-dollar  agreement (or any
     other similar agreernent) between the assignee and the assignor.


Signed at _____________________________   on ___________________________________
              (City and State)                              (Date)


- -------------------------------                ---------------------------------
Witness Signature                              Signature of Owner of Policy

                                       2

                                                                   Exhibit 10.33
Key Executive Life Plan 95


Number of Participants: 28

Total Initial Death Benefit: $8,500,000
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan 1995 (KELP '95)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

          THIS AGREEMENT, is made as of the _____ day of _______________,  19 by
and between Del Webb  Corporation,  and its successors and assigns,  of Phoenix,
Arizona, hereinafter called the Corporation, and ___________________________

          WHEREAS,   ____________________________,    hereinafter   called   the
Employee, has rendered service to the Corporation, and,

          WHEREAS,  the  Corporation  wishes to provide a death  benefit for the
Employee  and/or the  Employee's  designee  through the Key Executive  Life Plan
1995, and,

          WHEREAS, the Employee agrees to participate in such plan to the extent
hereinafter provided,

          NOW THEREFORE, it is mutually agreed that:

Insurance Policies                  1. In  furtherance  of the  purpose  of this
                                    Agreement, life insurance is to be purchased
                                    on the  life of  ___________________________
                                    hereinafter   called   the   Insured,   from
                                    Security  Life of Denver  Insurance  Company
                                    under Policy Number __________,  hereinafter
                                    called the Policy.

Security                            2.  As   security   for  the   Corporation's
                                    interest  in the Cash  Value of the  Policy,
                                    the  Employee  shall  execute,   on  a  form
                                    acceptable  to  the  insurance   company,  a
                                    collateral  assignment to the Corporation of
                                    certain  specified rights in the Policy,  as
                                    set forth in Article 5.  Except as  provided
                                    in  Article  5,  ownership  of the  Policy's
                                    rights,  including  but not  limited  to the
                                    right to name the  beneficiary,  shall  rest
                                    with the Employee.

Premiums                            3. All  premiums  due on the Policy shall be
                                    paid  by  the  Corporation.   However,   the
                                    Employee  shall  reimburse  the  Corporation
                                    each year in an amount  that is equal to the
                                    value,   as   determined   for  federal  tax
                                    purposes,  of the "economic benefit" derived
                                    by  the  Employee  from  the  Policy's  life
                                    insurance  protection.   The  Employee  will
                                    receive  Compensation  in addition to annual
                                    salary each year in an amount  equal to this
                                    reimbursement.

                                        1
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan 1995 (KELP '95)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

Termination                         4.   This   Agreement   shall    immediately
                                    terminate for any of the following  reasons:
                                    termination of the Employee's employment for
                                    any reason;  submission of written notice to
                                    terminate by either party to this  Agreement
                                    to  the  other  party;   the  death  of  the
                                    Insured;  or any  action by the  Corporation
                                    which would  impair,  reduce,  or defeat the
                                    Employee's  interest  in  the  Policy.  Such
                                    action by the Corporation  might include but
                                    is not limited to  surrender or lapse of the
                                    Policy for nonpayment of premiums.

                                         If  this  Agreement   terminates,   the
                                    Employee  shall have the right,  exercisable
                                    within 90 days,  to obtain a release  of the
                                    Corporation's  interest  in  the  Policy  by
                                    paying to the  Corporation  its  interest in
                                    the Policy as  determined  in Article  6(2).
                                    Upon receipt of such amount, the Corporation
                                    shall  either  transfer  the  Policy  to the
                                    Employee  or transfer  such  interest to the
                                    party   designated  by  the  Employee.   The
                                    Corporation  agrees to execute all documents
                                    necessary  to  transfer  the  Policy  to the
                                    Employee or his/her assigns. If the Employee
                                    does not timely  exercise  this  right,  the
                                    Corporation  may  exercise  its rights under
                                    Article 5.

Corporation's Rights                5.   Under  the  terms  of  the   collateral
                                    assignment  of the Policy,  the  Corporation
                                    shall have the following  rights:  the right
                                    to  receive,   upon   termination   of  this
                                    Agreement,    an   amount   equal   to   the
                                    Corporation's  interest in the Policy's Cash
                                    Value,  as  determined  in  accordance  with
                                    Articles 6(1) and 6(2); the right to release
                                    the  collateral  assignment;  the  right  to
                                    surrender or partially  surrender the Policy
                                    upon the giving of 14 days  advance  written
                                    notice of the Corporation's  exercise of its
                                    right to surrender the Policy; and the right
                                    to make and receive loans against the Policy
                                    to the extent of its  interest as defined in
                                    Article 6(4).

                                         Any rights to Policy values or proceeds
                                    in  excess  of  the  Corporation's  interest
                                    shall  be  owned by and  payable  to,  or as
                                    designated by, the Employee.

                                         Any    designation    or    change   of
                                    beneficiary   or  change  in   election   of
                                    settlement  options  or  exercise  of policy
                                    rights   shall  be  made   subject  to  this
                                    Agreement  and  the   Corporation's   rights
                                    hereunder.

                                        2
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan 1995 (KELP '95)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

                                         Policy rights shall be  exercisable  by
                                    the  sole  signature  of a  duly  authorized
                                    representative of the Corporation.

                                         The Corporation  agrees to refrain from
                                    making loans or partial  surrenders  against
                                    the  Policy  in an amount  greater  than its
                                    interest  under  the  Policy as  defined  in
                                    Article   6(4).   The  parties   agree  that
                                    Security Life of Denver Insurance Company is
                                    authorized  to recognize  the  Corporation's
                                    right  to  borrow   without  the   insurance
                                    company    being    responsible    for   the
                                    calculation  of  amounts   permitted  to  be
                                    borrowed  and without  investigation  of the
                                    validity  or  amount of the  request  by the
                                    Corporation to borrow. The sole signature of
                                    a  duly  authorized  representative  of  the
                                    Corporation  shall  be  sufficient  for  the
                                    exercise  of  the  Corporation's   right  to
                                    borrow  and  shall be a full  discharge  and
                                    release to Security Life of Denver Insurance
                                    Company.  The  Employee  shall  not have the
                                    right to make a loan  against  the Policy or
                                    otherwise  have access to cash values unless
                                    and  until  such  time  as  the   Employee's
                                    employment     is    terminated    or    the
                                    Corporation's   interest   in   the   Policy
                                    terminates   in    accordance    with   this
                                    Agreement.

Corporation's Interest              6. For  purposes  of  Articles  4 and 5, the
                                    amount  receivable by the  Corporation  upon
                                    (1) death of the Insured, (2) termination of
                                    this  Agreement  for reason other than death
                                    of the  Insured,  (3)  surrender  or partial
                                    surrender of the Policy,  or (4) exercise of
                                    the loan right by the  Corporation  shall be
                                    as follows:

                                         1. Upon  termination  of this Agreement
                                    resulting  from  death of the  Insured,  the
                                    Corporation's  share of the  Policy's  death
                                    proceed  shall  be an  amount  equal  to its
                                    Aggregate   Premiums  paid,  as  defined  in
                                    Article 6(5),  plus any death  proceeds paid
                                    under the  Policy  that  exceed  the  amount
                                    payable to the Insured's  named  beneficiary
                                    based  on  the  current  schedule  of  Death
                                    Benefits as set forth on Appendix A attached
                                    to this Agreement.

                                         2. Upon  termination  of this Agreement
                                    for  reasons  other  than  the  death of the
                                    Insured,  the  Corporation's  share  of  the
                                    Policy's Cash Value shall be an amount equal
                                    to its Aggregate  Premiums paid. The excess,
                                    if any, of the Policy's  Cash Value shall be
                                    paid to the Employee.

                                       3
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan 1995 (KELP '95)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

                                         3. Upon the Corporation's  surrender or
                                    partial   surrender   of   the   Policy   in
                                    accordance with Article 5, the Corporation's
                                    share of the Policy's Cash Value shall be an
                                    amount equal to its Aggregate Premiums paid.
                                    The  excess,  if any, of the  Policy's  Cash
                                    Value shall be paid to the Employee.

                                         4.If the Corporation  obtains any loans
                                    against the Policy,  the amount of the loans
                                    together with the interest  thereon shall at
                                    no time exceed the Aggregate Premiums paid.

                                         5. "Aggregate  Premiums" shall mean all
                                    premiums paid by the Corporation,  including
                                    premiums paid for any extra  benefit  riders
                                    or  agreements  issued  under the Policy and
                                    shall be reduced by any indebtedness and any
                                    accrued  unpaid  interest  incurred  by  the
                                    Corporation  on the Policy and the amount of
                                    any  Policy  dividends  used  to  reduce  or
                                    offset such  premiums.  "Cash  Value"  shall
                                    mean  the  guaranteed   cash  value  of  the
                                    Policy,  plus the cash value of any dividend
                                    additions  as of the date to which  premiums
                                    have  been  paid  and any  dividend  credits
                                    outstanding, and reduced by any indebtedness
                                    and any accrued unpaid interest  incurred by
                                    the Corporation on the Policy.

Application for Additional          7. Should the parties to this Agreement deem
Agreements or Riders                it desirable,  application may be made for a
                                    supplemental  agreement  or rider  providing
                                    for the  waiver  of Policy  premiums  in the
                                    event of the Insured's total disability. Any
                                    additional  premium   attributable  to  such
                                    agreement  or  rider  shall  be  paid by the
                                    Corporation.  Waived  premiums  shall not be
                                    treated as paid by the Corporation.

Named Fiduciary                     8. For purposes of the  Employee  Retirement
                                    Income Security Act of 1974, the Corporation
                                    is  the   "named   fiduciary"   of  the  Key
                                    Executive  Life  Plan  1995 for  which  this
                                    Agreement is hereby  designated  the written
                                    plan instrument.

Claims and Review                   9. At the Insured's  death,  the Corporation
Procedure                           and the  beneficiary  designated  to receive
                                    proceeds   shall   execute  such  forms  and
                                    furnish such other  documents or information
                                    as are required to receive payment under the
                                    Policy.  The Corporation  shall also furnish
                                    to Security Life of Denver Insurance Company
                                    an affidavit specifying

                                       4
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan 1995 (KELP '95)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================

                                    the amount of death proceeds  payable to the
                                    Corporation as defined in Article 6(1).

                                         With  respect  to  claims  against  the
                                    Corporation  arising  under this  Agreement,
                                    the following procedure shall be used:

                                         The  claimant  shall  file a claim  for
                                    benefits by  notifying  the  Corporation  in
                                    writing. If the claim is wholly or partially
                                    denied,  the  Corporation  shall  provide  a
                                    written notice within 90 days specifying the
                                    reason for the  denial,  the  provisions  of
                                    this  Agreement on which the denial is based
                                    and   additional   material  or  information
                                    necessary to receive benefits, if any. Also,
                                    such written notice shall indicate the steps
                                    to be  taken if a review  of the  denial  is
                                    desired.

                                         If a claim is  denied  and a review  is
                                    desired,   the  claimant  shall  notify  the
                                    Corporation  in writing within 60 days after
                                    receipt  of  written  notice  of a denial of
                                    claim. In requesting a review,  the claimant
                                    may  review  plan  documents  and submit any
                                    written issues and comments he/she feels are
                                    appropriate.   The  Corporation  shall  then
                                    review  the  claim  and  provide  a  written
                                    decision  within  60  days of  receipt  of a
                                    request for a review.  This  decision  shall
                                    state the specific  reasons for the decision
                                    and shall  include  references  to  specific
                                    provisions on which the decision is based.

                                    The   Corporation's   liability  under  this
                                    Agreement  shall not  exceed  the  amount of
                                    proceeds it has received  from the insurance
                                    company.

Payment of Proceeds                 10.  In  lieu of the  lump  sum  payable  at
                                    Insured's   death,   the  Employee  may,  in
                                    accordance   with  the   procedures  of  the
                                    insurance company, elect any of the optional
                                    modes of payment  for the death  proceeds as
                                    enumerated   in  the  Policy  and  known  as
                                    "settlement  options"  with  respect  to the
                                    portion of the Policy's  death proceeds that
                                    become  payable  to the  beneficiary.  If no
                                    such  election is in effect at the Insured's
                                    death, the beneficiary  shall have the right
                                    to  elect  such  settlement   options.   The
                                    Corporation  shall  have a similar  right to
                                    elect a  settlement  option for the proceeds
                                    attributable to its interest in the Policy.

                                        5
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan 1995 (KELP '95)
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

================================================================================
Amendment/Assignment                11. This Agreement may be altered,  amended,
                                    or modified,  including  the addition of any
                                    extra  Policy   provisions,   by  a  written
                                    agreement  signed  by the  parties  to  this
                                    Agreement.  In  addition,  either  party may
                                    assign   his/her   rights,   interests   and
                                    obligations  under this Agreement,  provided
                                    however,  that any assignment  shall be made
                                    subject to the terms of this Agreement.

Interpretation                      12.  Where  appropriate  in this  Agreement,
                                    words used in the singular shall include the
                                    plural and words used in the masculine shall
                                    include   the   feminine   and   vice-versa.
                                    Headings and subheadings are for convenience
                                    purposes  only  and  have no  effect  on the
                                    construction of the Agreement.  The internal
                                    laws of the State of  Arizona  shall  govern
                                    this Agreement.

          IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the parties  hereto have executed this Agreement
the day and year first here in above written.


                                       ---------------------------------
                                       (Assignor)


                                       ---------------------------------
                                       (Corporation)


- ------------------------------         ---------------------------------
(Witness)                              (By)


                                        6
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan 1995 (KELP '95)
Split-Dollar Collateral Assignment - Equity Method

================================================================================


- --------------------------                     ---------------------------------
Policy Number                                  Insured

The original of this  Assignment  should be forwarded to the Home Office,  to be
retained by the Company (hereafter called the Insurer) which is Security Life of
Denver Insurance Company.

The  undersigned  owner/applicant  of  the  policy  to  be  issued  pursuant  to
application  Part I number  ______________  and dated  ____________________  for
insurance  on the life of the  insured  named  above  authorizes  the Insurer to
insert the policy number in this Assignment after said policy is issued.


                                            ------------------------------------
                                            Owner/Applicant


ASSIGNOR________________________________________________________________________
ASSIGNEE:         Del Webb Corporation
                  2231 East Camelback Road, Suite 400
                  Phoenix, Arizona 85016

FOR VALUE  RECEIVED,  the  undersigned  owner  (hereafter  called the  assignor)
assigns,  transfers  and sets over to the assignee,  its  successors or assigns,
certain rights in the policy numbered above,  including any and all supplemental
extra benefit riders or agreements issued under said policy,  subject to all the
terms and  conditions  of the policy  and this  Assignment  and to all  superior
liens,  if any,  which the Insurer or any prior  assignee  may have against this
policy.  The assignor by this  instrument and the assignee by acceptance of this
Assignment  jointly and severally agree to the conditions and provisions  herein
set forth.  This  Assignment  is made and the policy is to be held as collateral
security for any and all liabilities of the assignor to the assignee, either now
existing or that may hereafter  arise between the assignor or any  successors or
assigns and the assignee in  conjunction  with a Split-Dollar  arrangement  with
regard to this policy.

1.(a)  It is expressly agreed that the assignee shall have the following rights:


  (1)  the right to make and receive  loans  against the policy to the extent of
       aggregate premiums paid by the assignee;

  (2)  the right to release this Assignment to the assignor or his/her assigns;

  (3)  the  right,  upon 14 days  advance  written  notice  to the  Insured,  to
       surrender  or  partially  surrender  the policy  and to receive  the cash
       values  and any  dividend  credits  outstanding  (but  not in  excess  of
       Aggregate Premiums (as defined below) paid by the assignee); and

  (4)  the  right to  receive  from the death  proceeds,  and to elect an income
       settlement option with respect thereto,  an amount equal to the aggregate
       premiums paid by the assignee until the date of the insured's  death plus
       any  death  proceeds  paid by the  Insurer  pursuant  to the  application
       numbered  above,  that exceed the amount  payable to the Insured's  named
       beneficiary  based  on the  schedule  of  Death  Benefits  attached  (see
       Appendix A).

                                        1
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Key Executive Life Plan 1995 (KELP '95)
Split-Dollar Collateral Assignment - Equity Method

================================================================================

    (b)  Assignor  shall not have the right to make a loan against the policy or
         otherwise  have access to cash values unless and until such time as the
         Assignor's  employment is terminated or the Assignor's  interest in the
         Policy  terminates.  Except as modified by  paragraph  1(a),  all other
         rights  in the  policy,  including  but not  limited  to the  right  to
         designate and change the  beneficiary and the right to receive any cash
         values and dividend credits outstanding in excess of aggregate premiums
         paid by the  assignee,  are reserved to the assignor and excluded  from
         this Assignment.

    (c)  Notwithstanding   any  other   provision  of  this  Assignment  or  the
         Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement entered into between assignor and
         assignee,  for all purposes,  the assignee shall furnish to the insurer
         an affidavit  specifying  the amount(s) to be paid, or the rights to be
         exercised,   by  each  party.   Both  the  assignor  and  the  assignee
         acknowledge that, between themselves, they are bound by the limitations
         of the  Assignment.  The Insurer will  recognize  the  signature of the
         assignee  and the insurer is  authorized  to recognize  the  assignee's
         claims to rights granted by this Assignment  without  investigating the
         reason for any action  taken by the  assignee,  or the  validity or the
         amount of any  liabilities  or the  existence  of any default  therein.
         Payment by the Insurer of the sums set forth in the affidavit  shall be
         a full discharge and release therefor to the Insurer.

         This assignment does not impede or change the Insurer's right under the
         "Policy  Loan"  provision  to charge  interest on any policy  loan.  If
         interest is not paid under the terms of the policy, the Insurer has the
         right to add such  interest to the unpaid loan from whatever cash value
         remains  regardless  of who owns that cash value under the terms of the
         Assignment.

    2.   Aggregate  premiums paid by the assignee shall include premiums for any
         extra benefit riders or agreements issued under this policy. "Aggregate
         Premiums"  shall mean all premiums paid by the  Corporation,  including
         premiums paid for any extra benefit  riders or agreements  issued under
         the Policy and shall be reduced  by any  indebtedness  and any  accrued
         unpaid  interest  incurred  by the  Corporation  on the  Policy and the
         amount of any Policy dividends used to reduce or offset such premiums.

    3.   Any death  proceeds  in excess of the amount  payable  to the  assignee
         shall be paid by the Insurer to the beneficiary named under the policy.

    4.   All  provisions  of this  Assignment  are binding  upon the  executors,
         administrators, successors or assigns of the assignor.

    5.   All  options  and  designations  in  effect  as of  the  date  of  this
         Assignment shall remain in effect unless  specifically  changed by this
         Assignment  or  by  action  taken   thereafter   consistent   with  the
         Assignment.

    6.   The Insurer shall not be responsible for the sufficiency or validity of
         this  Assignment and is not a party to any  split-dollar  agreement (or
         any other similar agreement) between the assignee and the assignor.

Signed______________________________________    at_____________________________
                (City and State)                            (Date)

                           SIGN ORIGINAL AND DUPLICATE



- ---------------------------------                -------------------------------
Witness Signature                                Signature of Owner of Policy


                                        2

                                                                   Exhibit 10.34

Group Term Carve-Out Plan


Number of Participants: 163

Total Current Death Benefit: $14,624,000
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Group Term Carve-Out Plan
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement - Endorsement Method

================================================================================

          THIS AGREEMENT is made as of the _____ day of _______________,  199_ ,
by and between Del Webb Corporation,  and its successors or assigns, of Phoenix,
Arizona,  hereinafter called the "Corporation",  and  __________________________
hereinafter called the "Employee".


                                    RECITALS:


A.        The Corporation is a corporation  duly organized and validly  existing
          under the laws of the state of its incorporation.

B.        The Employee is an employee of the Corporation.

C.        In  consideration  of the  performance of services by the Employee for
          the  Corporation,  the  Corporation  wishes to benefit the Employee by
          entering into a split-dollar life insurance  arrangement in accordance
          with the terms and conditions of this Agreement.

D.        The split-dollar arrangement provided for in this Agreement, which the
          parties intend to satisfy the requirements of Rev. Rul. 64-328, 1964-2
          C.B. 11, relates to a life insurance  policy number  ___________  (the
          "Policy") to be issued by Security  Life of Denver  Insurance  Company
          (the  "Insurer")  on the  life  of the  Employee  to be  owned  by the
          Corporation subject to an endorsement in favor of the Employee.

                  NOW, THEREFORE, the parties mutually agree as follows:

1.        Acquisition of Policy

          The parties. shall cooperate in applying for and obtaining the Policy.
          (The  Policy  shall be  issued  to the  Corporation  as owner  with an
          endorsement granting to the Employee the rights described in Article 4
          below.)

                                        1
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Group Term Carve-Out Plan
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement - Endorsement Method

================================================================================
2.        Payment of Premiums

          All  premiums  due on the  Policy  shall  be paid by the  Corporation.
          However,  the Employee  shall  reimburse the  Corporation in an amount
          such that the reimbursement for each year is equal to the value of the
          "economic benefit" of the life insurance protection in accordance with
          the principles set forth in Rev. Rul. 64-328,  1964-2 C.B. 11 and Rev.
          Rul. 66-110, 1966-1 C.B. 12. The Employee will receive compensation in
          addition  to  annual  salary  each  year in an  amount  equal  to this
          reimbursement.

3.        Corporation's Interest in Policy

          A.      The   Corporation's   Interest.   In   consideration   of  the
                  Corporation's   premium   payments   under  the   split-dollar
                  arrangement, the Corporation's interest in the Policy shall at
                  all times equal the amount  determined in accordance  with the
                  following  provisions.  The  Corporation  shall be entitled to
                  recover the Corporation's interest in the Policy in accordance
                  with the terms and conditions of this Agreement.

          B.      Termination of Agreement.  Upon termination of this Agreement,
                  the  Corporation's  interest in the Policy  shall be an amount
                  equal to the Cash Surrender Value (as hereinafter  defined) of
                  the Policy at such time.

          C.      Death  of  Insured.   Upon  the  death  of  the  Insured,  the
                  Employee's  designated  beneficiary's  interest  in the Policy
                  shall  be an  amount  equal to the  lesser  of one  times  the
                  Employee's  Basic Earnings or the policy death  proceeds.  The
                  Corporation  shall  receive  the  balance of the policy  death
                  benefits, if any.

          D.      Definitions. For purposes of this Agreement:

                  (i)      The Cash  Surrender  Value of the  Policy at any time
                           equals, at such time, the cash value set forth in the
                           Policy's table of values;  plus the cash value of any
                           paid-up  additions;  plus any dividend  accumulations
                           and unpaid  dividends;  less any policy  loans to the
                           Corporation  and  accrued  interest  thereon  at such
                           time.

                                        2
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Group Term Carve-Out Plan
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement - Endorsement Method

================================================================================

                  (ii)     Basic  Earnings  shall  be  determined  based  on the
                           definitions  set  forth in the Del  Webb  Corporation
                           Group Term Life Insurance Plan.

4.        Rights in the Policy

                  A.       Employee's  Rights. The Employee shall be entitled to
                           designate a beneficiary  under the Policy and elect a
                           settlement  option for death  proceeds  to be paid to
                           the  designated  beneficiary,   and  to  change  such
                           designations  or  elections at any time and from time
                           to time,  with  respect to that  portion of the death
                           proceeds as  determined  under  Article 3 above.  The
                           Policy   shall    contain   an    endorsement    (the
                           "Endorsement"),  in a form  acceptable to the parties
                           and the Insurer,  granting the Employee  such rights.
                           The Employee  shall be entitled to such other rights,
                           if any, as are  expressly  granted to the Employee or
                           the   Employee's   designated   beneficiary  in  this
                           Agreement or the Endorsement.

                  B.       Corporation's Rights. Except for those rights granted
                           to the Employee in this Agreement or the Endorsement,
                           the  Corporation  shall have all of the rights of the
                           owner under the Policy and the  Corporation  shall be
                           entitled to exercise all of such rights,  options and
                           privileges  without  the  consent  of  the  Employee;
                           provided,  however,  the  Corporation  agrees  not to
                           exercise  the right to  surrender  the Policy  except
                           following a Termination  Event and in compliance with
                           the provisions of Article 6 below.

                  C.       Conflict. As between the parties hereto, in the event
                           of any conflict  between the terms of the Endorsement
                           and this Agreement, the terms of this Agreement shall
                           prevail. The Insurer shall be bound, however, only by
                           the terms of the Policy and any endorsement thereto.

5.        Death of the Employee. In the event of the Employee's death while this
          Agreement is in force:

          A.      Corporation's  Recovery.  The Corporation shall be entitled to
                  recover out of the  proceeds of the Policy an amount  equal to
                  the  Corporation's  Interest in the Policy as determined under
                  Article 3 above.

                                        3
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Group Term Carve-Out Plan
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement - Endorsement Method

================================================================================

          B.      Beneficiary's   Recovery.  The  Employee's  beneficiary  shall
                  receive a death  benefit  equal to one  times  the  Employee's
                  Basic Earnings or the policy death proceeds if less.

          C.      Collection   of  Death   Proceeds.   Promptly   following  the
                  Employee's death, the parties shall cooperate in the filing of
                  a  death  claim  in  accordance  with  the  Insurer's   claims
                  procedures and shall request  distribution  to the Corporation
                  of the Corporation's Interest in the Policy and the balance of
                  the death  proceeds,  if any,  shall be paid by the Insurer to
                  the beneficiary designated by the Employee under the Policy.

6.        Termination of Agreement

          A.      Termination Events.  Subject to fulfillment of the obligations
                  arising upon termination hereinafter set forth, this Agreement
                  shall terminate on the first to occur of the following  events
                  (each referred to herein as a "Termination Event"):

                  (i)      Delivery  of written  notice of  termination  of this
                           Agreement by the Corporation to the Employee.

                  (ii)     Delivery  of written  notice of  termination  of this
                           Agreement by the Employee to the Corporation.

                  (iii)    Termination  of the  Employee's  employment  with the
                           Corporation for any reason, by either the Corporation
                           or the  Employee,  with or without  cause,  except as
                           indicated in 6.C.ii below.

          B.      Disposition of Policy Following a Termination Event.

                  Following a Termination Event prior to or upon reaching Normal
                  Retirement,  the Employee  shall have the option,  for fifteen
                  (15) business days after such Termination Event, to pay to the
                  Corporation  in  cash an  amount  equal  to the  Corporation's
                  Interest in the Policy as  determined  under  Article 3 above.
                  Upon receipt of such payment,  the Corporation  shall transfer
                  all of its right,  title, and interest in and to the Policy to
                  the Employee.

                                        4
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Group Term Carve-Out Plan
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement - Endorsement Method

================================================================================

                  If the Employee fails to exercise this option, the Corporation
                  shall be  entitled  to  surrender  the Policy or to remove the
                  Endorsement  from the Policy and  thereafter  to deal with the
                  Policy as the  Corporation  sees fit. The  Employee  agrees to
                  cooperate in the removal of the Endorsement  including signing
                  any   documents   requested  by  the  Insurer  in   connection
                  therewith.  The Employee hereby  authorizes the Corporation to
                  act on the Employee's behalf to sign all documents and to take
                  any  other  action  required  by the  Insurer  to  remove  the
                  Endorsement  following a Termination  Event. The Insurer shall
                  be  entitled  to  rely  on the  Corporation's  authority  upon
                  submission  by the  Corporation  of a photocopy of this signed
                  Agreement.

                  The  Corporation  shall  cooperate  in  effecting  any full or
                  partial policy surrender, policy loan, or surrender of paid-up
                  additions  requested by the Employee related to the Employee's
                  exercise of any option provided hereunder;  provided, however,
                  that the  Corporation's  Interest in the Policy is paid to the
                  Corporation in connection with such a transaction.

7.        Application of Policy Dividends

          Any Annual dividend attributable to the Policy shall be applied to the
          purchase of paid-up additions from the Insurer.

8.        Provision Regarding the Insurer

          The parties acknowledge and agree as follows:

          A.      Bound Only by Policy.  The Insurer  shall be bound only by the
                  provisions of the Policy and any endorsement thereto.

          B.      Discharge. Any payment made or actions taken by the Insurer in
                  accordance   with  the   provisions  of  the  Policy  and  any
                  endorsement thereto shall fully discharge the Insurer from all
                  claims, suits and demands of all persons whatsoever.

          C.      Insurer Not a Party.  The Insurer  shall not be deemed a party
                  to, or to have notice of,  this  Agreement  or the  provisions
                  hereof and shall have no obligation to see to the  performance
                  of the obligations of the parties hereunder.

                                        5
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Group Term Carve-Out Plan
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement - Endorsement Method

================================================================================

9.        Special Provisions

          In compliance with the requirements of the Employee  Retirement Income
          Security Act of 1974, as amended, the parties hereby confirm:

          A.      Named Fiduciary. The Corporation is the named fiduciary of the
                  split-dollar  life  insurance  plan of which this Agreement is
                  the written instrument.

          B.      Funding. The funding policy of the split-dollar life insurance
                  plan is that the  Corporation  will pay  that  portion  of the
                  premiums under the Policy required under Article 2 above.

          C.      ERISA Claims Procedures.  The following claims procedure shall
                  be utilized:

                  (i)      The  claimant  shall  file a claim  for  benefits  by
                           notifying the Corporation in writing. If the claim is
                           wholly or partially  denied,  the  Corporation  shall
                           provide  a written  notice  within  ninety  (90) days
                           specifying the reason for the denial,  the provisions
                           of this  Agreement on which the denial is based,  and
                           additional material or information, if any, necessary
                           for the  claimant to receive  benefits.  Such written
                           notice  shall also  indicate the steps to be taken by
                           the claimant if a review of the denial is desired.

                  (ii)     If a claim is  denied  and a review is  desired,  the
                           claimant  shall  notify  the  Corporation  in writing
                           within  sixty  (60) days  after  receipt  of  written
                           notice  of a  denial  of a  claim.  In  requesting  a
                           review,  the  claimant may review any  documents  and
                           submit any written  issues and  comments the claimant
                           feels are  appropriate.  The  Corporation  shall then
                           review  the  claim and  provide  a  written  decision
                           within  sixty (60) days of receipt of a request for a
                           review.   This  decision  shall  state  the  specific
                           reasons for the decision and shall include references
                           to specific  provisions  of this  Agreement,  if any,
                           upon which the decision is based.

                  (iii)    In no event shall the  Corporation's  liability under
                           this Agreement exceed the amount of proceeds from the
                           Policy.

                                        6
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Group Term Carve-Out Plan
Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement - Endorsement Method

================================================================================

10.       Disability  Waiver of Premiums.  The parties may, by mutual agreement,
          add an  agreement or rider to the Policy  providing  for the waiver of
          premiums  in the event of the  insured's  disability.  Any  additional
          premium  attributable  to such  agreement or rider shall be payable by
          the  Corporation in the proportion  that each  contributes to the base
          policy premiums under Article 2 for such period.

11.       Amendment.  This  Agreement  may  be  altered,  amended  or  modified,
          including the addition of any extra policy  provisions,  but only by a
          written instrument signed by all of the parties.

12.       Assignment.  A party may assign such party's interests and obligations
          under this  Agreement at any time subject to the terms and  conditions
          of this Agreement.

13.       Governing Law. This  Agreement  shall be governed by the internal laws
          of the State of Arizona.

14.       Entire  Agreement.  This Agreement sets forth the entire  agreement of
          the parties with  respect to the subject  matter  hereof.  Any and all
          prior  agreements or  understandings  with respect to such matters are
          hereby superseded.


          IN WITNESS WHEREOF,  the parties have signed and sealed this Agreement
as of the day and year first above written.


WITNESS:



- -------------------------------             ------------------------------------
Witness Signature                                Employee

ATTEST:                                          Del Webb Corporation

_______________________________             By: ________________________________
Witness Signature                                Signature of Representative of 
                                                 Del Webb Corporation

                                        7
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Group Term Carve-Out Plan
Designation of Beneficiary and Ownership Rights Form - Endorsement

================================================================================

Application or Policy No.:______________________________________________________

Insurer:                  Security Life of Denver Insurance Company

Insured:                  ______________________________________________________

Primary Owner:            Del Webb Corporation

Secondary Owner:          ______________________________________________________


I.       BENEFICIARIES

          (1)     The Secondary Owner shall designate a beneficiary for all or a
                  portion of the death  proceeds  that is equal to one times the
                  insured's  basic earnings  (Based on definitions  set forth in
                  the primary  owner's  group term life  insurance  plan) or, if
                  less, the entire death proceeds.

          (2)     The  beneficiary  of  any remaining  proceeds  (the "Remaining
                  Proceeds") shall be the Primary Owner.


II.      OWNERSHIP

          (3)     The owner of the policy shall be the Primary Owner,  who shall
                  have all  ownership  rights in the policy  except those rights
                  specifically granted to the Secondary Owner in paragraph (4).

          (4)     The Secondary  Owner shall own and have the right to designate
                  the  beneficiary  for that  portion of the death  proceeds set
                  forth in paragraph (1) that is to be paid to that beneficiary,
                  and to exercise all  settlement  options with respect to those
                  death proceeds.

                                        1
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Group Term Carve-Out Plan
Designation of Beneficiary and Ownership Rights Form - Endorsement

================================================================================

III.      AGREEMENT

          The undersigned  hereby agree that the Insurer may rely on the Primary
          Owner's signature alone as to any actions on the policy, including but
          not  limited to the amount  due to be paid to the  beneficiaries  upon
          death of the  insured.  Upon  payment  of any  proceeds  based on such
          signature,  the Insurer shall be fully discharged under the policy and
          the respective  recipients shall indemnify the Insurer to that effect.
          If the Insurer is made, or elects to become a party to any  litigation
          concerning  the  proper  apportionment  of  the  death  proceeds,  the
          Insurer's  litigation  expenses,  including  attorney  fees,  shall be
          deducted from the death proceeds.


IV.       SECONDARY OWNER'S AGREEMENT AND DESIGNATION OF BENEFICIARY.

          The Secondary Owner hereby agrees to the foregoing and, subject to the
          rights of the  Primary  Owner as stated  above,  designates  below the
          primary and contingent  beneficiaries of the death proceeds  described
          in paragraph (1).

          A primary or contingent  beneficiary  must survive the Insured to have
          or pass any rights to the death  proceeds.  If no primary  beneficiary
          survives the Insured, the death proceeds will be paid to the surviving
          contingent  beneficiary.  If no beneficiary  survives the Insured, the
          death proceeds will be paid to the Secondary  Owner's Estate. If there
          are two or more primary or contingent  beneficiaries,  death  proceeds
          will be  distributed  in equal shares to those  surviving the Insured.
          The beneficiary designation appearing on this form may be revoked, and
          new designations may be made.

V.        DIRECTIONS AND DESIGNATIONS: Check either box 1 below and complete the
          primary and contingent  beneficiary  designations or check box 2 below
          and complete the name of the spouse.


1.       [ ] PRIMARY BENEFICIARY(IES), of the Secondary Owner, are:

Full Name(s)                 Relationship to Insured             Date of Birth

- ---------------------------  ----------------------------------  ---------------

- ---------------------------  ----------------------------------  ---------------

- ---------------------------  ----------------------------------  ---------------


                                        2
<PAGE>
Del Webb Corporation
Group Term Carve-Out Plan
Designation of Beneficiary and Ownership Rights Form - Endorsement

================================================================================

If no primary beneficiary survives the Insured, CONTINGENT BENEFICIARY(IES) are:

Full Name(s)                Relationship to Insured              Date of Birth

- --------------------------- -----------------------------------  ---------------

- --------------------------- -----------------------------------  ---------------

- --------------------------- -----------------------------------  ---------------


2.       [ ] SPOUSE PRIMARY BENEFICIARY - CHILDREN OF THE MARRIAGE CONTINGENT
         BENEFICIARY:

         ____________________________   spouse  of  the  Insured.  Then  to  the
         children of the marriage.  The term  "children of the  marriage"  shall
         include  only  children  born of the  marriage  of the  Insured and the
         spouse named and those  legally  adopted by them.  It shall not include
         children of a different marriage


Signed this ____________ day of ___________________________ 19 _________



- --------------------------------                --------------------------------
         WITNESS                                         PRIMARY OWNER
                                                     (Authorized Corporate
                                                      Officer with Title)


- --------------------------------
         SECONDARY OWNER


                                        3

                                                                    Exhibit 21.0
                   ACTIVE SUBSIDIARIES AND ASSOCIATED ENTITIES
                                       OF
                              DEL WEBB CORPORATION
                              as of August 1, 1996

<TABLE>
<S>                                                              <C>
Asset One Corp.                                                  Sun City Georgetown Community Association,          
Asset Four Corp.                                                  Inc.  (Non-Profit)                                 
Asset Five Corp.                                                 Sun City Hilton Head Community                      
Coventry of California, Inc.                                      Association, Inc. (Non-Profit)                     
Del Webb Architectural Services, Inc.                            Sun City MacDonald Ranch Community                  
Del Webb California Corp.                                         Association, Inc. (Non-Profit)                     
Del Webb Commercial Properties Corporation                       Sun City Palm Springs Charities, Inc. (Non-Profit)  
Del Webb Communities, Inc.                                       Sun City Palm Desert Community Association          
Del Webb Communities of Nevada, Inc.                              (Non-Profit)                                       
Del Webb Community Management Co.                                Sun City Roseville Community Association, Inc.      
Del Webb Conservation Holding Corp.                               (Non-Profit)                                       
Del Webb Construction Services Co.                               Sun City Sales Corporation                          
Del Webb Home Construction, Inc.                                 Sun City Summerlin Charities, Inc. (Non-Profit)     
Del Webb Homes, Inc.                                             Sun City Summerlin Community Association, Inc.      
Del Webb Limited Holding Co.                                      (Non-Profit)                                       
Del Webb Midatlantic Corp.                                       Sun City Title Agency Co.                           
Del Webb Property Corp.                                          Sun State Insulation Co., Inc.                      
Del Webb Southwest Co.                                                                                               
Del Webb Texas Limited Partnership                               Terravita Commercial Corp.                          
Del Webb Texas Title Agency Co.                                  Terravita Community Association  (Non-Profit)       
                                                                 Terravita Corp.                                     
Del Webb's Contracting Services, Inc.                            Terravita Home Construction Co.                     
Del Webb's Contracting Services of                               Terravita Marketplace L.L.C.                        
 Tucson, Inc.                                                    The Villages at Desert Hills, Inc.                  
Del Webb's Coventry Homes Construction Co.                       Trovas Company                                      
Del Webb's Coventry Homes, Inc.                                  Trovas Construction Co.                             
Del Webb's Coventry Homes of Nevada, Inc.                        
Del Webb's Coventry Homes Construction of
 Tucson Co.
Del Webb's Coventry Homes of Tucson, Inc.
Del Webb's Stetson Hills, Inc. (Soon to be known
 as Del Webb Communities of Nevada, Inc.)
Del Webb's Sun City Realty, Inc.

Del E. Webb Cactus Development Corp.
Del E. Webb Development Co., L.P.
Del E. Webb Finance Company
Del E. Webb Financial Corporation
Del E. Webb Foothills Corporation
Del E. Webb Glen Harbor Development
 Corporation
Del E. Webb Land Conservancy (Non-Profit)

DW Aviation Co.
Fairmount Mortgage, Inc.
The Foothills Community Association (Non-Profit)

Marina Operations Corp.
New Mexico Asset Corporation
New Mexico Asset Limited Partnership
</TABLE>
                                        i

               CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT CERTIFIED PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS



The Board of Directors
Del Webb Corporation:


We consent to incorporation  by reference in the  Registration  Statements (Nos.
33-12023, 2-78336, 33-32309,  33-10228,  33-46720,  33-46704, 33-6564, 33-52725,
33-65161  and  33-65163  on Forms S-8 and No.  33-60089 on Form S-3) of Del Webb
Corporation  of our report dated August 16, 1996,  relating to the  consolidated
balance sheets of Del Webb  Corporation and subsidiaries as of June 30, 1996 and
1995 and the related consolidated statements of operations, shareholders' equity
and cash  flows and  related  schedule  for each of the years in the  three-year
period ended June 30, 1996 which  appears in the June 30, 1996 annual  report on
Form 10-K of Del Webb  Corporation.  Our report refers to a change in the method
of accounting for long-lived assets.




                                                KPMG Peat Marwick LLP

Phoenix, Arizona
September 10, 1996

<TABLE> <S> <C>

<ARTICLE>                    5
<LEGEND>
                             THIS   SCHEDULE    CONTAINS    SUMMARY    FINANCIAL
                             INFORMATION EXTRACTED FROM THE CONSOLIDATED BALANCE
                             SHEET  AS OF JUNE  30,  1996  AND THE  CONSOLIDATED
                             STATEMENT OF  OPERATIONS  FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED
                             JUNE 30, 1996 AND IS  QUALIFIED  IN ITS ENTIRETY BY
                             REFERENCE TO SUCH FINANCIAL STATEMENTS.
</LEGEND>
<MULTIPLIER>                 1,000
<CURRENCY>                   U.S. DOLLARS
                             
<S>                          <C>
<PERIOD-TYPE>                12-MOS
<FISCAL-YEAR-END>                                                 JUN-30-1996
<PERIOD-START>                                                    JUL-01-1995
<PERIOD-END>                                                      JUN-30-1996
<EXCHANGE-RATE>                                                             1
<CASH>                                                                 18,340
<SECURITIES>                                                                0
<RECEIVABLES>                                                          25,162
<ALLOWANCES>                                                                0
<INVENTORY>                                                           899,815
<CURRENT-ASSETS>                                                            0
<PP&E>                                                                 51,092
<DEPRECIATION>                                                         23,493
<TOTAL-ASSETS>                                                      1,024,795
<CURRENT-LIABILITIES>                                                       0
<BONDS>                                                               514,677
                                                       0
                                                                 0
<COMMON>                                                                   18
<OTHER-SE>                                                            264,758
<TOTAL-LIABILITY-AND-EQUITY>                                        1,024,795
<SALES>                                                             1,045,852
<TOTAL-REVENUES>                                                    1,050,733
<CGS>                                                                 850,187
<TOTAL-COSTS>                                                         850,342
<OTHER-EXPENSES>                                                      212,315
<LOSS-PROVISION>                                                            0
<INTEREST-EXPENSE>                                                          0
<INCOME-PRETAX>                                                       (11,924)
<INCOME-TAX>                                                           (4,173)
<INCOME-CONTINUING>                                                    (7,751)
<DISCONTINUED>                                                              0
<EXTRAORDINARY>                                                             0
<CHANGES>                                                                   0
<NET-INCOME>                                                           (7,751)
<EPS-PRIMARY>                                                           (0.44)
<EPS-DILUTED>                                                               0
        

</TABLE>


© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission